Jail Code
Jail Code
Jail Code
OF BANGLADESH
REVISED EDITION.
SUPERINTENDENT,GOVERNMENT PRINTING PRESS,
BANGLADESH.
2006
Volume I (Part I)
The Bangladesh Jail Code.
Rules for the Superintendence and Management of
Jails in Bangladesh.
(Published under the authority of Government)
CHAPTER I- INTRODUCTORY.
1. The following Acts and Regulations regulate the establishment and management of jails, the
confinement and treatment of persons therein and the maintenance of discipline amongst them :-
(1) The Prisons Act, No. IX 1894 as amended.
(2) The Prisoners Act, No. III of 1900 as amended.
(3) Act VIII of 1897, the Reformatory School Act.
(4) Act IV of 1912, the Lunacy Act.
(5) Act No. XXXIII of 1920.
(6) Act No. I of 1928, the Borstal School Act.
(7) Act IV of l965, the Factories Act.
(8) The Childrens Act XXXIX of 1974.
Those provisions of the Civil Procedure Code (Act V of 1908), and as amended thereafter, the
Criminal Procedure Code (Act V of 1898), as modified up to date, and the Penal Code (Act XLV of 1860)
as amended, which relate to the confinement of prisoners of all classes, the execution of sentences,
appeals, lunatics and the like, must also be complied with in connection with prison administration.
Note :- All the above Acts, except, the Childrens Act of 1974, the Code of Civil and Criminal the
Procedure and Bangladesh Penal Code, are printed in Volume II of this Code.
CHAPTER II CLASSIFICATION OF JAILS.
2. The following are the classes of jails established in the different Districts of Bangladesh :-
I. Central jails for the confinement of prisoners both convicted and under trial and also
prisoners of other categories.
II. District Jails at the headquarters of districts for the confinement of prisoners of all categories
including criminal, civil prisoners and detenus. The long term Prisoners with sentences
exceeding 10 years shall be transferred to the Central Jails. But whenever required under
Special Circumstances the long term Prisoners above the sentences of 10 (ten) years may be
kept confined in District Jails under the orders of the Inspector General of Prisons.
III. Deleted.
IV. Special jails for the confinement of Special or any other classes of prisoners as determined
by the Government.
G.O. No. 3. The following are the Central Jails in the Country:-
1964
(I) Dhaka Central Jail
PJ., dated
(II) Rajshahi Central Jail
the
(III) Comilla Central Jail
8th June 1929
(IV) Jessore Central Jail
(V) Mymensingh Central Jail
(VI) Sylhet Central Jail
(VII) Rangpur Central Jail
(VIII) Chittagong Central Jail
(IX) Barisal Central Jail
(X) Kashimpur Central Jail (Unit -1)
(XI) Kashimpur Central Jail (Unit-2).
These Central Jails are likewise District Jails and therefore receive prisoners of all
classes. However, Government may declare any District Jail as Central Jail if necessary
from time to time.
2
G of 4. An allowance may be drawn by a medical officer for the administrative charge of a
B.No.6514 district jail. For the purpose of determining this allowance, district jails will be divided
p., dated the into four classes according to the mean daily average of the prisoners under confinement
16th during the previous year, viz. :-
December
1912. First class district jails.Those which contained during the previous year a mean daily
average of 500 or more prisoners.
Second class district jails-Those which contained during the previous year a mean daily
average of not less than 300 and not more than 499 prisoners.
Third class district jails. Those which contained during the previous year a mean daily
average of not less than 150 and not more than 299 prisoners.
Fourth class district jails.- Those which contained during the previous year a mean daily
average of more than 50 and less than 150 prisoners.
G. of I. No. The class of each jail will not necessarily be constant but will be determined each
217, year in the month of April by the Inspector General in accordance with the average of the
dated the 29th preceding calendar year for observance during the current financial year. Whenever the
September status of a district jail is altered under this rule from a lower to a higher class, the
1908 and No.
Inspector-General is empowered to sanction the entertainment of the additional staff of
174 dt. the 2nd
June 1909.
warders necessitated by such alteration, provided that the financial grant under the head
Establishment is not thereby exceeded.
5.Deleted.
6. In order to ease congestion in Central jails short term convicts or any other categories of prisoners may
be kept confined in the District Jails as and when decided by the Inspector General of Prisons.
7. The law provides that Civil prisoners shall be kept separate from criminal prisoners in any part of a
District or Central jail in isolation.
8. Deleted.
Section 6 Act 9. For every Central Jail there shall be Senior Superintendent, Deputy Superintendent,
IX 1894. Chief Medical Officer, Medical Officers, Lady Medical Officer, a Jailor, Deputy Jailors
and such other officers and staff as the Government thinks necessary.
For the District Jails there shall be a whole time Superintendent, Chief Medical
Officer, Medical Officer, a Jailor, Deputy Jailors, and other officers and staff as
determined by the Government from time to time.
10. Deleted.
11. Deleted.
12. Deleted.
13. Deleted.
14. Charge allowance is admissible to a member of the jail staff if placed in executive charge of any
category of jails as per Government Rules.
15. An Officer discharging the current duties during the temporary absence of the Senior Superintendent
or Superintendent of any jail is not held to be in collateral charge.
16. Deleted.
17. No permanent establishment shall be entertained without the special sanction of Government. Nor is
the employment of any temporary establishment permissible without the previous sanction of the
Inspector General under rule 18, except as authorized in rules 18, 28, 912, 948, 983 and 1258.
3
Extra establishment.
Jail Circulars 18. Whenever for any sufficient reason Senior Superintendent of Central Jail or
38 of 1893 Superintendent of District jail considers it necessary to entertain any establishment in
and No. 18 of excess of the sanctioned scale, he shall submit an application to the Inspector General of
1907. Prisons in Bangladesh Jail Return No. 15, giving full particulars of any extra
establishment already sanctioned and details of the establishment on leave or otherwise
Rule 1355. not available. As a general rule the employment for guarding condemned prisoners or for
keeping company with under trial prisoners will not, unless for very strong reasons fully
Bengal Form stated, be permitted. In no case may the extra establishment be entertained without fresh
No. 5152. sanction after the period for which sanction was given has expired.
In case of serious illness of a prisoner requiring his immediate removal to an
outside Hospital for treatment, when the previous sanction of the Inspector General
cannot be obtained, the Superintendent may, subject to immediate reference to the
Inspector General, entertain in anticipation of sanction, such number of extra warders as
he may consider necessary.
19. Deleted.
20. 20. Deleted.
CHAPTER III- GENERAL SUPERVISION.
Section 5, 21. The Inspector General of Prisons shall be appointed by the Government. The post
Act IX, 1894. shall be filled up as per Recruitment Rules.
Rule 72. 22. The general control and superintendence of jails are vested in him and all Magistrates
Rules 44,50 and jail officers shall obey the orders issued by him in all matters relating to the internal
economy, discipline, and management of jails. He shall ascertain that all rules and
regulations relating to jails are strictly enforced. Any infringement on the part of
Magistrates or Senior Superintendents/Superintendents of jails of the rules or of the orders
of the Inspector General, if continued after attention has been called to it, shall be brought
by the Inspector General to the notice of Government.
23. He shall exercise full control over all expenditure in Jails, submitting annually to Government a budget
of the amount of funds necessary for their maintenance in such manner and at such time as may be
required.
24. All monthly and other bills for jail expenses of every description shall be submitted to and audited by
him with the exception of
(a) Charges for Public Works which are regulated by the Public Works Department;
(b) Charges for Registers and Forms supplied by the Forms Departments;
(c) Charges for Medical Stores supplied by the Medical Store Department.
G. Of I. Resn. 25. The financial powers of the Inspector General of Prisons shall be exercised in
No. 5829-5876- accordance with delegation of financial power declared by Government from time to time.
11 dated the 24th
July 1913.
Rules 1340,
1360.
G.O. No. 4854
P.J., dated the
28th November
1935.
To consider later
on.
See Art. 227, 26. The Inspector General without reference to Government is empowered to write off
C.A. Code, and
4
G. of B. Circular finally the irrecoverable value of stores or public money due to losses on account of fraud,
No. 28F.,dated theft or the negligence of individuals or other causes, subject to the conditions that -
the 29the July
1910. G.O. No.
5198-P.J., dated (1) The loss in any specific case does not exceed Tk. 30,000/-
the 9th (2) The loss does not disclose a defect of system, the amendment of which requires the
November 1932 orders of Government; and
Rule 1378(3)
(3) That there has not been any serious negligence on the part of some individual officer
or officers, which might possibly call for disciplinary action.
27. Deleted.
28. 28. He has the authority to sanction in case of necessity and subject to budget
provision temporary appointment of extra staff in the initial scale of pay in National
Grade of Pay for a period not exceeding one year. This does not however, authorise him to
create any temporary post in his own office.
29. He is also empowered, subject to budget provision to grant rewards up to an
amount not exceeding Tk 50,000/- in each case to an officer of Jail Department for
special work of an occasional character when the work is, in the opinion of the Inspector
General, either so laborious or of such special merit as to justify a special reward.
Note. - He may also authorize by general or special orders Senior Superintendents
or Superintendents of Jails to employ temporary female warders to escort or to keep
convicted or under trial female prisoners company on the existing scale of pay for periods
not exceeding three months at a time provided that necessary provision has been made in
the budget.
30. 29. All recruitment in the Prisons Department shall be made in accordance with provision of the
recruitment rules.
29.1 He may transfer, any Jail subordinate in which case he is the appointing authority. He shall award
punishment to these subordinates as per rule 194 in this Code and Government Servant Discipline and
Appeal Rule 1985.
Rule 843 30. He is vested with the powers of ordering the transfer of prisoners from one Jail to
another within the Country under the provision of section 29(2) of Act III of 1900.
Rule 840.
He is also authorized to sanction the removal of prisoners of all classes from the
permanent building of any Jail into temporary quarters during epidemic or natural
calamities. The place or places to which such prisoners are transferred shall be declared
by the Government on the recommendation of the Inspector General of Prisons as a
temporary prison within the meaning of Rule 3 of Act IX of 1894 (Prisons Act).
Rule 77. 31. The Inspector General of Prisons shall inspect every Central Jail once a year and every
District Jail at least once in every two years and oftener, if necessary. During each
inspection he shall see the yards, wards, cells and other enclosures. He shall also see every
prisoner in the Jail at the time of his inspection, and give every prisoner the opportunity of
making any application or complaint he may wish to make and shall enquire into and
determine all such matters as relate to Jail discipline. He shall also satisfy himself that all
accounts, registers and records are maintained according to rules in force, and that proper
arrangements are made for the safe custody of all records.
He shall also give patient hearing to the complaints or grievances of any
subordinate staff during his inspection and shall take any such step to ameliorate such
grievance/ complaints of the staff where he considers genuine.
32. Immediately, after the inspection of each Jail he shall record/enter in the Visitors Book of the Jail a
brief memorandum of the state in which he found the jail, of the manner in which it is administered, and
any suggestions or order to the Senior Superintendent or Superintendent he may deem necessary. If the jail
is in an unsatisfactory state a copy of the memorandum, with any explanation of the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent and the District Magistrate (if the Jail is not a Central Jail) shall be
submitted for the information and orders of the Government.
5
33. He shall submit to the Government annually, as soon after the commencement of the official year as
possible, and not later than the 30 th April, a detailed report of the jail administration for the previous and
calendar year, giving statistics of the prisoners in such forms as may be prescribed by the Government,
together with any necessary comments thereon and his remarks on every point of jail management. In his
annual report the Inspector-General shall briefly state what inspections he made in the course of the year,
and what was the general result of such inspections.
34. He shall exercise the powers of a Magistrate of the Ist Class within the limits of every jail in his
jurisdiction.
35. He shall be an ex-officio visitor of all Mental Hospitals and the Correctional Centers for young
offenders in the country.
Rule1045, 36. Section 30 (1) of the Lunacy Act, 1912 (IV 1912), provides that the Inspector
1244. G. of General shall at least once in six months inspect and submit a report upon every person
B. letter No. confined in a jail under the provisions of section 466 or section 471 of the Criminal
2240 J., date Procedure Code; and sections 473 and 474 of the Criminal Procedure Code empower the
the 20th July Inspector General of Prisons to grant certificates in certain cases. Under Section 471(2) of
1886. the Criminal Procedure Code and section 30(2) of the Lunacy Act, 1912, the Government
can empower the Senior Superintendent or Superintendent of the jail to perform any or
all of these functions. Provided, authority has been so conveyed.
37. The Inspector General of Prisons shall be the medium of communication between Government and
every officer of the Department, and except in cases specially excepted, every communication from any
officer of the Department intended for the perusal of Government, shall be submitted through him.
38. The postal address of the Inspector General is Prisons Directorate, Bangladesh to which must be
added the name of the place or station.
Section-IA
The Additional Inspector General of Prisons.
38.1 There shall be an Additional Inspector General of Prisons who shall be placed immediate next to
Inspector General of Prisons. The post of Additional Inspector General of Prisons shall be filled up as per
Recruitment Rules.
The following are the powers and functions of the Additional Inspector General of Prisons: -
(a) In the absence of the Inspector General of Prisons on the occasion of tour, leave and illness he shall
exercise all powers of the Inspector General of Prisons.
(b) He shall superintend all works of the officers of the Prisons Directorate and shall grant casual leave
of the officers.
(c) He shall exercise the power of transfer of class III employees posted in Jails except Deputy Jailors in
applicable cases.
(d) He shall represent the Inspector General of Prisons in different meetings/forums.
(e) He shall inspect at least four Central Jails and eight District Jails in a year and oftener if necessary
and submit report to the Inspector General of Prisons within 7(seven) days of the inspection. The
Inspector General of Prisons shall take such action as deemed proper, on the inspection report as
soon as possible.
(f) He is empowered to accord sanction to the removal of the prisoners from one Division to another.
(g) In case in which a convict has undergone in Jail a period of detention amounting together with
remission earned to 20 years shall be arranged for submission to Government for orders.
(h) He shall assist the Inspector General of Prisons in the disposal of the appeal preferred by the Head
Warders/Warders/ Female Warders.
(i) He shall as a member of the Tender Accepting Committee of the Prisons Department perform
responsibility and shall assist the Inspector General of Prisons in the disposal of the tenders.
(j) He is empowered to transfer Head Warders/Warders/Female Warders from one Division to another.
(k) He is empowered to grant earned leave up to one month (including Recreation Leave) to all class III
employees except Head Warders/ Warders/Female Warders.
(l) He shall perform the responsibilities as assigned by the Government and the Inspector General of
Prisons and render assistance to Inspector Generals of Prisons as and when necessary in the
management of the prisons administration.
6
Section IB
He shall also supervise industrial sections of the Jails and take all possible steps for the
expansion and improvement of the prisons Industries in order to create employment
opportunities for prisoners and impart vocational training to as many numbers of prisoners as
possible for their re-socialization.
In addition to the powers elsewhere prescribed in the Jail Code Rules, he will also exercise
the following powers (for the performance of duties) and functions (as Deputy Inspector
General of Prisons) :-
(a) To accord sanction to the transfer of all categories of prisoners excepting detenus from one jail to
another within the Division.
(b) Sanction of casual Leave to Senior Superintendent of Central Jail, Superintendent of Dist Jail
and Medical Officer with in the Division. Grant of leave to subordinate staff up to the rank of
Deputy Jailors for a period not exceeding one month at a time for whom no substitute is
necessary.
(c) Sanction to removal of sick prisoners of jails of the Division in case of necessity if and when
proposed by the Senior Superintendent of Central Jail or Superintendent of District Jail as the
case may be on the recommendation of the Medical Officer to outside Hospital. But in emergent
cases the sick prisoner should be removed to the outside Hospital and subsequent approval from
Deputy Inspector General of Prisons of the Division shall be obtained in case of the Central and
District Jails.
(d) Grant of permission to well-behaved convicts and under trial prisoners of Jails to appear at the
University and other examinations.
(e) (i) Approval to the forfeiture of remission of the prisoners up to the period of 30 days
(ii) Approval to the exclusion of the convicted prisoner from remission system up to 6 months for
committing serious offence.
(f) Approval of separate confinement of prisoners in excess of 30 days and up to 45 days.
(g) Powers to dispense with medical certificate of subordinate staff in case of grant of leave to such
staff on medical ground subject to the approval of the Inspector General of Prisons in case he
(Inspector General of Prisons) is the appointing authority.
(h) Sanction subject to the prescribed conditions to the employment of prisoners having more than
12 months unexpired portion of sentence but not exceeding 18 months in extramural labour.
(i) Supervision of the reformatory activities of the prisoners within the Division.
(j) Supervision of Industrial activities in jails of the Division and suggest measures for development
of the Industries in Jails specially for imparting vocational training to the long term convicted
prisoners on different trades for their re-integration in the society after release.
(k) Control and distribution of budget grant to the Jails as and when placed at his disposal.
(l) Countersigning of the contract deeds of the District Jails.
(m) Sanction to Annual contractual agreement made by the Superintendents of Jails except Central
Jails in the Division regarding supplies for Jail Manufactures. All formalities in regard to tender
and contract should be invariably observed.
7
(n) Ensure timely meeting and the follow up activities of Tender Evaluation Committee (TEC), of
the jails of his Division, to be constituted by the Head of the Procuring Entity (HOPE) as per
Public Procurement Regulations-2003.
(o) He is empowered to
(i) Grant reward to the subordinate staff of the Division up to an amount not exceeding Tk. 1500/-
in each case for exceptionally good work.
(ii) Grant reward to the subordinate staff up to an amount not exceeding Taka 1500/-for recapture of
a prisoner of any jail of the Division.
(iii) Sanction of reward up to the maximum of Tk.1000/- subject to the prescribed conditions to
custodial staff on the result of annual Target Practice.
(iv) Countersignature of Traveling Allowance bill of Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of Jails
and all other subordinate staff up to Head Warders of the Division.
(v) Sanction of pension to Jail subordinate staff up to Head Warders.
(vi) Sanction of all charges as per delegation of financial power under the Government Order No.
MF/FD/EC-1/DP-1/2000/ 64 dated 07-3-2000 subject to the amendment of rules in this regard
(vii) Sanction of full charges for remitting pay and allowances.
(viii) Sanction subject to rules laid down in this regard full charges on account of copying and
translation.
(ix) Sanction to the purchase of books and newspapers for any jail of the Division subject to the
budget provision up to an amount of Taka-5000/-.
(x) Entertainment of contingent establishment in jails of the Division as per rule.
Changed He is authorized to sanction ordinary and special repairs of each departmental structure to
G.O. to be an amount not exceeding Tk. 5000/- in each case.
issued. The Deputy Inspector General shall inspect every Central Jail once in a
Amount month, District jail at least thrice a year under the Division and oftener, if necessary, and
changed, submit report to the Inspector General of Prisons within 7 (seven) days of the inspection.
G.O. to be The Inspector General of Prisons shall take such action as deemed proper, on the
issued. Inspection Report as soon as possible.
The Deputy Inspector General of Prisons shall make an enquiry of the case
B.O. No. IM- like incidents of escape of prisoners or any other matter relating to serious breach of Jail
20/84/540/ discipline on the part of the staff of the prisons as and when occur and submit report to the
Mins/HA Inspector General of Prisons with his comments as early as possible of the enquiry.
(Admn.)
dated He shall exercise administrative as well as financial powers as enumerated in
23.4.1985 page 32 to 47 of the Standing Order Book, published by the Ministry of Home Affairs.
Section IIA.
40. The Deputy Inspector General of Prisons (Headquarters) shall be posted in the Prisons Directorate.
a.To assist to the Inspector General of his day to day functions and attend meeting in other departments on
the directive of Inspector General of Prisons.
b. To hold inquires into the allegations and conduct departmental proceedings against the subordinates as
an when asked for by the Inspector General of Prisons.
8
Section II B
40.1 The Assistant Inspector General of Prisons
HIS POWERS AND FUNCTIONS.
a. To assist the Inspector General of Prisons in his day to day functions and attend meeting in other
departments as and when asked for by the Inspector General of Prisons.
b. He shall be responsible for the whole business of branches/cells assigned to him.
c. To perform any other duties assigned by the Inspector General of Prisons.
d. He shall inspect the Industrial Section of Jails and when required by Inspector General of Prisons and
suggest progress and improvement of the Industries, especially for imparting vocational training to the
prisoners for their re-integration in the society.
41. The Administrative Officer shall be appointed as per approved Recruitment Rules. He will work under
Assistant Inspector General of Prisons (Admn).
43. One Jail show Room shall be established for the sale of articles of jail manufactures in all the Central
and District Jails of the Country. This shall be under the charge of a Store keeper who will be responsible
for safe keeping of the stores and cause pecuniary transaction in connection with disposal of jail
manufactures. The show room shall be conducted in accordance with the rules relating to jail
manufactures. He shall be assisted by a salesman.
43.1. The Jail show Room should run under the direct supervision of the respective Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent of the Jails. The Deputy Inspector General of prisons-in-charge of Industries shall visit the
Industrial section of the jails and jail show rooms and submit his report to the Inspector General of
Prisons.
Section V
The Magistrate of the District.
44. The District Magistrate shall have general control and supervision over a District Jail. In emergent
cases the District Magistrate may exercise control over the District jail should he consider it necessary to
do so, in consultation with the Inspector General of Prisons. The Superintendent shall have control over
details of management of the jail and shall solve any major problems faced by him in course of
management of the jail in consultation with District Magistrate subject to the approval of the Inspector
General of Prisons. The Superintendent will correspond direct with the Inspector General of Prisons who
will communicate his orders without reference to the District Magistrate. In case of a Central Jail the
Control of the District Magistrate shall be limited to the Prisoners belonging to his District only.
45. Deleted.
46. The District Magistrate shall not address any communication or order to any officer of any jail other
than the Superintendent. All orders issued by the District Magistrate shall be in writing and shall ordinarily
be issued in the form of an entry in the Visitors Minute Book (Bangladesh Form No. 4980).
47. The District Magistrate is not required to interfere in matters of detail affecting the management of jail.
He should avoid action having a tendency to weaken the authority of the Superintendent over subordinate
officers and prisoners.
9
48. The District Magistrate shall visit the District Jail (if not also a Central Jail) at least once a month. If
from any cause he is unable to visit the jail personally he may depute the Additional District Magistrate to
visit the jail.The date of the District Magistrates order of deputation shall be quoted by the officer so
deputed in the remarks made by him in the visitors Minute Book.
49. When the District Magistrate is absent on tour from headquarters, the officer in charge of the station
for the time being, shall perform the duties of the District Magistrate with regard to the jail, subject to any
instruction which the District Magistrate may give.
Rule 22. 50. The District Magistrate shall, in all matters affecting the discipline of jails, be subject
to the control of the Inspector General, and shall report to him all important steps which
he thinks proper to take.
G.O.No. 624 51. If the duties of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the Jail necessitate his
R.J., dated leaving the station, or if on account of illness he is unable at any time to supervise the jail,
the 6th the matter shall be reported to the District Magistrate, who will make arrangements for
August1923. carrying on the duties either by taking temporary charge of the jail himself or by placing
the Civil Surgeon of the station or, if there be no Civil Surgeon, one of his own
subordinates temporarily in charge.
52. In the event of a vacancy occurring in the office of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of a jail, or of
the absence of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent, of his sickness or inability to discharge his duties, the
Magistrate of the district shall take temporary charge of the jail or place the Civil Surgeon of the station or, if
there be no Civil Surgeon one of his own subordinates in charge, reporting his action, and the cause of it, to the
Inspector General. The officer so placed in charge shall exercise all the powers vested in a Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent but shall not be entitled to the special pay drawn by him.
53. Deleted.
G.O. No. 54. The Civil Surgeon when placed in temporary charge of a jail in accordance with
321-T.R., the above rules shall perform the duties of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent in
date the 19th addition to his own duties.
September
1922.
CHAPTER IV.
Visitors.
55. The following officers and such others as Government may, from time to time, appoint in this behalf
shall be ex-officio visitors :-
A. Visitors (official)
Of all jails in the Country within the respective areas under their official charge or within their
jurisdiction.
(a) The Director General of Health Services, Bangladesh.
(b) The Commissioner of a Division.
(c) The District Magistrate.
(d) The Director of Primary Education.
(e) The Director of Social Welfare Department.
(f) The Chief Metropolitan Magistrate.
(g) The District and Sessions Judge.
(h) The Metropolitan Sessions Judge and Metropolitan Police Commissioner (in the case of Central
Jails in Metropolitan Cities).
(i) The Additional District Magistrate and the Superintendent of Police of the District.
(j) The Civil Surgeon, if not also a jail officer.
(k) The Executive Engineer, P.W.D. of the District.
(l) The Executive Engineer, Public Health.
(m) The Deputy Director of Social Welfare Department.
(n) The Officer of Women and Children Affairs (District level).
10
G.O. No. B. Visitors (Non-Official).
1551 P.J.,
56. (1) Members of the Parliament shall be appointed as non-official Visitors, two for
dated the 9th
each Central or District Jail, of their constituency or within the District in which they
August
ordinarily reside. If the number of members exceeds the number thus required, members
1928.
shall be appointed in rotation for such periods as may be convenient. The appointment shall
be made by the Commissioners of the Divisions and notified in the Bangladesh Gazette.
When any such visitors cease to be a member of the Parliament he shall thereby cease to be
a visitor.
(2) The Commissioners of Divisions may also appoint by notification in the Bangladesh
Gazette as non-official visitors of any jail within their respective jurisdictions, other
gentlemen and ladies of position who are likely to take an interest in the welfare of the
prisoners for their rehabilitation in the society and are willing to accept this duty, provided
that their number is limited to a maximum of eight gentlemen, four ladies for central jails
and five gentlemen and two ladies for district jails. They shall be appointed for a period of
two years, and shall be eligible for re-appointment on the expiry of each term so long as he
or she is fit and willing to serve.
(3) The Commissioner of a Division may at his discretion, include retired class-I prisons
Officer.
(4) The Commissioners of Divisions may at his discretion appoint extra visitors for the
specific purpose of interviewing prisoners with a view to arranging after-care in suitable
cases. In making such appointments Commissioners should give due consideration to the
recommendation of any recognized Association or Society, which carries on After-care
work.
57. The appointment of non-official visitor who is not an ex-officio visitor, may be cancelled by the
authority appointing him (or her) within the period of his (or her) term for failure to visit the Jail for a
continuous period of three months or for non-attendance at two consecutive quarterly meetings of the
Board of visitors or for other sufficient reasons.
G.O. No. 92 58. The resident officers among the official visitors and the non-official visitors
P.J., Dated of each District jail shall constitute a Board, of which the District Magistrate shall be ex-
the 9th officio Chairman. In case of the Central jail, the Commissioner of the Division shall
January preside over the meeting of the board of visitors. It should be the duty of the Chairman to
1930. arrange the roster for weekly visits to the jail so as to give each resident official visitor and
each non-official visitor his due turn and to send out a notice by post intimating whose
G.O. No. turn it is, to visit the jail in the coming week. There should be a quarterly meeting of the
552-T.R., Board of Visitors on a fixed day as the Chairman may determine. The Board should meet
Dated the 14th at the Jail, inspect all buildings and prisoners, hear any complaints and petitions that may
September be preferred, inspect the prisoners food and see that it is of good quality and properly
1925. cooked and examine the punishment book and satisfy themselves that it is kept up-to-date.
After making their inspection, the Board shall record the proceedings of their quarterly
meeting in the visitors Minute Book before leaving the jail and the Superintendent of
District jail and Senior Superintendent of Central Jail after noting his explanations and
recommendations thereon shall forward a copy of the minute to the Inspector General of
Prisons who will submit it to Government with such observations as he may find
necessary to make. Besides, making visits in accordance with the roster, a visitor of the
jail is authorized to visit it at any other time.
A separate roster for lady visitors should also be arranged by the Chairman.
Bengal Form 59. All visitors are required to sign their names in the Gate Register (No. 46) both
No. 6023. on entering and leaving the jail. A list of visitors shall be hung up inside the entrance gate
of each jail.
11
60. Visitors may call for all books, papers and records of every department of the jail, but the
Superintendent may decline to produce any book, paper or record for the inspection of a non official
visitor, if for reasons to be recorded in writing he considers its production undesirable. Visitors should, if
possible, visit every yard, ward, workshop and cells, except those in which detenus or Division I prisoners
are confined, see every prisoner except detenus, or classified prisoner in confinement at the time of their
visit, and in every case of complaint made to them should enquire what the rules in force are, and whether
these are observed or not, and they should ascertain generally whether rules and orders are adhered to.
They should examine the punishment register and see that suitable punishments have been awarded, and
that properly recorded.
Bengal Form 61. A visitors Minute Book (in Register No.1) shall be kept in every jail and shall be
No. 4980. presented to every official or non-official visitor when he has completed his visit. In this
book every visitor shall record the date and hour of his visit and any remarks he may
desire to make. Such remarks should be limited to a statement and fair criticism of the
Bangladesh actual facts which come to his/her knowledge, and to any suggestions he may wish the
Form No. Superintendent or the Inspector General of Prisons to consider. The entries shall be made
5120 on the left-hand page. The Superintendent shall note the action taken by him in the
column provided for the purpose and shall forward copies in half margin of all such
G.O. No. 180 entries in the Visitors Book (in Bangladesh Jail Form No. 84) to the Inspector General of
T.-R., dated prisons for such further orders as may be required; and when explanation is necessary,
the 12th May, such explanation shall invariably accompany the copy. Whenever a visitor records the
1926. long detention of an under trial prisoner, both male and female a copy of his/her remarks
relating to such matters shall be forwarded to the Magistrate of the district and in case of
Metropolitan Cities to the Chief Metropolitan Magistrate, and if the prisoner be under trial
in the court of sessions shall also be forwarded to District Judge or Metropolitan Sessions
Judge as the case may be. The Inspector General of Prisons may, if necessary, forward a
copy of any visitors remarks to Government.
62. The functions of lady visitors shall extend only to the female prisoners and the female yard only. But
she may pass through male yard if it is necessary to do so to reach the female yard.
63. With prior intimation to the Senior Superintendent or Superintendent of Jail, the Superintending
Engineer of the Circle, Executive Engineer of the District, the local Assistant Engineer and their
employees actually engaged in executing public works in jails, shall have free access to the jail to such an
extent as may be necessary for purposes connected with the discharge of their official duties, but not
otherwise. Officers of the Agricultural Department shall be allowed to inspect jail garden and suggest its
improvement. The officers of Veterinary Department shall inspect the jail dairies and suggest its
improvement.
64. No police officer or the officer of any other Agency below the rank of Sub-Inspector of Police or of
equivalent rank shall be permitted to interrogate a prisoner without the special permission of the District
Magistrate or of the Court concerned. In case of Detenus such permission shall be obtained from the
Ministry of Home Affairs or from any other authority to whom such power is vested by the Government.
This permission shall be given in the form of a written order addressed to the Senior
Superintendent /Superintendent. The interview shall take place in presence of Jail Officer.
Note.- Deleted.
65. Except as provided for in these rules no person other than a superior officer not below the rank of
Assistant Commissioner or Assistant Secretary shall be admitted into any jail unless he is accompanied by,
or has obtained the written permission of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent or the Deputy
Inspector General of Prisons or the Inspector General, or in the case of district jail, the District Magistrate.
No visitor shall be allowed to go into the Jail without any escort.
66. Casual visitors to jails are forbidden to speak to, or communicate in any way with, any prisoner, and
jail officers are forbidden to point out prisoners to such visitors or to refer to them or their crimes. Usual
visitors are also forbidden to make any sketch, or plan or any photograph of any prison or part thereof, or
to take the photograph of any prisoner without the previous permission of Government.
12
67. Escorts for visitors shall, in central and district jails, be furnished by the reserve guard. At central jails
the escort shall consist of four warders, and at others of two warders, armed with batons. No visitor,
official or non-official shall be allowed to go into the jail without an escort.
68. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall be present at the quarterly meeting of the Board of
Visitors and shall accompany them during their inspection of the Jail.
The Jailor, if he can be spared, or the Deputy Jailor shall accompany all other visitors in order to
furnish them with any information they may require.
Rule 522 to 528 69. A reprint of the rules contained in this chapter shall be supplied to the office of each
of J.R.C. 1980. official visitor and to each non-official visitor on appointment. A copy of the pamphlet
Recommendatio
n G.O. to be containing this reprint shall be kept at the jail gate for ready reference by the official and
issued. non-official visitors.
Rule 493.3 72.(1) Subject to the orders of the Inspector General the Senior Superintendent of
Section 11 Central Jail and the Superintendent of District jail shall manage the prison in all matters
Act IX of relating to discipline, labour, expenditure, punishment, control and reformation of the
1894. offenders.
72. (2) The Senior Superintendent of Central Jail and the Superintendent of District Jail
shall be responsible for carrying out the rules of the Jail Code and the observance of the
Rule 22. provisions of legislative enactment relating to prison and prisoners and the execution of
all sentences of prisoners committed to his charge.
Rules 78, 73. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall maintain a minute book in
82,380, Register No. 1 in which all orders or minutes made by him shall be entered on the left
462,784, hand page. On the right hand page the Jailor or other officer for whom such orders have
1114. B.F. been given shall report how they have been carried out.
No. 4980.
Rules 74. The Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of any jail may suspend any officer up to
197,294. the rank of Jailor in case of serious misconduct. An approval shall have to be obtained
from the appointing authority.
13
75. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of every jail shall hold an enquiry touching every offence
committed by a prisoner, and punish such offender in accordance with the provisions of the rules in this
Code. He shall record with his own hand all orders for punishment, and shall see that the punishment is
carried out effectively provided that when required by this rule, the Medical Officer shall have previously
certified that the prisoner to be punished is fit to undergo it.
In the special case of prisoner transferred from a District Jail to Central Jail as refractory and
deserving of punishment more severe than the Superintendent of District Jail is empowered to inflict, the
Senior Superintendent of the Central Jail to which such refractory prisoner is transferred shall, on receipt
of the report from the Superintendent of the District Jail showing in detail the nature of the offence or
breach of Jail rules, with the evidence and the defence of the prisoner and the findings of the
Superintendent of the District Jail, inflict such punishment as he deems fit, being guided by the rule of this
code.
A prisoner alleged to have committed an offence should be given adequate opportunity of being
heard. No prison official or staff who is the complainant should enquire into the offence.
76. In respect of every punishment inflicted by the Senior Superintendent of Central Jail or Superintendent
of District Jail (including formal warning), entries shall be made in the Punishment Register No.19
furnishing all particulars as provided therein. In the case of every serious jail offence the name of
witnesses proving the Jail offence shall be recorded. All orders for punishment against any offence shall be
entered by the Superintendent in the prisoners history ticket, but the entries may be copied by a
subordinate from the prisoners history ticket into the Punishment Register. Against the entries in the
Punishment Register relating to each punishment the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent and jailor
shall affix their initials as evidence of the correctness of the entries.
77. The Senior Superintendent of Central Jail or Superintendent of District Jail shall accompany the
Inspector General and the Board of Visitors and also the District Magistrate on their inspection of the Jail.
Rule 462. 78. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall visit the jail daily, as soon after
sunrise as possible when his first duty shall be to release time-expired prisoners with due
Rule 73. observance of the rules regarding return of private property and the grant of subsistence
Rule 1189. allowance for the journey to their houses. He shall visit the whole jail premises at least
Rule 742. twice a week. He shall see every prisoner confined in a cell daily.
79. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall hold an inspection parade of all prisoners in the
manner as follows, in accordance with this code :
(1) On one morning in every week, which shall usually be Saturday, the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent shall hold an inspection parade of all Prisoners, at which the medical Officer shall also be
present.
(2) At each such parade the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall satisfy himself :-
(a) That every prisoner is properly classified as provided in the rules in that regard;
(b) That every prisoner is provided with proper clothing and bedding;
(c) That the provisions of the remission rules are understood by the prisoners; and
(d) Generally that the rules and orders applicable to prisoners are being duly carried out;
(3) The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall, at every such parade, hear and inquire into any
complaints that the prisoners may wish to make. It shall be his duty to listen to complaints and petitions of
prisoners in a patient and considerate manner, and to afford prisoners reasonable facilities for making such
representations.
(4) Nothing in this rule shall debar a prisoner from making a complaint or application to the
Superintendent at other times than the weekly parade, and it shall be the duty of every jail official to
produce before the Superintendent without delay any prisoner desiring to see him.
14
Section 12, 80. The senior Superintendent of Central Jail or the Superintendent of District jail shall
Act IX of keep, or cause to be kept, the following records:-
1894
Rules (1) a register of prisoners admitted ;
542.734. (2) a book showing when each prisoner is to be released ;
(3) a punishment book for the entry of the punishments inflicted on prisoners for prison
offence ;
(4) a visitors book for the entry of any observation made by the visitors touching any
Rules 61,543. matters connected with the administration of the prison;
(5) a record of the money and other articles taken from prisoners; and all such other
records as may be prescribed by rules under section 59 or section 60 of Act IX of 1894.
81. Senior Superintendents of Central Jails may appoint two warders to be their orderlies and
Superintendents of District Jails one warder as their orderlies. In Central and District Jails a warder may
be deputed by written order of the Superintendent to work as a jail Messenger and cash orderly, but such
warder shall not be employed at the house of any officer.
82. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of jail shall prescribe in writing (or see that this has been
done) in his minute-book the division of labour allotted to each of his subordinates, especially to those
employed in the jail office, so that the responsibility for errors in the jail records, and for any other
dereliction of duty, may be fixed with precision and without dispute. In district jails it should be
specifically stated what office work the Jailer, the Deputy Jailer and the Jail Clerk shall respectively
perform; but no such order shall relieve a Jailer of the responsibility of ensuring that the work in the jail
office, whether done by himself or by his assistants, is properly and punctually conducted.
83. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall submit punctually to the Inspector General all such
yearly and other returns, statements, bills and vouchers as, from time to time, may be prescribed. As soon
as possible after the close of each year, and not later than the 31 st January, he shall furnish the Inspector
General with a report, in which all matters of importance relating to the jail statistics and administration
for the year shall be noticed. He shall be generally responsible for carrying out of all rules relating to
account books and records of all kinds.
84. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall report to the Government as well as Inspector-General
of prisons, the Deputy Inspector General of Prisons as they occur, all serious breaches of jail discipline,
escapes, recaptures, suicides, deaths or serious injury to prisoners from accidental causes, any outbreak of
epidemic disease or unusual sickness, and the measures taken to prevent the spread of the diseases.
85. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall keep a constant and careful watch over the jail
receipts and expenditure; he shall promote all possible economy in every department of the jail and
carefully examine all demands and indents before sanctioning or submitting them for sanction; he shall
frequently satisfy himself that the registers and books are written up-to-date; that cash balances correspond
with those entered in the books; that daily entries are made in the day-books, and that outstanding dues are
not allowed to remain unrealized.
The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall see that the cash-book is closed and balanced
each day and verify the balance of each column with the balance of cash in hand at the end of the month.
He shall also record in the cash-book a Certificate of such verification over his signature. He shall be held
responsible for any defalcations on the part of the jail establishment if it be shown that such defalcations
were rendered possible by neglect on his part of this or any other rule laid down for his guidance.
15
86. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall satisfy himself by frequent inspection of the accounts
and of the food before and after cooking and weighment of the food after distribution that the prisoners
obtain their full ration properly cooked.
86.1. Any article brought to the jail gate either for consumption of the prisoners or for manufactures shall
cause to be examined by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent before these are passed inside the Jail.
87. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall every six months, as soon as possible after the 15 th
June and 15th December of each year, examine all stores, machinery, plant, tools, raw materials,
manufactured articles, live and dead stock appertaining to the jail and satisfy himself that he has on the
premises stock and plant equivalent to the balances shown in the accounts on those dates. At the close of
the year this examination shall include counting, measurement, or weighment of all stock susceptible of
such action. On the Ist July and 31 st December he shall submit to the Inspector-General certificates in
Returns Nos. 5 and 6, showing the result of his examination.
Before ordering fresh stock of any kind he shall scrutinize the existing stock as well as consider
the future needs in order to prevent overstocking. His half-yearly examination shall accordingly include
also a definite enquiry whether there is a surplus stock under any head, and if so, and if it is not likely to
be worked off before deteriorating, he shall arrange disposal of such stock with the concurrence of the
Inspector General of Prisons. He shall also see at his half yearly examination whether there are any
unserviceable articles and arrange for their disposal or write-off. In submitting such cases for the requisite
sanction of the Inspector-General, the Superintendent shall forward a statement showing details of the
surplus or unserviceable stock and other property of Government. He shall record a certificate in the
relevant stock book furnishing the remarks of physical verification of stocks carried out by him.
88. On change of Superintendents, the relieving officer shall, before taking over charge, satisfy himself
that the cash balances, permanent advance, and accounts are correct; also, as far as possible, that all stock
(both general and manufactory), machinery, plant and tools shown by the accounts to be in stock, are
forth-coming; that the registers have been written up to date; and that sanction has been obtained for all
the establishment employed; and shall report to the Inspector-General that he has done so. The
responsibility of the relieved officer shall not cease till this is done.
88.1 The Senior Superintendent of Central Jail as well as the Superintendent of District Jail shall
encourage participation of officers and custodial staff in athletics, sports and games so as to promote
physical fitness and esprit-de-corps.
Note: - All these rules in section I of this chapter (Chapter V) shall equally be applicable in case of any
other officer holding charge of the Central Jails.
88.2 The Senior superintendent of Central Jail and the Superintendent of District Jail shall maintain
healthy relation between the prisoners and staff and also between the superior and subordinate staff for
smooth running of the administration as well as for encouraging reformatory activities amongst the
misguided elements behind the bars, for their reintegration in the society.
Section I A.
Welfare Officer, Psychologist and Sociologist.
88.3 In every Central Jail there should be one Welfare Officer, one Psychologist and one Sociologist and
in all District Jails there should be one Welfare Officer and one Psychologist. They shall be appointed by
the Government.
88.4 The Social Welfare Officer shall look into the grievances of the prisoners and act as liaison officer
between the prison officials and the prisoners, arrange their job opportunities, for rehabilitation of the
offenders upon their release. He shall also assist the prison administration in the implementation of the
training and treatment programmes, drawn up for the offenders.
88.5 The Psychologist shall assist the prisons administration for scientific classification of prisoners, to
enable the prison officials to draw up training and treatment programme for officers according to the need
of the individual prisoner after classification and psychological tests, for them before reformation.
88.6 Sociologist shall carry out investigation into the background of the prisoners, circumstances and
reasons of their criminality, success of rehabilitation and reformative programmes in the post-release
period etc.
16
88.7 In all matters relating to the prison administration the Welfare Officer, the Psychologist and the
Sociologist shall obey the orders of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of Jail and shall assist the
prison officials in the implementation of the treatment programme and smooth running of the prison
administration.
They shall submit fortnightly report to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of jail as to the
progress made by the offenders regarding acceptance of the training and treatment program drawn up for
them for such action as the circumstances demands, for the correction of the offenders.
Section II. The Chief Medical Officer.
89. The Civil Surgeon of the District in which a jail is situated shall be the Chief Medical
See section Officer of such jail.
13 Act IX of
1894. Subject to the control of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent, in all matters
except the medical treatment of the sick, the Chief Medical Officer shall have charge of
the sanitary administration of the prison and shall perform such duties as are detailed in
this code or as are prescribed from time to time by the authority. His duties shall embrace
every matter affecting the health of the prisoners and the general hygiene of the jail. The
Chief Medical Officer shall be under the general control of the Inspector General of
Prisons.
90. Deleted.
See Section 91. Whenever the Cheif Medical Officer of a district jail is temporarily absent from the
62, Act IX of station, his duties shall be performed by the next senior Medical officer of the station.
1894.
Bengal Form 92. The Chief Medical Officer shall maintain a minute book in Register No. 1, in
No. 4980. which he shall enter on the left-hand page the date of his visit, with any observations,
recommendations, or orders he may wish to make; and on the right-hand the jailer shall
report, in the case of an order, how the order has been carried out, and the Senior
Superintendent of central jail or Superintendent of District Jails, as the case may be, shall
endorse recommendations made, or state his objections to them. If the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent is unable, or is of opinion that it is impossible or
inexpedient, to comply with any recommendation made by the Chief Medical Officer, he
shall submit a copy of the minute to the Inspector-General and state his reasons for not
carrying out the recommendation. See Rules 109 and 258.
Rule 341. 93. He shall visit the jail once in a month (except on Friday and on that day also, if
necessary) and more frequently, if necessary. He shall in course of his visit inspect every
part of the jail and its precincts, and shall satisfy himself that nothing exists therein which
is likely to be injurious to the health of the prisoners, that the drainage is satisfactory, that
the water supply is pure and not liable to pollution, that due precautions against over
crowding are taken, and that the ventilation and cleanliness of the barracks, workshops,
cells, yards etc., provided for and properly attended to. He shall also frequently inspect the
cook house and feeding parade, and shall test the weight and quality of the rations both
before and after cooking.
Rule 1181. 94. In course of his visit he shall see the patients in Hospital. This duty shall not be
delegated to any subordinate. He shall also examine prisoners complaining of illness, if he
feels necessary and do the needful as he deems fit and proper. In case of malingering he
shall at once report the guilty party to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent for
punishment.
Section 35, 95. He shall inspect all the prisoners during his visit and shall from time to time
Act IX of examine the labouring prisoners. When the Chief Medical Officer is of opinion that the
1894. health of any prisoner suffers from employment on any kind or class of labour he shall
Rules record such opinion in the prisoners history ticket and such prisoner shall not be
507,1217.
employed on that labour, but shall be placed on such other kind or class of labour as he
Rules
may consider suited for him.
17
507,553,784.
G.O. No. 96. Whenever the Chief Medical Officer shall have reason to believe that either the mind
5810 R.J., or the body of a prisoner is likely to be injuriously affected by the discipline or treatment
dated the 22nd observed in the prison he shall, after careful scrutiny (as convicts are prone to feign
April 1927. insanity), report the case in writing to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent
accompanied by such suggestions as he may think the case requires.
The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall thereupon submit his
recommendations to the Inspector General of Prisons, suggesting the manner in which he
proposes to alter or suspend the ordinary rules of discipline and treatment with regard to
the prisoner. The Inspector General of Prisons shall then pass the necessary orders on the
Senior Superintendents/Superintendents recommendations. A report on every such case
with sufficient detail shall forthwith be submitted to the Government for information.
Note: - Under the powers conferred by this rule it will be possible, whenever in the
opinion of the Chief Medical officer the usual diet scale in force in a prison or the usual
scale of clothing or bedding is so unsuitable to a prisoner as injuriously to affect or to be
likely to affect his health, to recommend the issue of such special dietary or such special
clothing or bedding as may deem best suited to meet the needs of the case. Similarly in
regard to labour, if any form of labour is found to be injuriously affecting a prisoner it
should be changed.
Rule 1106 97. He shall occasionally exercise a general supervision over the supplies and may reject
any article that he considers unfit for consumption. He may order any addition or
Rules 1103, alteration of diet for sick, special group, convalescents, the aged and infants, in course of
1238. his visit.
G.O. No. 98. In the event of the death of a prisoner in the jail, if death is suspected to have been due
8050 R.J., to cause other than natural causes, or if the cause of death is not known, he shall make a
dated the 6th complete post-mortem examination of the body. In other cases, he shall see the body and
September shall satisfy himself as to the cause of death and report the cause of death to the Senior
1922. Superintendent/ Superintendent who shall then pass orders for disposal of the body in
accordance with the religion or custom of the community or caste to which the deceased
prisoner belonged.
N.B.- In all cases whether a post-mortem examination is or is not made, the reason for
the action taken should be explained in the monthly sick return No. 29.
See Section 99. On the death of any prisoner in the jail the Chief Medical Officer shall forthwith
15, Act IX of record in Hospital Register No. 27 the following particulars:-
1894.
(1) the day on which the deceased first complained of illness or was observed to be ill;
(2) the labour, if any, on which he was engaged on that day;
(3) the scale of his diet on that day;
(4) the day on which he was admitted to hospital;
(5) the day on which the Medical Officer was first informed of the illness;
(6) the nature of the disease;
(7) when the deceased was last seen before his death by the Medical Officer or Medical
Subordinate;
(8) when the prisoner died; and
(9) (In cases where a post-mortem examination is made) an account of the appearances
after deaths, together with any special remarks that appear to the Chief Medical Officer to
be required. The prisoners history ticket and hospital bed-head ticket (with temperature
chart, if any) shall be kept for two years.
18
100. The death of every Foreign prisoner with details of his parentage and previous residence, if known,
shall be reported by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent to the District Magistrate, the Inspector
General of Prisons and the Government.
101. Whenever the mortality in a jail during any month exceeds one percent, the Medical Officer shall
record in the monthly return his opinion as to the cause to which the excess is to be attributed, and any
observations he may have to offer on the subject. If there is unusual mortality, he shall make a special
report to the Inspector General for transmission to Government.
See Section 102. All prisoners previously to being removed to any other prison shall be examined by
26, Act IX of the Medical Officer. No prisoner shall be removed from one prison to another unless the
1894. Medical Officer certifies that the prisoner is free from any illness rendering him unfit for
removal. No prisoner shall be discharged against his will from prison if labouring under
Rules 843, any acute or dangerous distemper, nor until, in the opinion of the Medical Officer, such
862. discharge is safe to himself and the general community. The death of any prisoner so
detained shall not be included in the jail statistics of deaths. However District Magistrate,
Inspector General of Prisons and Government should be informed.
Rule 133. 103. The Chief Medical Officer shall attend all members of the jail staff and their
families who reside on the jail premises. Medicines required for the treatment of
members of the jail staff and their families shall be supplied from the jail store. He shall
bring to the notice of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent any facts respecting the
causes of illness that may be of importance in enabling him to determine as to the fitness
or otherwise of a subordinate for continued employment in the jail service.
Jail Circular 104. The Chief Medical Officer shall -
No. I D of (a) submit, for the sanction of the Inspector-General of Prisons, a yearly indent (M.S.D.135) for
1914. medicines and medical stores for his jail on the Ist March.
I-G. C.H.s (b) keep or cause to be kept a proper account including daily expenditure of medicines, instruments
and appliances; showing therein, if any article is missing, whether it has been broken by accident
No. 569-D.,
or carelessness or whether it has been lost and the name of the Medical Subordinate responsible for
dated the 24th it (see Rule 93);
May 1910. (c) satisfy himself that poisons are kept separate from other medicines properly labeled and under
Rules lock and key;
114,807. (d) cause a list of scheduled poisons (B.J. Form No.113) to be hung in the dispensary;
Bengal Form (e) cause a copy of Poisons and Antidotes (B.J. Form No. 112) to be hung in every dispensary;
No. 5140. (f) from time to time examine the medicines in store to assure himself that they are in a fit
Bengal Form condition for use ;
No. 5139. (g) regularly check the account of bazar medicines ;
Rule 115. (h) be responsible that all foreign medicines, instruments and appliances debited to the jail, and all
bazar medicines and medical stores charged in the jail accounts, are faithfully and solely expended
in the service of the jail; and
(i) satisfy himself that all hospital and other records of sick and convalescent group prisoners are
duly kept up to date by the Medical Subordinate.
105. He shall ordinarily correspond with the Inspector General through the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent, on any matter connected with the Jail or prisoners.
106. The Medical Officer should be selected from the Department of Health, for service in
Jails. The Medical Officers during the period of their deputation to the jail department
which exclusive of leave will ordinarily be limited to 3 years and shall be formally placed
at the disposal of the Inspector General of Prisons and shall not ordinarily be liable to be
withdrawn without his consent.
They should not ordinarily be liable to be called upon to serve a second time in
the Jail Department. The Inspector General of Prisons may initiate disciplinary action
against any Medical Officer for his misconduct or indifferent work as per Government
19
Servants Discipline and Appeal Rules.
G.O. No. 7322 107. The Medical Officer deputed to the Jail Department will not be permitted to engage
R.J., dated the in private practice and they shall not be deputed to work elsewhere in addition to their
7thAugust, duties in Jail.
1922 and G.O.
No. 677, dated
The Medical Officer will be allowed to draw a fixed amount of Tk. 1000/- per
the 28th August
1923.
month as non practising allowance.
108. After the close of each year the Inspector General of Prisons may grant to any
Medical Officer who in that year during his connection with a jail has done thoroughly
good work in all branches of his duties and is recommended by the Chief Medical Officer,
a special reward in addition to his regular pay. This special reward will be granted in a
single payment after the close of the calendar year and upon the following conditions :-
G.O. No. (1) The special rewards cannot be claimed as a matter of right. They are granted solely at
7322 R.J., the discretion of the Inspector General within the limits of the sanctioned lump allotment
dated the 7th in the budget to those incumbents who may have shown special merit during the
August 1922. preceding calendar year. They may be withheld or reduced at the discretion of the
Inspector General.
(2) The grant of a reward will depend upon the opinion recorded by the Inspector General
at his inspection of the jail and on the recommendations of the Chief Medical Officer of
the jail. The Inspector General will base his opinion on evidence of good work done as
seen at his inspection; in the general health of the prisoners; in the management of the
Hospital and the various infirm groups; in the preparation and cooking of the food, both
for ordinary prisoners and for those in Hospital; in the general sanitary condition of the
jail; and in the management of epidemic diseases, if any such outbreaks have occurred.
(3) If there has been in any jail a change of Medical Officer during the year, the special
reward if sanctioned shall be divided between the several incumbents, in accordance with
the recommendation of the Chief Medical Officer or recorded opinion of the Inspector
General.
(4) The decisions of the Inspector General shall be final.
G.O. No. 109 (1) In all matters relating to, or connected with the feeding, clothing and medical
7322 R.J., treatment of hospital patients and other professional duties, the medical officer and staff
dated the 7th shall obey the orders of, and discharge such duties as may from time to time be lawfully
August, assigned to him by the Chief Medical Officer. In matters relating to, or connected with,
1922. the maintenance of order and discipline in, and the general management of the jail, he
Bangladesh shall obey the orders of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent and the Jailor,
Form No. respectively.
4980. (2) In every jail the Medical Officer shall record in his report book (register No.1) and
report to Chief Medical Officer all orders given to him by the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent or Jailor.
Rule 139. 110. In jails where there are more than one Medical Officer and Pharmacist they shall
be on duty in such manner and for such hours as the Chief Medical Officer may direct. At
least one of them should always be present in the Jail premises and shall be available on
call. In Jails where there are more than two Medical Officers, one of them shall always
remain present in the Jail Hospital. In jails where there are one such officer and a
Rule 341. Pharmacist their hours of attendance should be so distributed between them by the Chief
Medical Officer that one or the other shall always be available on call. In Central Jails one
of the Medical Officers and in District Jail in which necessary accommodation is
available, either the Medical Officer or the Pharmacist, in turn, shall be required to sleep
in the Hospital from 10 p.m. until unlocking of the jail next day. The Medical Officer and
the Pharmacist shall be present in the Jail while the Chief Medical Officer is attending the
sick and also at such times as he considers necessary.
In a jail where there is only one Medical Officer whose sole duty is to attend to
20
the jail, he shall be present in the jail throughout the day except when allowed to be absent
for meals or for other sufficient reasons. Where the Medical Officer is attached to a
neighbouring institution, he shall visit the Jail early in the morning before attending to
other duties and again in the evening before lock up time. In any case of serious disease
the Medical Officer should visit the hospital frequently at night and see that the prescribed
medicines and food have been distributed, and must be prepared at all times to attend
when his services are called for.
Rule 634. 111. At the opening of the wards the Medical Officer shall at once see any prisoners
complaining of sickness. If necessary he will send them at once to hospital, but if he
thinks this unnecessary he will bring them to the notice of the Chief Medical Officer on
his arrival. He shall keep in book form a register or list of all prisoners kept under medical
observation from day to day. He shall also see that medicines are distributed to prisoners
of the extramural groups who need them and shall then go round the hospital visiting each
patient and doing whatever is needful for him, at the same time making notes of the
Rule 1234. condition or progress of the cases on the bed-head tickets for the information of the Chief
Medical Officer.
112. He shall every morning visit the convalescent and special groups and prisoners kept under
observation, and see that medicines are distributed to those requiring them, and that they get the special
food, clothing, bedding, and rest ordered for them. If any prisoner is removed from the convalescent or
special groups without the authority of the Medical Officer, he shall report the matter to the Chief
Medical Officer.
113. He shall visit all prisoners confined in cells daily, and report to the Chief Medical Officer any
complaints that may have been made to him.
Rule 807. 114. He shall be responsible for proper safe keeping of the medicine under his charge in
the medicine almirah under lock and key. He shall also see that the poisonous drugs are
kept separate. He will write up the hospital diet book, make the necessary indents for
hospital diet and submit them to the proper jail authority, and see that the food is properly
prepared and distributed to the sick.
Rule 104. 115. He shall keep all the hospital registers written up to date, shall punctually prepare
and submit to the Chief Medical Officer monthly and other returns, and be generally
responsible for the hospital records.
116. He shall be responsible that the surgical instruments are kept in good order and for the safe keeping
and cleanliness of clothing, bedding, blankets, etc., issued for use in the hospital. Any deficiency in stock
should be reported to the Jail authority, through the Chief Medical Officer.
117. He shall be responsible for the maintenance of cleanliness, order and discipline in the hospital, that all
jail rules are strictly observed in it, that the Pharmacist/Nurses and other Technical Staff as well as
hospital attendants do their duties, and also that any want of, or excess of, hospital attendants is brought to
the notice of concerned authorities.
118. When any prisoner is so seriously ill as to need the services of a special sick attendant, the Medical
Officer shall take the orders of the Chief Medical Officer, who shall apply to the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent for the services of a convicted prisoner for this duty.
No sick attendant should be changed without the written order of the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent for as the case may be. The names of such convict prisoners as are selected as general
hospital or sick attendants shall be recorded, and the fact of such duty entered on the history tickets of
each, and they shall not be changed without the written order of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent.
Note. - For detailed rules regarding Nursing Hospital Orderlies see Appendix No. 31.
Rules 94, 119. He shall carefully watch all prisoners who may possibly be malingering, and bring
21
740, 1225. such cases to the notice of the Chief Medical Officer. All prisoners who are suspected to
Rule 736. be insane shall be examined by him daily, and a report of their mental condition to be
submitted to the Chief Medical Officer.
When the Chief Medical Officer visits the jail the Medical Subordinate shall
accompany him on his round and take notes of any order given by him regarding the
treatment of the sick or the sanitation of the jail.
Rules 122. He shall carefully examine all new admissions to the jail, and record in the
505,507. Admission Register their state of health, weight, personal marks, including marks of
wounds, vaccination or inoculation. Under trial prisoners should be specially examined
G.O. No. 140 for marks of wounds, bruises, etc., and anything, which may be useful to the courts, the
T. R., dated result being reported to the Chief Medical Officer and duly recorded. If a prisoner is
the 3rd May received from the police bearing marks of injury not mentioned in the police report, he
1927. shall at once bring it to the notice of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent who shall
Rules forthwith send a report to the District Magistrate. He shall simultaneously record his
506,544. observations in the History Ticket. He will satisfy himself that the private clothing of
newly admitted prisoners is cleansed, and disinfected, if necessary, before removal to the
godown.
Rule 508. 123. He shall see that all convicted prisoners and infants are vaccinated as soon as possible
after admission to the jail. Instruction of Chief Medical Officer may be obtained if considered
necessary.
Rules 124. If he has reason to believe that any female prisoner is pregnant, he shall report the
994,995. circumstance to the Jail authority through the Chief Medical Officer.
Rules 125. He shall at once bring to the notice both of the Chief Medical Officer and the Senior
811,812. Superintendent/Superintendent any case of infectious disease. In case of serious injury from
accident, or where a major operation is necessary, he shall at once communicate with the Chief
Medical Officer; and every factory accident or serious injury to a prisoner from any accident
should at once be reported to the Senior Superintendent or Superintendent as the case may be.
G.O. No. 126. He shall inspect the food godowns and kitchens daily, see that they, and all vessels for
7322-R.J., cooking or distributing food, are clean, and that all food material, vegetables, etc., are of good
dated the 7th quality, properly husked, washed and prepared and sufficient in quantity. He shall keep
august 1922. samples of anything he considers to be unwholesome for the Chief Medical Officers
Rules inspection. Should he consider that the quality and quantity of food to be unsatisfactory, he
901,925, should immediately report the fact to the Chief Medical Officer. He should inspect all meat,
1136. fish, and milk supplied for the prisoners from whatever sources, and report at once, for
rejection, anything unfit for human consumption. He will see that milk is properly boiled
before issue to the prisoners; and also inspect the food supplied to civil prisoners or to under
trial prisoner by their friends.
Rules 64,119 127. He shall examine all food before it is distributed; also see that it is properly cooked,
and that the proper quantity of oil, salt, and antiscorbutics have been added to each ration.
He should bring to the notice of the Chief Medical Officer any prisoner who frequently
leaves a considerable portion of the food supplied to him, especially cases in which it
appears that this is caused by failing health or is purposely done in order to cause
reduction of weight on the day of weighment.
22
Rule 1203. 128. He shall periodically examine the tube-wells, tanks or other sources of water supply,
and should bring to the notice of the jail authority and deficiency of supply or likelihood
of the water being polluted. He shall daily examine the filters, and all vessels in which
water for drinking or cooking is stored or conveyed, and see that they are clean and in
good working order.
Rule 1191. 129. He shall daily inspect all latrines and urinals, and see that they are kept clean, that the
conservancy rules are carried out, and that a sufficient quantity of soap and water is kept
for washing of hands after use of latrines. He should also see that the orders about
ventilation of hospital wards, sleeping barracks, and workshops are properly attended to
according to the season of the year; that the prisoners while sleeping are not exposed to
direct draughts or the fall of rain, and that all the batten doors are freely opened during the
day.
Rules 130. The sheds in which milch cows are kept shall be examined by him daily. He shall see
1128,1137. that these places are kept clean and free from smell; and that the vessels for boiling and
holding milk are clean and fit for use. He shall keep a daily record of the quantity of milk
obtained from the jail cows, and of its expenditure, and shall report to the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent any instance in which it is not all expended for the benefit
of the sick or in improving the diet of the prisoners.
Rule 1216. 131. The fortnightly weighment of all prisoners as well as the weekly weighment of those
who are infirm or losing weight, shall be made under the immediate superintendence of
the Medical Officer, who shall record with his own hand the weight of each prisoner in his
Rule 554. history ticket. In central jails he may be assisted by the Pharmacist or by Deputy Jailer
deputed by the Senior Superintendent. All prisoners steadily losing weight shall be
reported to the Chief Medical Officer not later than the day after weighment.
Rule 259. 132. He shall report all deaths at once to the Jailer and the Chief Medical Officer; see that
the body is decently removed to the dead-house; make the necessary preparations for
post-mortem examination; assist the Chief Medical Officer in making such examination,
Rule 98. and be responsible that the body is afterwards properly stitched up and covered.
133. He shall afford medical aid to all the jail staff, warders, guards, and others living on the jail premises.
In cases of difficulty he should consult the Chief Medical Officer.
134. In addition to his own proper duties as above detailed, he shall render the Chief Medical Officer
every assistance, exercising general vigilance over all matters which can in any way affect the mental and
physical health of any of the inmates of the jail, and report to the Chief Medical Officer any instance in
which he believes that rules affecting the health of the prisoners have been infringed; as, for example, in
such matters as the following: -
(a) Overcrowding of wards, workshops or other spaces.
(b) Incorrect weighment or distribution of food.
(c) Unseasonable, worn-out, or dirty clothing.
(d) Neglect of personal cleanliness.
(e) Undue exposure of prisoners to wet or sun.
(f) Unpunctuality or curtailment of meals.
(g) Neglect to air, dry or clean bedding.
(h) Unsuitable tasks, especially in the case of weakly men.
(i) The use of workshops as dormitories or vice versa.
(j) Deficient or incorrect use of important articles of diet such as salt,spices, oils and antiscorbutices.
23
135. In central jails where the Medical Officer must spend more time in regular hospital duties than is
necessary in district jails, his visits to all the wards, latrines and urinals, and to see the condition of the
water and milk receptacles, need not be made daily, but at such intervals as the Chief Medical Officer
may direct. The Medical Officer must in all cases give his constant attention to these matters and will be
held personally responsible for any irregularity regarding them.
136. The Medical Officer may purchase bazar medicines as authorized to do so in writing by the Chief
Medical Officer, who shall satisfy himself that the medicines are actually required. The Medical Officer
shall not purchase articles of diet for the sick, whose food shall be supplied by the same authority as that
of other prisoners. Vouchers signed by the Medical Officer and countersigned by the Chief Medical
Officer for bazar medicines shall be submitted with the contingent bill.
136.1 Services of Specialists from the outside Hospital must be ensured on the recommendation of the
Civil Surgeon-Cum-Chief Medical Officer on requisition of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent
whenever such situation demands.
Note :- A prisoner who has been suffering from any chronic or serious disease may provide the jail
Medical Officer through the Jail authority with any documentary information on the treatment,
previously he had, by himself or by his relations or friends or the doctor to whom he underwent
treatment. Medicines brought for such patient as in special cases, shall invariably be checked by the
Medical Officer of the jail.
Section IIIA.
PATHOLOGIST, RADIOLOGIST AND TECHNICIANS
AND PART TIME DENTIST.
136.2 For Central Jail Hospitals there shall also be the following technical staff in order to facilitate
medical treatment of the prisoners and staff: -
(a) Pathologist: - The Pathological Section attached to the Jail Hospital shall be equipped with requisite
re-agents and necessary instruments to carry out pathological examination as and when suggested by the
Medical Officer for the treatment of the inmates and staff.
(b) Radiologist- Part time:-The Department of Radiology attached to the Jail Hospital must have modern
X-Ray machine and all other instruments and equipments for radiological examination of the patients as
and when required by the Medical Officer for the proper diagnosis of the diseases and treatment of the
patients.
(c) Technicians There shall be one part time Laboratory Technician for the Pathological Department to
assist the Pathologist and another part time technician for Radiology Department in order to assist the
Radiologist for due performance of his technical duties. In the long run literate convicted prisoners may
be trained as technicians and be utilized as such.
(d) Part time Dentist There shall be one part time Dentist in every Central jail with necessary equipments
to facilitate Dental Treatment of the prisoners and custodial staff.
The Central Jails should be provided with necessary surgical instruments to carry out simple
operation when necessary.
136.3 For District Jails- There shall be one part time Pathologist and also one part time Laboratory
Technician to assist the Pathologist for due performance of his technical duties.
In the foreseeable future the literate convicts may be trained as Laboratory Technicians and their service
be utilized in the Jail Hospital.
136.4. There shall be one part time Dentist in every Central Jail. The Dentist should be provided with
Dental Chair and other surgical equipments for treatment of the patients suffering from Dental problems.
24
The Inspector General of Prisons shall be the appointing authority of such Technical staff as under :-
(a) Part-time Pathologist
(b) Part time Radiologist
(c) Part time Laboratory Technicians and
(d) Part time Dentist.
He may form a Board with such medical officers, as deemed necessary for appointment of such technical staff.
They shall be granted such remuneration as decided by the Government.
151. Every Central jail shall have a Deputy Superintendent trained in different trades, capable to supervise
the manufactory Department in all its branches.
The post of Deputy Superintendent shall be filled up as per recruitment rules.
152. The rank of the Deputy Superintendent shall be superior to that of the Jailer, who will be bound to carry
out any orders he may give relating to his own department, provided they be in accordance with the jail rules
and the Senior Superintendents instructions.
153. He shall, as an officer of the jail, make himself thoroughly acquainted with all the jail rules with which
he shall strictly comply, and shall assist the Senior Superintendent and other jail officials to maintain order
and discipline. In cases of emergency he shall be expected to render assistance at any time. He shall carry on
the routine duties of the Senior Superintendent during the temporary absence of the latter due to illness or for
any other reasons.
154. He shall be bound to do his utmost to conduct the jail manufactures to the best advantage, subject to the
control of the Senior Superintendent, whose orders he must obey.
25
Rule 803 155. All the manufacture department stores, both of raw materials and finished goods, together
with the accounts, shall be under his supervision, and he shall be held responsible for their
correct keeping.
156. He shall be provided with a report or order book (Register No.1) in which he shall make written entries
of any matters which require the Senior Superintendents orders, such as requisitions for prisoners, materials,
tools or plant, manufacture, sale and despatch of goods and recommendations of any kind relating to his
branch of jail management. He shall also enter any important instructions connected with his department he
may have to give to the Jailer or any of his subordinates. On the right hand page the Senior Superintendent
will record his orders, or the subordinate officer concerned will note what action he has taken on instructions
given. Any orders relating to manufactures passed by the Senior Superintendent shall likewise be entered in
this book.
157. He shall make himself acquainted, as far as possible, with the character and industry of every prisoner
working under him, and assist the Senior Superintendent in granting remission and rewards for good work.
He shall report to the Senior Superintendent, for punishment, all prisoners guilty of idleness, or of breaches
of jail discipline which come within his cognizance.
158. Free quarters shall be provided for him on the jail premises, in which he must reside. He shall not
absent himself from his duties without the permission of the Senior Superintendent, unless he is sick, in
which case he will produce a certificate of sickness from the Chief Medical Officer.
159. Deleted.
Section VII. -Rules relating to Subordinate Officers particularly and in some cases to Jail
Officers generally.
Note. - Subordinate Officer means and includes every non-gazette officer of a jail (not being a convict
officer).
160.The Inspector General shall appoint all subordinate officers and staff except those who may be
appointed by Government or whose appointment is entrusted to some other authorities, through written test,
when necessary. All appointments shall be made as per Recruitment Rules framed by the Government from
time to time on the recommendation of the Selection Board or the Public Service Commission as and when
applicable.
Every subordinate officer and staff appointed against a substantive vacancy shall be on probation
and his confirmation shall be contingent on his proving himself efficient. Every subordinate officer and staff
on appointment will be liable to serve in any jail within the Country.
Rule 193. 161. Every subordinate officer who desires to leave the Jail service is bound to give notice
in writing at least two months prior to leaving. Subordinate officers or staff, who are
discharged except for misconduct or during probation, or at their own request, shall be
entitled to a months notice or in lieu a months pay. In case of abolition of post, three
months notice shall be given. This Rule is not applicable to persons holding temporary
posts, their appointment can be terminated at any time.
Rule 482. 162. All persons employed in Prison Department must be persons of respectable character,
disreputable conduct, even outside the jail, will render an officer or staff liable to dismissal.
No person who has been punished for any offence with imprisonment, shall be employed in
Government Service.
G. of I. Resn. 163. Every candidate for employment in the Prisons Service shall state in writing whether he
10-919,dated has been previously employed in any post under Government or any local authority, and, if
15.6.1895. so, shall produce his service Book or other record of service or a certified copy thereof. No
Government servant who has been dismissed shall be re-admitted to service without the
sanction of the Government.
163.1. A great precautionary measure shall be taken for verification of the character and
antecedent of every subordinate officer and staff selected for employment in Prisons
26
Department through the competent authority before he is allowed to join the service.
Rule 858. 164. Every subordinate officer shall inform the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent or
Jailor if he has a relative or connection among the prisoners of the jail to which he is posted
or has had any pecuniary dealings or close acquaintance with any of them.
Rules 165. Prior to appointment all candidates for employment as subordinate officers at any jail
277,297. shall be examined by the Civil Surgeon and the fitness certificate shall be produced to the
appointing authority. The Civil Surgeon who examines them shall also certify that they
possess the requirements as to the height, strength and capacity to perform the duties
required of them. Every candidate must consent to vaccination/inoculation, if not done
earlier.
Rule 215. 166. Candidates before appointment to the jail service shall read or have read to them
Bengal Form Section 54 of the Prisons Act (IX of 1894) and shall acknowledge by signature that this has
No. 5122. been done. The acknowledgment shall be attached in the service book of each of officers and
Bengal Form staff. They must also understand that they may be employed wherever it seems fit to the
No. 5126. appointing authorities. No candidate shall be enlisted until he has signed the declaration
contained in B.J. form No. 89.
(Note.-For the warder establishment, this form is printed in page 1 of the Service Record-
B.J. Form No.96)
167. Every subordinate officer shall make himself acquainted with the rules and orders regulating the duties
through proper training in a Training Institute where applicable, Every officer on being relieved, shall point
out to successor all matters of special importance connected with the duties of his post, and explain any
directions of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent, Medical Officer, or other superior officer affecting
any particular prisoner or matter. Jailors and Deputy Jailors shall each carry with them a notebook in which
they shall enter at the time, any verbal order given to them by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent.
G.of 1 Resn. 168. Neither the Jailer nor any officer subordinate to him shall engage in any
2998 P., employment or business other than his prison duty. No Jail officer on leave may engage in
dated the 16 any trade or undertake any employment other than his public duties except with the previous
May, 1907. sanction of the Government.
Rule 193
169. No officer shall take a loan of money or gift from or lay himself open to any pecuniary obligation to,
any officer subordinate to him. Any officer who is appointed or transferred to a post in which he will be in a
position to exercise official influence or authority over any person to whom he is under any pecuniary
obligation, shall be bound to declare, without delay, the circumstance to the officer to whom he is
immediately subordinate for report to the Government, and failing to do so shall be subject to the same
penalty as if the obligation were incurred after his appointment or transfer.
170. All wrangling or disputes between officers or subordinates of the jail are strictly forbidden, and any
disagreement between subordinate officers as to any matter connected with their duties must be referred to the
Jailer, or, if necessary, to the Senior Superintendent or Superintendent as the case may be. All complaints must
be made to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent or Jailor within twenty-four hours of the occurrence of
the cause of complaint. Officers making frivolous or false complaints will be liable to punishment.
170.1 All Jail officers must discharge their respective duties in perfect harmony and co-operation with each
other. No officer shall, either directly or indirectly, obstruct others in performing their duties in accordance
with the Rules and Orders in force.
171. No combinations among officers and staff are allowed, and proceedings tending to such will be
punished.
Rules 181, 172. Every subordinate officer for whom free quarters are provided by Government shall
188. live in those quarters, and those for whom no quarters are provided shall live as far as
Rule 314.
G.O. No. practicable within such a distance of the jail as may be fixed by the Senior Superintendent or
3238 P.J., Superintendent or Jailor. Rent-free Quarters on the jail premises shall be provided for Jailor,
dated the 10th Deputy Jailers, Medical Officer, Pharmacist, Nurse and the Warder Establishment. The
27
September Inspector General of Prisons may provide free quarters to such other officers, as he may
1911(1931) deem necessary. Subordinate officers shall not take in lodgers in Government quarters.
Rules 59, 334. 173. All jail officers above the rank of Head Warder are required to sign their names in
Bangladesh the Gate Register (No. 46) both on entering and leaving the jail.
Form No. 5023.
174. No subordinate officer shall be permitted to receive any visitors in the interior of the jail. No female
except on official duty shall, under any circumstances, be allowed to enter the warders barrack, guard room
or cook house; all outsiders of loose or evil character must be excluded from the jail precincts.
175. Subordinate officers and staff shall not lounge about the jail. They shall confine themselves to their
respective posts, except when ordered by a superior officer to go elsewhere, or when going upon duty.
Rule 244 176. No subordinate officer shall absent himself/ herself from the jail premises either by
Rule 350. day or night, or from duty during the hours fixed for his/her attendance, without the
High Court permission of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent or (if subordinate to the Jailer) of
C.O. No. 8, the Jailer, except when summoned by a Court of Justice. Any subordinate officer disabled
dated the 22nd from the performance of duty by illness, or summoned by Court of Justice, shall at once
August 1878. send notice to the Jailer, who shall make such arrangement as may be necessary for the
Rules 346(u) performance of the duty of the officer during his absence. Every subordinate officer to
347,358-361. whom any leave has been granted shall, immediately on his return there from, personally
report the fact of his return to the Jailer.
177. Subordinate officers shall pay strict attention to cleanliness of person and dress; and those for whom a
uniform is ordered shall at all times wear it while on duty, but relaxation of this rule may be allowed when a
jail official on account of caste rules is unable to wear uniform during the period of mourning. When off duty
on the jail premises or in any public place, they must either appear altogether in private clothes or in
complete uniform, no combination of the two shall be allowed.
178. No Jail officer or staff shall sing or talk loudly while on duty, or in any way or at any time conduct
himself in an unseemly or disorderly manner, or introduce liquor, tobacco, or any drug into the jail.
Rule 294. 179. No officer of a jail, nor any person in trust for, or employed by him shall have any
interest, direct or indirect, in any contract for the supply of any jail articles; nor shall he derive
Recommend any benefit, directly or indirectly, from the sale or purchase of any article on behalf on the jail
-ation of the or belonging to a prisoner; nor shall he receive, directly or indirectly, any fee or gratuity or
Committee.
present from any person tendering or furnishing supplies for the jail, or from any person
visiting the jail. A breach of such rule on the part of any officer or staff shall liable him to
disciplinary action.
Recommenda 180. No officer of a jail shall sell or let, nor shall any person in trust for, or employed by, him
-tion of the sell or let or derive any benefit from selling or letting any article to any prisoner or have any
Committee
money or other business dealings, directly or indirectly, with any prisoner or prisoners friends.
A breach of this rule on the part of any officer or staff shall liable him to disciplinary action.
181. No subordinate officer shall have unauthorized communication with any person whatsoever concerning
the jail or regarding administrative matters; nor shall he allow any discharged prisoner to visit or remain in
his quarters, except with the special permission of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the jail.
182. No subordinate officer shall converse unnecessarily with any prisoner, or treat him with familiarity, or
discuss matters connected with the discipline or regulations of the jail with him or within his hearing or
extend support by supply of mobile phone or any electronic device.
Rule 202. 183. No jail officer shall employ any prisoner on his own private work, except as provided
in Rules 796 to 798 or for his own private benefit or gain, except within the jail premises for
the benefit of jail administration.
Recommenda 184. The main object of institutional treatment being chastisement of the offenders and there is
-tion of the growing view that main concept of reform derives from the acceptance of the fact that human
Committee. treatment is more effective than retributive treatment. Hence with this end of view all Jail
officers and staff shall treat prisoners with temper, humanity, kindness, and strict impartiality.
Any complaint or grievances should be listened patiently and without irritability or while at the
same time maintaining strict discipline and enforcing the observance of all rules and regulations.
It is important that every complaint written or verbal made by a prisoner shall be heard with
28
attention, in order that if real it may be redressed and that no cause for discontent may be
allowed to remain. In case the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the Jail is unable to
redress of the grievances of any prisoner due to his limitations he shall without delay refer the
matter to his higher authorities for a reasonable solution.
Rule 708. 185. No jail officer shall in any circumstances punish any prisoner except under the Senior
Recommenda Superintendent/Superintendents order, or threaten any prisoner with punishment or use
tion of the violent, abusive, or insulting language to any prisoners. All conduct intended merely to
committee. irritate or annoy any prisoner shall be avoided. Any breach of this rule shall liable an officer
or subordinate staff to disciplinary action.
Rules 186. No officer shall on any pretext strike a prisoner, except in self-defence or in the
202,253. repression of a disturbance (in which case no more than necessary force shall be used), In
Rule 399. the event of any riot, violent attempt to break out of the jail, or assault by the prisoners, or
by any of them upon the jail officers, the Jailor and his subordinates shall be strictly guided
by these rules.
Rule 253. 187. No officer, on any pretence whatever, through favours or from a mistaken notion of
kindness, shall fail to make an immediate report to the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent, or other superior officer, of any misconduct or willful disobedience of the
Jail Rules, whether on the part of a prisoner or of another officer.
Rules 341,462. 188. Subordinate officers shall not use the jail lanterns for private purposes. An unlighted
G.O. No. 642- lantern, or two if necessary (due to electricity failure etc.) shall be kept at the main gate for
T.R., dated the use, if required, in the office or for the night visit to the jail of the Jailer or Deputy Jailer; but
5th October these lamps shall not be removed to the private quarters of these officers. Subordinate
1925.
officers are prohibited from using naked kerosene lamps or unprotected native chirags in
katcha or thatched dwelling house belonging to the Jail.
Rule 249. 189. No subordinate officer or staff entrusted with keys shall leave them lying about, or
deliver them to any other person, except when, on leaving the jail or going off duty, he
delivers them to such officer as may be authorized to receive them, and he shall not leave his
post or the jail without making them over as above directed. The keys of wards, cells, outer
Rules gates or workshops are not on any pretext whatever to be taken out of the jail or made over
491,738. to any prisoner. If a key is lost the lock or locks to which it belongs must be put out of use,
as they will be no longer secure, and the officer responsible shall be liable to replace them at
his own expense.
Rule 456. 190. No officer shall on any account enter a ward or a prisoners cell at night, unless
Rule 741. accompanied by another officer, and then only in case of sickness or other emergency.
Rules 318(r) 191. All jail officers are bound
325,417,475.
(1) to exert the utmost vigilance in the prevention of escapes ; to this end the Jailor and his
Rule 675. subordinates shall see that all ladders, ropes, bamboos, privy vessels, and other articles
Rules which may facilitate escape are not left in any place from which they may be taken by a
657,658. prisoner;
G.O. No. 50
H.J., dated (2) to prevent to the best of their power the introduction into the jail and the giving to any
the 13th prisoner of any opium, ganja, tobacco, biri or cigarettes or other prohibited articles
January enumerated in Rule 660 or any article not permitted by rule ;
1954.
(3) to prevent and report any attempt at communication between prisoners and outsiders
except as permitted by rule; and shall report the fact when any suspicious persons are
observed loitering about the jail.
29
and the guarding and defending of the jail and all persons and property kept therein or
belonging thereto against the use of criminal force by any person;
(2) to render prompt and strict obedience to all lawful orders of his superior officers and to
treat all superior officer and visitors with respect;
(3) to comply with the requirements of all laws, rules, regulations, directions and orders for
the time being in force regulating the duties which they are to perform and the manner in
Rule 22.
which they are to perform them;
(4) to take proper care of all property of whatever kind any time entrusted to them and duly
account for the same whenever called upon so to do.
See section 193. Every Jailer or officer of a prison subordinate to him will or shall be guilty of any
54 Act IX of violation of duty or willful breach or neglect of any rule or regulation or lawful order made
1894. by competent authority, or who shall withdraw from the duties of his office without
permission, or without having given previous notice in writing of his intention for the period
of two months, or who shall willfully overstay any leave granted to him or who shall engage
Recommenda without authority in any employment other than his prison duty or who shall be guilty of
tion of the cowardice, shall be liable and punishable as per Section 54 of Act IX of 1894 on conviction
committee. before a Magistrate, to a fine not exceeding taka five hundred, or to imprisonment for a
period not exceeding three months, or to both.
193.1. In awarding punishment to subordinate officers and staff undue harshness should be
avoided and careful distinction made between serious offences and offences of trifling
nature.
194. Every subordinate officer who shall be guilty of any offence shall be liable to be punished by the
following departmental punishments, namely:-
1. Formal reprimand ;
2. Deferment of payment of salary for not more than fifteen days;
3. Cancelling of leave due ;
4. Deferment of leave due;
5. Extra drill up to a maximum period of one hour a day for not more than seven days (applies to the
warders of the warder establishment only);
6. Suspension for any period not exceeding six months.
7. Reduction in rank or emoluments or both ;
8. Postponement of increment due;
9. Removal from office and employments;
10. Compulsory retirement;
11. Dismissal;
12. Recovery from pay or gratuity of the whole or any part of any pecuniary loss to Government by
negligence or breach of orders.
13. Any combination of the above.
Note - 1. Deleted.
Note - 2 Departmental punishment is altogether distinct from punishment under the criminal law and
may be inflicted apart from any action taken under the later, but no officer shall be punished twice for the
same offence. Dismissal under Rule 201 is not a second punishment within the meaning of this rule.
Note.- 3. Deleted
195. No punishment of reduction in rank or removal, dismissal or compulsory retirement, shall be inflicted
on any subordinate officer except by the authority in whom the appointment of such officer is vested.
196. The Senior Superintendent of Central Jail and Superintendent of District Jail may punish-
(1) Any Deputy Jailor, or Assistant Jailor, Chief Head Warder and subordinate officer of the Manufactory
Department with any one or more of the punishments enumerated in clauses (1), (2), (3) and (4) of rule 194
provided that when any punishment other than those specified in clauses (1) and (2) is awarded, a report of
the fact shall be made to the Inspector General for record in his office;
(2) Any Head Warder or warder with any one or more of the punishments enumerated in clauses (1), (2), (3),
(4), (5) and (6) of rule 194 ; when the punishment enumerated in clause (6) is awarded to the warder guards
30
approval of the appointing authority shall have to be obtained.
(3)The Pharmacist or Diploma Nurse/Male Nurse with any or more of the punishment in clauses 1,2,3 and 4.
(4) Any Clerk or member of clerical establishment; with any one or more of the punishments enumerated in
clauses (1), (2), (3) and (4).
197. The Senior Superintendent of Central Jail and Superintendent of District Jail may draw proceedings
against any Head Warder or Warder of his Jail for any serious breach of Jail rules (for which such officers can
not be adequately punished by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent) and submit the charge sheet along
with the papers of proceedings to the Deputy Inspector General of Prisons (Division) for disposal.
198. The Deputy Inspector General of Prisons has no power to revise or modify any punishment awarded by
a Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of any other jail, but if, in any case, he is of opinion that a Head
Warder or Warder has been too leniently or too heavily punished, or that the punishment awarded exceeds
the powers granted by these rules, he shall report the matter to the Inspector-General.
199. When any subordinate officer is accused or suspected of having committed any offence,
and if the Senior Superintendent of Central Jail/Superintendent of District Jail is of opinion that
Rules a prima facie case against such officer has been made out and that the case cannot be adequately
74,193, dealt with departmentally, he shall forthwith suspend such officer and cause him to be brought
before a Magistrate having jurisdiction to enquire into or try the case. All such cases of
205.
suspension of subordinate officers should be reported at once to the appointing authority for
approval. Every case in which the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent is in doubt whether to
deal with departmentally or institute a criminal prosecution should promptly be reported to the
appointing authority for orders.
200. For the following offences, if committed by any jail officer, a prosecution shall be instituted against the
offender, provided the evidence is such as to make a conviction probable; if the evidence is not sufficient for
this, but is sufficient to produce a reasonable belief of the guilt of the officer in the mind of the Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent, he shall take action in accordance with Rule 204:-
1. Wilfully or negligently permitting an escape.
2. Any offence under section 42 of Act IX of 1894 relating to the introduction of, or supply to prisoners
of forbidden articles, unauthorized communication with prisoners, and abetment of such offences.
3. Being concerned directly or indirectly with any contract for supplies for the jail or receiving any
present from a supplier.
4. Any serious offence punishable under the Bangladesh Penal Code or other criminal law.
No offence of this character can be ignored, condoned or punished departmentally with a minor
punishment. Any case in which a criminal prosecution is not instituted shall be reported to the appointing
authority.
201. Every subordinate officer who shall at any time be convicted of any serious offence by a Criminal
Court shall, without prejudice to any other punishment to which he may be liable or subjected, be liable to be
summarily dismissed from his office and shall not be retained in the Government Service.
31
202. Subordinate officers and staff who commit any of the following offences shall ordinarily be punished
by dismissal, or in serious cases, when there is sufficient evidence to obtain conviction, shall be prosecuted
under section 54(1) of Act IX of 1894:
Rule 213. 203. In enquiring into and passing orders upon charges of a minor kind against a subordinate
officer, it will be sufficient for the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent to record, in the
service book or service roll of the accused, the nature of the offence and the punishment
awarded.
Jail Circulars 204. (1) When any subordinate officer is accused of an offence deserving of dismissal or
No. 7 of 1924 removal or any other penalty the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall hold a formal
and 56 of 1904.
departmental enquiry.
(2) The record of such departmental enquiry will consist of a proceeding in the form given in
Rule 205, and shall include-
(a) the framing of specific charges in writing against the Government servant concerned, of
which he shall be furnished with a copy and which he shall be called on to explain;
(b) the record of a memorandum of the evidence of the witness examined (if any). Such
examination should, if there be no special reason to the contrary, be conducted in the
presence of the accused, who should be given an opportunity of questioning the witness.
Except under very special circumstances, no pleader or agent should be allowed to appear
either on behalf of Government or the accused either before the officer who conducts the
inquiry or any officer to whom appeal may be made;
(c) a reasonable opportunity to the accused of adducing his defence, which shall be reduced
to writing, also the record of a memorandum of the evidence of any witnesses adduced by
the accused in so far as their evidence may be relevant to the charge against him;
(d) a recital of the accuseds previous character as recorded in his service book or office
records;
(e) a clear and definite finding upon each of the charges originally framed against the
accused;
(f) a clear and definite finding as to the punishment to be inflicted. Or, when the officer
conducting the enquiry has not the power to punish, a clear statement of what he considers
to be an appropriate punishment for the offences established.
(g) after the enquiry has been completed and after the punishing authority has arrived at a
provisional conclusion in regard to penalty to be imposed, the subordinate officers/staff
shall, if the proposed penalty be dismissal, compulsory retirement, removal or reduction in
rank or time scale, be supplied with a copy of the report of the authority conducting the
inquiry and be called upon to show cause within 7(seven) days against the particular penalty
proposed to be imposed. Any representation in this behalf within 7 days shall be only taken
into consideration before the orders are passed.
(3) When the orders for punishment are passed by an authority other than the person
conducting the enquiry into the conduct of the Government officer concerned, it will be
sufficient if the authority passing orders of punishment definitely records his agreement or
32
disagreement with the person by whom the enquiry was conducted.
(4) The record is to be prepared by the authority conducting the enquiry, as the enquiry is
proceeded with; it shall not be written by any Jail Assistant after the case has been
completed.
(5) When any orders of punishment have been passed, the officer punished shall be entitled
to receive a copy of the order of punishment free of cost, and shall also be allowed to take a
copy of the rest of the records, paying for the copy at the usual copy rates or providing his
own paper and copyist.
(6) Deleted.
(7) The above instructions will not apply-
(i) in the case of public servants.
(a) who are judicially convicted of a criminal offence and are dismissed or otherwise
punished solely with regard to the finding of the Court, or
(b) who abscond with an accusation pending against them;
(ii) when from facts elicited in a criminal case brought against a public servant in which the
latter has not been convicted, or in a civil suit instituted against him, it is apparent that his
retention in the public service is prima facie no longer desirable. These facts may be used as
the basis of an order calling on him to show cause why he should not be punished by
dismissal or otherwise. In such a case the officer concerned should have an opportunity of
submitting his defence, and he should not be precluded from tendering such further evidence
in support of his case as he may see fit to produce.
205. Instructions for drawing up proceedings.-
1. The following sequence will be observed in drawing up of proceedings against any subordinate
officer:-
2. Charges, which are to be specific, shall be separately numbered and shall indicate the date, occasion
and the nature of the offence committed. A copy should be given to the accused charged.
3. Memorandum of evidence.
4. Defence-The officer charged should be permitted to submit his defence in writing.
5. Remarks- Comments on the evidence and defence should be recorded.
6. Character-Date of appointment. Punishments and rewards to be noted.
7. Order.-shall be passed by the competent authority.
8. Orders, if any, regarding subsistence allowance, service for pension, etc, should be given.
N.B.- If it is decided to prosecute, this will be noted as a preliminary order, the final order being recorded
when the judicial proceedings, including appeal, have been disposed of. At any time after hearing the
evidence in support of the charge, the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent may, if he is of opinion that a
prima facie case has been made out, suspend the officer from his office.
206. The proceedings shall be forwarded to the authority in whom the appointment and dismissal of the
officer is vested for disposal.
Recommenda 207. All subordinate officers who are dismissed or discharged, shall be required to quit their
-tion of the quarters in the jail at once, and shall not be allowed to re-enter the jail premises. An officer
Committee. under suspension pending decision of a case against him may remain at his quarters,
provided no substitute is appointed to act for him; but if suspended for a definite period as a
punishment, he shall forthwith quit the jail premises. An officer under suspension shall not
enter the jail or jail offices or hold any communication with prisoners, without prior
permission of the competent authority.
208. Claims by subordinate officers to allowances during any period for which they may have been under
suspension shall be determined according to Bangladesh Service Rules.
Rule 30. 209. All proceedings of a Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent under Rule 204 shall be
subject to the control and revision of the appointing authority, who, either on his own motion
or on an appeal from any person who considers himself aggrieved, may call for the record of
33
the case and pass such orders as may appear to him to be necessary.
210. Appeals from the decisions of the Deputy Inspector General of Prisons shall lie to, and be disposed of
by, the Inspector-General of Prisons, Appeals from jail officers still in the service must be made in writing
and be forwarded through their Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent; and to every petition of appeal shall
be attached a copy of the order of the Deputy Inspector General of Prisons, attested by him. This rule applies
to an order requiring an officer to retire from service.
Bengal Govt. 211. All appeals under Rule 212 must be preferred to the Inspector General of Prisons within
Revenue the period of two months from the date of communication of the order to the appellant.
Dept No. Unnecessary and vexatious appealing will be considered, and dealt with by the Inspector
2494 of General of Prisons as insubordination. The Inspector General of Prisons after having passed
4.12.1913 an order on any appeal will not notice a second petition on the same subject unless it
contains some new or important matter
Bengal Govt. 212. The following rules regulate the presentation of appeals by Government servants
Revenue holding subordinate appointments, that is to say, Government servants whose appointments
Dept. No. are not gazetted by the Government: -
2494 of
4.12.1913. (1) Departmental punishments shall be held to include (i) dismissal, (ii) removal (iii)
suspension (iv) degradation (v) stoppage of promotion or of increment of pay.
(2) Every officer on whom any departmental punishment is inflicted, shall have the right
of preferring one appeal namely, to the authority immediately superior to the officer
who passes the order of punishment.
(3) No officer whose service is inferior shall have the right of preferring a second appeal
in the case of any departmental punishment.
Note: - Subordinate officers of inferior service mean warder guards up to the rank of
Head Warder for whom Deputy Inspector General of Prisons is the appointing authority.
(4) Executive officers in superior service whose appointments are made by the Inspector-
General of Prisons shall have the right to prefer a single appeal to the Secretary to
Ministry of Home (Jail) department in cases in which the Inspector-General has
passed an original order which materially affects the position of the appellant in the
public service, e.g., orders of dismissal, removal, suspension or degradation. But
where the Inspector-General has acted as an appellate authority in respect of any
orders passed by a subordinate officer which the latter is competent to pass, such
decision shall be final except in the case of officers drawing more than Tk. 3605/- per
menses, to whom a second appeal will be allowed.
(5) All ministerial officer shall have the right of preferring a single appeal from an order
of dismissal, removal, degradation, suspension or stoppage of promotion or of
increment of pay to the authority immediately superior to the officer who originally
passed such order; Ministerial officers on a pay of more than Tk. 3605/- a month shall
have the right of preferring a second appeal (1) against an order of dismissal or
removal, (2) against an order of suspension or degradation or stoppage of promotion
or of increment of pay when the period in respect of which the order is passed exceeds
six months.
Provided that an order passed on appeal by the Inspector General shall, in the case
of an officer whose service is superior and who draws pay of less than Tk. 1875/- a month,
be final.
(6) No appeal as of right shall lie against an order declining to give an appointment or
promotion to a particular individual, or affecting a transfer or an extension of service.
Recommenda
212.1. The Government shall have the power to revise any order, whether it is appealable
-tion of the
or not or whether an appeal has actually been preferred or not when in the opinion of the
Committee.
Government an order in revision is required in order to do justice in the case.
34
213. (1) Upon appointment every non-gazetted officer shall be furnished at his own expense with a
service book. This will be the record on which the grant of pension will depend and will contain details of
every stage of his official life. In it will be entered particulars of his appointment and changes of
appointment, transfers, leave, changes of pay, offences and punishments (serially numbered) with brief
details of the reasons for punishments awarded.
No estimate of on officers character or of his merits and demerits and on periodical assessment of
his work will be rendered in his service book, but entries will be made of any commendation or reward
officially conveyed or awarded by or through the Inspect of General of Prisons.
(2) Every entry in the service book will be made over the full signature of the
superintendent, in case of warder establishment, will also be simultaneously made in the
service register maintained for them.
B.J. For No.97. (3)The service book will be kept in the custody of the Jailer or, in the case of the
Government of manufactory establishment, of the Deputy Superintendent in the office of the Jail to which
India, finance
Department the officer is attached. On transfer of an officer, his service book, after all necessary entries
No.502 C.S.R have been made in it and after comparison with the service register maintained under rule
dated the 29th 303 and the correction of any discrepancies between the two records and any omissions in
May 1917.G.O. either will be sent under registered cover within seven days to the Superintendent of the Jail
No. 2956 H.J,
dated the 3rd
to which he is transferred. See Rule 231.
September 1941.
Note. - Service Book together with Service Rolls should be maintained for all inferior
servants.
Rules, 214. It is most important that every service book or service roll should be carefully and
217,303,304. accurately kept up and that every erasure should be properly attested, otherwise difficulties
may arise as to verification of service when the officer applies for pension.
Note.- The detailed instructions regarding the annual verification of service as laid down in
S.R. 247 of the Fundamental Rules should be carefully followed.
Bengal Form 215. Every non-gazetted officer shall also be furnished with a service record (in B.J. form
No. 5126. No.96), which shall be securely attached to his service-book. This book when complete shall
Bengal Form contain-
No. 5122. 1. the declaration Form B.J. Form No. 89. See rule 166.
Bengal Form 2. the Verification Roll-B.J. form No. 95. See Rule 300.
No. 5125. 3. the Record of Issue of Uniform See Rule 365.
Bengal form 4. the Verification of Service. See Rule 308.
No. 5123. 5. the Results of Examination. See Rule 380.
6. Deleted
Jail Circular 216. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of Jails shall cause the services of every
No. 35 of subordinate officer/staff under him to be entered in detail in his record (B.J. Form No. 96)
1896. Bengal and shall verify under his signature every such entry from the Pay List and Acquaintance
Form No. Roll.
5126. He shall also cause to be recorded in the Service Book of all such subordinate officers
Bengal Form and staff including Manufactory staff, all particulars regarding the rewards, punishment,
No. 2435. transfer, leave and results of departmental Examination etc., under his signature.
The Jailor shall ensure safekeeping of service books and records of the above-
mentioned officers and staff.
The Service Book and Records of the Manufactory staff shall be kept under the safe
custody of the Accountant in case of Central Jail.
Section VIIA
Annual Confidential Reports.
Recommenda 217. (1) The Inspector General of Prisons shall write the Annual Confidential Reports in the
-tion of the prescribed form of Additional Inspector General of Prisons and Deputy Inspector Generals
Committee.
35
of Prisons and submit the same to the Secretary, Ministry of Home Affairs for his
countersignature. The Annual Confidential Reports of the above officers shall be maintained
in the Ministry of Home Affairs. The Deputy Inspector General of Prisons (Headquarters)
will write the Annual Confidential Repots of the Assistant Inspector Generals of Prisons and
submit the same to the Inspector General of Prisons for his countersignature. The Annual
Confidential Reports of the above officers shall be maintained in the Prisons Directorate.
(2) The Annual Confidential Reports of all other subordinate officers of the Prisons Directorate shall be
written by the Assistant Inspector General of Prisons and submitted to the Deputy Inspector General of
Prisons (Headquarters) for his countersignature and recording his opinion. The reports will be maintained in
the A.C.R. Section of the Prisons Directorate under the supervision of the Assistant Inspector General of
Prisons (Administration).
(3) The Deputy Inspector General of Prisons, shall write the Annual Confidential Reports of the Senior
Superintendent of Central Jail, Medical Officers of all the Jails and Superintendent of District Jails of his
Division and submit the report to the Inspector General of Prisons for his countersignature and recording his
opinion thereon. These reports shall be maintained in the Prisons Directorate.
(4) Senior Superintendent of Central Jail shall write A.C.R. of the Deputy Superintendent, the Jailor and all
other subordinate officers under him up to the rank of Chief Head Warder and submit the same to the Deputy
Inspector General of Prisons of the Division for his countersignature and transmission to the Inspector
General of Prisons. These reports shall be maintained in the Prisons Directorate.
(5) Similarly the Superintendents of District Jails shall write A.C.R. of the Jailor and all other subordinate
offices under him up to the rank of Chief Head Warders and shall forward the reports to the Deputy Inspector
General of Prisons of the Division for his countersignature and transmission to the Inspector General of
Prisons. These reports shall be maintained in the Prisons Directorate.
(6) All unfavorable remarks in the Annual Confidential Reports of the above offices shall be communicated
to the officers concerned reported upon in writing and signature of such officers obtained against remarks.
The representation if any, against the adverse remarks from the officers reported upon, should be submitted
through the initiating officer who will send it to the countersigning officers with his comments for review
and disposal.
(7) History of Services of all superior and subordinate officers shall be maintained in the Prisons Directorate
in the form of a personal file.
217.1 Service Register (in B.J. Register No. 4) in respect of Chief Head Warder, Head Warders, Warders
(including Chief Matron/Matron and Female Warders) shall be maintained in the office of the Deputy
Inspector General of Prisons of each Division.
Rule 305. 218. A gradation list of all officers and staff (excluding Head Warder and Warders) shall be
Rules published by the Inspector General of Prisons annually for general information of all
302,306,307, concerned.
316. Similarly the gradation list of Head Warders and Warders of each Division shall be
Recommenda published annually by the Deputy Inspector General of Prisons for general information.
tion of the
Committee. Promotion in different grades and appointments will be made on the grounds of merits
on the result of the departmental examination and not by seniority. Seniority shall be taken
into account only when it is impossible to choose between two or more person on grounds of
merit alone.
G.O. No. 2729 219. For drawl of increments rules 24 and 25 of the Fundamental Rules should be seen.
P.J., dated the
15th July 1933.
G. of B. No. 220. The pension rules contained in Bangladesh Service Rules Part-I as amended by the
4084 P.J.,
Government from time to time will apply to all jail officers. Services of warders will count
dated the 28thfor pension on the superior scale. Applications for pension or gratuity in prescribed form for
November retirement of all superior and subordinate officers (except Head Warders and Warders)
1919. whose appointment lies with the Government or Inspector General of Prisons, as the case
may be, shall be submitted to the Inspector General of Prisons with the Service Book or
Jail Circular Service Roll/Service Statement of the officer, on whose behalf the application is made after
36
No. 77 of necessary verification of service, by the respective officers in which the officer is in service
1913. at the time not more than six months before the date of the officer is to leave the service so
that his claim to pension may be verified before he actually quits the service.
But in the case of Head Warders and Warders the pension case will be prepared in the
above manner by the Senior Superintendent of Central Jail/ Superintendent of District Jail
under whom the above noted custodial staff were serving and submitted to the office of the
concerned deputy Inspector General of Prisons of the division for submission to the Chief
Accounts Officer/ District Accounts Officer, as the case may be, for issue of pension
payment order.
G.of B.No 221. The Additional Inspector General of Prisons shall grant leave except casual leave in
16369p. accordance with the provisions of Bangladesh Services Rules (as amended from time to
Dated the 21st time) to all class II Jail officers and also to all other officers of the Jail upto the rank of Chief
December Head Warder (above the rank of Head Warder).
1917.
The Inspector General of Prisons is empowered to grant casual leave to Additional
Inspector General of Prisons, all Deputy Inspector General of Prisons and Assistant
Inspector General of Prisons. The Additional Inspector General of Prisons is empowered to
grant casual leave for other gazetted officers as admissible under the rules.
221.1 The Deputy Inspector General of Prisons of the respective Division shall grant leave
(except casual leave) in accordance with Bangladesh Services Rules (as amended) to all
subordinate officers of the Divisional office as well as to the subordinate officers of the Jail
upto the rank of Deputy Jailer for a period not exceeding one month.
He shall also grant leave to all Head Warders of his Division as admissible under the
Services Rules and to the Warder guards for a period exceeding 4 (four) months as
admissible.
He is empowered to grant casual leave to the Senior Superintendent of Central Jail,
Superintendent of the District Jails and to all other subordinate staff of the Divisional office
under his jurisdiction.
222. (a) Senior Superintendent of Central Jail or Superintendent of District Jail is empowered to grant such
leave (except casual leave) as may be permissible under the rules applicable to any Warder of his jail
provided that-
(i) the period of leave granted shall not exceed four months.
(ii) Local arrangement can be made, when necessary, for carrying on the works of the absentee, when
local arrangements cannot be made, he will inform the Deputy Inspector General of prisons of his Division
for arranging substitute from any of the jails within his jurisdiction.
(b) Senior superintendent of Central Jail is empowered to grant casual leave to the Deputy Superintendent of
his Jail and to any other subordinate officer under him.
Similarly Superintendent of District Jail shall grant casual leave to all categories of subordinate
officers of his District Jail.
G.O. No., 223. Application for grant of leave other than casual leave for a period exceeding one month
2368 P.J., from all subordinate officers (above the rank of Head Warder) in the prescribed form should
dated the 11th be submitted to the Additional Inspector General of Prisons sufficient time ahead.
June 1931.
Note.- A leave register for all kinds of leave including casual leave shall be maintained
in all the Jails including subsidiary Jails.
37
(b) All permanent staff of the warder establishment including Chief Head Warder, Head
Warders and Warders are to be granted one full day and night off each in a week when the
strength of the guarding staff so permits without dislocating the guarding duties.
Section-VIII- Security and Penalty Bonds
226. Deleted.
227. Deleted.
228. Deleted.
229. Deleted.
230. Deleted.
231. Deleted.
232. Deleted.
233. Deleted.
234. Deleted.
235. Deleted.
236. Deleted.
237. Deleted.
238. Deleted.
239. Deleted.
240. Deleted.
Section IX. - The Jailor.
G.O. No. 1045
P.J., dated the 241. Any rule in this Code referring to a Jailor shall apply to any Deputy Jailor or other
31st March, person performing the duties of a Jailor.
1928.
G.O. No. 242. The Jailor shall be the chief executive officer of the jail and shall control the whole
1/E-16/88- subordinate jail establishment under the orders of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent
Jail-1/668
dated and shall assist him on all occasions, and see that his instructions are carried into effect. He
13.11.93. shall be responsible for the strict carrying out of all the rules in this Code relating to the
management of the jail and prisoners. He should therefore make himself thoroughly
acquainted with the rules and with the circulars issued by the Inspector General.
The appointment of a Jailor shall be made by the Inspector General of Prisons subject
to the recommendation of the Public Service Commission. His appointment shall be notified
in the Bangladesh Gazette.
242A. The post of Jailor shall be filled up by promotion from amongst the Deputy Jailors who have five
years of experience in the feeder post. Provisional selection shall be made by the Selection Board,
constituted by the Government from time to time, by a Departmental examination, which shall be held in the
office of the Inspector General of Prisons.
The syllabus of the examination shall be as follows:-
(1) Jail Code Rules Vol. I and II and Acts and Regulation regulating establishment and management of Jails,
the manner of confinement and treatment of the prisoners and maintenance of discipline amongst them.
(2) Bangladesh Services Rules, Part I and II and Bangladesh Financial Rules.
(3) Contents of Circulars originated by the office of the Inspector General of Prisons.
(4) Arms Drill.
(5) General Knowledge.
Each of the above subjects will carry full marks of 100 and a pass mark of 50 respectively.
The result of the examination along with the Annual Confidential Reports of the officers eligible for
appointment as Jailor shall be sent to the Public Service Commission for approval and final selection.
243. All officers subordinate to the Jailer shall be under his immediate control and shall implicitly obey his
orders.
38
244. The Jailor is authorisd to grant leave of absence from the Jail to any subordinate officer without the
sanction of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the jails, but this leave shall not extend beyond four
hours, and during the subordinate officers absence the Jailor shall be held personally responsible for the due
performance of the absentees duties.
See Section 245. The Jailor shall reside in the Jail premises, unless the Senior Superintendent/
16, Act IX of Superintendent of jail permits him in writing to reside elsewhere. He must always be present
1894. in the jail or jail grounds except when he has to attend a Court of Justice, or on permission
Rule 1338. from the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent. The Jailor shall, before leaving the jail
G.O. No. 709 precincts for any purpose whatsoever make over charge of the jail to the next senior officer
P.J., dated the in rank present. He shall record the fact that he has done so in his report book. The officer
9th receiving charge shall thereupon countersign such entry.
November
The Jailor and Deputy Jailor shall not be absent from the Jail at the same time during
1927.
the day from unlock to lock-up. The hours for meals and rest should be so arranged that
either the one or the other is present at the jail.
G.O. No. 246. He shall, if required, accompany the Magistrate, Chief Medical Officer, Inspecting
8493 R.J., Officers, and Official and Non-Official Visitors on their visits to the jail. He shall always
dated the 16th accompany the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent on his visits to the jail.
September
1922.
Rules 247. The Jailor shall keep a report book, in Register No. I, in which he shall record daily on the
245,260,462, left-hand page the state of the jail and all occurrences of importance, and make reports and
472. representations.
In this book he shall enter daily-
(a) The hour at which the wards were opened.
(b) What members of the jail staff were present.
(c) The hour when prisoners began work.
(d) The number of prisoners who used the night latrine (in small jails, the number and
names of these prisoners).
(e) In jails in which a Cell Register is not kept, the names of prisoners who slept in cells last
night.
(f) The hour at which prisoners stopped work at midday, and at which work was
recommenced.
(g) The hour at which work was stopped for the day, and at which the prisoners were locked
up.
He should also record all cases in which he may have found it necessary to use restraint to
any prisoner, any violent outbreak or serious offence, accident, death, outbreak of epidemic
disease, or any occurrence out of the ordinary routine or his visits to the female ward on the
previous night with the reasons and hours thereof. In default of performing his daily visits or
duties as are required by these rules he should state how far he has omitted them, and the reason.
He shall report any neglect or offence committed by or the absence of any subordinate officer
from duty, or application for leave requiring the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendents order;
also enter requests for sanction for unusual expenditure or for the employment of prisoners in
any special manner, or for extramural work or any matters he may require orders. This book shall
be laid daily before the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent, who shall endorse his orders
upon each entry, or, if no order or comment is required, append his initials, on the right-hand
page. On Saturday mornings, the Jailor in district jails and in central jails such official as the
Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may nominate for the purpose, will certify in the Jailors
report book that he has carefully examined the entries made in the several registers since the
preceding Friday, and that they have been found correct and up to date.
Rules 248. His chief duties are to secure the safe custody of prisoners, to enforce discipline among
647,742. prisoners and his subordinates, to ensure that prisoners sentenced to rigorous imprisonment
do the work assigned to them after attitude tests required for imparting vocational training to
the prisoners on any particular trade best suited for such prisoners for their rehabilitation
after release, and to maintain a high standard of health among them so far as this can be
secured by strict compliance with the rules and orders made with this object. The sedulous
39
attention to all matters, which can improve the health of the prisoners, will be considered
one of the highest qualifications for the post of Jailor. He shall visit every part of the jail
daily, including cells and hospital, and see every prisoner at least once in every 24 hours and
motivate them to keep themselves away from the criminal acts upon release.
Rules 249. It shall be his duty to be always present when the prisoners are locked up at night and
436,446. taken out of the wards in the morning, and this duty cannot be delegated except by
permission of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent, unless the Jailor is sick and unfit
for duty. When it is so delegated a note of the same must be made in the Jailors report book.
In large jails a part of the unlocking and locking up must be performed by the Deputy Jailor,
Chief Head Warder, Head Warder who shall be responsible for the proper performance of
their portion of the work, but the Jailor must ascertain from these officers that everything is
correct and that every prisoner is present. He shall also see that all keys are counted and
properly disposed of every night as required by Rules 324,333 and 348.
Rules 250. It shall be his duty, on the admission of a prisoner, to satisfy himself that the writs,
543,544. warrants or orders are in order, to take from the prisoner all money, jewelery, and other
articles found upon him, and all clothing not required in jail, and to see that the same are
G.O. No. properly entered on the prisoners writ, warrant or order. When the property consists of
1587 H.J., money, the amount shall be entered in the contingent cash-book. He shall be responsible for
dated the 19th the safe custody of prisoners property. He shall cause to be produced the prisoners as soon
April, 1938. as possible before the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent and to the Medical Officer as
required by rules 507 and 514.
Rule 503. 251. The Jailor is responsible for the safe custody of all warrants of convicted prisoners
Rule 542(3). and the strict enforcement of their terms; he shall see that the name of every prisoner is on
Rules his arrival entered in the Release Diary under the date on which he is to be released that in
523,769. case of the prisoner obtaining a remission of sentence, or receiving any additional sentence
while in jail, the entry in the Release Diary is transferred to the correct date; and that no
prisoner is on any account either released before his time or (except under the provisions of
Rule 102) kept in jail beyond the termination of his sentence or beyond the date on which
under the remission system he is entitled to be released.
252. The Jailor shall assign to each prisoner his work, after aptitude test and on the result of classification of
such prisoner by the Classification Board subject to the control of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent
and shall see that the task is properly entered on the history ticket, and that all changes of labour are so
entered. In the distribution of labour he shall invariably consult the result of the fortnightly weighments,
aptitude tests etc, and see that no prisoner who is losing weight is placed on any labour, which is likely to
injure his health. This duty cannot be delegated to any subordinate without the permission of the Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent, who, however, in central jails, if he considers it expedient, may entrust it to
the Deputy Superintendent.
Rules 253. The Jailor shall note every breach of jail rules in the prisoners history ticket, and shall
186,187,202, bring the offender before the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent, but is strictly
247,262,558, prohibited from punishing any prisoner. In case of absolute necessity, he may lock up a
730,981. prisoner in cell. But in such a case he shall bring the matter to the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendents notice with the least possible delay.
Rule 274(10) 254. With the view of preventing the secreting or possession of prohibited articles in the jail
he shall occasionally, at uncertain time, but at least once a week cause every prisoner and all
clothing, bedding, wards, workshops and cells to be thoroughly searched.
Rules 65,66. 255. The Jailor shall be strictly guided by the rules in Chapter XVII of this Code regarding
prisoners interviews and communications with their friends or outsiders. He shall not permit
any stranger or person not authorized to visit the jail under Chapter IV of this Code to enter
the jail without the written order of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent.
Rule 1115. 256. He shall be held responsible for the proper weighment and issue to the cooks of
prisoners rations, and for seeing that these are properly cooked and distributed so that
every prisoner receives his proper quantity; but, subject to such responsibility, he may with
the permission of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent, delegate these duties to the
Deputy Jailor or any other officer.
40
Rule 555. 257. The Jailor shall arrange that every prisoner who is desirous of seeing the Medical
Subordinate, or who is ill, or whose state of mind or of body appears to require medical
attention, is shown to the Medical Subordinate without delay; and he shall record the
circumstance on every such Prisoners history ticket.
258. All directions entered by the Chief Medical Officer or Medical Subordinate on a
Rule 555 prisoners history ticket relating to the treatment of such prisoner shall be complied with by
the Jailor, unless they are contrary to any order in these rules or unless the Jailor has not the
means or power to carry them out. In every case the Jailor shall record on the prisoners
history ticket, in respect of every direction, what action he has taken, or why he has not
taken action; and in any case when he considers it improper to comply with any direction, or
is unable to do so, he shall show the history ticket to the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent at his next visit and obtain his orders thereon. He shall carry out forthwith
emergent written orders of the Medical Officer regarding the sick in hospital.
Rule 132. 259. When any prisoner dies, the Jailor shall send immediate notice of the death to the
Rule 548. Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of Jail and to the Chief Medical Officer and also the
Rules 541,567. Medical Officer, if he is not already acquainted with the fact. A written intimation of every
G.O. No. 3244 death of a prisoner or of any person residing on the jail premises shall be furnished by the
P.J., dated the
Jailor to the Chairman of the municipality, if there be not a municipality, to the UP Chairman
16+th October
1936.
or to the Mayor of the City Corporation in case of Metropolitan City and to the Deputy
Commissioner of the District.
The following procedure should be strictly followed in regard to the sending of
intimation of the death of a prisoner to his relation:-
(a) When a prisoner dies in Jail, the Senior superintendent of Central Jail or the
Superintendent of District Jails as the case may be, shall send intimation of death direct by
telegram/radiogram/fax to the concerned Police Station with request to transmit the same to
the next kin of the deceased resides outside the limits of the town in which the jail is
situated. The dead body shall be retained for not more then twenty-four hours at the
discretion of the Senior Superintendents/Superintendent of the Jail.
(b)The Officer in-charge of the Police Station will take action as asked for by the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent.
260. Every Friday morning the Jailer shall hold a parade of all the prisoners for the time
being confined in the jail and shall, with the Medical Subordinate,-
(a) carefully inspect every prisoner;
(b) examine the clothing and bedding of every prisoner;
(c) check the group-books and satisfy himself generally that everything is in proper
Rule 247. order. He shall enter a report of his inspection in his Report Book, noting therein
the state of the clothing, cleanliness, numerical strength and other matters of
importance relating to the prisoner.
261. The Jailor shall be held responsible that the warder guards being properly drilled, generally
efficient and clean and neat in appearance. It shall be his duty to see that the reserve guard is at
all times present at the jail in full force, and properly armed. He shall see that all the warders
Rule 349. invariably sleep in the quarters allotted to them, and he shall occasionally, at least once a
fortnight, visit the warders quarters at night, and ascertain that none of the custodial staff has left
Rule 314. the jail premises without permission. He shall also visit warders Barrack frequently at least once
a week to see that off-duty Warder-guards are present in the Barrack/Jail premises and that the
Barrack has been kept neat and clean and sanitation of the highest standard is maintained.
261.1 The Jailor and his subordinates shall be specially trained in using modern fire
arms and be acquainted with defence technique system relating to the self restrain, in
any institution where such facilities are extended to the Prison Officers on request till
the establishment of a training institution for the Prisons staff.
261.2 The Jailor should give special attention in imparting vocational training to the
prisoners in different trades best suited for each of the convicted prisoners while
allotting work to such prisoner, for their rehabilitation in the society as a useful citizen
41
upon release. This principal function and duties shall be to see that all correctional
measures are taken for reformation of the offenders sentenced to rigorous imprisonment
for which he shall receive proper training in a training institute meant for the prison
staff.
Rule 1313. 262. The Jailor shall be responsible for safe custody of all important documents and for the
registers and records prescribed by these rules. He shall exercise general supervision over
Rule 82. the work of the office. The delegation of the preparation of returns, entries in registers, or
any other duty of the Jailor to any authorized subordinate, shall in no way relieve the former
(Jailor) of the responsibility of ensuring that these are correctly and punctually performed,
G.O. No. but his main duties are direct control and reformation of the prisoners and the management
2626-P.J., of the Jail. The cash-book shall be maintained by U.D. Assistant-cum-Librarian/Jail
dated the 5th Assistant or an Accountant at the discretion of the Senior Superintendent/the Superintendent
September of the Jail as the case may be.
1929. The Jailor shall be responsible for the cash balances correspond with those shown in
the cash-book, initial the latter if correct, and present them daily to the Senior
Superintendent or Superintendent for inspection. In jails with a Deputy Superintendent,
these duties, in so far as they relate to the manufactory department, shall devolve on that
officer, the cash-book being maintained by the Accountant.
Rule 1346. 263. The Jailor is prohibited from making advances from private funds for jail purposes. In
all financial transactions he shall strictly follow the procedure laid down in the Jail Code and
in the Civil Account Code.
264. The Jailor shall be responsible for all stores, machinery, etc., in his charge, and shall
render an account, on his removal or transfer, of all manufactured goods, raw material, tools
plants, money, etc., so far as the District Jail is concerned. He shall see that all store rooms
are kept clean and neatly arranged, and protected as far as possible from vermin, birds,
insects and damp. The Jailor of a central jail to which a Deputy Superintendent has been
Rule 801. appointed shall be responsible for all stores, etc., not appertaining to the manufactory
Rule 1122. department, and shall similarly render an account of them. The responsibility of the Jailor
for stores, etc., may be delegated to the Deputy Jailor and the Store Keeper by written order,
which shall be submitted for approval to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent. This,
however, will not relieve the Jailor from his general responsibility for the safe custody and
correctness of stores in the jail. The keys of Store/Godown shall always remain with the
officer placed in charge of the godown, duplicate keys being kept in a sealed envelope under
the initial of the Senior Superintendent or Superintendent.
Jail Circular 265. When a Jailor is discharged or suspended, resigns, takes leave (other than casual leave),
Letter No. or is transferred, he shall be required, on making over charge to his successor, to give an
3537-67, inventory (in B.J. Form No. 87) of all property, stores, etc., in his hands, which will be kept
dated the in the jail records a copy being given to his successor. Whenever the responsibility of the
19th Jailor for stores, etc., are delegated to the Deputy Jailor or jail clerk under Rule 264, the
February relieving Jailor shall simply inspect the stores, etc., and check some of the items and get a
1935. certificate from the officer-in-charge that the stores are correct. A detailed check of stores,
Rule 234. etc., is not necessary as the officer-in-charge is responsible for the correctness of actual
stock in the jail. The relieving Jailor shall however take over personally such articles as were
in the charge of the relieved Jailor. He shall give vouchers for all credit sales to the relieving
officer. The Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall ascertain that the inventory is
correct and complete, and that the unrealized credit sales are duly vouched for. After full
time for all due enquiry within one month, if the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent be
satisfied of the correctness of the accounts, a no demand certificate (in B.J. Form No. 88)
shall be granted to him and a duplicate copy forwarded to the Inspector-General. In case of
the jailors death, the inventory shall be made by, or under the directions of, the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent, and the certificate shall be granted on the application of the
heirs or executors of the deceased. This rule may be suspended in the case of a Jailor who
takes privilege leave or leave on average pay for not more than six weeks, but in that case
the Jailor who takes leave shall be pecuniarily responsible for the stores, etc., during his
absence, and the burden of proving the responsibility of his locum tenens for any loss
42
shall lie with him.
266. When a Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of jail newly assumes charge of a Jail, it shall be the
duty of the Jailor to bring to his notice all special rules and orders relating to the management of that Jail.
Any omission or neglect on the part of Jailor in this respect will make him liable to disciplinary action.
Section X.- European Warders
267. Deleted.
268. Deleted.
269. Deleted.
270. Deleted.
271. Deleted.
Recommendation of Section XI.-The Deputy Jailor.
the Committee.
G.O. No.709 P.J.,
date the 9th 272. In every Central and District Jail there shall be such number of Deputy Jailors as
November 1927.
Rule 278. G.O. No. determined by the Government depending on the (1) population of the Jail (2) Volume of
S.R.O. 149-L/84 work and (3) Size of the Jail.
dated 17th April
1984.
Commending of the The post of Deputy Jailor should be filled up by direct appointment as per Recruitment
Committee.
Rules.
273. The Deputy Jailor is the Jailors immediate subordinate and assistant, whose duty it is to take his place
whenever he is absent, and to undertake whatever portions of the Jailors duties are assigned to him by
proper authority.
274. It shall be clearly understood that a fair share of the duties imposed by these rules on
From West the Jailor shall be assigned to the Deputy Jailor, who shall perform the duties allotted to him
Bengal Jail under the general supervision of the Jailor as required by rule 273. The work he is to do
Code Rule. must be clearly prescribed by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent in his minute book,
Rule 1178 and should from time to time be changed so that he may undergo a thorough training for the
Rule 256. appointment of Jailor. Among the duties which may ordinarily be allotted to the Deputy
From West Jailor the following may be specified:-
Bengal Jail
Code Rule. (1) The superintendence of the admission and search of newly received prisoners; the
Rule 256. inspection and custody of their warrants.
(2) The custody of prisoners private property (except cash and ornaments). See Rules
Rule 254. 250, 543 and 544.
Rule 241. (3) The placing of newly admitted prisoners in quarantine.
(4) The correct production of under trial prisoners at the court.
(5) The supervision of the prisoners' interview, dealing with prisoners' letters, petitions
and other communications and appeals.
(6) The supervision of the lock up and unlock of the Jail.
(7) The supervision of the execution of various forms of jail punishment .
(8) The charge of clothing store, the issue of jail clothing, bedding, etc., and the
maintenance of clothing register.
(9) The examination and weighment and storing of all grains and other rations stored and
the care of the grain and ration godowns.
(10) The supervision of the proper husking and cleaning of grains, and vegetables.
(11) The weighment and issue to the cooks of rations, the examination of the cooked food
and its proper distribution.
(12) Supervision of the reformatory activities of the prisoners and their training on
different trades for their future rehabilitation.
(13) The maintenance of cash-books, ration accounts and store register in prescribed
forms.
(14) The supervision and drilling of the custodial staff
(15) The keeping of warders Circle list, Service registers and service Books.
(16) Weekly search through-out the jail for prohibited articles.
Rule 241. 275. When the Deputy Jailor officiates for the Jailor during the temporary absence of the
latter, he shall possess all the powers, functions and responsibilities of that officer.
43
G.O. No. 709 276. In addition to the duties specified in rule 274, the Senior Superintendent/
P.J., dated the Superintendent may, by an order to be recorded in the Minute Book, allot to the Deputy
9th November Jailor any specified portions of the Jailors duties other than those referred to in rules 242,
1927. 247, 248, 251 and 262.
The Deputy Jailor shall share the Jailors responsibility for the carrying out of rules and
for the maintenance of discipline. He shall not be absent from his quarters at night without
the permission of the jailer.
Section XII. -Jail Assistants.
(U.D. Assistant-cum-Librarian, Jail Assistant-cum-Typist, Accountant, Assistant Accountant,
Store Keeper)
There shall be such numbers of Jail Assistant-cum-typists in the Jails as determined by
the Government from time to time including an U.D. Assistant-cum-Librarian in case of
Central Jail.
277. Candidates for employment as Jail Assistant and U.D. Assistant-cum-Librarian of Jail
Department shall be appointed by the Inspector General of Prisons on the recommendation
of the Selection Board as per recruitment rules.
Recommendation 278. There shall be such number of Jail Assistant appointed to each jail as Government may
of the Committee.
from time to time direct.
278.1. The Jail Assistant and U.D. Assistant-cum-Librarian shall see that all books, papers
and documents are properly maintained and the office kept clean and in proper order.
279. In Central Jails the duties to be assigned to the several Jail Assistant-cum-Librarian including Assistants
of Manufactory Department shall be determined by the Senior Superintendent by written order.
The Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the Jail shall be guided by the following Rules :-
Ordinarily the senior Jail Assistant shall remain in charge of the stores if he is capable to perform such work.
The Jail Assistant will hold the charge of accounts of a section in which he is employed, submit returns
and make general correspondence relating to his section.
The Jail Assistant shall be required to work as Assistant to the Deputy Jailor and be named Assistant to
the Admission Branch, Release Branch, Establishment Branch and Correspondence Branch and so on
according to the allotment of their duties made by the Jailor by written order in the minute book, which shall
be approved by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the Jail. The Jail Assistants shall be
subordinate to the Jailor and Deputy Jailors.
279A. Duties of U.D. Assistant-cum-Librarian:-
Duties and functions of U.D. Assistant-cum-Librarian shall relate to the General Department. He shall
be responsible for the maintenance of Cash-book and the Contingent Register and for the account, returns
and general correspondence, preparation of budget estimate and of forecast of annual requirement of food
grains and other necessary commodities, timely invitation of tenders and quotations for those articles. He
shall also be responsible for due checking of the bills of contractors or other suppliers, preparation of
Abstract Contingent bill and arranging for their drawl from the Treasury.
Recommenda 280. In district jails where there is no post of U.D. Assistant-cum-Librarian the above duties
tion of the and functions shall be performed by the senior Jail Assistant who is capable to perform such
Committee. duties. These duties shall be allotted to the Jail Assistant by the Jailor by written order which
is to be approved by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent.
Recommenda 280A. In Central Jail the duties are to be assigned to the Technical staff of the Manufactory
tion of the Department by the Deputy Superintendent through a written order which is to be approved by the
Committee. Senior Superintendent. There shall be an Accountant in the Manufactory Department in the
Central Jail. He shall be responsible for the maintenance of Cash-book and the Contingent
Register and for the accounts, returns, general correspondence, preparation of budget estimate
and other necessary commodities, arrangement for timely invitation of tenders/quotations for
these articles. The Accountant shall also be responsible for the due checking of the bills of the
contractors and other suppliers, preparation of abstract contingent bills and arranging for their
drawl from the Treasury and payment in time.
44
280B. There shall be an Assistant Accountant for the Manufactory Department of the Central Jail
who shall assist the accountant in his aforesaid duties and functions or any other duties and
functions assigned by the Deputy Superintendent with the approval of the Senior Superintendent.
280C. There shall also be a store keeper for the Manufactory Department of Central Jail who
shall keep accounts of all stores of the Manufactory Department namely, raw materials and
finished goods and submit such Returns as may be required by him under the orders of the
Deputy Superintendent with the approval of the Senior Superintendent. He shall be
responsible for preparation of annual stock of all store materials and finished goods for half
yearly and annual verification by the Senior Superintendent and arrange submission of
reports to the Inspector General of Prisons through the Senior Superintendent.
He shall also maintain accounts of all deadstock articles of the Manufactory
Department for annual verification and disposal of unserviceable articles by the Senior
Superintendent with due approval of the Inspector General of Prisons.
Note.- Technical Staff means-
1) Factory Overseer, Task Taker, Tailor Master, Tailor, Blacksmith, Carpenter, Book Binder
and Weaving Instructor. They shall be recruited by the Inspector General of Prisons under
the Recruitment Rules framed by Government from time to time.
Recommenda 281. Jail Assistant-cum-typist shall be subordinate to the Jailor and the Deputy Jailor and
tion of the shall carry out their orders. They will be held responsible for seeing that all books, papers
Committee. and documents are kept properly arranged in their places in the Jail office and that the office
is kept clean and in proper order.
Section XII-A.
The Sergeant Instructor.
281A- The appointment of Sergeant Instructor shall be made by the Inspector General of Prisons from the
following custodial staff on the recommendation of the Departmental Selection Board, constituted by
Government from time to time.
By promotion on the basis of merit-cum-seniority from amongst the Chief Head Warders as per recruitment
rules.
The Sergeant Instructor of a Central Jail shall perform the following duties and functions:-
(a) He shall impart training to the custodial staff in Arms Drill, defence technique, self restrain and
physical exercise and enforce strict discipline amongst them.
(b) Supervise the works of the gate keeper.
(c) Assist the Jailor in the maintenance of security and discipline in the Jail, especially in between
the gates.
(d) Prevent smuggling of any prohibited or unauthorized articles from the Jail.
(e) Check with reference to challans and gate passes, all articles coming into or passing out of the
Jail, and cause entries of these articles in the gate Register of Articles (No. 25).
(f) Search all prisoners passing into or out of the Jail Gate.
(g) He may also search Head Warders, Warders and all the prisoners passing into or out of the Jail
gate except official and non-official visitors and casual visitors who may be exempted from
search by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of Jail.
(h) If he has reason to suspect any person exempted from search is carrying unauthrized articles, he
may detain the person between the gates and refer the matter to the Jailor for necessary action
in this regard.
(i) Receive official and non-official visitors at the gate with due courtesy.
(j) Attend the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendents inspection and other ceremonial parades.
(k) Go on surprise rounds inside the jail to ensure observance of the rules by the prisoners and
cause search of wards, cells, and other places inside the jail for detection of prohibited articles
which may endanger the security of the jail.
(l) Do other duties as may be allotted by the Jailor with the approval of the Senior Superintendent
of Central Jail.
45
Section-XII B
School Teachers of Central and District Jails.
281B. The offenders of the prisons, main causes of their criminal acts being illiteracy and poverty, should
not also be kept away from education policy. Primary Education should be made compulsory for all
misguided human being lying behind the bars.
With this end in view there should be such number of paid teachers in every Central Jail and District
Jail proportionate to the prison population, as determined by the Government.
The post of Teacher should be appointed by direct recruitment as per Recruitment Rules.
281C. Duties and functions of the teachers:- The main duties to impart primary education to the
illiterate offenders of all classes for their correction in order to keep them away from criminal acts upon
release and to give them basic knowledge about moral values so as to enable them to differentiate between
right and wrong so that they may be rehabilitated in the society as a useful citizen.
He should, therefore, work as a social reformer and impart reformatory training to the literate offenders
as well, for their reintegration in the society.
He should treat the offenders with all humanity and kindness in order to make them understand that
Prisons are for the chastisement of the offenders and not for subjecting them to any hardship.
He should ensure attendance of all classes of illiterate offenders in the School in batches to give each of
them at least basic education.
He has, therefore, a vital role to play for the correction of the offenders and suggest measures to his
higher authorities in this regard, if possible in writing.
282. In every central jail and district jail there shall be Chief Matron, Matron and Female
Warders (Number will be determined by the Government)
Recommenda
Their recruitment shall be made as per recruitment rules.
tion of the
The appointment of Chief Matron, Matron and Female Warder shall be made on the
Committee.
recommendation of the Selection Board as per recruitment rules.
Before their appointment the antecedents of candidates selected for appointment as
such should be verified by the police authorities. It should be ensured that they are of good
moral character and have knowledge in technical know how in handicraft, tailoring,
embroidery etc. to enable them to impart training to the female prisoners. They must also be
certified by the Medical Officer to be physically fit for duties.
282A. Duties of Chief Matron.: In addition to the duties elsewhere prescribed in this Code, it shall be the
duty of every chief Matron to-
a. Subject to the general control of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent and Jailor, the Chief Matron
shall have the entire care and superintendence of the female Wards.
b. The Chief Matron shall supervise the duties of Female Warder and Matron and shall see that all Female
Warders and Matron are properly dressed whilst on duty.
c. The Chief Matron shall be present at the opening of the wards and mastering of the female prisoners in the
morning of each day. She shall likewise be present at locking up at night and shall see that every prisoner is
present.
46
d. The Chief Matron shall comply with rules 191,192 & 463.
e. During the day she shall have the custody of the keys of the wards, cells and yards in which female
prisoners are confined and at night after locking up she shall deliver them to the Jailor for safe custody,
unless any female prisoners are confined in the cells in which case rule 954 to be observed.
f. The Chief Matron shall, subject to the control of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent and Jailor,
allot tasks to the female convict sentenced to labour according to the class of labour for which each is passed
by the Medical Officer, and shall see that the tasks are duly performed, or report any convict who does not
perform her task.
g. The Chief Matron shall issue all necessary tools, implements, raw materials and other articles required for
the days work and to make a record for all articles so issued. Each evening she shall also collect all such
articles together with the product (if any) of the prisons labour after the period prescribed for work is over.
h. The Chief Matron shall measure or check the task (if any) performed by each prisoner and note the same
in the prescribed task record.
i. The Chief Matron shall keep constantly moving about while on day duty amongst the prisoners supervising
the work and discipline of female Jail and keeping female warders and female convict officers on the alert.
j. The Chief Matron shall carefully supervise the distribution of food to the female prisoners and see that
each receives her proper rations. She shall report to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent any instance
in which the food is bad or badly cooked or is insufficient in quantity.
k. The Chief Matron shall see that no male staff/warders/prisoners enter the female ward unless accompanied
by an authorised Jail officer. She shall also report to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent, if any Jail
officer who having no business there, enters or attempts to enter such ward.
l. The chief Matron shall search all female prisoners who are detained in a cell in the female enclosure.
m. The Chief Matron shall frequently visit the cells where condemned female prisoners are confined. She
shall also supervise the security system of the condemned prisoners.
n. The Chief Matron shall arrange examination of the condemned prisoners diet regularly by the Medical
Officer.
o. The Chief Matron shall look after the children daycare Centre.
p. The Chief Matron shall be responsible for identification of court going and released prisoners.
q. In the event of an escape taking place (female prisoners) the Chief Matron shall primarily be held
responsible unless she satisfactorily proves that the escape was due to no laxity of duty on her part (See rule
191 and 200).
283. Deleted.
284. Subject to the general control of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent and Jailor, the Chief
Matron/Matron shall have the entire care and superintendence of the female prisoners.
285. The female warder, if there is one, shall act as the immediate subordinate and assistant of the Matron,
shall take her place and perform her duties when absent, and under the Matrons control undertake whatever
portion of the Matrons duties may be delegated to her. She shall also be employed in escorting female
prisoners.
Rule 504 286. The Matron shall search all female prisoners on admission to the jail and remove all
prohibited articles found upon them. She shall also examine such prisoners, under the orders
of the medical officer, for the record of any wounds or marks on the person. Money or other
Rules property delivered with them or found on them shall be made over to the Jailor. She shall
543,544. also daily search the convicted prisoners in confinement to prevent the retention of
forbidden articles, or when ordered to do so by a superior officer. The search or examination
of a female shall be made only in the presence of females.
Rule 953. 287. The Matron shall be present at the opening of the wards and mustering of the female
From West prisoners in the morning of each day. She shall likewise be present at locking up at night,
Bengal Jail and shall see that every prisoner is present. During the day she shall have the custody of the
Code. keys of wards, cells, and yards in which female prisoners are confined, and at night after
locking up she shall deliver those to the Jailor for safe custody, unless any female prisoners
are confined in cells, in which case see Rule 954.
287.1. The Matron shall report to the Jailor any unusual occurrences in the female ward. She
shall also report to the Medical Officer as well as to the Jailor the case of any female
47
prisoner showing sign of sickness or any irregularity in the supply of medicines or sick diet.
Rule 955. 288. The Matron shall see that the wards are thoroughly cleansed and purified as soon as the
prisoners turn out in the morning, at which time also the latrines, bathing places, cells, work
sheds, and all other parts of the female jail shall be swept and cleaned.
Rule 786. 289. The Jailor shall allot tasks to the female convicts sentenced to labour, according to the
class of labour for which each is passed by the medical officer. The Jailor shall see that the
tasks as assigned, any change of labour is entered in the History Ticket. The Matron shall
see that the task of each is duly performed and report any convict who does not perform her
task.
289.1 The Matron shall see that the female prisoners shall be trained in such trade while
allotting task to them, which will facilitate their re-habilitation in the society.
The Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of jail shall make liaison with the female
Social Welfare Officer of Social Welfare Department for advice as to the re-socialization of
the female prisoners after release and then after care aid when necessary.
290. The Matron shall see that the female prisoners are clean in their persons and clothes; that they have the
prescribed amount of clothing; that their clothing not in use and bedding are properly aired and folded and
arranged in the place assigned to each prisoner.
For this purpose the matron shall regularly search and inspect persons, clothes and bedding of the
female prisoners.
291. The Matron shall carefully supervise the distribution of food to the female prisoners, and see that each
receives her proper rations. She shall report to the Senior Superintendent /Superintendent any instance in
which the food is bad, or badly cooked, or is insufficient in quantity.
292. The Matron shall take care that no male prisoner or officer enters the female enclosure of the jail unless
accompanied by a female warder or an authorised jail officer. She shall report to the Senior
Superintendent /Superintendent of Jail any jail officer who, without having authority to enter the female jail
or who, having no business therein, enters or attempts to enter into the female enclosure.
Rule 954. 293. When a female prisoner is detained in a cell in the female enclosure, the Matron or
female warder shall always be present in the enclosure with the cell keys in her possession,
to attend to prisoners wants and to prevent suicide. If a female prisoner is confined in a cell
at night, the Matron and female warder shall be present on alternate nights near the cell in a
suitable place of shelter. The female warders shall perform night duties in the female
enclosure from lock up by turn.
48
297. Man of good character, high moral, good social back ground and good physique should be selected as
Warders. The selection should be made as per Recruitment Rules on the basis of written and viva-voce test
by a departmental selection Board comprising of:-
a. Senior Superintendent of Central Jail. Chairman.
b. 2 Superintendents of affiliated District Jails. Member.
c. Assistant Surgeon of central jail Member
d. Deputy Superintendent of Central Jail. Member Secretary.
The candidate must be certified by the Civil Surgeon to be of good health and physically and mentally
fit for prisons duties.
298. Deleted.
G.O. No. 299. Ten percent of the total guarding staff of all Jails should always remain on training and
160/MHA(Jai leave reserve.
ls-1) dated
16.3.81. After recruitment all warders should undergo a course of training in drill, use of
firearms, in self-defence system and prison duties. They should also undergo a course of
training in reformatory activities and the rules relating to the relevant chapters of Jail Code,
From West and also Elementary Psychology, Sociology, Penology, Criminology as per syllabus as
Bengal Jail approved by the Government in G.O. No. 271MHA(Jail-1) dated 29.5.82 so as to enable
Code. them to impart proper training to the offenders behind the bars for their resocialisation.
These duties should be in addition to their guarding duties. The Sergeant Instructor shall
Recommenda impart Military training to the Warder guards. The Deputy Jailors or other suitable officers
tion of the as may be selected by the Senior Superintendent /Superintendent of the Jail shall hold
Committee. regular classes at least three times a week, to deliver lectures to the men on the rules of
relevant chapters of Jail Code, relating to their duties and also give them guidance in
reformatory activities amongst the offenders of all classes on such subject as enumerated
above in any Institute.
In order to keep the custodial staff in efficient trim, periodical examination of every
Warder and Head Warder in drill, rules and duties, after every three years, shall so be held,
the results along with the marks gained in Musketry, being noted in their Service Record. A
Warder or Head Warder who fails at this examination will have suitable action taken against
him. Head Warder found inefficient will be liable to be reduced in rank temporarily or
permanently after observing all the formalities. All orders in this connection shall endorse in
the service books under the initials of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent. Sub
Departmental examination shall be held in the Divisional Head Quarters/training institute
where situated.
300. Immediately on the enlistment of a warder, the Deputy Inspector General of Prisons of the division shall
forward for verification, his verification roll in Bangladesh Jail Form No. 95 to the Superintendent of Police
of the district to which such warder belongs; in the case of Metropolitan City such verification roll shall be
sent to the Police Commissioner; on the return of this roll from the police, the Jailor shall post it in the
Warders Service Book-Jail Form No. 96. In the event of the report of the Police unsatisfactory, the warder
shall be at once discharged.
49
Bengal Form 303. A service register (No.4) shall be kept at the Office of the Deputy Inspector General of
No. 4981. Prisons of each division containing in respect of every Head Warder and Warder of the
division, particulars of appointment, promotion, home district, all districts in which service
Rule 213. has been passed and in which serving, rewards, offences and punishments, and leave taken,
with date of each change or occurrence. Every offence committed shall bear a consecutive
number in order of date of occurrence.
304. To enable the Deputy Inspector General of Prisons of the Division to have the record kept complete and
up to date, the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of every Central and District Jail shall send to him
every month a return (No.28) giving all necessary details for the preceding month, in respect of his jail, of
deaths, suspensions, dismissals, absconding, offences and punishments with the date of every occurrence.
Rule 218. 305. The Deputy Inspector General of Prisons of the Division shall publish on the 1st of July
of each year a Division List containing the names, Division Numbers and other
particulars of Head Warders and Warders of the Division arranged in order of seniority. The
Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of jails should scrutinize this list with respect to the
warder establishment of their Jails and should draw the attention of the Deputy Inspector
General of Prisons of the division to any inaccuracy that may be discovered. Two copies of
this list shall be sent to the Inspector General.
Rule 351. 306. Whenever for any reason the appointment of a Head Warder in any jail is necessary
in his Division, the Deputy Inspector General of Prisons of the division shall promote to the
Rule 218. vacancy a warder of his division who has qualified in the Head Warder-ship Examination.
Rules 307. No warder shall be promoted to the rank of Head Warder unless he is efficient in drill,
218,326. can read and write satisfactorily, and has some knowledge of Jail Code rules relating to his
job, Elementary Penology, Criminology, Human Rights and in Woman and Children Rights
and Psychology. Head Warder found to be inefficient in these respects is liable to be reduced
temporarily or permanently.
308. No Head Warder or Warder shall remain in any Jail for more than three years. The Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent of the Jails shall be responsible for seeing that this rule is complied with. The
Deputy Inspector General of Prisons concerned shall arrange transfer necessary to give effect to this rule.
308A. No Head Warder shall be promoted to the rank of Chief Head Warder unless he passes the Chief Head
Warder-ship Examinations, which shall be conducted by the Departmental Selection Board constituted by the
Inspector General of Prisons and instructions issued by the Inspector General of Prisons according to the
merit list.
309. All orders of major importance affecting the Warder Guard, e.g., transfer, leave,
Rule 194. promotion, degradation, etc., shall be entered by the Deputy Inspector General of Prisons/
Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent in the Order Book (Bangladesh form No. 46). Copies
Bengal form of such orders in B.J. Form 98A or 98B or 983 shall be forwarded to the Senior
Nos.5127,51 Superintendent/ Superintendent of the jail concerned. A copy of orders shall be given to
28,5129. every Head Warder or Warder transferred or granted leave, as also the last pay certificate in
case of transfer.
310. Deleted
Rules 311. The Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall cause all necessary entries to be
213,215,217, made in the Warders Service Book or Roll and Service Record (B.J. Form No. 96) and shall
303. cause the two books to be forwarded together with form No. 97 complete in all particulars to
the jail to which the officer/ warder has been transferred within seven days of his departure.
50
312. (1) Whenever a simultaneous transfer of Head Warders or Warders is issued by the Deputy Inspector
General of Prisons, the concerned Senior Superintendent/Superintendent in consultation with his counterpart
shall fix up a date on which the custodial staff transferred, shall start for their destination, allowing sufficient
time for his instructions to be received and acted upon, and the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of Jails
concerned shall punctually despatch the Head Warders or Warders, as the case may be, on the date fixed,
unless unable to do so on account of sickness or other cause, in which case timely intimation shall be given
to the concerned Deputy Inspector General of Prisons/ Superintendent of Jails to enable him to make other
arrangements and fix some other date if necessary. No casual leave or other leave shall be granted to the
custodial staff whose transfer is ordered, so as to have effect, after the date fixed for his despatch, but in
order to prevent un-necessary delay, such guarding staff shall be struck off duty not later than noon of the
day preceding the date fixed for transfer.
(2) In order that there may be no difficulty or delay on the part of a Head Warder or Warder under orders of
transfer in proceeding to the jail to which he is transferred, such Head Warder or Warder may, if necessary,
be granted an advance under the Bangladesh Financial Rule 297(a) to an amount not exceeding one months
pay and also not exceeding the amount of expenditure which he is likely to incur by reason of his transfer or
to an amount not exceeding the travelling allowance to which he is entitled under the rules in consequence of
his transfer. Advance under this rule should be drawn on bills to be presented at the Treasury/Accounts
Officer for payment and should on no account be met from the permanent advance; and they should be
recovered from the salary/regular T.A. Bill (in case of T.A. bill drawn in advance). The advance pay should
be recovered from the salary of such staff in three equal installments.
G.O. No. S.R.O. 313. Whenever a Head Warder or Warder is posted to Hill Districts he shall be entitled to
354-
4/85/MF/FD(impl) Hill Allowance sanctioned by the Ministry of Finance from time to time.
-1/M.N.S.-16/85-
58 dated 5.8.1985.
314. All Head Warders, Matrons and Female Warders should be provided with separate quarters for
themselves and families, and all warders with sleeping and cooking accommodation on the jail premises. If
available separate quarters for certain percentage of warders with their families may also be provided, but
these must be quite separate and at some distance from the Guard House.
315. If there are fruits/ vegetables to spare they may be given to the warders at the main
gate; but the supply to each individual shall not exceed his personal needs, and care must be
Jail circular taken that such articles are not disposed of to outsiders. The unauthorized plucking of fruit
No. 5 of or vegetables from the jail land or the appropriation of Government property to their own
1911. use shall be treated as a serious offence, or may render the offender liable to criminal
prosecution.
Recommenda 316. Where separate Hospitals are not provided for the custodial staff, sick Chief Head
-tion of the Warders, Head Warders and Warders are treated as in-patients in jail hospitals shall be dieted
committee. at Government expenses.
316.1 During the period for which such sick-custodial staff remain admitted in the Jail
From West Hospital he will not be entitled to Basic Ration at subsidized rate for himself, for the period
Bengal Jail of time spent in the Hospital.
Code.
In case, the sickness is due to own fault of a custodial staff he will not be entitled to
treatment at Government cost.
316.2 In exceptional cases where the Medical Officer attached to the Jails, certifies that
specialized treatment in a Hospital other than Jail Hospital is necessary and unavoidable,
From West these staff shall be treated in the Hospital where such specialized treatment is available. Any
Bengal Jail Hospital fees for treatment on this account shall be met by the Government subject to the
Code. recovery of cost of diet charged by the Hospital to which such patient is referred. Similarly
in the case of these custodial staff, the cost of X-ray and bacteriological examinations or any
special treatment that may be considered necessary on the recommendations of the Medical
Officer attached to the Jail shall also be borne by the Government.
316.3 Sanction of the Inspector General of Prisons shall be obtained in each case before
payment is made.
51
317. (a) There shall be at least three Chief Head Warders for every Central Jail one for the Reserve Guard
and the other two for morning and afternoon duty inside the Jail and one Chief Head Warder for each of the
District Jail.
(b) The Chief Head Warders detailed for inside duty shall, subject to the general control of the Jailor, be
entrusted with the following duties:-
(1) Supervision of all details of internal administration of the Jail.
(2) He is responsible for due observance of all the rules in this code by all Head Warders, Warders and
prisoners.
(3) It is his duty to promptly bring to the notice of the Jailor or of the Superintendent of Jail any infringement
of rules by any person inside the Jail.
(4) He shall go on round the jail on different nights and at different hours at least twice a week.
(5) He should be conversant with the rules relating to the reformation of the offenders behind the bars and
shall also help the officers and staff to superintend reformatory activities amongst the offenders.
(6) It will be also his duty to see the prisoners begin and stop works at the hours specified in this code.
(7) It shall be one of his duty to see that the prisoners ration is issued in the kitchen according to their
entitlement.
(8) He shall also visit the kitchen frequently to see that the prisoners food is properly cooked and that the
prisoners get their due share of cooked food in time.
(9) Any case of less distribution of ration to the prisoners and bad cooking of food by the cooks, and short
supply of cooked food to the prisoners, shall be brought to the notice of the Jailor immediately for
appropriate action.
(10) He shall enforce strict discipline amongst the prisoners and custodial staff on duty inside the Jail.
(11)It shall be his duty to visit every corner of the Jail to see that the Head Warders and Warders perform
their duties as allotted to them.
(12) He shall be responsible to cause to maintain high standard of sanitation and cleanliness inside the Jail.
(13) He shall see that no prisoner leaves his respective areas and place of work except on call.
(14) He shall cause newly admitted prisoners to be brought before the Jailor next morning following their
admission for necessary verification.
(15) He shall also bring the prisoners reporting sickness to the notice of the Jailor/Chief Medical Officer or
the Medical Officer for necessary examination if required.
(16) He shall attend the lock up and unlock along with other officers and cause physical verification of the
prisoners to see that correct number of prisoners are present at the time of lock up and unlock as per lock up
Book.
(17) He shall see that bamboos, Ladders, Poles, Ropes and other articles likely to be used to facilitate escape
of prisoners are kept in a secured place.
(18) The Chief Head Warder shall go on round by the wall inside the jail and see the no contraband articles
are left near about or within the wall as enumerated in Para (16).
(19)He shall perform such other duties as are assigned to him by the Jailor from time to time for smooth
running of the administration.
(20)He shall bring to the notice of the Jailor the cases of any combination or conspiracy by the prisoner, for
outbreak or escape for his (Jailor) immediate action.
(c) The Chief Head Warder in outside duty in Reserve Guards shall perform the following duties and such
other duties as prescribed in this Code:
52
(1) He shall see that the Reserve Guards are present in full strength from unlock to lock up with their arms
and ammunitions in such a secured place fixed for them, to enable them to come out for emergency duty.
(2) He shall see that the Gate Sentries perform their duties as required under the rules in this Code and their
duties are changed at the scheduled hours; and that the Reserve Guards not enter into confrontation with the
members of the public.
(3) He shall be held responsible for the maintenance of discipline amongst the guarding staff and to look into
their welfare.
(4) He shall attend the roll call of the custodial staff and see that all off duty warders are present in the roll
call.
(5) He shall be responsible for distribution of duties among the warder guards.
(6) He shall appear before the Jail Gate with his armed Reserve Guards and off duty Warder to protect the
jail in case of any attack to the jail from outside or attempt of outbreak from inside the jail for necessary
instructions of the superior officers present during the time in order to foil such attempt.
(7) He shall arrange drilling of the warder guards at the appropriate hours under the instructions of his
superior officers.
(8) He shall be in charge of the Armoury and see that the correct number of Arms and Ammunitions placed
under his charge are there in the Armoury.
(9) He shall be responsible for the proper maintenance and cleanliness of the Arms and Ammunitions under
his charge.
(10) He shall arrange half-yearly and yearly verification of the Arms and Ammunitions by the Senior
Superintendent in central Jails.
Any infringement of these rules on the part of any Chief Head Warder shall liable him to disciplinary
action.
The Head Warder in charge of the Reserve Guard shall perform such duties in district Jail.
Head Warder.
318. In addition to the duties elsewhere prescribed in this Code, it shall be the duty of every Head Warder to-
(a) superintend the warders subordinate to him in the discharge of their duties;
(b) be responsible for the appearance and discipline of his warders. Any warder found to be improperly
dressed whilst on duty shall be reported by the Head Warder;
(c) exact strict compliance on the part of both warders and prisoners with all the rules of the department,
and report every breach of them that comes within his knowledge to his superior authority. Should it
be proved that any Head Warder has willfully neglected to report a breach of discipline of which he is
cognizant, he shall be liable to severe punishment;
(d) especially comply with Rules 191, 192 and 463.
(e) assist the Jailor in all routine duties;
(f) open, in the presence of the Jailor, the sleeping wards, cells, and other compartments each morning
and count the prisoners;
(g) distribute the prisoners who are liable to labour each morning to their respective work groups;
(h) cause the name and prison numbers of every prisoner placed in charge of any warder to be entered in
the proper group-book;
(i) issue all necessary tools, implements, raw materials and other articles required for the days work and
to make a record for all articles so issued;
(j) collect all such articles together with the produce (if any) of the prisoners labour after the period
prescribed for work is over, each evening;
(k) satisfy himself that all articles issued have been duly returned to him and accounted for;
(l) measure or check the task (if any) performed by each prisoner and note the same in the prescribed
task record;
(m) superintend the use of the latrines and all bathing and feeding parades;
(n) check the prisoners at each change of guard;
(o) see that no dirt or litter is allowed to be about the jail, and that the drains are kept clean;
(p) see that the wards are cleaned and ventilated during the day time, and that the bedding is properly
folded and arranged in them;
(q) cause all gratings, doors and the like to be secured and satisfy himself from time to time that they are
secure;
53
(r) cause all bamboos, scantlings, poles, ladders, ropes, well gear and other articles likely to be used for,
or to facilitate the escape of any prisoner, to be removed and placed beyond the reach of the prisoners
in the places prescribed for storing and keeping the same;
(s) keep constantly moving about while on day duty amongst the prisoners, supervising the work and
discipline of the jail, and keeping warders and convict officers on the alert; and
(t) to count, in the presence of the Jailor, search and lock up the prisoners in their respective wards, cells
and other compartments at the prescribed time each evening.
319. (1) The Head Warder of the relieving guard shall at least ten minutes before the hour
Rule 417. fixed for relieving the guard on duty, collect the warders of the relieving guard at the main
gate of the jail. At the proper time he shall march the relieving guard of warders to their
B.J. Form
respective posts and remove the guard to be relieved.
No. 38
(2) When relieving the warders of groups working outside the jail walls the Head Warder of
the relieving guard shall, before removing the warders then in charge and about to be
relieved, muster the prisoners and satisfy himself that the group is complete and is made up
in the manner recorded in the group-book.(Bangladesh Form No. 5099).
320. Warders whether going on or off duty shall be marched in double file. Each warder shall be posted in
the presence of both the relieving and relieved Head Warders, the relieving warder being taken from the front
and the relieved warder falling in at the rear of the squad. When the relief is complete the relieved Head
Warder shall march the relieved warders outside the jail and then dismiss them.
Rule 327. 321. The Head Warder on duty shall likewise see that the day gate sentries and gate-keepers
are changed according to instructions. At central jails the gate sentry shall be changed by the
Head Warder in charge or the senior warder of the reserve.
Rule 318. 322. (1) Every Head Warder shall ordinarily be on duty for half the day and for one watch at
night, and also at the opening of wards, cells, and other compartments in the morning and
during locking up of prisoners at night.
(2) The periods of duty shall be so arranged that a Head Warder shall the present at every
relief of warders from duty of any kind throughout the day and night.
Rules 323. At each change of watch the relieved and relieving Head Warder or gate-keeper on
950,953. duty shall, without entering the female ward enclosure, ascertain by calling out to the female
Warder-in charge of the Female Ward/Convict Watchman or the Matron who is available,
whether all the female prisoners are in safe custody.
Rules 324(1) The keys of the jail shall, when not in use or in the personal custody of any officer of
249,333. the jail, be kept in the key box at the main gate and the key of such receptacle shall by day
Rule 332. be retained by the senior Head Warder on duty and by night by the patrolling officer for the
G.O. No. 983 time being on duty.
P.J., dated the (2) Any keys which any officer may have to carry about his person while on duty shall be
26th March attached to his person by means of a stout chain.
1936.
Jail Circular, (3) Duplicate keys of all locks of wards, cells, gates, etc., shall be properly labelled and kept
No. 9 of in a separate almirah in the custody of the Jailor. Duplicate keys of safes shall be kept in the
1932. local treasury. For duplicate keys of store godowns and of Armoury see Rules 264,344 and
371.
Rules 325. In the event of an escape taking place, the Head Warders in-charge of the respective
239,417,482. area and the warder on duty shall be held primarily responsible unless they can satisfactorily
prove that the escape was due to no laxity of duty on their part. See Rules 191 and 200.
Gate-keepers.
B.J. Form 326. Two senior warders shall perform the duties of gate-keeper, but when the senior
No. 100 warders are acting as Head Warders or are themselves absent, the most efficient warders
may be posted to this duty. Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of jails shall exercise
54
great care in selecting the best men for this responsible duty.
327. The gate-keeper of the first watch shall come on duty at the opening of the jail, and
each gate-keeper shall remain between the gates until duly relieved. For these officers the
Rule 321. day may be divided into either two or four watches, as deemed expedient. At each change of
gate-keeper an entry of the hour of change shall be made in the gate-keepers registers by
both the relieved and the relieving staff.
Bangladesh 328. The gate-keeper shall keep two gate registers i.e. gate register of persons and gate
Form Nos. register of articles (Nos. 24 and 25); in one he shall record the names and appointments,
4999 and purpose of visit, time of entrance, time of exit of all jail officers, prisoners and other persons
5000. who pass out of or into the jail, and in the other he shall make notes of all goods, tools, or
stores passed either into the jail or out of it through the gate. He shall record the hour and
minute of the entrance and exit of every person and thing. He shall to the best of his ability
prevent the improper removal of any property from within the jail or the introduction into it
of any prohibited articles.
He shall attend the telephone calls coming from outside over the telephone kept at the
jail gate and take prompt action to convey it to the officer/staff concerned and in case the
officer/staff called over the phone is absent from duty/office, he shall convey the message to
the Jailor for communication to the concerned officer/staff at the earliest opportunity. He
shall also assist in effecting petty sales at the gate, recording, in regard to each item, the
article sold, quantity, rate, value received, and name and address of the purchaser. At the end
of his turn of duty he shall enter in writing the total of sums of money received by him and
shall sign his name thereto or if nothing has been received shall make an entry to that effect,
the relieving gate keeper shall receive and verify the amount, also sign the entry. The Jailor
on receiving from the gate warder the cash for articles sold at the gate shall enter in red ink
at the end of the gate keepers entries, the amount received, with initials and date.
329. He shall also help the Jailor or officer deputed to receive new prisoners. He shall be responsible for the
cleanliness of the main gates and the passage in between the gate and he shall also be responsible for
cleanliness of the fetters and other articles placed at the gate under his charge.
330. The main entrance of every central and district jail shall have a double gate with a space between the
gates; in each gate there shall be a wicket; all these should have secure fastenings that can be easily closed
and made fast from between the gates. The inner gate should be a batten door provided with eyeholes in it to
enable the gatekeeper to observe any person who wishes to leave the jail, and to see that there is no large
gathering of prisoners inside preparing for a rush to force open the gate. The outer gate will be an iron barred
gate. All ingress and egress for ordinary purposes shall take place through the wicket doors.
331. The gate-keeper shall open only one gate at a time, and shall never under any circumstances have both
gates open at once. Whether the person who has to pass through the gates is a high official or a prisoner, the
first gate through which he passes shall invariably be both carefully bolted and securely locked before the
second gate is opened. Neglect of this rule shall render the offending gate-keeper to severe disciplinary
action. The Jailor shall also be held responsible for seeing that this rule is strictly observed.
Rule 324. 332. The main gate keys shall be kept in bunch with eight others somewhat similar to, though not
exactly resembling them, and shall be attached by a stout chain to the waist of the gate-keeper.
This will add materially to the security of the jail by making it difficult for prisoners to obtain the
keys and to ascertain which of them will fit the locks of the gate.
55
333. The gate-keeper shall not allow the keys of the inner and outer main gates to pass out of his personal custody until
the lock-up is completed in the evening. After completion of the lock-up a second padlock shall be put upon the wicket
of the inner gate. The gate-keeper shall then in the presence of the Jailor make over the key of the large folding doors of
the inner gate to the Chief Head Warder/Senior Head Warder, who shall lock it up with other keys not required for the
night in the gate key-box. The gate-keeper shall (also in the presence of the Jailor) make over one of the keys of the
inner wicket to the Chief Head Warder/Head Warder who is to patrol inside the jail, and the other key of the inner
wicket, together with the keys of the outer gate, to the night gate-sentry.
Rules 59,173 334. In the passage between the main gates, the following articles shall be kept:-
Bangladesh
Form No. 5023. 1. The jail clock.
Bangladesh 2. A locked key box fixed to the wall.
Form No. 5142. 3. Fetters and handcuffs hung on the wall ready for use.
B.J. Form No. 4. A standing deck for the Gate Register (No.46) and writing materials.
115. Rule 69 5. Weighing scale.
From West 6. Notice Board.
Bangladesh Jail 7. Fire extinguishing apparatus.
Code Eighth
8. Duty Roster of the gate keepers and gate sentries.
Edition
(SL.No.5 to 8) 9. A list of non-official visitors hung with the wall.
10. Arch-way Metal detector.
11. Hand held Metal detector.
335. When prisoners have to be passed out of or into the jail the following procedure shall invariably be followed:-
The gate-keeper first let them enter through the inner gate, and having done so he shall lock it; he shall then write
in full in the gate register the name of every prisoner of a group leaving the jail, the name of the warder who is in
charge, and the name of the convict overseer who is assisting him and shall obtain under these entries, the signature of
the warder concerned. These entries having been carefully made, he shall then open the outer gate and count the
prisoners out one by one in order to see that there is no mistake in the total number entered in his register. On return of
the group of prisoners he shall open the outer gate, the inner one being carefully locked first, and admit them to the
passage between the gates. He shall then lock the outer gate, and call out the name of each prisoner, the convict
overseer and the warder, each man answering as his name is called out. The group having been found correct, he shall
open the inner gate and count each man into the jail one by one, to see that there is no mistake in the total number.
Under no circumstances whatever shall this procedure be departed from, and no prisoner shall be allowed to leave the
jail unless he is in charge of a paid official.
Rule 746. 336. Prisoners who are allowed to go outside the jail gate shall be specially selected by the Jailor
with the sanction of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent. should it come to the knowledge of
the gate keeper that any prisoners are being taken out of the jail contrary to rule, he shall make a
note of the fact in his book, report it to the Jailor at once, and subsequently to the Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent/Deputy Superintendent on the first opportunity. He should see that
every prisoner, not a convict officer, passing out except on transfer or for production in Court has on
an ankle ring, and stop any who has not one.
337. The gate-keeper shall be furnished with a list of all official and non official visitors who are entitled to enter the
jail. On their presenting themselves at the gate he shall at once admit them, but shall not admit outsiders without a pass
from the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the Jail.
Rule 683. 338. He is authorized to search all persons passing into or out of the jail, except those whose
names are included in the list of official and non-official visitors with which he is furnished,
or such persons as may be exempted by the special order of the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent. All official and non-official visitors, casual visitors admitted by special
order of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent, and the higher officers of the jail,
including Head Warders, shall ordinarily be exempted from being searched. Should he have
B.J. Form reason to suspect that any person exempted from search is introducing or removing articles
No. 100 which ought not to be taken into or out of the jail, he may detain the person between the
gates and must give immediate notice to the Jailor who will himself search the person, but
Rule 346(d). this search shall not be made in the presence of any prisoner or of another visitor. He shall
search all prisoners passing through the gate. When the number of prisoners passing through
the gate is large, the Jailor may specially depute one or more warders to assist. If on
searching an officer or outsider any article is found which ought not to be taken into or out
of the jail he shall send immediate notice to the Jailor. If such article is found with a prisoner
he shall report to the Jailor at the first opportunity. The search of a female shall be conducted
only by a female; it shall be done in private inside a room and without the presence of male
person.
56
339. No dog shall be allowed within the inner gate of a jail. This prohibition is absolute, and applies to the
dogs of official and non-official visitors, as well as those of jail officers.
340. The reserve guard shall furnish one sentry at the main gate both by day and by night; the turn of duty
may be 2 or 3 hours according to the number of men available. The day sentry at the main gate shall be
posted immediately outside the iron-barred gate, and shall carry his rifle with bayonet fixed.
341. The night sentry at the main gate shall be posted between the gates as a precaution against surprise
either from within or without, and he shall keep the key of the second lock on the inner gate wicket as well
as those of the outer gate in his possession. He shall not permit any person to enter or leave the jail until he
has satisfied himself by examination with his lantern that the person is an official duly authorized to visit or
leave the jail at night and he shall not permit any warder to enter or leave the jail except in company with the
Head Warder on duty. The officers authorized to visit the jail at night are the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent, Magistrate, Official and Non-Official Visitors, Deputy Superintendent, Jailor, Deputy
Jailors, Head Warders on duty, and the patrolling warders in the charge of the Head Warders; also the
Medical Officer and his subordinates. He shall not loudly challenge any person presenting himself at the
main gate, or give notice to the Head Warder or warders within, of the approach of any visiting officer; being
posted behind a barred gate he can ascertain in safety whether the person has any business at the jail or not; a
duplicate key of the inner gate wicket shall be kept by the Head Warder in charge of the reserve guard for the
use of any inspecting officer at night.
342. The night sentry shall inform the Head Warder on duty whenever any officer of the jail visits the jail at
night, or of any unusual occurrence of importance during his time of sentry duty, and this Head Warder shall
report the fact to the Chief Head Warder of the reserve Guard/Head Warder of the Reserve for information of
the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent next morning when making his daily report.
343. An electric light (bulb or tube) or other light shall always be kept in between the gates at night.
Rule 371. 344. The gate sentry shall be provided with a rifle and twenty rounds of buckshot ammunition.
In the event of an outbreak or alarm he shall sound the alarm and defend the gates as prescribed
in Rule 466. He shall be furnished with a duplicate key of the Armoury.
Note.- A special bandolier holding twenty rounds of buckshot ammunition should be kept ready
at the gate for the use of each gate sentry in turn and put on by each man on duty.
Warders.
345. Each warder shall have a particular duty assigned to him by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent
of jail or Jailor; such as charge of a particular ward or set of wards; workshop or set of workshops; or a
particular group of prisoners inside or outside the jail. The posts and duties of warders shall be frequently
changed, so as to prevent the warders from forming permanent relations with any of the prisoners. Warders
in charge of work-sheds will be responsible for all tools and property kept in them.
345.1 As far as possible the duties of warders will be arranged in the following manner:-
The strength of warders shall be determined at the ratio of 1:8 (one warder against eight prisoners in
each watch) subject to the provisions of rule 348 and 985.
Number of Warders shall to be determined on the basis of duty places into number of watches as
arranged conveniently.
57
346. In addition to the duties elsewhere prescribed in these Codes it shall be the duty of all warders to -
(a) count the prisoners made over to them, and to declare the number to the Head Warder;
(b) stand or patrol whilst on duty. On no consideration may a warder take off his belt and lie or sit down
whilst on duty;
(c) know the number of prisoners in their charge; to count their prisoners frequently during their turn of
duty; and to satisfy themselves that they have in their custody the correct number;
(d) search all prisoners of their groups at the time they are made over to them, likewise before they give
over charge of them to any other person, at such other times during their watch as may be necessary,
and to report the discovery of any prohibited articles upon any of the prisoners in their charge;
(e) prevent the use or possession of any drugs, or of money or unsanctioned articles of food. They will
see that prisoners do not steal or eat grain, vegetables, berries or fruit and drink no water except that
prepared and supplied for their use;
(f) in the case of convicts sentenced to labour to report all cases of idleness and short work;
(g) prevent all loud talking; laughing, singing, playing, except in authorized manner at stated hours; also
prevent quarrelling and other unseemly behaviour;
(h) see that the prisoners march two by two when moving from one place to another and that they do not
leave their proper places, or loiter about the jail. In the event of a prisoner being found separated
from his group, the warder in charge will be punished;
(i) see that no prisoner leaves his own enclosure or group without authority or communicates with any
prisoner with whom he has no proper concern or with a prisoner of another class or group or with
any outsiders;
(j) see that no dirt or litter is allowed to lie about the jail, and that the drains are kept clean, and to
report the sweepers who neglect their works;
(k) report prisoners urinating or defecating into the drains or in any place other than the places provided
for the purpose, and to bring to the notice of the Jailor any prisoner who goes to the latrine in work
time;
(l) see that any prisoner who has to go to the latrine at unauthorized times is made over to the charge of
a responsible officer whilst away from his group;
(m) see to the cleanliness of the persons, clothes and bedding of the prisoners in their kits, that the
prisoners bathe only at the bathing parades and that the bedding is aired according to order;
(n) specially to comply with the rules relating to 191,192 and 463.;
(o) bring to the notice of the Jailor any sign of sickness or any prisoner complaining of sickness;
(p) report any plots against the jail authorities for the purpose of escaping or of assault or outbreak, or of
obtaining forbidden articles, and every breach of jail rules;
(q) report any case of willful injury to clothing or jail property;
(r) prepare prisoners for muster and for parades and to see that each prisoner comes to his proper place
in proper order, behaves well, and keeps silent;
(s) report at once to the Jailor or other responsible officer, the fact of any prisoner being missing;
(t) see that no food is secreted by the prisoners, that every prisoner gets his proper allowance of food,
and that no prisoner gives his food to another; to report any cook who gives a short allowance, or
favours a prisoner by giving too much;
(u) keep his arms and accoutrements clean and in good order and fit for immediate use.
(v) he shall be acquainted with correctional rules and shall try to enforce reformatory activities amongst
the offenders in his charge for their integretion in the society.
Rule 177 347. Every warder shall, at all times, whilst on duty, be properly and cleanly dressed in his
G.O. No. uniform, and shall wear his belt and carry a baton or lathi when considered necessary by the
3823 P.J., Senior Superintendent / Superintendent of Jail. The baton should be slung on the belt with a
dated the 17th loop and button easily detached, or by means of a spring clip.
August 1935.
Rules
358,457.
58
348. In all Central and District jails there shall be a reserve warder guard in accordance with following
scale:-
Chief Head Warder Head Warder Warder
351. In the Central Jail the Reserve Guard shall be under the charge of Chief Head Warder and in a District
Jail under the charge of an efficient Head Warder specially selected for the Reserve Duty who shall be
competent to give the warders a thorough Military training.
352. In addition to the duties elsewhere prescribed in this Code, it shall be the duty of the Chief Head Warder
or the Head Warder in charge of the reserve guard to-
(a) make all necessary arrangements, subject to the authority of the jailor and Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent for the safety of the jail and the safe custody of the prisoners.
(b) arrange and detail men for the convenient watch, pickets, sentries, and convict night guards;
(c) have charge of the armoury and contents thereof, and to be responsible that the regulations relating
thereto and to the care, custody, cleanliness and readiness for immediate use of all arms, etc., are
strictly complied with;
(d) keep an account of ammunition in stock, received and expended;
(e) maintain the military efficiency of the warder guard;
(f) drill all warders once in every week, giving each warder at least 45 minutes;
(g) report every warder who absents himself from drill;
(h) give effect to any punishment drill ordered by the Superintendent of the jail;
(i) see that no warder absents himself from the jail premises without due authority, and to report every
warder who offends in this respect, stating the period of absence A register shall be maintained for
the purpose;
(j) see that all warders when on duty are always properly dressed, and to report every man who is not
so dressed, see that rules 353 and 357 are strictly complied with;
(k) take one turn of watch at night;
(l) see that the guard-room is kept neat and clean and the beds properly arranged, and that the lights
supplied for it are kept burning and that any defect is at once reported to the Jailor;
(m) satisfy himself that every sentry knows and understands the orders for his post;
59
Note. - The Chief Head Warder shall not, however, be required to take one turn of watch at night as
prescribed in clause (k) above. But he shall go on round the jail on different night and at different hours at
least twice a week.
353. The Reserve Guard shall be inspected daily by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the jail and
on his arrival at the jail the Reserve Guard shall turn out in full force properly equipped, and shall present
Arms. The same procedure should be followed in case of the visit of Non-Official and Official visitors
before 9 A.M. After this hour one-half of the guard shall turn out.
354. Every day on the arrival daily of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent at the jail gate, the Chief
Head Warder or Head Warder of the reserve shall present himself and make reports on the following points:-
1st Whether during the preceding 24 hours the reserve guard was at any time below its full strength, and if
so, the cause of it.
2nd Whether any visiting officer of the jail visited the jail last night and any other matter of importance
reported to him during the night.
3rdWhether the arms and ammunition in pouches are ready for immediate use.
4th Whether any warder committed any irregularities or misconduct or absented himself without leave.
355. The reserve guard shall furnish escorts for visitors as prescribed in Rule 67. It shall furnish a gate sentry
as prescribed in Rule 340, and in central jails another sentry in some position from which he can command a
view of the interior of the jail, and shall have access to a bell or signal by means of which he can raise an
alarm and call out the rest of the reserve guard.
60
Section XV-Uniforms, Accoutrements, Armoury, Arms etc.
Uniforms
358. The uniforms and kits prescribed below for the officers and staff ( Jailor to Warders including
female officers and staff ) shall be supplied free at government cost from Dhaka Central Jail or from
any other jail as the Inspector General of Prisons decides. The indents for uniforms shall be submitted
by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendents of jails concerned to the Inspector General of Prisons
every year on the first of July for transmission to the jail concerned from where uniforms will be
tailored and supplied.
61
(iv) Deep green trouser with two side pockets & right side back pocket 2 (two) One year
without cover
(v) Black cotton socks 1 (one) pair One year
(vi) Black nylon socks 1 (one) pair One year
(vii) Boot DMS 1 (one) pair One year
(viii) Black shoes oxford 1 (one) pair One year
(ix) Deep green jersey pull over with two breast pockets with cover 1 (one) Two years
(x) Deep green winter jacket 1 (one) Three years
(xi) Sam brown belt (cross belt) 1 (one) Five years
(xii) Black web belt 1(one) Two years
(xiii) Revolver 1 (one) Once for all
(xiv) Brown leather holster 1 (one) Five years
(xv) Brown leather pouch 1 (one) Five years
(xvi) (a) Beret cap dark blue 1 (one) Eighteen months
(b) Field cap deep green. 1 (one) Two years
(c) Peak cap deep green. 1 (one) Five years
(xvii) Shoulder title-"BDJ" written on silver coloured metal 1 (one) pair Three years
(xviii) Name plate on hard cloth with velcro 1 (one) One year
(xix) Ribbon on the top of left pocket according to authorization 1 (one) Two years
(xx) Divisional sign on the left arm 1 (one) One year
(xxi) Bangladesh jail badge on right arm 1 (one) One year
(xxii) Cap badge-silver coloured with sailing boat amidst wave of 1 (one) Five years
stream, spikes of paddy flower at one side and leaf of jute on other
side of boat with full bloomed shaplaon top and BDJ written at
bottom
(xxiii) Cane baton (two feet long) 1 (one) Five years
(xxiv) Black Lanyard 1 (one) One year
(xxv) Whistle 1 (one) Two years
(xxvi) Pips silver coloured metal 2 (two) pairs Three years
Note: Pattern of coat Deep green cloth with four pockets, roll collar, shoulder strap with two pips
with four silver coloured metal half ball buttons with inscription "BDJ", one in each pocket.
358.3. Sergeant Instructors shall wear the same uniform as Deputy Jailers except coat, tie, revolver,
peak cap and shoes oxford. They shall wear red ribbon with shoulder strap.
62
(xviii) Cane baton (two feet long) 1 (one) Five years
(xix) Black Lanyard 1 (one) One year
(xx) Whistle 1 (one) Two years
(xxi) Pips silver coloured metal 1 (one) pair Two years
358.5. Head Warders, Assistant Head Warders and Warders shall be provided with uniforms as follows :
63
(xi) Red ribbon with shoulder strap for Chief Matrons 1(one) pair One year
(xii) White coloured chevron with three bars on right arm for Chief 1(one) pair One year
Matrons
(xiii) Name plate on hard cloth with velcro 1 (one) One year
(xiv) Silver coloured number plate below the name plate of right 1 (one) Once for all
breast
(xv) Ribbon on the top of left pocket, according to authorization. 1 (one) Two years
(xvi) Divisional sign on the left arm 1 (one) One year
(xvii) Bangladesh jail badge on right arm. 1 (one) One year
(xviii) Cap Badge-silver coloured with sailing boat amidst wave of
stream, spikes of paddy flower at one side and leaf of jute on
1(one) Five years
other side of boat with full bloomed "shapla" on top and "BDJ"
written at bottom
(xix) Cane baton (two feet long) 1(one) Five years
(xx) Black lanyard 1 (one) One year
(xxi) whistle 1 (one) One year
(xxii) Mosquito net 1 (one) Three years
(xxiii) Pips silver coloured metal (for Chief Matrons) 1 (one) pair Two years
(xxiv Deep green Sari 2 (two) One year
(xxv) Deep green Blouse 2 (two) One year
(xxv) Deep green petty coat 2 (two) One year
(xxvi) Black ladys shoe normal heel 1 (one) pair One year
Note :- Item serial no. xxiv-xxvi only for night duty in the female enclosure
359. Chevrons shall be worn by Head Warders as in rule 358.5
The wearing of shawls or other wrappers over uniform is prohibited.
Every member of the guarding staff should be provided with one iron or wooden cot, a kit book and a
kit box (steel). A record of the receipts and issue of uniforms to the guarding staff (with life time noted)
shall be recorded in the Service record. The kit box should be returned at the time of transfer/
discharge/dismissal/retirement and death of the guarding staff. Any officer/staff losing or damaging the
uniform shall pay the cost of replacement or renewal. Uniforms should be three sizes as follows.
1. For tall man 1.75 to 1.82 meters.
2. For men of medium size. 1.70 to 1.75 meters.
3. For short man 1.65 to 1.75 meters.
360. While submitting Indents to the Inspector General of Prisons, the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent of Jails should mention the size of the Uniforms required for his custodial staff.
361. Deleted.
Bangla- 362. A record of the receipts and issues of warders uniform shall be kept in Bangladesh Jail
desh Register No. 47. All the uniform including boots, supplied by Government to Deputy Jailors and
Form others are Government property during the period for which these were issued, and must be
No. accounted for until the next periodical issue of uniform becomes due, but it is issued for the
5148. personal use of the officer to whom it is given and will be taken with him when transferred to
any other jail. If the uniform is not properly used and becomes unserviceable before the next
G.O. issue becomes due it will be renewed at the officers expense; but if it has been in use for the
No. 441 period prescribed in Rule 361, it shall become the absolute property of the officer/ staff. This
R.J., rule does not apply to arms and accoutrements (i.e., batons, belts, badges, sword slings, bayonet
dated frogs, Revolver and ammunition pouches) and the charpoy, and box all of which shall remain at
the 11th the jail to which supplied, but any officer losing or damaging these otherwise than by fair wear
January and tear shall pay the cost of renewal or repair.
1926.
G.O. 363. When a Jailor, Deputy Jailor or other custodial staff dies, resigns, retires, absconds or is
No. dismissed or discharged his uniform will be taken over by an authorized jail official, and will be
7715 issued, at the discretion of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent to the man who fills the
R.J. vacancy or to a new recruit on the temporary list. The Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of
dated jail shall determine the period for which such uniform should last and shall cause a note of it to
th
the 16 be entered in the Service Book. Provided that if the uniform has been lost or has grossly
64
July deteriorated owing to the fault of a Jailor, Deputy jailor or other custodial staff, who resigns,
1926. retires, absconds or is dismissed or discharged, its value or a part of the value to be determined
by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent may be recovered from the Officer at fault.
364. Recoveries due from any Jailor, Deputy Jailor or other custodial staff under Rule 363 may be made
from any pay at the time of discharge or retirement etc. and the sale proceeds of the uniform, and shall be
paid into the local treasury. All such recoveries should be reported to the Senior Superintendent of Central
Jail to whom the treasury receipts for them shall be sent.
365. The Government supply of uniform shall be issued to Jailor, Deputy Jailor or other custodial staff as it
becomes due to them; to newly appointed warders at the time of appointment; to others on any date on
which the period prescribed for the use of the last previous issue expires. The date of issue of every article
of uniform shall be recorded in the officers service record (B.J. Form No. 96).
G.O. 366. When a Head Warder or warder goes on leave other than casual leave he shall make over
No. his uniform to the care of the Head Warder of the reserve or to any other person authorized by
2638 the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent. During the officers absence his uniform shall not be
P.J.,
dated used by any other Head Warder or Warder.
the 11 th Note. - Absent Head Warders or warders uniform when bundled up and put away may
June/ be preserved from the attack of insects by naphthalene or by sprinkling amongst the clothing
1938. before tying it up a handful of burnt crude borax commonly known as sohaga.
367. Whenever any custodial staff authorized free uniform is granted leave of absence other than casual
leave, or is suspended from duty, the dates on which the next issue of the several articles of uniform will
be due shall be advanced by the period during which the uniform is not used:-
368. Deleted.
G.O. No. 369. The Jail Officers and staff may have their uniforms /clothes washed in the Jail laundry
2392 P.J., where such arrangement exists at cost price as fixed by the Senior Superintendent/
dated the
6th August Superintendent of the jail. Leather belts and boots of each of the uniformed staff be kept clean
1929. and polished with cobra polish which will be purchased and supplied to the uniformed officers
and staff from the jail to which such officers/ staff is attached, and badges must be kept bright
with brasso to be supplied at Government cost. Uniform which has become damaged by fair
wear and tear may be repaired in the jail Manufactory section.
369.1. Wearing of combination of Civil dress with the prescribed uniforms by the uniformed
officers/staff is strictly prohibited. The uniformed officers and staff shall invariably wear their
uniforms whilst on duty and shall not go out of the Jail premises with uniform except on official
duty. They shall appear before their superior officer as and when required wearing their
prescribed uniforms. Violation of this rule shall render the officer/staff concerned to disciplinary
action.
369.2. At the weekly kit inspection parade which shall be held under the supervision of the
Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of Jail, the warders shall place their uniforms neatly
folded in their front in the following order:- Great Coat, Shirt, Cap, Jersey, Mosquito Net,
Pajama, Belt.
They shall display each item by holding it up as its name is called out by the Reserve
Head Warder and then turning it, also at his word of command, so that both the front and the
back may be examined by the Officer-in-charge. The officer-in-charge shall make notes of the
repairs or replacement necessary against each individuals name and pass them on to the officer-
in-charge of the Establishment Branch, who shall be responsible for taking immediate action. If
the number of warders on parade is large, they shall be divided into convenient sections, each
section being in charge of the Jailor or a Deputy Jailor. To facilitate check, every Head Warder
and warder should hand over his service Record for exhibition at the kit inspection and other
parades, and also Head Warders and warders on duty shall be dressed alike. The Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent should decide the period of the year when the warders should
be allowed to wear half shirts. It should be seen that the half shirts are worn with their lower
65
ends pushed inside the shorts.
Armoury, Arms, etc.
Rule 370. (1) special and secured room near the main gate, to be called the Armoury, shall be set
352 apart for storing the arms, ammunition, etc.; it shall be furnished with proper racks for the
muskets and for hanging up the accoutrements.
G.O.
No. (2) In case of emergency, the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of a Jail is authorized to
3297 allow arms and ammunition to be kept in the guardroom or a sleeping barrack at night.
P.J, The rifles and ammunition shall be kept on an arms rack and shall be in charge of a
dated sentry, who shall be changed at intervals under the orders of a Reserve Chief Head Warder,
the 16th Head Warder, who shall satisfy himself that everything is in order. The Senior Superintendent/
Septem Superintendent of the Jail shall give written orders as to the number of rifles and amount of
ber ammunition to be kept in the guard-room or barrack and shall report to Inspector-General his
1931. action for the information of Government.
371. The key of the Armoury shall be kept by the Reserve Chief Head Warder/Head Warder and a
duplicate shall be kept by the gate sentry and the gate keeper and at night by the Head Warder off duty. In
order to diminish the possibility of improper access to the Armoury, the duplicate key shall be enclosed in
a cover of stout cloth sealed in such a way that the key cannot be used without breaking the seal. The
procedure is applicable for Central and all Classes of District Jails.
Rule 372. The Chief Head Warder of the Reserve or, in fourth class district jails, the senior Head
346(u). Warder, shall be in charge of the Armoury and shall be held responsible for safe custody of all
the arms, ammunition, accoutrements, etc., kept therein. He shall see that all arms, etc., are kept
Rule clean, in good order, properly arranged, and ready for immediate use. He shall inspect the arms,
380. uniforms, accoutrements and ammunition daily, and the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent
From of jails and the Jailor shall inspect them once a week. Any warder whose rifle, uniform or
West accoutrements are found to be dirty will be liable to punishment
Bengal
372.1 Care shall be taken that no unauthorized person is admitted at any time into the
Jail
Armoury or gets access to, or opportunity to handle, any arms and ammunition kept elsewhere
Code.
in the Jail.
Rules 373. (1) Swords as prescribed shall be provided for every executive officer/Chief Head
358,360. Warder/Head Warder of the Reserve. A Breach-loading Rifle and accessories with bayonet,
bayonet scabbard and frog, and a belt with two ammunition pouches shall be provided for every
warder both of the Reserve and General Guards.
(2) Every Fire Arm is numbered. Every Arm shall have a special place assigned to it in the
Armoury, and shall be placed in the special care of officer for whose use it is intended, and who
will be held responsible that such Arms and its accoutrements are always kept clean and in a
serviceable condition. A list showing the number and name of each officer/staff, the number of
his Fire Arms, and the various arms and accoutrements for which he is responsible, shall be kept
by the Chief Head Warder/Head Warder of the Reserve and posted up in each Armoury.
(3) The bayonets and ammunition pouches shall be slung on the belts and, together with Rifles to
which they belong, shall when not in use, be kept each in special place in the Armoury ready for
immediate use. The Rifles of the Reserve Guard shall, during the day be kept in a rack in the reserve
guard room with the bayonet and ammunition pouches on the belts ready for immediate use.
(4) Of the pouches prescribed in clause (1) the back pouch shall always contain five rounds of
ammunition of rifle and the front pouch not less than five rounds of blank ammunition.
(5) Rifle cartridges, when carried loose in pouches quickly become unserviceable, and must be
changed frequently. If they fit loosely in the pouch, a piece of soft dry cloth should be inserted
to prevent the pellets being shaken out.
Rule 352.
Bangladesh 374. The following scale of ammunition is sanctioned annually for the use of uniformed officer
66
Form No. and Warder Guards:-
5016.
For Service 50 rounds per weapon.
G. of 1 For practice 75 rounds per capita per training. annum
letter
The ammunition not in the pouches shall be kept in the Armoury in a suitable locked
No.
197of box and in the charge of the Chief Head Warder/Head Warder of the Reserve. A record of the
11th receipt and issues shall be entered in order of date as they occur. The account should be
June balanced every month, and the balance carried forward. A similar account shall be kept by the
1909 Chief Head Warder/Head Warder of the Reserve. expenditure of ammunition shall be kept by
the Jailor in Register No. 39.Register of receipt and expenditure of ammunition.-This account
shall be opened with the balance of each kind of ammunition in hand. The receipts and issues
shall be entered in order of date as they occur. The account should be balanced every month,
and the balance carried forward. A similar account shall be kept by the Chief Head Warder/Head
Warder of the Reserve.
Note.-50 rounds of ammunition for revolver for the use of Body Guard of Inspector
General of Prisons, Additional Inspector General of Prisons be sanctioned.
Ammunition sanctioned may be used for the purpose of practice and training.
375. Indents in quadruplicate for ammunition shall be submitted to the Inspector General of prisons in the
form (B.J. Form No. 63) prescribed by the Ordnance Department on the 1st March of each year. In
preparing such indents, ammunition in stock should be deducted from the total requirements calculated on
the scale laid down in the above rule, and a number below or above the difference should be indented for
so that a full box can be supplied by the Arsenal. The average yearly expenditure for the preceding five
years shall also be stated while submitting indents.
The Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall submit a detailed explanation of the loss of every
metal cartridge to the Inspector General of Prisons.
Oil for cleaning rifles shall be obtained on indent from the concerned Central Jail.
376. (1) If more than one per cent of cartridges of the same date and place of manufacture miss
fire or burst, by which latter term is meant a rupture of the metal in the body of the case and not
a split at the mouth, which is of no importance, the defective cartridges, each in its original
wrapper, and a report shall be at once sent to the Ordnance Depot at Dhaka Cantonment, under
intimation to the Inspector General of Prisons.
(2) Service ammunition which shows signs of deterioration (i.e., has a green appearance round
the caps and rust on the base discs) shall be returned to the Arsenal.
G.O.
No.
(3) Empty paper cartridge cases shall not be returned to the Arsenal, but shall be burnt in the
3133
presence of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of jail , who shall certify on the delivery
P.J.,
voucher as to the number so destroyed.
dated
the 9th (4) Before returning empty cartridge cases, Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall cause
June every package to be most carefully examined, and all loaded cartridges, whether balled or blank,
1932. which may be discovered, removed prior to their despatch to any Arsenal or depot. This
precaution is never, under any circumstance to be dispensed with.
67
377. When returning arms, ammunition, or empty fired cases to the Arsenal, the following procedure shall
be observed:-
(1) The articles shall be packed securely in a strong box.
(2) Each box shall be clearly sealed, the seal being countersunk to avoid being broken in transit.
(3) The gross weight shall be marked on each box.
(4) The address of the Arsenal shall be clearly marked on each box.
(5) The name of the jail of despatch shall be marked on each box.
(6) The voucher number shall be marked on each box.
(7) A packing note shall be enclosed in each box.
(8) The voucher number shall be entered on the railway receipt or bill of lading.
(9) A facsimile of the seals used shall be furnished to the Arsenal except when boxes with the original seal
of the Arsenal intact are despatched.
(10) Two delivery and two receipt vouchers shall be furnished.
(11)A letter of advice enclosing the railway receipt (freight prepaid), facsimile of seals and the 4 vouchers
shall be forwarded.
Note.-Under no circumstance shall loaded cartridges (including misfires) be enclosed with empty fired
cases.
P.R.B. 378. All arms belonging to the Jail Department shall be repaired by the Police armourers on the
Rule understanding that the necessary component parts are supplied by that Department on payment.
1480.
Rule 352. 379. All Jailors, Deputy Jailors, and the whole warder force shall be required to become efficient in drill
G.O. No. and to maintain that efficiency; for this purpose they shall undergo a thorough military training in squad
4087 drill and in the use of arms. Deputy Jailors on first appointment shall undergo a course of Training in the
R.J., Arms drill for three months in the Departmental Training Centre in order to make them efficient in drill.
dated the
25th
Jailor should also undergo in service training in drill for six weeks in any Training Academy. After every
March two years for maintenance their efficiency in drill. Head Warder and Warders shall be drilled by the
1927. Sergeant Instructor/Reserve Head Warder in Central Jail for at least 45 minutes once daily in the morning
(except Fridays and Government holidays) and in the District Jail, the warders shall be drilled by the
Rule 221. Reserve Head Warder.
G.O. No.
4087 A course of annual Target practice shall be conducted in each jail in the month of January each
R.J., year, so that the uniformed officers and warder-guards may be able to use their rifles with confidence. The
dated the practice may be held if necessary, at the Police Butt. if there are butts within a suitable distance of the jail.
25th Riot drill shall also form a part of their training. Detailed Rules will be found in Appendix No. 5
March, appended in Jail Code Volume II. It must be fully understood by all officers that no leave, except leave on
1927. medical ground, shall be granted to uniformed officers and guarding staff until be has qualified himself
Rule 221. in drill.
This procedure shall continue till the Prison Department shall have Training Institute, as
recommended by the J.R.C.(Vide page 137 of the report of J.R.C.) of its own.
380. The Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall hold a weekly parade at which the reserve
guard and the whole warder staff not on duty; together with their Head Warders and superior
officers, shall be inspected by, and drilled before, the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of jail.
Rule Practice with blank cartridges shall ordinarily take place at these inspections at least once a month.
215. The Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of jail shall take this opportunity of testing by
examination or re-examination the efficiency of individual officers/staff, and shall record the results
Rule of his examination on page 9 of the Officers Service Record. He shall examine the arms and
372. accoutrements closely and satisfy himself that they are clean and in good order, and that the pouches
contain the prescribed ammunition, that the men are properly turned out clean in their persons and
clothing, and that no buttons or other articles are missing. When jailors and Deputy Jailors have
acquired knowledge of their drill, and are found to be qualified to drill their warders, they will be
only required to attend the Senior Superintendent/Superintendents weekly parade.
381. The following general instructions in regard to saluting superior officers shall be observed.
Jailor, Deputy Jailors, Sergeant Instructor, Chief Head Warders and Head Warders.
68
When on When not on If drilling
parade with parade with with warders
warders, warders. in the ranks.
armed with
sword.
Deputy Jailors, Sergeant Instructors, Chief Head Warders shall salute an officer superior to them in rank
but subordinate to those above indicated, with hand.
Warders.
When on When passing armed When passing
parade with Rifle. unarmed.
armed.
To Inspector General of Prisons, Shall be Shall slope arms and salute Shall salute with the
Additional Inspector General of halted and by carrying the right hand hand, as instructed
Prisons, Deputy Inspector General present smartly to the small of the in Infantry Training
of Prisons, Assistant Inspector arms at butt and turn his head Vol. I, 1932.
General of Prisons and Senior towards the person saluted. If
word of
Superintendent/ Superintendent of marching in squad shall slope
jail, official and non-official command arms and receive the
visitors and superior officers of command "Eyes right" from
Government the squad commander.
To Jailor and Deputy Jailors Shall slope Shall slope arms. If Ditto.
and Sergeant Instructors. arms at marching in squad shall do
word of so at word of command.
command.
To Chief Head Warder and Nil. Shall slope arms, but not if Ditto.
Head Warders. marching in squad.
The gate sentry shall present arms to the Jailor or any officer superior to the Jailor or to official or non-official
visitors. A Head Warder or warder sitting, shall, when any such officer approaches rise, stand at attention and
salute with the hand; when addressing an officer he will halt two paces from him and salute as above. He will
also salute when withdrawing. If two or more men are sitting or standing about, the senior warder present will
call the whole to attention and will alone salute.
Rule 470 382. Swords, bayonets, and firearms shall only be taken inside the jail at "alarms" in which case the
G.O. No. armed officers and warder shall march into the jail in a body. Any officer or warders carrying his
IM- sword, bayonet, rifle or revolver inside the jail when on ordinary duty will be liable to punishment.
17/91-
Jail- "However, the Inspector General of Prisons, may for reasons to be recorded in writing in
1/286 this behalf, permit any officer or warder to carry sword, bayonet, musket, revolver or any other
dated firearms inside the jail for performing ordinary duty for such period as may be specified by him".
12.6.91.
69
CHAPTER VI Progressive Grade Treatment
CONVICT OFFICERS
383. There shall be two grades of convict officers, namely, convict watchmen and convict overseers who
may be entrusted with responsibilities to help the prison administration and to assist the prison guard in
such manner as enumerated in this code. Such gradation of well behaved non-habitual convicts shall be the
part of reformatory activities amongst the prisoners.
With this end in view, these upgraded convicts may be called convict officers and shall be given status of
public servants within the meaning of the Bangladesh Penal Code.
G.G. 384.(1) No prisoner shall be employed as a convict officer who-
No. (a) has been convicted of drugging , unnatural offence;
6489 kidnapping or abduction for immoral purposes, rape, extortion, hijacking;
R.J. (b) is physically unfit to perform the duties of the office.
Dated (c) if on the remission system, has not earned or maintained three fourths of the possible
the 25th (ordinary) remission;
July (d) has committed serious prison offence or has been removed from remission system
1924 permanently.
(2) Convict officers required for employment in yards or barracks reserved for prisoners
sentenced to simple imprisonment shall as far as possible, be drawn from the ranks of simple
imprisonment prisoners.
In case it is not possible to recruit convict officers for such employment from the rank of
simple imprisonment prisoners, they may be recruited from the non-habitual (i.e.casual) class of
prisoners, sentenced to rigorous imprisonment.
Prisoners sentenced to a term of simple imprisonment are not eligible for appointment as
convict officers unless they elect to labour throughout their term of imprisonment.
Except in the case of a non-habitual prisoner/ first offender of means and status, who has been
sentenced to imprisonment for a serious crime against the person committed in a passion and
who but for this lapse was responsible member of society and who through his position of
responsibility over habitual is not likely to be contaminated, no non-habitual prisoner/first
offender shall be employed as a convict officer in charge of habitual prisoners.
(3) convict overseer recruited from the habitual class of prisoners may be associated with the
paid Warders in watch and ward duty over the habitual groups during the day time.
Note: The employment of habitual convicts as instructors of non-habitual convict is strictly
prohibited.
Rule-73 385. Every order appointing a prisoner a convict officer shall be written by the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent on the prisoners history ticket and a Register be maintained for
the purpose furnishing details of such prisoners conduct in jail, actual period of sentence served,
remission earned and number of prison offences committed and punishments awarded etc. and
the jailor and the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall put their initial against the name
of such prisoners promoted as convict officers.
This order shall invariably be quoted in all official reference to such a prisoner in the following
manner:-
(a) C.N.W.= Convict Night Watchman.
(b) C.O. = Convict Overseer
Rule- 386. No convict officer shall on any pretext strike a prisoner, except in self defence or in
186 defence of a jail officer, or in the repression of a disturbance ( in which case no more than
necessary force shall be used) or use any violence except when absolutely necessary. Any
convict officer proved to have infringed this rule shall be permanently degraded to the position
of an ordinary convict.
387. Any convict officer detected in introducing or conniving at the introduction of prohibited
articles is liable to be prosecuted before a Magistrate under section 42 of Act IX 1894 ; and
whenever guilty of willfully or negligently permitting a prisoner to escape he shall invariably
be prosecuted under section 222 of the Bangladesh Penal Code. Convict officers are bound to
do all in their power to prevent escapes.
70
Rule- 388. Should any convict officer be permanently incapacitated to perform all or any of the duties
413 required for him, the Senior Superintendent /Superintendent may reduce or remove him from
office.
Rule- 389. Whenever a convict overseer received from any jail, is permanently degraded for a serious
402 offence, he shall be retransferred to the jail at which he was appointed.
390. Any prisoner eligible under rule 384 may be appointed by the Senior Superintendent
/Superintendent to be a convict watchman provided:-
(a) that he has been sentenced to not less than 6 months imprisonment (4 months at district
jails) ; and
(b) that he has completed one-fourth of his sentence (exclusive of remission).
Prisoners sentenced to less than a years imprisonment should be appointed only if a
sufficient number of prisoners with longer terms are not available.
Habitual prisoners may be employed as convict Night Watchman in barracks reserved
for habitual prisoners. But shall not be promoted to any higher grade without the sanction of the
Deputy Inspector General of Prisons of the Division.
Note: For the purpose only of calculating the eligibility of a prisoner for appointment as
a convict watchman a sentence of imprisonment for life should be interpreted as one of 20
(twenty) years.
G.O.No- 391. The number of convict watchman shall be limited to the number actually required in
6489 addition to the convict overseers for guarding all the sleeping wards of the jail.
R.J.dated
the 25th
July
Provided that the maximum number of convict officers in a jail shall in no case exceed ten
1924. percent, of the daily average population thereof.
G.O.No- 392.In addition to the duties elsewhere prescribed in this code, it shall be the duty of every
6489.R.J convict Night Watchman:-
. dated (a) to comply with rules 191,192 and 463;
the 25th (b) to patrol the inside of wards and maintain or assist in maintaining discipline and
July,
order at night;
1924.
(c) to prevent prisoners leaving their berths except with permission and for a necessary
purpose;
(d) to count the prisoners in his charge frequently, satisfy himself that all are present, and
reply when challenged by the outside patrol;
(e) to prevent as far as lies in his power any breach of jail rules by any prisoner in his
charge and to report the same;
(f) to assist in quelling any disturbance and, in case of necessity to defend any official;
(g) to report cases of sickness and the use of the latrine otherwise than at times
specified in that behalf;
(h) to perform such task as may be allotted to him during the day and render all proper
assistance to the warder or convict officer in charge of his group;
(i) When so required, to act as a messenger within the jail walls and escort prisoners
from one part of the jail to another;
(j) To watch the jail walls and prevent prisoners from lurking near them;
(k) to take charge, if necessary, of the under trial ward or of part of a group inside the
jail; and;
(l) to take charge of his group in the absence of his convict overseer.
Note: - clauses (h) to (l) are not applicable to convict night watchmen recruited from habitual
prisoners.
Rule- 393. Before the prisoners are locked up for the night the Jailor shall, with the assistance of the
453 Chief Head Warder/Head Warder, arrange for the hours of watch for each convict watchman
noting the hours in the lockup report book for the information of all patrolling officers during
the night, or the turn of watch for each ward may ordinarily be fixed every week. The night
duties of the convict watchmen are clearly set forth in Chapter VII.
71
394. Convict watchman shall wear kurtas with sleeves have a band of blue cloth sewn on to the right
sleeve. Those appointed as messengers should have a red band to distinguish them from others. They shall
not be put to hard labour except as a punishment, but shall be in position of ordinary prisoners as regard
labour and discipline by day and shall for any ties or short work be punished in accordance with rules in
chapter xix. They are allowed special privilege in regard to interviews and letters and shall/receive
remission as laid down in rule 757, if they have their duties thoroughly well. For offences while on duty as
watchmen they shall be liable to punishment, as convict overseers.
Convict Overseer.
395. A convict watchman may be promoted by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent to be a convict
overseer, provided-
(a) that he is literate or has become so by attending the jail school;
(b) that he has served as convict watchman for three months; and
(c) that he has served half of his sentence or ten years (exclusive of remission) whichever shall be less.
Note:- For the purpose only of calculating eligibility of a prisoner for promotion to the rank of convict
overseer, a sentence of imprisonment for life (30 years) should be interpreted as one of the 20 years
rigorous imprisonment.
72
(k) to see that every prisoner properly folds up and arranges his bedding in the morning
before the wards are opened;
(l) to see that the prisoners in their charge wash themselves and their clothes and that they
do not barter, alter or damage their clothing;
(m) to assist in quelling any outbreak, and to defend any jail official in case of assault;
(n) to take charge, if necessary of a group or part of a group of prisoners inside the jail;
(o) to watch the jail walls and prevent prisoners from lurking near them.
Rule 400. Convict overseers will be supplied with a special uniform consisting of one cotton coat,
1164, one woolen coat, one kurta, one pair of trousers, one jungeah, one cap, one gumcha, a pair of
1165 chappal and a leather belt with a brass badge. The cotton clothing and chappal, should last a
year and the woolen coat three years. The badges shall be engraved with the words Convict
Overseer and be serially numbered from 1 upwards, and shall be worn by overseers in their
order of merit , the badge bearing the No.1 being given to the most deserving man. They shall
not carry any cane or weapon. When required to do duty in any position exposing them to sun or
rain, they shall be provided with a rain coat which should last for three years.
Rule- 401. The privileges of overseers, besides their freedom from hard labour, consist in the power of
652 earning remission of sentence as laid down in Rule 757 ; exemption from ankle rings, wearing
distinctive clothing and having shoes.
Rule 712 402. Minor offences or negligence on the part of the convict overseers may be punished by loss
Rule 389 of remission, or by temporary degradation. For serious offences a convict overseer may be
Rule 389 degraded to convict night watchman or an ordinary prisoner or confinement in cell for a certain
period.
Grade-1. CONVICT NIGHT GUARDS
403. Deleted.
404. Deleted
Bangladesh 405. Deleted.
Form No.5070
Rules 406. Deleted
434,446,425
and 476.
G. of 1. Letter No. 407. Deleted.
142 of 13th may,
1909.
B. J. Form No.9 Convict Warders
(Bangladesh Form
No. 5070) 408. Deleted.
409. Deleted.
410. Deleted
411. Deleted.
Rule 757 412. Deleted
Rule 409
Rule 388,389 413. Deleted
Rule 1164, 414. Deleted
1165
415. Deleted.
416. Deleted
CHAPTER VII GUARDING
Rules 417. The main principle to be observed in guarding a jail is that every prisoner shall, at all
325,941 times, both by day and night, be in charge of some responsible officer whose responsibility for
B. J. Form
No-37, 38 an escape resulting from negligence can be proved in a criminal court. To effect this, it shall be
(Banglades on a strict rule that a record of the names of the prisoners made over to each officer shall be kept
h Form no
5098,
in a group book, and that every subsequent change of a prisoner from one group to another shall
5099). be recorded therein; also that at every change of guard a Head Warder shall be present to
witness and verify the number of prisoners made over to the relieving officer.
Rule- 418. The prisoners of every jail shall be divided into groups; every prisoner shall, throughout
452 the whole period of his imprisonment, be a member of one or other of these groups, and no
prisoner shall, except under the orders of competent authority , be changed from one group to
73
another, and no prisoner shall, except for release, be removed from his group unless he is
formally transferred to another group and his name is entered in the group book of the other
group under the initial of competent authority.
Rule- 419. Groups shall be divided into two main classes:-
431.
(1) Extramural or those employed outside the jail walls; and
(2) Intramural or those employed inside the jail walls.
. 420.The strength of a group including convict officer shall not exceed-
(1) if extramural and employed-
Prisoners.
a. beyond the jail precincts .10
b. within ditto ..15
(2) if intramural- 20
Rule 421. The prisoner of extramural group shall invariably be in the charge of two paid warders, one
447 to be in charge of the group and the other to assist him in guarding duties. They shall also be
assisted by a convict overseer and convict watchman in the proportion of one watchman to
every ten prisoners.
Bangladesh 422. The convict overseer of every group shall be provided with a group book (B.J. Form
Form No. no. 38.) in which the names, numbers , and dates of joining of all the prisoners of the group
5099 shall be entered under the orders and initial of the Head Warder on duty.
423. The officer in charge of a group shall be solely responsible for his group throughout the day and shall
be prepared to account for the number of men placed in his charge when required. When, however,
warders are also required to take charge of groups in addition to convict overseers, they shall be put in
charge over the convict overseers and the responsibility for the charge of a group shall never be divided
between two or more officers.
Rule 424. The members of each group shall, except as herein after provided, always remain together;
428 they shall sleep in the same ward and shall eat and work in specially allotted place. The convict
Rule overseer should not except in the under trial ward, remain with his group at night.
432,
473
Rule 425. The convict overseer shall be present before unlocking at the door of the ward in which his
440 group has passed the night and shall take over his group from the Head Warder on unlocking
Rule duty. He shall remain with his group throughout the day and shall not leave it except as
399 hereinafter provided. He shall maintain discipline and shall observe the other rules of this Code,
and his responsibility shall not cease until he has made over his group to the locking up Head
Warder or until he has been otherwise relieved of his charge by a competent authority.
Rule 426. If it be necessary for a warder or convict overseer to leave (even temporarily) his
428 group, he shall under the order and supervision of a Head Warder make it over to a warder or
convict officer or to the senior convict watchman of the group. The relieving officer shall verify
the number of prisoners made over to him and shall be held responsible for them during the
absence of the officer originally in charge.
Rule 427. If for any reason it be necessary to temporarily detach one or more prisoners from an
430 intramural group, e.g., for latrine purposes or to go to hospital, etc. the senior convict watchman
Rule (who shall be also a messenger) shall with the permission of the Head Warder be detailed to
392 (1) take charge of the prisoner or prisoners so detached and shall remain with them until they are
394 again made over to the officer in charge of the same or some other group.
Rule 428. Warders in charge of and convict overseers attached to extramural groups must be specially
476 careful to keep their prisoners as much together as possible, and should be warned that they are
Rule on no account to let the prisoners wander about or go out of their sight on any pretence
424 whatever. Any prisoner temporarily detached from such a group for a special purpose shall be
74
Rule under charge of a convict overseer of the group. When prisoners are kept working all day at any
426 distance from the jail a temporary latrine shall be provided, the entrance to which shall be
distinctly visible to the warder and the convict overseer shall take charge of prisoners who have
to go there. Warders shall always accompany any of the prisoners (sweepers for instance) when
they go outside the jail leaving the convict overseers in charge of the prisoners left inside. The
sweepers who are to go outside should be distinctly specified in the group book.
429. When more than 20 prisoners are taken beyond jail precincts two of the reserve guard armed with
Rifles and cartridges shall be told off to follow the groups and station themselves in a suitable position for
rendering assistance if required.
Rule 430. When any portion of a group is for any reason separated at night from the rest of the group
427 a convict overseer or the senior convict watchman shall be detailed by the Head Warder on duty
to march the prisoners so detached to or from their several destinations. The names of prisoners
so detached shall be recorded on slips or note books. The receiving officer shall initial the slip
or note book and return it to the issuing officer (see Rule 438).
431. Groups may conveniently be divided as follows:-
(1) Extramural groups
(a) Garden
(b) Jail servants.
(2 ) Intramural groups-
(a) Civil prisoners.
(b)Under trial prisoners.
(c) Segregation.
(d) Simple imprisonment.
(e) Hospital
(f)Wall guards.
(g)Door-keepers and other isolated prisoners.
(h)Jail servants.
(i)Manufactory.
432. If a warder is not available for the duty, a trustworthy convict officer shall, at all times, both by day
and night, be placed in charge of the prisoners in the under trial ward; but in selection a prisoner for this
duty, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent must satisfy himself from the mans antecedents that he is
not likely to corrupt the prisoner in his charge.
Rules 433. It is expedient during the day time, when prisoners are moving about the jail, to have the
392, 437 outer walls of the jail watched by convict officers patrolling inside.
J. Form No.99 434. A roster showing the turns of duty of each Head Warder and Warder shall be prepared
Bangladesh
Form No. 5130 every week by the Jailor, or under his orders, and posted up in the guard room. If it should
Rules be necessary to change any warders turn of duty in the course of the week the change must
393,453.J. be noted on the roster. Each warders beat should be changed every night, and no warder
Form No-24
and 35. should be informed beforehand to what beat he will be put. A record shall be kept in the
(Bangladesh lock-up report book of the officers put on each beat in each watch. A roster of day and night
Form No. 5082
and 5095)
duties of Warders and convict officers shall be kept in B.J. Form No. 5095. Of the warders
G.O. No. 1831 off duty half shall always be on the jail premises ready for any emergent duty. Any warder
P.J. dated the not present during his turn of duty shall be liable to be punished.
20th May, 1930.
Rule 435. For day work the whole of the Head Warders and Warders on the establishment, excluding
633 the reserve guard and gate warders, shall ordinarily be divided into two squads. The first squad
shall come on duty at the opening of the wards.
Rule 436. Immediately before the opening of the wards the Jailor (and Deputy Jailors, if necessary)
249 and all the Head Warders with the Warders who are to be on duty in the morning shall enter the
jail together.
75
Rule 437. The Jailor (or in Central and District jails the Chief Head Warder) shall then let out of their
317 wards the convict overseers and the group of watchmen who are to watch the jail walls during
the first turn of duty. One of the Head Warders shall take these convict watchmen to the latrine
and then shall post them round the jail walls.
Rules 438. When the Head Warder has reported that the wall guards are posted, the wards shall be
318(f) opened and the prisoners counted out in pairs in the presence of the Warders and convict
322 watchmen of the last watch and of the relieving day warders and day convict overseers. The
prisoners, who under Rule 427 were on the previous evening escorted by messengers to
different parts of the Jail, shall now be escorted back to their day groups, the slip or note book
on which their names were recorded at lock-up on the previous evening being again used for
checking their return to the day group. After the numbers locked up the previous evening
convict overseers of the day groups in which they shall remain throughout the day. When this is
done, the relieved Warders of the fifth watch shall be marched out of the jail.
Rules, 439. The usual morning latrine, bathing and feeding parades shall then be carried out, the
634- groups remaining in charge of the same warder or convict overseer who received them on
636 leaving the sleeping wards at the opening of the jail.
Rule 440. When the morning parades are completed the Head Warders shall send the several groups
637 in pairs to their respective places of work, after calling out the names of the prisoners from the
roll call, in order to make sure that all prisoners who should be present in each group are
actually present, the convict overseers placed in charge of the groups at the opening of the jail
continuing to be responsible for the whole day.
Rule 441. Each group shall be counted in the presence of the Warder or convict officer receiving
642 charge of it , whose name shall then be recorded in the group book . At each subsequent change
of guard during the day, the same procedure shall be followed, whether the change is made in
the ordinary course or on account of sickness or other cause. The rolls of groups made over to
the independent charge of convicts overseer need not be called at noon, if these officers are not
changed during the day; but these groups should be counted and verified at the time the warder
guard is changed. In Central and District Jails there should be several group books for different
sections of the jails, so that the rolls may be called simultaneously by the several Head Warders
to save time and vernacular convict writers will be allowed to assist in writing up the group
books. In Central and District Jails in the cold season, when only one hour is allowed for time to
call the roll at the mid-day change of guard; the groups therefore, shall then only be counted.
Rule 442. The convict watchmen who watch the walls shall also be changed at noon by a Head
433 Warder who should at the same time examine the walls and report if he finds any marks or
indication of a prisoner having escaped or tried to escape over the wall. Arrangements shall be
made temporarily to relieve the watchmen who guard the walls to enable them to have their
meals etc.
Chapter 443. In the evening when the bell is sounded to stop work , each group in charge of its warder or
XVI convict overseer shall, after being checked, proceed to the spot where the usual bathing,
feeding and latrine parades are carried out, and the officer in charge shall remain in charge till
all prisoners have been locked up in their respective wards.
444. At the conclusion of the parades the groups shall be marched to and filed in front of their
sleeping wards by their respective warders or convict officers.
B.J. Form 445. The prisoners shall then be locked up (their names being recorded in and called from the
No.37.
(Banglades group book) and placed in charge of the first night-watchman of the watch inside the ward and
h Form subsequently made over to each succeeding night-watchman, the numbers in the ward being
No. 5098) carefully verified by counting at each change of night-watchman.
Rule 453.
Rule 446. After completion of the afternoon parades the first night patrol shall be brought in by the
249 Head Warder of the reserve, and the Jailor and in Central Jail , Deputy Jailors and Head Warders
shall count the prisoners into their wards, respectively, in presence of the warder or convict
Rule
officer who is to take charge of each ward for the first watch. When all locked up except the
76
406 convict watchman at the walls who are to take part in the first watch, the total number of
prisoners shall be verified. If found correct a Head Warder shall then collect the convict
Rule
watchmen from the wall, take them to the latrine and bathroom and then count and lock them up
643.
seeing that the number is correct.
Rule 447. When extra warders are entertained unless required for night duty, they shall be on duty
423 both morning and afternoon during work hours. They shall receive charge of their groups at the
same time, other warders in the early morning and after the midday parades and rest, but after
Rule stopping work in the morning and afternoon they shall deliver up their groups in the presence of
421 the senior Head Warder inside the jail, and shall then be allowed to go off duty. The convict
overseers will remain in independent charge of these groups inside the jail. Extra warders shall
not be required to do night duty except in case of emergency, such as overcrowding, sickness,
epidemics, escape or outbreak. Selected warders of the permanent establishment should be put
to guard the outside groups in two shifts as prescribed above and the extra men should be put to
other less important work.
Rule 249.
448. After locking up, the keys of the wards shall be collected and counted in presence of the
Bangladesh Jailor; the numbers of the prisoners and keys shall be noted in the lock-up report (B.J. Form No.
Form No.
5082. 24), so that the officer in charge of each watch may satisfy himself that he receives the correct
number of both. Regarding the custody of the keys of the female ward and of the main gate,
relevant rules (i.e. 333, 953 and 954) in this Code shall be strictly observed.
448A. All locks used for securing wards, cells and the main gates shall be thoroughly examined
daily by the Head Warder in District jails and in Central Jails by the Deputy jailor or Chief Head
Warder responsible for the different sections of the Jail under the supervision of the jailor. Any
lock which is out of order shall forthwith be brought to the jailor. Lever locks must not be oiled
with vegetable oil, as it causes the lever to stick together and thus renders the lock easy to pick.
The keys of wards, cells, godowns or any other place of which the security must be assured
shall not be put into the hand of convict officer or of any prisoner. If convict officers are
allowed to have common padlocks and keys for temporarily, locking up tools or materials in
their charge during the day time, the keys shall be taken from them before the lock-up.
Bangladesh
Form No.
449. After the wards are locked up the total number of prisoners confined in each separate place
4991. shall be recorded in the lock up register No. 12. This register is intended to show whether the
Rules 1179, wards are overcrowded or not. There shall be a page for every month and a line for every day.
1182 On the head line shall be shown the number or designation of each ward, as Female Ward,
Juvenile Ward, convict Ward No. 1, etc. and the class of prisoners, Non-habitual and
habitual for which each convict ward is set apart, and below this, the capacity of each ward at
the sanctioned superficial and cubical allowance of space per prisoner or in the hospital ward,
the number of beds. The Jailor or senior Deputy Jailor or other officer deputed by the Jailor
shall take a note of the number in each ward at lock-up time, and the Deputy Jailor or other
officers shall afterwards enter the numbers in the book.
450. Deleted
451. Convict night watchmen and convict overseer shall not be employed to guard over the
prisoners condemned to death. Only paid warders shall be employed for guarding over the death
sentenced prisoners.
77
453. There shall be a special system of watch by convict watchmen in each ward, the changes of watch to
correspond with the change of the warder watch. In cases where the wards require exceptional precautions, or
are of unusual length, there shall be two or more watchmen on duty at one time. Convict officers whilst on
watch shall keep moving inside the wards, and shall prevent any prisoner leaving his place or committing any
breach of prison discipline, and also satisfy themselves, by counting that all the prisoners in their charge are
safe. On change of watch patrol or other duly authorized official the number of prisoners made over, and the
name of any prisoner who has been removed to hospital. In case of any important occurrence the convict officer
on watch shall give immediate notice to the patrol, who shall summon the Head Warder in order that he may
make inquiry into the matter and take such action as he considers necessary.
454. Where jails are lighted by electricity in case of failure of power alternative arrangement like Dynamo etc.
should be made to meet the emergency. If such arrangement is not available charger light should be provided for
every 10 meters length of the ward and the ceiling or roof should be white washed., The light shall be placed in
position by means of a hook fixed to the wall at 2.5 to 2.75 meters height from the ground. All warders shall be
instructed in the proper management of the charger light in use. The light shall be placed at suitable distance,
outside.
455. It is the duty of the patrolling officers and of both the warders and convict watchmen to see that all the
charger lights, lamps are in order and kept burning during electricity failure. Any prisoner wishing to visit the
night latrine must obtain the permission of the convict watchmen. In case of apparently serious sickness of any
prisoner the matter shall be at once reported to the warder on patrol and to the Head Warder on duty.
Rule 456. Should it be necessary to open a ward at night previous to unlocking the gate or door, a chain
190 should be so attached to the doors, or to the door and door post, as to prevent the admission and exit
of more than one person at a time; this procedure will render futile any combined attempt to break
out through the door way when the door is opened.
Rules 457. During the night the watch shall patrol round the outside of the barrack or barracks of which
347,358 they respectively have charge, at a smart pace and shall on no account sit down or quit their beat .
Rule 740 They shall be always on the alert. In wet weather, warders on exposed duties shall each have a water
G.O.No. proof complete with hood and no warder shall seek any other shelter from the weather either by day
3823
or night. (No sentry boxes shall be allowed inside the Jail.) They shall each be armed with a baton or
p. j.
dated the lathi when considered necessary by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent and carry a torch
17th light; they shall frequently examine the gratings and doors and see that they have not be tempered
august, with. They shall look inside the wards, if possible, to see that prisoners are in their proper places and
1935. that the convict watchmen are alert, not sitting down, and shall frequently challenge them and make
them report the number of prisoners.
458. There shall be watch towers at each corner in each Central and District Jails outside the perimeter wall.
Two Warders shall always remain on duty there with binoculars to observe the movements of prisoners. Any
untoward events such as out breaks, attempt to escape or any kind of disturbance inside the jail must be
communicated to the Jailor at once with the help of walkie-talkie provided for the watch tower guards in order
to bring the situation under control.
459. The Head Warder, or senior warder on patrol duty at night, shall move about inside the jail visiting the
patrolling warders, convict night watchmen during the whole time of his watch. He shall keep the lock-up report
book with him and both on taking over and giving over charge shall see that the wards and cells are secure and
that the correct number of prisoners is reported to be in custody in each ward. It follows, therefore, that when
changing guard at night both the relieving Head Warder and the one to be relieved or (senior grade warder, as
the case may be) shall verify the numbers, see to the security of the wards and changing the guards in company.
He shall keep the keys of the wards and of one of the locks of the inner main gate wicket attached to his person
by a chain. In case of serious sickness he shall give notice at once to the Medical Officer and the Jailor and if
ordered to do so, by him, shall remove the sick prisoner to Hospital. Should any irregularity either on the part of
Warders or prisoners occur, he shall at once enter the circumstances in the lock-up report book for report to the
Senior Superintendent/Superintendent or Jailor next morning. Immediate notice to the Jailor shall be given of
any occurrence requiring prompt action on the part of a higher authority, such as attempt at escape, riot, or
serious sickness. He shall see that the main gate sentry is standing at his post between the gates, that he is on the
alert, and that both gates are kept closed. Punctually at the hour for change of watch the Head Warder who is to
take the next watch shall bring in the relieving warders. The Head Warders on duty shall frequently search the
warders between the gates on entering and leaving the jail. In all the jails the Jailor may arrange that the Head
Warders shall be assisted in performing the change of guard by senior grade warders the Head Warder taking
one half of the jail and senior grade Warders the other half; but in every such case two warders the relieving and
the one to be relieved shall go round together and shall verify security of the wards, for which a record shall be
maintained, for the inspection of the Jailor.
78
460. When it is necessary to let out some of the cooks before dawn to prepare the early morning meal, the
Head Warder shall let out the necessary number and put them in charge of a paid Warder. Only prisoners
with short unexpired sentences should be selected for this work.
461. Only padlocks of approved pattern shall be used, such locks will be supplied on indent by the
Inspector General. 7.5. cm. padlocks are best for main gates and 6.62 cm. for wards and cells.
Rule 462. The Jailor, and Deputy Jailors at central jails, shall go round the jail on different nights and
247. at different hours at least once a week, and at district jails twice a week, each on different nights
Rule 78 and at different hours, and see that convict watchmen and guards are on the alert, the patrol is
Rule properly maintained and that the prisoners are quiet and correct. The night and hour of visit
73. should not be known beforehand, but should be subsequently recorded in the jailor's report
book. A roster shall be maintained for such duty duly signed by the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent in jails. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent in Central/District Jail shall
also visit the jail after lockup at least twice a month to see that these rules are carried out, and
shall note the visit in the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendents minute book.
463. The following rules regulate the use of arms against any prisoners, body of prisoners or other persons
in the case of an outbreak, attempt to escape or attack from within or without:-
(1) Any officer of the prison may use a sword, bayonet, fire-arm or any other weapon against any
prisoner escaping or attempting to escape: provided that resort shall not be had to the use of any such
weapon unless such officer has reasonable ground to believe that he cannot otherwise prevent the escape.
(2) Any officer of the prison may use a sword, bayonet, fire-arm or any other weapon on any prisoner
or other person engaged in any combined out break or in any attempt to force or break open the outer gate
or enclosure wall of the prison from within or outside and may continue to use such weapon so long as
such combined outbreak or attempt is being actually prosecuted.
(3) Any officer of the prison may use a sword, bayonet fire-arm or any other weapon against any
prisoner using violence to any officer of the prison or other person: provided that such officer has
reasonable grounds to believe that the officer of the prison or other person is in danger to life or limb, or
that other grievous hurt is likely to be caused to him.
(4) Before using fire-arms against a prisoner under the authority conveyed in sub- Rule-1, the officer
of the prison shall give a warning to the prisoner that he is about to fire on him.
(5) No officer of the prison shall, in the presence of his superior officer, use arms of any sort against a
prisoner in the case of an outbreak or attempt to escape, except under the orders of such superior officer.
Note-1. - See also chapter V, Criminal Procedure Code, on Arrest. Escape and re-taking and section 99,
Bangladesh Penal Code, on the right of private defence.
Note-2- In case of an attack on the jail from outside, the senior jail officer present shall make arrangements
for defence against outsiders , as he would do for defence against a rising inside the jail . Provisions of Jail
Code Rules 463. 467,468 and 470 should be followed in such cases until the arrival of a superior authority.
464. In every jail there shall be a pre-arranged signal to be known as The Alarm by means of which
information may be conveyed to all officers of the jail and to the police of the occurrence of an outbreak,
escape, or other untoward event. This signal should, as a rule, be the continued ringing of one or more
bells or gongs at the main gate building or other prominent part of the jail, or the beat of a drum placed
near the gate sentry, or the blowing of a steam whistle. If a bell or gong is used it shall be of a different
tone to that used for conducting parades, so that there may be no doubt as to its meaning. When more than
one bell or gong is provided the ringing of the second bell or gong shall be started by the sentry in charge
immediately on his hearing the sound of the first alarm and both signals shall, if possible, be continued
until an order to cease is given by the senior officer present.
465. In the event of any serious emergency one long blast on the warders whistle signifies that help is
needed; three short blasts signify sound the Alarm.
466. At the alarm the gate sentry shall load his rifle with cartridges. If posted outside he shall not enter
within the two gates. He shall at all risks and subject to the provisions of Rule 463 defend the outer gate
from being forced and the gatekeeper or other persons from attack.
79
467. The reserve guard shall fall in fully armed and shall assist the gate sentry to defend the outer gate;
two warders with loaded rifles from watch towers and roof shall observe the movement of the prisoners
and to warn any who may be about the inner gate to disperse. Should they consider it necessary in order to
save the life of any person, they shall open fire as provided in Rule 463.
468. Every jail officer (not in immediate charge of prisoners), whether in uniform or not, shall proceed
immediately to the armoury, arm himself, fix his bayonet and fall in at the main gate under the orders of
the senior officer present. He shall not load without direct orders. Information shall be sent to the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent; two squads of men shall be despatched to the opposite angles of the jail
enclosure outside the walls with the view of preventing any attempt on the part of the prisoners to scale the
walls. A shot (fired in the air) shall be the signal that assistance is needed or that prisoners are breaking
over the wall in the direction whence the sound came. When this signal is heard the Chief Head Warder
and senior Chief Head Warder shall run with the rest of the guard to the spot indicated and shall act as
circumstances require subject to the provisions of Rule 463.
Note. A certain number of warders shall be armed with lathis instead of rifles, the proportion being
fixed by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent.
469. At the alarm, warders in charge of extramural groups shall collect their prisoners and shall cause them
to sit down in file at some spot not in the immediate vicinity of the main gate. Such prisoners shall not be
passed into the jail without the orders of the senior officer present, until the disturbance has subsided. All
prisoners inside the jail shall, with the exception of convict overseers, be locked into the nearest and most
convenient ward, workshop, or other building. The convict overseers may be employed to guard the walls,
patrol outside barracks or in such other ways as they may be directed. The other convict officers who are
locked in with the prisoners shall be required to maintain order in the building in which they happen to be
confined.
470. After the sentries are posted and the jail staff and warder guards are assembled, the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent or, in his absence, the Jailor or other most senior officer present, shall with
the whole available staff enter within the two gates. The outer gate shall then be locked and the inner gate,
if clear, opened, and the guard passed into the jail to act as circumstances may necessitate, subject always
to the provisions of Rule 463. The senior officer present, or the Head Warder of the reserve guard, on
arriving at the scene of disturbance, shall, in a loud tone of voice, give notice to the prisoners that if they
do not immediately submit they will be fired upon. If circumstances admit of the delay, this warning shall
be repeated thrice, and then, if there appear no other means of quelling the disturbance he may open fire
upon the refractory prisoners but he shall be careful to stop it the moment they fly or submit. On the arrival
of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent or other superior officer of the jail the guard shall act under
his orders. Warders shall not fire upon a prisoner attempting to escape by stealth and who is not offering
or attempting to offer criminal force, nor shall they fire unless threatened or actual violence on the part of
the prisoners renders the use of fire-arms absolutely necessary, or unless they are called upon to fire in the
case of general outbreak.
471. The procedure to be followed must necessarily depend on the character of the occurrence. Absolute
silence shall be preserved and the proceedings shall be carried out in an orderly and systematic manner.
Every officer shall be instructed in his duties beforehand so that he shall know exactly what to do and
where to go. When the alarm sounds a number of handcuffs should be taken by the guard for securing
refractory prisoners.
472. In order to train all jail officials in the respective duties which they will have to perform in the case of
an outbreak, an alarm parade shall be held once a month at unexpected hours. In carrying out this parade
the procedure detailed above shall be strictly followed except that warders will fire blank instead of buck-
shot cartridge. At these parades the Jailer shall make a note of the time at which each jail official appears
ready for duty after the alarm has been sounded. The date and hour at which each parade is held shall be
reported by the Jailer in his report book; likewise the time taken by the reserve guard to come to the main
gate, the time taken by his subordinates and other warders to muster and proceed to their posts, the names
of any who were late or absent, and the time taken to complete the parade. If the parade was not carried out
correctly he shall state what the defect was and who was in fault.
473. Whether an alarm is real or false all the details from the preliminary signal to the conclusion of the
search for the missing prisoner, or the suppression of the disturbance, as the case may be, should be carried
out.
80
474. Where the police lines are sufficiently near a jail for the alarm signal to be heard there the constables
stationed at the police lines shall take part in alarm parades, and if there is an outbreak they shall march to
the jail to assist to quell it. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall make with the Superintendent
of police such arrangements as seem advisable for a concerted plan of action in the case of an outbreak
Note. In view of the fact that the Superintendent of police is specially trained in the duties connected with
the quelling of disturbances, this rule should be interpreted to mean that in the event of an outbreak in a
Jail the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the jail should ordinarily ask the Superintendent of
Police to take charge of the operations. The Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the jail will continue
to remain in charge of the Jail. The Commissioner of Police, Metropolitan cities , will exercise the
functions of the Superintendent of police in this respect in the case of the jail located at Metropolitan City.
475. It is the duty of every jail officer to arrest any prisoner detected in the act of escaping or attempting to
escape; should such officer be a Warder in charge of a group he shall make over the charge of his group to
another warder or to the senior convict officer of his group and shall pursue the prisoner who is escaping
or attempting to escape.
476. Immediately a prisoner is found to be missing, notice shall be sent to the Jailer and by him to the
Senior Superintendent/Superintendent. If the prisoner is missed from a group working beyond jail
precincts all the groups working in the same place shall be at once collected by their warders and marched
back to the jail gate, and if there are reserve warders with them one shall proceed with speed, in advance,
to the Jail gate. If the prisoner escaped over the wall or from near the jail and may be lurking in the
vicinity, the Jailor shall despatch as many of the Warders off duty as can be spared to search for him, and
shall at the same time send notice to the nearest Police Station, to the District Magistrate, and the
Superintendent of Police with full descriptive rolls of the missing prisoner sufficient for his identification,
and stating his usual place of residence. If the prisoner is missed from a ward at night, or after all the
groups are inside the jail, the alarm should be at once sounded, the wall shall be guarded as in alarm
parade, and the Jailor shall then take in the reserve guard and spare warders unarmed to search for the
prisoner. If it appears probable that the prisoner is still lurking within the jail walls, the reserve guards and
Waders off duty shall be taken posted round the outer walls inside. They should be furnished with lighted
torches and be ordered to give notice if any prisoner approaches the walls (torches ready for use should be
kept in stock.). If it is found that the prisoner has scaled the wall and got away, notices to the Police and
Magistrate should be sent without delay, as ordered above. If the prisoner belongs to any district other than
the one in which he was confined, a report in the same form shall be made to the Magistrate in which the
prisoner resides, and to the Magistrates of all districts which he is likely to traverse on his way to his own
district; and a report shall also be furnished to the Superintendent of Railway Police, if the prisoner is
likely to avail himself of the railway. In regard to Metropolitan cities such a report shall be addressed to
the Commissioner of the police. If it appears expedient information shall be sent by fax/telegraph or
radiogram to the Police of other Districts.
477. On recapture, intimation of the fact shall be given to all officers who have been addressed under the
preceeding rule. An escaped prisoner who is recaptured may be received back into jail on his original
warrant. The time he is at large does not count as sentence served; the date of expiration of sentence shall
be calculated as prescribed in Rules 520,524 and 525.
478. A separate report of the escape and recapture of each prisoner shall be submitted in the prescribed forms
Nos. 25 and 26 to the Inspector-General of Prisons. In the case of escapes that do not arise from mere
negligence, but from some defect in the building or in the jail rules , such defect shall in all cases be pointed
out. Whenever a prisoner escapes from any Central or District Jail a copy of the escape report shall be sent to
the Deputy Inspector General of Prisons of the respective division The report shall show to what extent any
Chief Head Warder, Head Warder or Warder has been in fault in connection with the escape, what action has
been taken against the offender, and the punishment awarded, if any.
479. Senior Superintendent/Superintendents of Jails may advertise rewards for the apprehension of
escaped prisoners and pay rewards up to a maximum of Taka 5000 in each case according to the
circumstances of the escape and recapture, the degree of exertion taken or danger run by the person
recapturing the prisoner, the physique of the prisoner and the degree of resistance he offered and similar
considerations. No rewards for the apprehension of prisoners who escape from the custody of the police
shall be paid for from the jail department budget.
81
Whenever peculiar circumstances may render it advisable to offer a larger reward than is authorized by the
above rules, a special application shall be made to the Inspector-General of Prisons, who is empowered to
dispose of all such cases and to sanction rewards up to Taka 10000. Should he consider a higher reward
necessary, he shall refer the case for the order of Government.
480. The name, register number, and date of escape, of every prisoner who has escaped and has not been
recaptured shall be entered inside the cover of the current release diary of each year. When a prisoner is
recaptured, the name should be marked off and the date of recapture noted. By this means every new
Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent and Jailor can ascertain what escaped prisoners remain at large. For
the procedure to be observed if a prisoner escapes in course of transfer see Rules 884 and 885 and for
disposal of warrants of escaped prisoners see Rule 583.
Rules 481. Every prisoner who escapes, or attempts to escape shall be prosecuted judicially. On no
708,885, pretext shall these offences be treated as breaches of jail rules.
906
482. All jail officials and convict officers should be frequently warned by the Senior
Rules Superintendent/Superintendent and Jailor of the penalties they incur under rules 200 and 387 for
325,417 negligently or willfully permitting an escape. Any paid officer dismissed for this offence shall
not again be employed in the jail service. It is the duty of all prisoners to prevent escapes, and
any prisoner who appears to have been instrumental in aiding an escape, or to have been privy
to it in any way, shall be punished.
Rule 483. All cases where prisoners prevent an escape or apprehend a prisoner in the act of escaping,
765 or give such information as may lead to the prevention of an escape or to the apprehension of a
prisoner attempting to escape, shall be brought to the notice of the Inspector General and if the
prisoner comes under the remission rules, extra remission may be given or recommended, as the
case may be.
G. of I. 484. Prisoners who have escaped from jail, or while in transit from one jail to another, or have
letter attempted or conspired to escape, may be placed in fetters under section 56 of Act IX of 1894,
Nos. with the sanction of the Inspector General. Every prisoner who escapes or attempts to escape
160- from jail shall not on that ground be treated as an habitual, but shall be distinguished from all
162, other prisoners by a red cap. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may, with the previous
dated sanction of the Inspector General, allow an escaped prisoner an ordinary cap when by good
the 28th behavior he has shown himself deserving of consideration.
may,
Note:- Prisoners who have escaped from jail, or while in transit from one jail to another, with
1909.
the sanction of the Inspector General of Prisons, be forfeited all remission they may have earned
up to the date of conviction under section 224 of the Bangladesh penal code. Any prisoner who
has escaped from the Police or from jail should wear a red cap. But a prisoner who escapes from
police custody, before conviction, should not be debarred from other privileges as defined in
this rule, which privileges are earned by actual conduct while in jail.
G.O.No 485. No prisoner inside a jail, other than a camp jail or temporary jail, shall be fettered as a
194T.R means of restraint except on the ground that the prisoner is violent, or dangerous, or unless he
dated the has escaped or has attempted to escape or has made preparation to escape: provided that
11th may prisoners under sentence of transportation may be fettered while confined in a district jail.
1925.
486. If the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent considers it necessary to impose fetters on any prisoner
under rule 485, he shall record the number and name of the prisoner, the date when fetters were imposed
and removed, and his reasons for considering the use of fetters necessary. This list should include
transportation prisoners confined in fetters. See Rule 821. The removal of fetters in any case may be
ordered as soon as the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent is of opinion that this can safely be done.
487. The fetters of prisoners fettered for safe custody under Rules 485 and 821 should be examined daily
by the Chief Head Warder, senior Head Warder and once a week by the Jailer, who should certify in his
report book that he has complied with this rule on each occasion. Fetters and rivets should be obtained
from the central jail. Care should be taken that the fetter rings fit the ankles, so that the feet cannot be
withdrawn, and that the rivets fit the holes and have sufficient head on each side; also to see that the rivet
heads are not rubbed off. Leather gaiters shall be provided for and worn by each prisoner wearing fetters.
82
488. Broken glass must not be fixed on the top of the outer walls of a jail, as it affords a hold for a blanket
or for cloth thrown on to the wall, and thus facilitates escape; and there shall be no cornice or projection on
the top of a wall, which should be rounded or slope to an edge. At every junction of a partition wall with
the outer wall of a jail, there shall be a semi-circular addition to the outer wall of sufficient dimensions to
prevent a prisoner from scaling it when standing on the partition wall.
G.O. 489. In order to prevent escapes, the Government may direct that any jail or a portion of it may be
notificati bounded or enclosed by electrified fences or entanglements. The inmates of such jail shall be clearly
on
No.5168P
informed that the entanglements are electrified and will kill or seriously injure, any one coming in
.j. Dated contact with them. Notice marked danger in English and the vernacular shall be posted alongside
the 13th at convenient distances facing such fences or entanglements both inwards and outwards. Where
Nov.1930 fences and entanglements have been electrified and marked in accordance with this rule, no liability,
civil or criminal will fall on any jail official or employee, performing his duties in good faith, for
death or lesser injury caused to any prisoner by contact with them, provided that such contact is
brought about by the voluntary action of such prisoner in attempting to pass through or tamper with
the fence or entanglement or by the negligence of such prisoner.
Rule 490. A jail garden or permanent brick-field shall always be enclosed either by a thick hedge,
1153 preferably of aloes or cactus, planted in several rows on a bank with a ditch on either side or a
mud wall protected by tiles, so that the prisoners may not be able to see outsiders or be seen by
them. No gaps should be allowed, and the hedge or wall should be impassable to thieves or
cattle. The number of openings should be strictly limited to those absolutely necessary for
purposes of ingress and egress and should be provided with efficient gates or doors.
Rule 491. All locks used for securing wards, cells and the main gates shall be thoroughly examined
738 daily by the Chief Head Warder or in Central Jails, by the Head Warders, respectively, according
to the section of the Jail for which each is held responsible, to ascertain that they are in good
Rule working order. Any lock out of order shall forthwith be brought to the Jailor. Lever locks must
189 not be oiled with vegetable oil as it causes the levers to stick together and thus renders the lock
easy to pick. The keys of wards, cells, godowns or any other place of which the security must be
assured shall not be put into the hands of a convict officer or of any prisoner. If convict officers
are allowed to have common padlocks and keys for temporarily locking up tools or materials in
their charge during the daytime the keys shall be taken from them before the lock up.
Rule 83 492. A full report shall be submitted to the Inspector-General by the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent of any serious assault committed by any prisoner upon a paid or convict officer,
or of any combined outbreak amongst prisoners. Convicts of a sulky, morose, or violent
temperament shall on no account be allowed to have in their possession a knife or other
instrument which might be used as a weapon of offence.
CHAPTER IX.-THE ADMISSION OF PRISONERS
Note-The term warrant in this chapter means any order of a court directing the detention or otherwise of
any person.
493. The power of Senior Superintendent of Central Jail/ Superintendent of District Jail to give effect to
sentence and orders of courts for imprisonment is contained in the prisoners Act-1900(Act III of 1900) as
amended.
494. Officers-in charge of prisons in Bangladesh are authorized to give effect to any sentence or order or
warrant for the detention of any person passed or issued by any court or tribunal, or the Government in the
Ministry of Home Affairs or any other lawful authority.
495. Deleted.
496. The Deputy Jailor-in-charge of admission section shall ordinarily admit new prisoners into the jail at
any time after the opening of the jail up to the hour of lock-up, which takes place at sunset. After lock-up
he shall not receive any prisoner except on the special written order ( in addition to the warrant) of a Judge
or Magistrate or an Officer of the Supreme Court acting under the direction of a Judge of the Court. No
newly convicted prisoner shall be admitted into the convict wards after lock-up .A prisoner brought to the
jail upon conviction after lock-up, he shall be confined in a cell for the night or in separate ward.
See Rule
393(c)
497. It is the duty of the court police officer to inform the jailor when any prisoner sent to jail is
Bangladesh a desperate character, or is accused of a very heinous offence. This information should always
83
police
Regulations.
be given in writing. It shall not be endorsed on the jail warrant but shall be given in a slip
addressed to the Jailor.
The trying court shall intimate the Senior Superintendent of Central Jail/Superintendent of
District Jail, the nationality of a foreign prisoner committed to jail.
498. Before admitting a prisoner, the Deputy Jailor, in charge of Admission Section shall question him and
ascertain that his name and other particulars correspond with those entered in his warrant. In the event of a
prisoner refusing to answer to the name or denying the accuracy of the particulars entered on the warrant,
the Deputy Jailor shall request the officer in charge of the police escort to identify the prisoner as the
person named in the warrant. If the police officer cannot do this the Deputy Jailor shall refuse to admit the
prisoner and report the fact to the Jailor.
G. O. 499. No prisoner shall be admitted into any jail except on a writ, warrant or order signed by
No 352 competent authority. All warrants shall be examined to ascertain whether they are apparently correct
p.j, and complete.
dated the
31st There should be a separate writ, warrant or order for every prisoner, even if two or more prisoners
January have been jointly charged or convicted. If a prisoner is brought to jail without a writ, warrant or
1928. order the Deputy Jailor in charge of admission section shall refuse to admit the prisoner and shall
bring the fact to the notice of the Jailor immediately.
500. The following are the powers of the criminal courts:-
(1) The High Court Division may pass any sentence authorised by law.
(2) A Sessions Judge or Additional Sessions Judge may pass any sentence authorised by law; but
any sentence of death passed by any such Judge shall be subject to confirmation by the High
Court Division.
(3) An Assistant Sessions Judge may pass any sentence authorised by law, except a sentence of
death or of transportation for a term exceeding ten years or of imprisonment for a term
exceeding ten years.
(4) An Assistant Sessions Judge deemed to have been appointed as Additional Sessions Judge
under the provision to sub-section (3) of section 9 may pass any sentence authorised by law
except a sentence of death.
(5) Courts of Metropolitan Magistrates and of Magistrates of the first class: Imprisonment for
term not exceeding five years including such solitary confinement as is authorised by law.
Fine not exceeding ten thousand taka;
(6) Courts of Magistrate of the Second Class:-Imprisonment for a term not exceeding three years, including
such solitary confinement as is authorised by law ; Fine not exceeding five thousand taka.
(7) Courts of Magistrates of the third class:-Imprisonment for a term not exceeding two years;
Fine not exceeding two thousand taka.
See 501. (1) Where an officer in charge of a prison doubts the legality of a writ , warrant or order
section sent to him for execution, or the competency of the person whose official seal or signature is
17, affixed thereto, to pass the sentence and issue the writ, warrant or order, he shall refer the
Act III, matter, through the Inspector General of Prisons, to the Government, by whose order on the case
1900. he and all other public offices shall be guided as to the future disposal of the prisoner.
Rule (2) Pending a reference made under sub- rule(1) the prisoner shall be detained in such
250 manner and with such restrictions or mitigations as may be specified in the writ, warrant or
order.
(3) If any error or omission, which is , in the opinion of the Senior Superintendent of
Rule Central Jail/Superintendent of District Jail due to mere oversight or mistake, is found in any
523 writ, warrant or order of commitment or, if the sentence or order passed, though within the
competency of the tribunal or authority which passed it, is in any way defective in form or
otherwise irregular, he may receive the prisoner subject to reference to such tribunal or
authority, as the case may be, for orders.
(4) Any case of importance in which the representations of the Senior Superintendent of
Central Jail/Superintendent of District Jail have not been attended to, or neglect to furnish a
84
fine-realization statement, or serious mistake in such statement shall be reported by the Senior
Superintendent of Central Jail/Superintendent of District Jail to the Inspector General of Prisons
who may refer it to Government, if necessary.
Note:- (1) A warrant ordering imprisonment without specifying whether it is to be simple or
rigorous or a warrant which is undated or unsealed or a warrant signed in pencil shall be
returned for correction.(An unsigned warrant should not be accepted)
Note:- (2) If a warrant purporting to have been issued by a Magistrate of the third class directs
that prisoner be subjected to rigorous imprisonment for a single offence for over 2(two) years,
the case should be referred.
Note:- (3) The period of solitary confinement ordered on a warrant is dependent on the term
of sentence and should not be more than what is allowed under section 73 of the Bangladesh
Penal Code.
Note:- (4) High court criminal process Form No. 38 (Bangladesh Form No. 3964) should be
attached to every warrant of commitment.
502. When a warrant is returned for correction, a copy shall be retained in the appropriate place
in the warrant almirah until the original is returned. The receipt of the corrected warrant shall be
acknowledged by the Jail authorities by a special letter.
Rule 503. The date of a prisoners admission into jail and the serial number given him shall be
251 endorsed on his warrant and signed by the Jailor/ a Deputy Jailor, the warrants shall be arranged
according to the date of release and put together in the monthly bundles, docketed outside with
Rule the month and year, all the warrants of prisoners to be released in one month being placed in the
510 same bundle. Each bundle shall occupy a separate receptacle or pigeon hole in the warrant
almirah which shall be kept locked, and of which the Jailor or Deputy Jailor shall keep the key.
In any subsequent reference to a prisoner the spelling of his name shall be that given in the
committal warrant, even if the spelling be incorrect. In all Jail records and documents both the
name of the crime and the section of the Code shall invariably be given.
Rule 981 504. Either the Jailor or a Deputy Jailor shall invariably be present at the time of reception of a
prisoner in the prison. On admission into jail all prisoners shall be thoroughly searched for
prohibited articles. The search shall be made with due regard to decency and self-respect so far
Rule as is consistent with the necessity of discovering articles which may be kept concealed. All
662,
private properties such as clothing, money, jewellery, documents or anything else, shall be taken
1151
charge of and brought into account as provided in Chapter X. If prisoners are received late or
Rule 286 after lock up their clothing should be left with them until next morning. Prisoners sentenced to
Rule simple imprisonment shall be allowed to retain their clothes. Under trial prisoners and the civil
250 prisoners should be allowed to retain their clothes, beddings and shoes. The caste threads of
Brahmins or other thread wearing castes shall in no case be removed. The civil prisoners shall
not be searched in the presence of other prisoners. The search of female prisoners shall be made
by the Matron or Female Warder and only in the presence of females.
Rule 505. All prisoners shall be seen immediately after admission by the Medical officer, who shall
122 send those who are sick to the Hospital for treatment. If there is an observation or segregation
Rule ward for new admissions, the new arrivals shall be located there until the Medical Officer
1214 directs that they may be placed with other prisoners. If any epidemic is prevalent and
Rule accommodation for new admissions is provided outside the jail, prisoners shall not be admitted
1272 within the jail till orders have been given by the Medical Officer for their admission. They shall
Rule at once be provided with necessary beddings and protection from cold. Prisoners on first
736, admission to jail shall, at the discretion of the Medical Officer be kept in quarantine for such
1246 period as may, in his opinion, be necessary.
506. Immediately after admission (or, in the case of prisoner received late or after lock up, early
next morning) all prisoners shall be made to wash themselves and their clothing thoroughly;
convicted prisoners shall each be furnished with the full jail equipment prescribed in chapter
XXXVIII of the private clothing received with convicted prisoners as can be boiled without
damage shall be boiled before it is stored.
Rule 507. All newly admitted prisoners shall be brought before the Medical Officer usually on the
122, 250 morning following their admission, and he shall then make or cause to be made, in the
85
Rule admission register and prisoners history ticket, a record , in respect of each prisoner, of his or
933. her age, health on admission with such particulars of previous illness as may be known to him,
Rule784. weight on admission, marks of wounds on the person and ( in the case of any prisoner sentenced
Rule to rigorous imprisonment ) the class of labour for which the prisoner is fit, with any other
1212.
observations he may think necessary. In describing a prisoners health, if he is in bad or
Rule
553.
indifferent health, the Medical Officer would enter the general cause such as enlarged spleen,
anaemia, heart problem etc. The Medical Officer shall also record whether the prisoner has been
vaccinated or inoculated.
507A. When in any jail a newly admitted prisoner received is found to be under sixteen years
of age the Senior Superintendent /Superintendent of jail shall arrange his /their transfer to
nearest Children Correctional / Development Centre under the provision of Children Act, 1974
(as amended from time to time).
508. Every prisoner should be vaccinated against small pox and inoculated against cholera and typhoid
immediately after admission. Inoculation against prevailing epidemic /infectious diseases should be
repeated as per medical advice. Should be repeated at least once in 5 years of successful vaccination or
revaccination. The Medical Officer may, however, dispense with such vaccination or inoculation in any
case for sufficient reasons which must be immediately entered in the history ticket of the prisoner
concerned under the initial of the Medical Officer.
509. Deleted.
510. Every prisoner shall receive a serial number corresponding with entry relating to him in the admission
register; and this register number shall be his distinguishing mark whilst in the jail. The series in each jail
shall run from 1 to 10,000 in case of convicted prisoners. The prisoners number and a letter signifying his
class shall invariably precede his name when he is referred to in any official communication. A prisoners
Descriptive Roll shall always be sent to the Inspector General of Prisons or Deputy Inspector General of
Prisons with any reference concerning him.
511. For the purpose of identification and a full personal information of every prisoner giving a general
account of his physiognomy, complexion and habit of body and a note of any special marks on his person
shall be recorded in the admission register. The personal description shall be entered by a Deputy Jailor.
Where there is no Deputy Jailor these work shall be entrusted with the Jail Assistant-cum-Typist.
512. The extent of every prisoners literacy shall be ascertained on admission and entries in the admission
register shall be made in this form:-
(1) Can read and write well
(2) Can read and write a little.
(3) Can read only.
(4) Illiterate.
513. An abstract of the rules relating to conduct, maintenance of discipline inside the jail by the prisoners
shall be read over to all newly admitted prisoners ; and a copy of this abstract in Bengali shall be hung up
in every ward.
514.1. On completion of the necessary entries in the admission registers and release diaries, and of the
procedure laid down in the fore- going rules, which must ordinarily be effected within the day following
the admission of the prisoners, the Jailor shall bring these registers and the prisoners with their warrants
before the Senior Superintendent of Central Jail/Superintendent of District Jail who shall satisfy himself
that the entries ( which he shall initial ) are correct and that the rules have been carried out.
(2) The list of every prisoners property noted on his warrant or the property statement (Bangladesh Form
No.5158) shall be read over to him in the presence of Senior Superintendent of Central Jail/Superintendent
of District Jail and if the prisoner acknowledges it to be correct, the senior Superintendent of Central Jail
Superintendent of District Jail shall initial the entry. The Senior Superintendent of Central Jail/
Superintendent of District Jail shall at the same time write in the prisoners history ticket any special order
regarding the treatment of the prisoner that may be necessary.
86
515.1. When a person is sentenced at one trial to several punishments for two or more distinct offences
such punishments, when consisting of imprisonment shall commence the one after the expiry of the other
in such order as the court may direct, unless the court directs that such punishments shall run concurrently.
(2) When a person already undergoing a sentence of imprisonment , penal servitude or transportation is
sentenced to imprisonment , penal servitude or transportation, the sentence shall be served consecutively
unless the court directs that the subsequent sentence shall run concurrently with such previous sentence: if
he is undergoing a sentence of imprisonment, and the subsequent sentence is one of transportation, the
court may direct that the latter sentence shall commence immediately, and the direction must be carried out
if the person is an escaped convict the provisions of section 396, Criminal Procedure Code will apply.
(3) In case of doubt (See Rule 520) to the order in which sentences shall take effect, the instructions of the
court imposing the latest sentence shall be taken.
516. Under no circumstances shall a prisoner be detained in jail beyond the period indicated by the terms
of the warrant of commitment; but see Rule 102.
518. With regard to cases in which detention for a period exceeding one year has been ordered in default of
furnishing security under section 123, Criminal Procedure Code, the High court have issued the following
order:-
When a magistrate passes an order of the nature in question, and security is not given on or before the
date on which the period for which such security is to be given commences, he should issue a warrant
directing the person against whom the order is made to be detained in prison until the orders of the
superior court are received, making the necessary modification in form 13 or 14, schedule V, Criminal
Procedure Code. When he receives the order of the superior court, he should, if the order is one to detain
the person in jail, issue a revised warrant in the terms of that order. The warrant will not, in such a case, be
issued by the superior court, by the Magistrate before whom the proceedings were instituted. Where,
however, a superior court, on a reference being made to it under section 123(2), Criminal Procedure Code
directs the release of the person detained, the warrant for release shall, as in the case of appeal, be issued
by the superior court in form No. 15, Schedule.
It is the duty of Superintendents to see that the warrant of the superior court is duly received, and they
must be guided in the issue of reminders by the instructions given in Rule 609 as if the superior court were
a Court of Appeal.
519. Prisoners detained in prison under the terms of an order passed under the provisions of section 123 of
the Code of Criminal Procedure shall serve the full period as specified in the warrant in default of
furnishing security as ordered by the court. The period at large on bail or escape should not count towards
detention in jail but in such cases the warrant of commitment should be put up before the Sessions Judge
or the Magistrate for prefixing the date from which the detention order shall run, for under sections 120(2)
and 123(1) and (3)of the Code of Criminal Procedure the period may not commence on the date of the
order, but on a later date if fixed by the Magistrate or by the Sessions Judge. If such a later date fixed, the
warrant should clearly show it. In the absence of any later date on the warrant the period shall start from
the date of the order specified on the commitment warrant, for the period mentioned in the warrant.
87
520. When an additional sentence is passed on an escaped convict, such sentence shall take effect as
follows:-
(1) If the new sentence is one of death, fine or whipping, it shall take effect immediately, subject to the
provisions relating to these punishments;
(2) If the new sentence is one of imprisonment, penal servitude or transportation, it shall, if severer in its
kind than that which the convict was undergoing when he escaped take effect immediately and the
unexpired portion of the sentence he was undergoing when he escaped shall be served subsequently and
(3) If the new sentence is not more severe in its kind, it shall take effect after he has served the period of
his original sentence which at the time of his escape remained unexpired.
Explanation:-
(a) A sentence of imprisonment with solitary confinement is severer than imprisonment of the same kind
without solitary confinement.
(b) A sentence of rigorous imprisonment is severer than one of simple imprisonment with or without
solitary confinement.
The date of release of a prisoner in such a case shall be calculated in accordance with Rules 477, 524 and
528.
521. When a prisoner has been committed to jail under two separate warrants, the sentence in the one to
take effect from the expiry of the sentence in the other, the date of such second sentence shall, in the event
of the first sentence being remitted on appeal, be presumed to take effect from the date on which he was
committed to jail under the first or original sentence.
522.1. The term of imprisonment or imprisonment for life to which an accused person is sentenced under
the original sentence of the court below, or under any sentence or substituted sentence of the Appellate or
Revisional Court, shall, unless that court otherwise order, be deemed to run, if the accused is not in
custody, from the day on which he is received into prison under the sentence.
(2) If the accused is in custody, the sentence shall unless the court otherwise order, be deemed to run in a
reference under section 307, Code of Criminal Procedure from the day on which the reference is
determined by the High Court, and in other cases from the first day of imprisonment under the original
sentence.
523. The date on which a prisoner is entitled to be released shall be calculated by the Senior Superintendent of
Central Jail/Superintendent of District Jail and Jailor, and an entry shall be made in the Release Diary under that
date, giving the name and serial number of the prisoner. It is not the duty of the committing officer to note the
date of release on the warrant. If the date of release is stated on the warrant incorrectly or omitted the warrant
shall not be returned for correction on that account. The entry in the release diary shall be made either by the
Jailer personally, or by the Deputy Jailer; in case the term of imprisonment be changed, either by the judicial
imposition of additional imprisonment, or by remission of any part of the sentence, or by absence from the jail
on bail or after escape, the fact shall be noted opposite such entry and a reference made to the date of release
under the new order, under which date a new entry shall be made. The Senior Superintendent of Central Jail/
Superintendent of District Jail and the Jailor shall himself check each entry in the Release Diaries and
Admission Register and shall be personally responsible for the correctness of such entries, and for any illegal
detention of a prisoner or failure to execute a sentence due to neglect of this rule.
524. The duration of a prisoners sentence shall be calculated by the calendar year or month, unless stated in
weeks or days. When a prisoners sentence contains a fraction of a month, the date of his release shall be
calculated by reducing the fraction to days, the whole month being for this purpose, taken to consist of 30 days.
The day on which the sentence is passed and the day of release shall both be included and considered as days of
imprisonment. For example, a prisoner sentenced to one year's imprisonment on the 15 th January, 1992 shall be
released on the 14th January 1993; a prisoner sentenced on the 1 st January to one months imprisonment shall be
released on the 31st January, and not on the 1st February following; a prisoner sentenced to one day's
imprisonment must be released on the same day; but if he be sentenced to imprisonment for 24 hours he shall be
kept in confinement for that period. In such a case, however, the committing court should be required to specify
the hour from which the sentence should begin. If the month in which the sentence expires has no date
corresponding to the date of sentence, then the last day of the said month must be taken to be the date of
expiration of sentence. This rule shall also apply to civil prisoners.
Illustration- A and B are sentenced respectively to one months imprisonment on the 30 th and 31st January,
1992 both sentences will expire on the morning of the last day of February, and the prisoners will be
released accordingly.
88
525. The following method shall be adopted in calculating the date of release of a prisoner who after
conviction is released on bail pending the hearing of his appeal, and is afterwards remanded to jail to serve
out his sentence, or who escapes and is at large for a certain period:-Add the period the prisoner has been
on bail or at large, in years, calendar months, and days, to the term of his sentence; the date on which the
sum of these periods will elapse, counting from the date of conviction, is the date of expiration of sentence.
The court to which a prisoner surrenders after being at large on bail should note in the prisoners warrant
the date on which the prisoner was released on bail and the date of his re-commitment to jail.
Note-1. A prisoner released on bail in court on the day he is sentenced without having been sent to jail
shall not be deemed to have served any part of his sentence.
Note-2. For release of prisoners detained under section 123 of the Code of Criminal Procedure, see
Rule 519.
526. In cases where the conditional release granted to a prisoner under section 401, Criminal Procedure
Code, is revoked and the prisoner ordered back to jail to serve out the original sentence, he shall be sent to
a jail accompanied by the original warrant, copy of the order of the Government and an endorsement in the
warrant.
527. When a prisoner is sentenced, either on the same day or on following dates, to two or more sentences
to be served consecutively, the date of release shall be calculated as if the sum of the terms was awarded in
one sentence.
Illustration-A prisoner sentenced on the 21st June 1992 to one years imprisonment is , for another offence,
subsequently sentenced to a further term of one year, the period to commence from the expiration of the
first sentence; he will be released on the 20th June 1994, not on 19th June 1994.
528. If a prisoner be sentenced to imprisonment of which the whole or any portion is in default of the payment
of any fine, and if the fine be not immediately paid, the date of release shall be fixed and entered in the release
diaries on such dates as shall correspond to the date of release (a) if the fine is subsequently paid,(b) if the fine
is not paid. When any portion of the fine is paid, the date of release shall be altered accordingly.
Illustration. If a prisoner be sentenced on 1 st January to six months imprisonment and to a fine of Tk.300, and
it be ordered that if the fine be not paid he be imprisoned for a further period of six months, then, supposing that
the prisoner , immediately on conviction, paysTk.100, the date of release shall be fixed at 31 st October (viz,
6months+4 months the equivalent of the fine unpaid), and entries shall be made in the release diary on the 30 th
June and 31st October; if he afterwards pays another Tk.100, the latter date will be changed to 31 st August; and
on his paying the whole the fact shall be noted opposite the entry on the 30th June.
529. If a prisoner who is sentenced to a fine and in default to imprisonment for a certain number of
months, pays any part of his fine, the remission for the payment shall be calculated in calendar months and
not in days, Any fraction of a month obtained by such calculation shall be reduced to days. A fraction of a
day shall not be counted.
Illustration- If a prisoner be sentenced on the 15 th July to six months imprisonment and to pay a fine of Tk.
300, or in default of payment to serve six months further imprisonment, and he pays Tk.63, the calculation
shall be made as follows:-
Tk.6 months = = 1 month. The date of release deducting one month, would fall on the 14 th June. As the
month preceding June has 31 days, theof a month will be calculated on 31 days.
31= = 8 days. Here the remission for payment of Tk. 63/- is one month and eight days.
If the prisoner had been sentenced on the 15 th June instead of 15th July, the calculation of the of a month
would have to be made on a 30 days' month, because from any date in April to the day preceding the same
date in May is 30 days, as follows:-
30= = 7 days, so that in that case the remission would be only one month and 7 days.
89
530. If such fine or any portion of it be paid immediately on conviction, the Magistrate issuing the warrant
shall endorse upon the warrant the fact of such payment. If payment be made afterwards, the court
receiving the fine shall, unless it has already received back the prisoners warrant with an endorsement
showing that he has been released, draw up fine realization statements in the prescribed form and in the
Bengali language and send them in duplicate direct(and not through any other Court) to the Jail in which
the prisoner was first confined after conviction, the original being sent by the first available opportunity,
and the duplicate on the following day: provided that if the fine is paid to the Magistrate of the district in
which the prisoner is confined, not being the District in which he was convicted, the Magistrate shall also
send intimation direct to the jail in which the prisoner is. The responsibility of the court shall not cease
until it has received back the duplicate statement, with an acknowledgment from the jail in which the
prisoner is confined, showing that the necessary corrections have been made in the Release Diary. The
original fine realization statement shall be filed with the warrant and returned with it after the sentence has
been carried out. If a fine realization statement of a prisoner be received at a jail after he has been
discharged on bail, the Jailer shall, before returning the statement to the issuing court, make an entry in the
Admission Register opposite the prisoners name recording the fact that payment of the fine has been made.
531. When a prisoner whose sentence includes an order of imprisonment in default of payment of fine is
received in any Jail by transfer from some other jail, intimation shall forthwith be given by the receiving
jail to the Jail where he was first confined after conviction. A record of receipt of every such intimation of
transfer shall be made in red ink in the convicts Admission Register in the place where the prisoners
admission is entered. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the Jail in which a prisoner was first
confined after conviction shall be held personally responsible that duplicates of the fine realization
statements are forwarded on the day succeeding that on which the originals were despatched to the jail in
which the prisoner is confined at the time, and his responsibility in this matter shall not cease until he
receives an acknowledgment on the duplicate statement from the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent to
whom the statement has been forwarded. This acknowledgment he shall pass on to the court issuing the
fine realization statement.
532. If a prisoner sentenced to a term of imprisonment in default of payment of fine is also, either at the
same time or subsequently, sentenced to another term or to other terms of imprisonment, the imprisonment
in default of payment of fine shall be kept in abeyance till the expiration of all the absolute sentences of
imprisonment, and shall be annulled wholly or partially by the payment of the fine, in whole or in part,
before the completion of the imprisonment in default.
Illustration.-A prisoner sentenced on the 9th June 2004 to two years rigorous imprisonment and a fine of
TK.500/- or in default six months rigorous imprisonment; on the 17th July of the same year he is sentenced
on another account to an additional imprisonment for 18 th months; and on the 6 th October 2005 he is
sentenced on another charge to an additional imprisonment for two years. The sentence of six months
imprisonment in default of the payment of fine of TK.500/-. should begin from the 9 th December 2009( the
date of expiration of all the absolute sentences of imprisonment being the 8 th December) and shall be
annulled wholly or partially by the payment of the fine, in whole or in part before the completion of the
imprisonment in default.
Note:- This rule covers the case of a prisoner whose first sentence of imprisonment is only in default of
payment of fine. The substantive sentences of imprisonment subsequently passed shall count from the date
of the first sentence, and the imprisonment in default of payment of fine shall take effect last, although a
portion of it may have already been served when the substantive sentences were awarded; unless the
imprisonment is of a different denomination to that of the substantive sentences, in which case the
imprisonment in default of payment of fine shall be completed before the substantive sentence of
imprisonment shall take effect.
533. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent or a Jailer is not authorized to receive fines offered at the
Jail and will refer any persons tendering them to the court which imposed the fine; or, in sessions cases, to
the Magistrate of the District where the fine was imposed.
534. Deleted.
535.1 Deleted.
536. Deleted
90
537. Deleted.
538. Deleted.
539. Deleted.
540. Deleted.
541. Police registered prisoners are divided into two classes.
The first class consists of prisoners who are to be transferred before release to the jails of the Districts in
which their homes are situated. This class shall be described in the Admission registers and Release
Diaries as P.R.T. prisoners, the letters P.R. standing for police registered and the letter T. signifying
transfer.
The second class consists of prisoners who are not to be transferred, but are to be released from the jails
in which they are confined at the time of the expiry of their sentences. This class shall be described in
the Admission Registers and Release Diaries as P.R.(police-registered) prisoners.
All prisoners in respect of whom the sentencing court may have recorded an order under section 565
Code of Criminal Procedure, shall be described in the Admission Registers and Release Diaries as P.R.T
565 and released from the jails of the Districts in which their homes are situated.
When intimation respecting prisoners police registration is received from the police after his name has
been entered in the Admission Registers and Release Diaries, the letter P.R. P.R.T. and P.R.T 565 as the
case may be, shall be added in red ink. Entries on the back of the P.R. form relating to finger impression,
viz., F.I. taken or Tested shall be similarly added. The police P.R form intimating the fact that a prisoner
is on the police register shall be attached to, and kept with, the warrant, and sent with him to the jail to
which he may be transferred. On the death or escape of a P.R. prisoner of either class, the police P.R. form
attached to his warrant shall be returned to the Superintendent of Police of his District with an
endorsement showing the date of his death or escape. All other P.R. slips shall be sent to the
Superintendent of Police of the District, a fortnight before the release is due, as directed by the Rules 567.
Note. The number and names of P.R.T and P.R.T/565 prisoners should be noted in red ink in the release
diaries three months before the date of probable release, any remission likely to be earned (see Rule 585)
being taken into account.
542. The following registers shall be maintained in respect of the newly admitted convicted prisoners in any jail.
(1) No.6. Register of convicts Admitted. The entries in all the columns, except 16, 17 and 24 shall be
made on the reception of the convict. The entry of age, column 4, personal appearance and peculiarities
column 8, health on admission, etc. column 22 , and health and weight on discharge, column 24, shall be
made as directed in rules 122, 507 and 511. If the prisoner is received from the under trial ward, the entries
giving detail of personal appearance, wounds or marks and health shall be copied from the under trial
register.
(a) The entries in column 21 shall be made, in respect of previous character, on the entrance of the convict
or at any time during his imprisonment, when any particulars regarding previous convictions or previous
character shall have been ascertained either from the Magistrate trying the case or from the police; that of
jail character should be entered at the time of his discharge.
(b) Height shall be measured by means of an upright bar graded in centimeter from one to two and half
meters with small horizontal bar sliding on it.
(c) Every sentence of imprisonment awarded to a prisoner and every period ordered in default of payment
of fine, shall be entered separately in columns 13 and 14. a single entry showing the sum total of several
sentences is not sufficient.
(d) In the descriptive rolls of prisoners submitted to the Inspector General of Prisons extracts of the entries
in this register referring to such prisoners shall be made. On the receipt of a prisoner in another jail, the
entries contained in the descriptive roll shall after verification be copied into the register of the new jail, in
which the prisoner shall receive a new serial number.
(e) Prisoners received into a jail in course of transfer from some other jail to some third one, shall not be
entered in this register; but prisoners received on conviction shall invariably be entered, although it is the
intention of the authorities to transfer them immediately.
91
(f) When a prisoner escapes or is transferred or is released on bail if he be recaptured or retransferred or
remanded to jail during the same calendar year, he shall not have a new serial number or a new entry in the
register but if he be re-captured or retransferred or remanded in a different calendar year, he shall have a new
number and be entered again in the register as a new admission.
(g) In case of a further conviction during any sentence the prisoner shall not have a new number or page
of the register, but on every such conviction an entry shall be inserted containing the particulars relating to
the new sentence.
(2).No.7- Alphabetical index of convicted prisoners.
In every Central and District Jail a Register in B.J. Form No.4984 shall be maintained wherein the names of
the convicted prisoners shall be entered in alphabetical order. The Index shall be arranged, if possible , to last for five
years.
(a) The family names or surnames shall precede the personal names in all cases and determined the position in
the Index. As for example
(1) Sk. Burhanduddin.
(2) Sen kalipada.
(3) Smith John.
(4) Barua
(5) All aliases shall be entered into the Register.
(3) No.10- release Diary- A page shall be set apart for every day. As a rule volumes for 10 years in advance should be
kept up. Names of prisoners to be released after ten years should be entered on the last page of the last volume, and
when new volumes are opened, carefully transferred to their proper place in them. The particulars of uncaptured
escaped prisoners shall be entered inside the cover of the current diary. see rule 480.
(a) On conviction of a prisoner, his name shall be entered on the page devoted to the day on which he is
to be released; thus, if he is sentenced on 4th August 1998 to a years imprisonment, his name shall be
entered on the page headed 3rd August 1999.
(b) If a prisoner be entitled to be released before the expiration of his sentence, the fact should be noted
opposite the original entry, and a reference made to the day on which he is to be released, under which day a
new entry shall be made. So also in the case when a prisoner while in jail receives a further sentence.
(c) If a prisoner receives a sentence of imprisonment and also of fine, with additional imprisonment in
default of payment, entries shall be made in the Release Diary in accordance with the instructions in Rule
528 and the illustration there given.
(d) The names of civil prisoners shall be entered on the day on which they are to be released, and the
numbers and names of under trial prisoners should, in district jails, be noted at the top of the page relating to
the day on which they are to be produced in court.
(e) The last columns of the release diary are to be used to give the information relating to prisoners on
their discharge, Whenever cash is given to a prisoner as subsistence allowance or to pay his way on his
journey to his home, the amount shall be entered in the column provided for the purpose. When a prisoner is
transferred or dies before the expiry of his sentence, full particulars shall be entered regarding him under the
date on which he died or was transferred.
(4) Register No.14- Daily Abstract. This record is an abstract of the statistics of registers Nos.6, 8, 9, and 10 and
includes particulars of all classes of prisoners. Parts 1 (A and B) VI and VII of quarterly Return No. 1 are compiled
from this register. The daily abstract shall always be written up on the morning after the day to which it refers. Non-
criminal lunatics sent to the jail for observation, recovered criminal lunatics detained during the pleasure of
Government, and female prisoners children should be entered separately below in the lines reserved for statistics
regarding them. The number of simple imprisonment prisoners should be shown separately, but will also be included
in the figures relating to convicts generally.
CHAPTRE -X- PRISONERS PROPERTY.
543. All money or other articles in respect whereof no order of a competent court has been made, and
which may with proper authority be brought into the prison by any prisoner or sent to the prison for his
use, shall be placed in the custody of the jailor. A list of all property of a prisoner taken from him under
rule 504 or delivered with him, or afterwards received on his account, shall in the case of civil prisoner be
endorsed on his warrant and in the case of a convicted or under trial prisoner in the property statement
Bangladesh Form No. 5158 and signed by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent and the jailor. These
statements should be maintained in bound volumes, class by class and with an alphabetical index in each
volume for facility of reference. It will be advantageous for Jails to open two such registers for convicts
according to the length of sentence, viz., one for those with sentence upto one year and the other for those
with sentence for more than a year.
92
A record of all private properties except cash of a prisoner shall also be kept in B.J. Register Nos. 48
and 48A Bangladesh Form No. 5156 and 5157. There shall be two separate registers one for valuable
property and other for ordinary property, in every jail. The entries in these4 registers should tally with
those in the property statements maintained in bound volumes. Any property or money belonging to a
prisoner may at any time during his imprisonment be delivered to his friends, with the approval of the
Senior Superintendent/Superintendent under an authority signed by the prisoner; but no prisoner shall be
allowed to make over any of his clothings if he will thereby on his discharge leave himself with
insufficient clothing and no prisoner shall be permitted to make over any of his property to any other
prisoner either during imprisonment or on release.
There should be at least one annual verification of all private properties of prisoners early in April by the
Senior Superintendent/Superintendent.
544. Subject to the provisions of Rule 543, prisoners property shall be dealt with by the Jailor under the
following rules:-
(a) Such prohibited articles as opium, ganja, chillums, intoxicating liquor, etc, shall be destroyed.
(b) Perishable articles such as grain or food, if of any value, shall be sold and the proceeds shall be dealt
with under clause(g).
(c) If the Medical Officer considers there are sanitary objections to the retention of the clothing of any
prisoner, or if a prisoner is suffering on admission from any infectious or contagious disease, the clothing
shall, under the written order of the Medical Officer, be destroyed.
(d) If the clothing of a prisoner is ragged and absolutely worthless it shall be destroyed, and the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent shall enter his order for destroying it opposite the item on the back of the
warrant.
(e) In the case of every prisoner sentenced to rigorous imprisonment for two years and upwrds (not
including imprisonment in default of payment of fine) his clothes shall be sold on confirmation of sentence
on appeal, or on expiration of the time allowed for appealing if no appeal is made, and the proceeds shall
be dealt with under clause (g). This shall invariably be done before the prisoner is transferred to a central
jail if sentence has been confirmed. In other cases the clothing of a prisoner sentenced to rigorous
imprisonment shall, after being cleansed, etc., be tied in a bundle and stored. Lotahs and other non-
perishable articles capable of storage shall be included in the clothing bundle . Every such bundle shall be
labelled with the number and name of the prisoner and date of release. The bundles shall be arranged in the
storage godown according to the month of release for the current year and according to the year release for
subsequent years.
(f) Valuable jewellery shall be folded in a separate paper packet for each prisoner, on which shall be
inscribed the prisoners number, name and date of release, and shall be kept in a secured box in the Jailers
office under lock and key.
(g) Cash belonging to prisoners including sale proceeds of their articles shall be kept in the Jailors cash
chest. Prisoners cash upto a maximum of TK.10,000/- in Central Jails and Tk.2000/- in District Jails may
be kept in hand and well behaved prisoners may be allowed to purchase soap, tooth brush and paste, fruits
biscuits, tobacco etc. at a reasonable quantities from their private cash with the permission of the Senior
Superintendent /Superintendent. The excess amount if any, shall be placed in the revenue deposit, in the
name of the Senior Superintendent./ Superintendent at the Treasury who shall keep a record of the amounts
deposited and withdrawn on the first page of the cash-book and maintain a detailed account of the money
belonging to each prisoner in the prisoners private cash statement wherein all transactions regarding
receipt of money and expenditure on account of the purchase of the articles or payment on release shall be
noted under the initial of the Jailor and Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent. Withdrawal may be made
whenever required for payment to prisoners on release or purchase of their articles as stated above, in lump
from any one or more of the deposit items according to requirements, the oldest item being withdrawn first
to avoid lapsing to Government.
Any money meant for a prisoner shall be acknowledged by him by putting his signature or thumb impression on
the back of the money order form or on the formal receipt accordingly as the money is received by a postal
money order or by other means, and his signature or thumb impression shall be attested by a Deputy Jailor or
Jail Assistant-cum-Typist. The receipt and disposal of all money belonging to prisoners shall be recorded in the
gate register, cash-book and their private cash statement of the prisoners and also noted in the history ticket
under the initial of Jailor and Senior Superintendent/Superintendent.
All purchase made for prisoners from their private cash with cost thereof should be noted on their history tickets
with balance in hand.
93
545. Only such property shall be kept as can be stored in the Jail godowns other than food godowns. If
live-stock or cumbrous articles. Such as large boxes, charpoys, etc., are received with or for a prisoner,
they shall be handed over to his friends, if he so desires or shall be sold and the proceeds dealt with under
Rule 544 (g). All articles or money found on a prisoner, other than a civil prisoner, after he is being
searched on admission, shall be forfeited, and the value carried to the credit of Government, a certain
proportion, not exceeding one third, being awarded to the finder by the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent. Only cash, valuables and sufficient clothes for the prisoners' use on release should be
taken charge of by the Jail Department: other articles of a bulky nature, such as boxes, trunks, beds, etc.
should, in accordance with the wishes of each prisoner, be either sold or made over to his friends by the
police, the proceeds in case of sale being paid to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the Jail to
hold as deposit on the prisoners account.
546. On transfer of a prisoner from one jail to another all his property shall be sent with him.
547. On the release of a prisoner his property shall be delivered to him as provided in Rules 577 and 578.
Any unclaimed property of a released prisoner shall be retained in the jail for one year from the date
of his release. If no claim is put forward within that period, the property shall be sold and the proceeds
shall be deposited into the treasury as unclaimed prisoners property.
548. In the event of a prisoner dying in a Jail his property shall be made over to the officer in charge of the
nearest police station and the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall forward, with the property, the
prisoners descriptive roll, and a certified copy of the record relating to the prisoners property. The wishes
of any dying prisoner about his property should be mentioned to the police in the letter. The Jailor is
responsible that, on the prisoners leaving the jail or dying, the property made over to him or sent with
him, or made over to the police, as the case may be, corresponds with the record of what has been taken
charge of. The property of an escaped prisoner shall be retained for one year from the date of his escape. If
he is not recaptured within that period , his property shall be sold and the proceeds with any cash
belonging to the prisoner shall be deposited into the Treasury as unclaimed prisoners property
Every entry in every ticket shall be made at the time of, or as soon as possible after, the occurrence of
the event to which it relates and shall be dated and initialed by the entering officer.
552. The Senior Superintend/Superintendent shall record or certify on a prisoners' history ticket-
(a) any special order he may have to give as to the treatment of the prisoner, e.g. location in juvenile
ward, separation at night in cubicles or cells , any particular work or duty, etc: see Rule 514.
(b) the award of punishment (including formal warning) or an admonition: see Rules 75 and 710;
(c) sanction for extramural employment: see Rule 795;
(d) promotion to grade of convict watchman, overseer, or night guard: see Rule 385;
(e) the award of special remission: see Rule 767
94
553. The Chief Medical Officer shall record, or cause to be recorded under his instructions in the heading of the
history ticket of each prisoner, the prisoner's age, height, and weight on admission, his state of health, the class
of labour for which the prisoner is fit if sentenced to rigorous imprisonment, and whether he has been protected
by vaccination, inoculation, see Rule 507. He shall also subsequently enter or cause to be entered on the ticket
the fact of vaccination having been performed in jail and the result, admission into and discharge from hospital
on every occasion, with the disease for which admitted and any special instructions for the treatment of the
prisoner, change of work or food, etc, other than matters for which either he himself or his Medical Subordinate
are solely responsible, see Rule 93.On discharge of a prisoner from hospital or the convalescent or special
groups he shall invariably enter whether the prisoner may revert to his original work and task, or whether some
other work and task should be allotted to him: see Rule 1223. He shall also see that the fortnightly weighments
are duly recorded on the history tickets. He shall record the existence of leprosy and necessity or otherwise for
segregation see Rule 1046; the physical fitness for labour of every simple imprisonment prisoner who
volunteers to labour, see rule 942; the physical fitness for punishment of any prisoner awarded a punishment
requiring a preliminary medical certificate; fitness for judicial solitary confinement; fitness for transfer; every
order for cutting the hair of any female or other prisoner on account of vermin or disease, etc, see Rule 652.
554. The medical subordinate shall, in addition to any entries made by him under Rule 553, record every visit
to, and detention in hospital under observation of, any prisoner, together with the nature of the complaint and
the fact of the administration of medicine; he shall also enter in a prisoner's ticket any special recommendation
regarding his treatment he may have to make, but unless the matter is urgent, he shall submit it to the medical
officer for confirmation. He shall, together with the Deputy Jailer or Pharmacists/ Nurses if deputed to assist
him in weighing the prisoners, enter the fortnightly weighments of every prisoner in his history ticket, and see
Rules 131 and 1216.
555. The Jailor or the Deputy Superintendent, if ordered as regards(a) and (b) shall record on every prisoner's
history ticket-
(a) the particular work and task in weight, number, or measurement to which the prisoner is put, see Rules
252,636 and 786;
(b) every subsequent change of work or task, see Rule 252;
(c) the action taken to carry out any direction of the Medical Officer or recommendation of the Medical
subordinate relative to the prisoner, or reason why such order cannot be carried out see Rule 258;
(d) the fact of a prisoner requiring medical attention, see Rule 257;
(e) any recommendation specially relating to the prisoner ;
(f) action taken on any order entered by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent;
(g) location of class B prisoners in cells by day or night, see Rule 627;
(h) every breach of jail rules, see Rule 253;
(i) any order for the imposition of hand cuffs or fetters on a prisoner or for his confinement in a cell for restraint
pending action by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent, see Rule 253; and
(j) imposition of fetters for safe custody under Rules 485 and 821
556. The Deputy Superintendent ( in a Central Jail) or the Jailor, the Deputy Jailors or Jail Assistant shall
enter into the history ticket the following particulars:-
(a) the date of admission into the jail;
(b) the issue of clothing and kit on admission and subsequently, see Rule 506 and chapter XXXVIII;
(c) any complaint made by the prisoner of sickness or report of his sickness;
(d) application for copy of judgement if the prisoner wants to appeal, see Rule 603;
(e) receipt of copy of judgement, see Rule 603;
(f) despatch of appeal, see Rule 603;
(g) substance of order of Appellate court, see Rule 609;
(h) the fact of appeal not being made before expiration of term allowed for appealing, see Rule 599;
(i) the fact that a prisoner does not wish to appeal. see Rule 606;
(j) the total remission in days earned up to the end of each quarter;
(k) any offence committed, including omission to perform tasks;
(l) any interviews allowed and the receipt or despatach of private letters, see Rule 664;
(m) Inspector General's sanction for employment as convict warder, see Rule 405 and 408;
(n) despatch to a court, or transfer, discharge, or death;
(o) receipt of the amount of money by postal money order,
(p) the word "unidentified" in respect of every prisoner notified under Rule 623;
(q) the weight of ankle-ring or fetters if imposed; see Rule 1216;
(r) any order for the repair of clothing see Rule 800
95
557. The History Ticket of each prisoner shall be kept in a proper receptacle by the convict officer in
whose charge he is placed, to be produced by him whenever required. It shall go with the prisoner
whenever he is changed to another group or work or sent to hospital. At the weekly parades each prisoner
shall hold his ticket in his left hand for the Senior Superintendent/Superintendents inspection; and it shall
invariably be produced with the prisoner when he is reported for an offence or brought before the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent or Medical Officer for any reason, or when remission is awarded.
558. The History Tickets of prisoners who died in jail shall be kept for two years after death; those of
prisoners released, for one or two years at the discretion of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent .
When a prisoner is transferred to another jail his history ticket shall be sent with him.
Note-1. A sentence of solitary confinement shall be executed as if it were a sentence of confinement, with
or without hard labour as entirely secludes a prisoner from communication with other prisoners.
Note2.- For the judicial solitary confinement of females, Rule 954 ( Chapter XXIX.)
559. The period of solitary confinement that can be ordered by a court is a time not exceeding-
(a) one month, if the term of imprisonment does not exceed six months;
(b) two months, if the term of imprisonment exceeds six months but does not exceeds one year, and
(c) three months, if the term exceeds one year.
(d) If the period of solitary confinement ordered is stated in months, one month, shall be counted as four
weeks, two months as eight weeks, and three month as twelve weeks.
Note: The maximum period of solitary confinement permissible with a sentence of one month is 14 days;
of seven month is 7 weeks; of eight to twelve months is 8 weeks.
560. In executing a sentence of solitary confinement, such confinement shall in no case exceed fourteen
days at a time, with intervals between the periods of solitary confinement of not less duration than such
period; and when the imprisonment awarded shall exceed three months, the solitary confinement shall not
exceed seven days in any one month of the whole imprisonment awarded with intervals between the
periods of solitary confinement of not less duration than such periods.
561. If any warrant contains an order relating to solitary confinement, which is contrary to section 73 or 74
of the Bangladesh Penal Code, the matter shall be referred to the Inspector General, or the Tribunal or the
authority passing the sentence, as the case may be in accordance with Rule 501. For example, such action
will be necessary if a prisoner sentenced to seven months imprisonment be ordered two months solitary
confinement.
562. (1) No prisoner shall be placed in solitary confinement until the Medical Officer certifies that he is fit
to undergo it.
(2) Prisoners sentenced to solitary confinement should ordinarily be divided into four groups; each group
should be placed in cells for a week at a time, so as to utilize the cells to the fullest extent and at the same
time comply with the requirements of sections 73 and 74 of the Penal Code. It will be convenient to fix on
the 1st , 8th 15th, and 22nd of each month as days on which to commit batches to solitary confinement.
(3) A prisoner,who is unfit at the time he would ordinarily be confined should be placed in a cell at a
subsequent date if the conditions imposed by section 74 of the Penal Code allow it.
(4) The execution of a sentence of solitary confinement need not be postponed on account of an appeal.
(5) Every prisoner undergoing solitary confinement shall be visited daily by the Medical Officer or
medical subordinate and the Jailor.
(6) If prior to any period of judicial solitary confinement a prisoner is declared by the Medical Officer to
be unfit to undergo such confinement, or if during any period of judicial solitary confinement it becomes
necessary, under the Medical Officer's orders, to remove a prisoner on the ground of injury to mind or
body,the fact shall be reported to the Inspector-General and to the court by which the sentence was passed.
(7) If a prisoner sentenced to judicial solitary confinement be declared by the Medical Officer to be
permanently unfit to undergo such confinement, the matter shall be reported to the court which awarded
the sentence, and the order of solitary confinement shall not be carried out.
96
563. If a prisoner is sentenced under two or more separate warrants, any period of solitary confinement
awarded can only be given effect to during the time the sentence of which it forms a part, is being
executed.
563A.On each occasion on which a prisoner undergoes solitary confinement, the Jailor shall note on the
History Ticket the date on which the prisoner was placed in the cell, the date on which he was removed
and the number of days passed in such confinement. The entries shall be initialed by the Jailor and the
Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent.
563B. When a convict who has partially served a sentence of solitary confinement in a jail is transferred
to another jail the period of solitary confinement undergone by him up to the date of his transfer, shall be
entered on the back of his warrant under the signature of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent.
564. On the expiration of the sentence of every prisoner awarded judicial solitary confinement the
endorsement on the warrant by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent, certifying to the execution of
the sentence shall state in weeks the total period of judicial solitary confinement the prisoner has
undergone, and if any portion of such sentence has not been duly executed, the reason shall be explained.
565. No prisoner who has undergone a period of judicial solitary confinement shall be punished with
separate or cellular confinement for a jail offence within a period equal to the judicial solitary confinement
he has undergone after the expiration of such confinement.
CHAPTER XIII.-RELEASE OF PRISONERS.
Note: For the method of calculating the date of release, see Chapter IX on the admission of prisoners.
566. The warrants of all convicts whose release becomes due in any month shall be examined on the 25 th
day of the month preceding to ascertain their correctness.
567. On the 1st and 3rd Thursdays of every month the police register slips of police registered prisoners who
are to be released during the ensuing fortnights shall be delivered to the Police Officer who is deputed by
the Commissioner of the Metropolitan City/Superintendent of Police of the District in which the jail is
located to prepare the jail parade report. At the same time the Police Officer shall be furnished with the
police register slips of any police registered prisoners who died during the preceding fortnight.
When a police registered prisoner is received after the submission of the last set of police register slips
and his release will take place before the next set is due, or when a police registered prisoner is released before
the expiry of the term of his sentence and it is found that his police register slip was not included in the last set
submitted, his police register slip shall be sent immediately to the Commissioner of Police, the Metropolitan
City/Superintendent of Police of the District. Police register slips of all police registered prisoners released on
bail shall be sent by the Senior Superintendent of Central Jail/ Superintendent of the District Jail to the
Commissioner of Police of the Metropolitan City/Superintendent of Police who shall return them to the jail if a
prisoner is again incarcerated. For rules regarding the release of P.R.T. prisoners see Rule 848.
Duplicate P.R. slips shall be issued by the Police Department in the case of persons convicted of
offences under sections 395, 396, 397, 399, 400, 401, 402 and 412, Penal Code and for all Foreign
convicts one being marked in red ink for Criminal Investigation Department. Senior Superintendent/
Superintendents of Jails shall not later than the second week of each month, send to the Additional
Inspector General of Police, Criminal Investigation Department, direct, after filing in the release
portions , all the duplicate P.R. slips of such prisoners who are due for release in the following month.
568. In every case when a court records an order under section 565, Criminal Procedure Code, an entry shall be
made by the Jailor in the Release Diary on the date falling fourteen days before the probable date of the
prisoner's release to have the prisoner brought before the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent for action
under Rule 2 of the rules issued by Government under sub-section (3) of section 565, Code of Criminal
Procedure, reproduced below. The statement of the prisoner as to his intended residence referred to in Rule 2
below shall also be recorded in the release notice and shall be sent ( in triplicate) with it to the local
superintendent of police. A copy of the statement shall also be entered in the High court form attached to the
prisoners warrant. A translation in B.J. Form Nos.32,32A, B or C of the Rules (3), (4), (5) and (6) in the
vernacular known to the prisoner or in his District shall be given to him at the time of his release and shall be
read and explained to him, and he must be informed for what period he is required to comply with them.
97
RULES MADE BY THE GOVERNMENT UNDER SECTION 565, SUB-SECTION(3) OF THE CODE
OF CRIMINAL PROCEDURE, 1898(ACT V OF 1898)
(1) These rules shall apply only to convicts against whom an order has been made under section 565 of the
Code of Criminal Procedure, 1898, relating to notification of residence or change of or absence from
residence after release.
(2) Before release a convict shall, upon being required to do so by the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent of the Jail in which he is confined or by any person authorized in this behalf by the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent notify in the Bangladesh Form No.5093 to the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent or person authorized by him, as the case may be, the place in which he intends to reside
after his release.
(3) If , after the seventh day following his release, a convict is residing in any place other than that notified
by him in accordance with rule (2), he shall within nine days after the date of his release, attend in person
at the Thana or outpost within the local limits of which he is residing and notify his place of residence to
the officer- in charge.
(4) If, after taking up his residence in any place notified in accordance with any of these rules, a convict
intends to change his residence, he shall, if the place to which he intends to change his residence is situated
within the local limits of the Thana or outpost within which he is at the time residing at least three, and in
any other case, at least seven days before he intends to leave his notified place of residence, attend in
person at such Thana or outpost and notify to the officer-in-charge the place to which he intends to change
his residence and the date on which he intends to leave his present notified residence.
(5) If, after the seventh day following the date notified in accordance with rule (4) , a convict is residing in
any place (including his last notified place of residence) other than that notified by him in accordance
with rule (4) as his intended place of residence, he shall, within 9 days after the date so notified, attend in
person at the Thana or outpost within the local limits of which he is for the time being residing and notify
his place of residence to the officer-in-charge thereof the village and the homestead within that village, at
which he is for the time being residing.
(6) If a convict intends to absent himself temporarily for one or more nights from his notified place of
residence, he shall if he does not intend to leave the local limits of the Thana or outpost within which he is
at the time residing, not later than the first and in any other case, not later than the third day before his
departure from his notified place of residence, attend in person at such Thana or outpost and notify to the
officer-in-charge his intention to absent himself together with the place or places to which he intends to
proceed and the probable dates of his arrival thereat and departures therefrom respectively.
Note. These rules shall apply also to class(2) convicts and term convicts of class (1) released under the
provisions of the remission rules without special orders of Government, see Rules 770 and 771.
569. Every case in which a convict sentenced to rigorous imprisonment or transportation for life
G.O.No or both prior to 7th December, 1990 and every case in which a convict sentenced there-after to
.IN- rigorous imprisonment or imprisonment for life or both has under gone in jail a period of
36/87- detention amounting together with remission earned to 14 years and 20 years respectively, shall
Jails- be submitted through the Inspector General of Prisons for the orders of the Government not less
I/109 than two or more than three months before the probable date of release under this rule (see also
dated note to Rule 751)
12.2.91.
Note:-(1) All kinds of remission if granted by the Government (Govt. remission) on the
occasion of public rejoicings on any holiday or religious occasion should be taken into account
in calculating the date of release under the 20 years rules.
Note:-(2) All long term convicts including life convicts who are not released by the
Government under the 20 years rule shall be dealt with under the remission rules (chapter XXI )
and be released when they have completed their sentence including remission without further
reference to Government.
98
570. When the sentence of a prisoner expires, the Jailor shall bring him before the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent, together with his warrant and he shall be released in the presence of the Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent and at the jail gate. All orders for the final discharge of prisoners are to be
signed by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail. In cases of release on appeal, payment of
fine , furnishing security giving bail, etc, in which the power of legal detention ceases as soon as the order
of the court is delivered at the jail, the Jailor shall release the prisoner on his own responsibility, provided
that an immediate reference to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent is , from the distance of the jail or
other causes, impracticable. The warrant of a prisoner released by the Jailor shall be signed by the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent as if the prisoner was released before himself. The warrant for the release
of a prisoner who has been transferred to another jail, shall immediately on receipt be forwarded under a
registered cover to the jail in which the prisoner is confined.
571. The identity of each prisoner shall before being released, be carefully compared with his personal
description in the Admission Register and the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent or Jailor as the case
may be, shall satisfy himself that the proper prisoner has been brought forward and that his sentence has
been duly executed except in respect of remission earned under the remission rules.
The Medical Officer shall record, or cause to be recorded, the health and weight of every prisoner on
release, in the Admission Register, Release Diary, and History Ticket.
572. Prisoners shall ordinarily be released from the jail in which they are confined at the time of release;
but the Inspector General may give special orders directing that prisoners confined in any jail shall be
transferred to the jail of the district in which their homes are situated and released there.
573. No prisoner shall on any account be released after lock-up. Warrants for release should not be
despatched by a court after sunset, or if so despatched should be endorsed with instructions for release as
early as possible next morning. Ordinarily prisoners shall be released after they have partaken of their
morning meal, and as soon after sunrise as possible (see Rule 78). All prisoners shall, before they are
released , be required to bring to the office and deliver up their jail kits. all the articles of the kits shall be
clean and fit for use. Any prisoner who gives up his kit in a dirty state shall be made to wash and clean it
before he is released. A convict about to be released shall present himself before the Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent in his private clothes and carry in his hand, for inspection, the kit given
him on his admission to jail or at the last issue of clothing. The clothing and bedding of released prisoner
shall be immediately washed again by the prison dhobies, after which they shall be stored in the clothing
godown for re-issue in turn; the passing on of kits from released to newly admitted prisoners is prohibited.
574. If the date of release falls on Friday, the prisoner shall be released on the preceding Thursday; but a
judgement debtor entitled to his discharge on the omission by the person, on whose application he has been
detained, to pay subsistence allowance must be released on Friday if the 1st of the month falls on that day.
575. No prisoner shall be released on the authority of telegram, radiogram or telephone message.
576. Every prisoner sentenced to imprisonment for 6 months or upwards shall, on release, be furnished
with a certificate (B.J. Form No.31) signed by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent to the effect that
he has completed his term of imprisonment. In case any remission of sentence has been granted, the
amount should be stated.
577. On releasing a prisoner the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent/Jailor, as the case may be shall
deliver to him balance of cash money if any belonging to such prisoner and any other property of which he
may have been in possession and which is entered on his warrant, or the value of such property if it has
been sold. An acknowledgement of the receipt of the property will be taken from the prisoner in the
Admission Register. In any case the prisoner shall be called upon to declare, in presence of a witness, if he
has received his property in full, or to claim at the time anything not delivered to him. If any part of a
prisoner's property is not found and delivered to him, a note of it shall be made in the Admission Register
and the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall decide what compensation is to be given to the
prisoner and what officer is to be held responsible, provided that no prisoner shall be entitled to receive
any compensation other than the sale proceeds ( if any) in respect of any property destroyed or sold in
accordance with the provisions of Rule 544.
99
578. Prisoners will ordinarily be released in the clothing in which they came to jail; but if this has been
destroyed or sold, or appears insufficient or indecent to release them with the clothing they came to the
jail, they may be given one cotton pyjama and cotton shirt or Punjabi (preferably made of long cloth) and a
blanket in cold weather.
Cotton pyjama and cotton shirt/punjabi should be manufactured in the manufactory section of the jail and
be kept ready in stock for the distressed released prisoners.
All prisoners should be carefully searched immediately before release. Care should be taken to see that no
prisoner takes away jail property or any unauthorized articles/letters with him at the time of release.
Adolescent prisoners on release should be supplied with the following outfit of clothes:
1. one pair of long cloth shirt ( jail manufactured)
2. one pair of white trousers ( jail manufactured )
3. one piece of vest.
4. one Pyjama ( jail made)
579. (1) Every prisoner being a resident of Bangladesh whose home is situated more than 8 kilometers
from the jail from which he is to be released, and who is not in possession of more than Tk.15/-, shall at
the time of his release be provided with subsistence allowance at the rate of Tk.2/- for every kilometer or
part thereof but the total amount shall not exceed Tk 500/- to be travelled by road, train, steamer, bus or
boat to his home.
(2) Every prisoner whose home is near about a railway or steamer line shall be supplied with free pass
of the lowest class on the credit note system to the station nearest to his destination.
(3) Released prisoners sent to their home by boat or by bus shall be provided with necessary boat or
bus fare for which an approved fare chart shall be kept in every Jail.
(4) Prisoners whose homes are situated less than 8 km. from the jail shall usually be granted no
subsistence allowance. A copy of the official manual of distances in Bangladesh shall be kept in every jail.
The distance of each Thana from the jail shall be taken as the distance of every village within the Thana
jurisdiction. No prisoner whose home is more than 8. km. from the jail shall, however, be refused
subsistence allowance by reason of the Thana within the jurisdiction of which it is situated being within 8
km. of the Jail.
(5) Released prisoners, who are certified by the Medical Officer to be unfit to travel on foot owing to
illness or physical infirmity , shall be furnished with bus or rickshaw hire which one is available for the
journey they will have to perform by road.
(6) Deleted.
(7) Any female prisoner who is a resident of other district than that in which she is confined, shall be
transferred , at least six weeks before her release is due, of the jail of her own District for release. When
the home of female prisoner, about to be released, is at any distance from the Jail, a notice will be sent one
month before her release to the Magistrate of the District in which her home lies asking him to intimate to
the womens relatives the date of such release, and to urge them to come and receive her, at the jail gate. In
the event of no relative appearing to receive her, and if she be under 25 years of age or likely to be led
astray, she should be sent to her home in charge of the female warder, if there is one attached to the jail, or
of a respectable woman entertained to escort her. If this escort is not considered necessary, the prisoner
shall be given a railway pass ( if she can travel by train) and full and liberal means of subsistence to enable
her to reach her home in comfort.
(8) The allowances granted by this and the next rule shall be given in presence of the Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent when the prisoner is released by him.
580. All juvenile convicts shall, on release, be escorted to their homes by the police. Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent of jails shall send notice of the release of such prisoners to the
Superintendent of Police one day previously. The subsistence allowance granted to such convicts shall be
made to the policemen who escort them home.
Note.- for the purposes of this rule, a juvenile convict means a convict under 16 years of age.
100
581. Deleted.
581A. On the release of long term prisoners of either sex, (convicted and sentenced to rigorous
imprisonment for more than five years) trained in different trades in the jail industry should be supplied
with necessary tools and equipments along with a reasonable amount of money as fixed by the
Government from time to time to enable these prisoners to run the industries at their home upon release for
future rehabilitation as useful citizens so as to prevent them from reverting to criminal acts in future.
A fund namely prisoners rehabilitation fund should be created from which expenditure for the purchase of
the tools and equipments shall be incurred and payment of cash money etc. to the released prisoners can be
met. Such prisoner should be provided with a certificate of training in any particular trade.
582. Deleted.
583. On the death of a prisoner or his release upon the expiry of his sentence or on bail, his warrant of
imprisonment shall immediately be returned to the court which issued it, with an endorsement showing
the date of death, or date and cause of release, and the date on which the warrant is returned.
Warrants issued by Metropolitan Magistrates shall be returned to the Chief Metropolitan Magistrate.
Warrants issued by Magistrates at the headquarters of a District shall be returned to the District Magistrate
of the District.
If any prisoner is required to undergo two or more sentences under separate warrants, such
warrants shall be returned when the combined sentences have been executed.
The warrant of every prisoner who has escaped and has not been recaptured shall be returned to the court
of issue after a period of ten years from the date of escape or after expiry of the period of sentence as
indicated in the warrant, whichever is later.
584. If a warrant is received from a court directing that a prisoner shall be released on his own
recognizance, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall cause a bond to be prepared in proper form
and after the prisoner shall have signed it in his presence, shall release him. If the warrant requires the
recognisance of any other person. the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall not release the prisoner
until he receives from the Magistrate a warrant setting forth that such recognisance has been given and
ordering the prisoner's discharge. Immediately on release of the prisoner the release warrant shall be
returned to the court which issued it with an endorsement on the recognisance bond, if any. The warrant of
imprisonment shall be returned to the court which issued it with an endorsement stating the fact and date
of release ,the name of the court which issued the order of release and the date of such order.
585. Care must be taken in regard to all prisoners who have to be transferred to other districts for release,
likewise, in the submission of police register slips to the police under Rule 567 that full allowance is made
for all remission of sentence such prisoners are likely to earn under the remission rules.
586. Deleted.
587. Deleted.
588.(1) Whenever the Senior Superintendent /Superintendent has reason to believe that any person in his
custody for any offence is a member of the Defense Services liable to serve the state on the expiration of
his imprisonment, he shall notify the facts of the case to the nearest military authorities.
(2) The Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall notify to the military authorities at least three days
previously the day and hour on which any military prisoner is to be released in order that they may make
arrangement to receive him on release.
589. Deleted.
590. Deleted.
591.(1) When a convicted prisoner is in danger of death from sickness, not due to infectious disease, and
there appears to be no hope of recovery within or outside the jail and it is considered desirable to allow
such prisoner the comfort of dying at home, the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall, provided the
prisoner has not been sentenced for a period exceeding seven years for any very heinous crime or series of
crimes against society, report the facts to the District Magistrate.
101
(2) If the unexpired period of the prisoners sentence does not exceed six months, the District Magistrate is
authorised to direct his immediate release, after making personal enquiries into the case, or, in the event of
the prisoner's offence having been committed in another district, after consulting the District Magistrate of
that District.
(3) In all other cases the District Magistrate shall immediately report the facts of the case, with his
recommendation thereon, direct for the orders of Government.
(4) No prisoner who has no friends or relatives willing and able to take charge of him shall be released
under this rule
(5) All releases under this rule shall be counted as deaths in the statistical records of the jail.
592.(1) When a convicted prisoner suffering from sickness not due to infectious disease, is likely to die if
detained in jail, but there is a reasonable chance of recovery if he is released , the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent shall report the facts to the District Magistrate of the district, in which the prisoner's
offence was committed, provided that
(a) the prisoner has not more than six months to remain in prison before the expiry of his
sentence ; and
(b) the Civil Surgeon of the District recommends the release and certifies that-
(1) the disease is likely to prove fatal, if the prisoner remains in jail;
(2) there is a reasonable chance of recovery, if the prisoner be released;
(3) the disease has not been produced or aggravated by any wilful act on the part of the
prisoner.
(2) The prisoner shall be informed before release that his liberation is conditional on the sanction of the
Government, and that if such sanction be withheld, he will have to return to prison to serve out the
remaining portion of his sentence. The prisoners friends shall be sent for, and a security bond taken from
them before he is released, that they will give him up if required to do so. The name and residence of the
person or persons who agree to take charge of the prisoner shall be stated in the application for sanction for
his release. In no case shall a prisoner be released and sent to a charitable dispensary or to a hospital for
treatment.
(3) If the Magistrate of the District dissents from the Senior Superintendents/ Superintendents
recommendation, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may request the Magistrate to submit the
recommendation to the Commissioner of the Division in which the prisoners offence was committed, and
the Commissioner may either issue order to release, subject to the above conditions, or submit the case for
the orders of the Government.
Note:- Cases of leprosy in the infective stage and open cases of tuberculosis should be included under the
term infectious diseases mentioned in the Jail Code Rules 591 and 592.
593.If a prisoner detained solely under a sentence of imprisonment in default of furnishing security to keep
the peace or for good behaviour is so seriously ill as to be likely to die, whatever the term of his unexpired
sentence, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall refer the case to the District Magistrate who
should exercise the discretion allowed to him by section 124 of the Code of Criminal Procedure, under
which he can release the prisoner without referring to the Government.
594. In cases of complete and incurable blindness not caused by the voluntary act of the prisoner, of
decrepitude or other incurable infirmity, such as absolutely incapacitates a prisoner from the commission
of further crime on release, and where release would not be attended with mischief or danger, a report in
B.J. Form No.105 shall be submitted by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent to the Inspector-General
of Prisons, who will at his discretion report the case for the orders of Government. Before such report is
made, the Magistrate of the District in which the prisoner was convicted shall be asked for his opinion.
102
595. Every case of release under Rules 591, 592 and 594 shall immediately be reported in B.J. Form No.
105 or 106 to the Inspector-General who shall report to Government such releases as have been made
without the special sanction of government.
596. In the event of the friends or relatives of a sick or dying prisoner, whose release has been sanctioned
under Rules 591,592 and 594, expressing their inability to meet the expenses of a journey to the jail in
which such prisoner is confined, the prisoner may be transferred, if fit to travel in anticipation of sanction
to the jail of the district in which such friends or relatives reside.
In the event of such prisoner dying before he can be released, the death shall be recorded in the statistics
of the jail from which he was transferred.
597. If in the opinion of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail a prisoner requires medical
treatment or a surgical operation which cannot be adequately or safely given or performed in the jail
hospital, he shall either
(a) arrange for the transfer of the prisoner to a jail where the treatment can be given or the operation
performed; or
(b) send the prisoner to the local hospital escorted by a guard of warders which shall be in charge of the
prisoner until he is brought back to the jail; or
(c) apply through the District Magistrate or Inspector-General of prisons to the Government, for the
suspension of the prisoners sentence under section 401 of the Code of Criminal Procedure for a period
sufficient for the required treatment or operation in a hospital outside the jail, forwarding with the
application an undertaking by the prisoner in Bangladesh jail Form No. 118.
(d) The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of Jail concerned will be responsible for making adequate
arrangement for guarding of the prisoner in an outside Hospital by Warder guards. In the case of dangerous
and desperate prisoner, he shall ask the Superintendent of Police or Police Commissioner for police guards
for reinforcing the Jail guards.
(e) Before the removal of the prisoner to outside Hospital sanction of the Deputy Inspector General of
Prisons shall be obtained. But in case of Dhaka Central Jail sanction of the Inspector General of Prisons
shall invariably be obtained.
In case of emergency the prisoner shall be removed to outside hospital in anticipation of sanction of the
above authorities and simultaneously concerned Deputy Inspector General of Prisons shall be applied to
for approval. In all the cases, copies of orders sanctioning removal of the prisoner to outside hospital be
submitted to the Inspector General of Prisons.
598. In case of removal of detenu to outside Hospital for treatment prior approval of Government shall be
necessary but in emergent cases the District Magistrate concerned may authorise such removal in
anticipation of governments approval for which immediate reference to government shall be made. Before
removal of such prisoner to outside hospital the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall intimate the
Additional Inspector General of Police, Special Branch, or the Superintendent of Police, Special Branch of
his intention and ascertain whether any special police guard is necessary.
599. Every convict desiring to appeal, and entitled to do so, shall be granted every reasonable facility for
the purpose and his request shall be promptly attended to , whether the appeal can reach the appellate court
within the period specified or not. In cases where a petition for appeal is made so late as to render it
unlikely or impossible for it to reach the Appellate court within the allotted time the officer in charge shall
endorse on the appeal the convicts reasons for not submitting it earlier, together with his own views (if
any) on the reasons so given.
103
600. The periods within which appeals must reach the various Appellate courts in order to prevent their
being time barred, be counted from the date of the sentence or order appealed against, as follows:-
Appeal to the Supreme Court ( High Court Division)
against a sentence of death .......... .....7 days
Appeal to the Supreme Court( High Court Division)
In cases other than a sentence of death....60 days.
Appeal to any other court ........................30 days.
Note: As per Articles 150,154 and 155 of First Schedule of Limitations Act l908.
601. Every convict shall be allowed reasonable opportunities of personally interviewing his relatives ,
friends and legal advisers for the purpose of preparing his appeal; provided that every such interview shall
be held within sight, but out of the hearing of the jail official in whose charge the prisoner is placed for the
purpose of such interview.
The convict shall be allowed to sign a power of attorney authorising any one to act for him; the power
must bear the proper stamp under the existing Stamp Act of 1899 and the prisoners signature must be
attested by the Jailor or Deputy Jailor.
602. No prisoner or officer of the jail shall prepare, write out or submit any appeal or petition on behalf of
any prisoner without the previous permission in writing of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent.
603. (1) If a prisoner desires to appeal and declares that he has no relative, friend or agent who is willing
to make an appeal for him, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall forthwith apply (B .J. Form No.
27) for a copy of the judgment or order relating to such prisoner from which he desires to appeal.
(2) On receipt of the copy of judgment or order, the prisoner shall, if he is able to write, be allowed to
write his own appeal. If the prisoner is not able to write, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall
cause his appeal to be written for him by another prisoner or by a jail official.
(3) If the copy of judgment is not received within seven days the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent shall send a reminder for it and if there is any excessive delay, shall report the matter to
the Inspector General.
(4) A prisoner, or official deputed to write an appeal, shall do so at the appellants dictation and shall neither
make any suggestions to the prisoner as to what should be stated, nor add anything to what the prisoner
himself desires to have stated in the appeal.
(5) The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall forward the appeal without delay with the copy of the
judgment or order appealed from to the Appellate Court.
(6) If after the receipt of the copy of the judgment or order, a relative, friend or agent of the prisoner
undertakes to make the appeal on his behalf and the prisoner consents to that course , the copy of the
judgment shall be delivered to such relative, friend or agent, as the case may be.
(7) If several prisoners sentenced in the same case petition at one time to the same court, one copy of
judgment will suffice for all. But it must be noted that orders issued on the appeal of one prisoner do not
necessarily apply to others who were sentenced in the same case and who appealed along with such
prisoner.
(8) If a convict has been transferred to another jail before the receipt of the copy of the judgment, the copy
of the judgment shall, on receipt, be forwarded without delay to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent
of the jail in which the prisoner is confined and an acknowledgment obtained.
(9) Appeals from military prisoners against sentences passed on them by Court Martial must be forwarded,
with a copy of the warrant, to the General Officer Commanding the District in which the jail is situated for
transmission to command Headquarters.
Note.- See Rules 990 and 991 regarding appeals and petitions for mercy of prisoners condemned to death.
104
604. Every appeal shall be made in the form of a petition [High Court Criminal Form (M) 97 B or C] in
writing, and if the appellant is in jail such petition is exempted from stamp duty. Care shall be taken to see
that the appeal has been duly signed by the appellant. The signature shall be witnessed and attested by the
Jailer or Deputy Jailer. All petitions of appeal shall be endorsed and forwarded by the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent, High Court Criminal Form No. M. 104 being used in the case of appeal to
the High Court. Prisoners in jail convicted in the same case may appeal or apply for revision either jointly
in one petition or separately.
605. Whenever a prisoner appeals from jail to the Supreme Court (High Court Division) the Senior
Superintendent /Superintendent shall inform the Sessions Judge of such appeal, in High Court Criminal
Form No. (M) 105.
606. If any prisoner states that he desires or does not desire to appeal, the fact shall be recorded on his
History Ticket.
607. No convicted prisoner shall ordinarily be transferred from the jail to which he is committed until he
has completed his term of appeal without appealing or unless his appeal has been rejected. But in case
when a prisoner is required to be transferred to other jails to give evidence or to face trial in any other case
under orders of the Court such prisoner shall not come under the operation of this rule even if his appeal
remain pending. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall give effect to the orders of the Court as
provided under Act III of 1900 and transfer such prisoner to the jails of the District where his attendance in
the Court is required.
Note.- when for any reason it becomes necessary to transfer prisoners before the expiry of the period
allowed for filing an appeal , the groups (i.e., of prisoners convicted in the same case) should be kept
unbroken as far as possible. If the groups have to be broken up, the appeals of the men should be sent
separately from the different jails in which they are confined
608. When prisoners who have not, to the knowledge of the jail authorities , preferred an appeal, are
transferred to other jails before the expiry of the period allowed for filing an appeal, a notice of the transfer
shall invariably be sent to the last convicting court. When an order to release of a prisoner who has been
transferred, or a revised warrant or any communication relating to his appeal, is received from the
Appellate Court by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of a jail, he shall forward it immediately by
post to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail to which the prisoner has been transferred.
609. If the result of an appeal is not communicated to the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent within 15
days, or in the case of the High Court Division of the Supreme Court within one month of the date on
which the appeal was submitted the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall send a reminder ( in B.J.
Form No. 29 ) to the Sessions Court, or to the Additional Magistrate of the District or , in Dhaka, Rajshahi,
Chittagong and Khulna to the Chief Metropolitan Magistrate , as the case may be enquiring what has been
the result of appeal, and there after shall repeat the enquiry at reasonable intervals. The result of appeal
when received, shall be communicated to the prisoner concerned and entered in his History Ticket.
Note.- Action under this rule in the case of a transfer should also be taken by the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent to whose jail the prisoner has been transferred.
105
610. (1) In every case in which a sentence is reversed, the Appellate Court shall fill in the prescribed form
of warrant of release on appeal, and shall send the same direct to the officer in charge of the jail in which
the appellant is confined. It shall at the same time recall and cancel the original warrant of commitment,
and this warrant and the warrant of the appellate court directing release of the prisoner, when returned with
an endorsement of execution, shall be attached to the record of the original court and returned to it
therewith.
(2) In every case in which a sentence is modified on appeal, the Appellate Court shall prepare a fresh
warrant in the form prescribed in accordance with the terms of the order passed, and shall send the same
direct to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail in which the appellant is confined, and shall
recall and cancel the original warrant of commitment, which shall be attached to the record of the original
court and returned to it therewith. When the fresh warrant is returned with an endorsement of execution,
the appellate court shall forward it to the court from the decision of which the appeal was preferred, to be
attached to the original record. Provided that if an appellant has been released on bail pending the hearing
of his appeal, the fresh warrant shall not be sent to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail
until the prisoner has surrendered, and it shall be the duty of the Appellate Court, either directly or through
the court by which the order of release on bail was actually issued, to take measures to secure his
surrender.
(3) In every case in which a sentence is confirmed on appeal, the jail authorities shall receive information
to this effect by means of the form prescribed. Irrespective of the procedure prescribed above, the
Appellate Court shall, for the information of the appellant, notify to the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent of the jail in which such appellant is confined the result of his appeal. This notification,
which shall be made in the sanctioned form, is intended solely for the communication of the result of the
appeal to the appellant, and in no way relieves judicial officers from the duty of issuing revised warrants
when such are necessary. All warrants and orders issued with reference to a prisoners appeal should be in
Bangla and should state the prisoners fathers and mothers name as well as the prisoners name.
(4) This rule does not apply to cases in which a sentence passed by a judicial court is commuted by
order of the President. In such a case the order of government, or a certified copy thereof, shall be attached
to the prisoners warrant, on which a note setting forth the alteration of sentence, and the number and date
of the Government order, shall be made and attested by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent.
611. When an Appellate court annuls a sentence and directs that the prisoner shall be retried and a warrant
for the prisoners release on bail is not received, the prisoner shall be remanded to the under trial
ward(unless he be undergoing some other sentence) and the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall
apply to the committing court for a warrant for his custody pending trial if such warrant is not at the same
time furnished. Such warrant should set forth the court by which the prisoner is to be tried and the date on
which he is to be produced before the court.
Note.- See Rule 584 regarding release of prisoner on recognizances by order of an Appellate court.
612. A prisoner can appeal only once to a judicial court; the order of the Appellate court is final. If the
prisoner wishes to move a higher court for the revision of the proceedings in his case, action must be taken
by his friend or agent. The jail authorities cannot act in the matter.
106
613. (1) A prisoner whose appeal has been rejected by the High Court Division of the Supreme Court or
in case of Chittagong Hill tracts by the Commissioner of the Chittagong Division or who has been
sentenced by the High court Division of the Supreme Court may submit petition to the president for pardon
or remission of sentence within three months from the date of order of the Supreme Court (High Court
Division ) or the Commissioner of the Chittagong Division.
(2) Petitions which are not made in accordance with rule (1) shall be withheld unless they are based on
some ground arising subsequently to the trial of the prisoner.
(3) Petitions based on the ground of family distress or on the health or good conduct of the prisoner shall
ordinarily be withheld.
(4) Any petition which would ordinarily be withheld under rule(3) may be forwarded if an official visitor
thinks it advisable. To enable an official visitor to form an opinion in the matter copies of the petition and
of the order thereon shall be kept in the jail office and shall be shown to the visitor, when required.
Note.1- Prisoners condemned to death shall be allowed to appeal for mercy under the conditions specified
in rule 991 of this Code
Note-2. Recommendations for remission on the ground of the ill- health or good conduct of a prisoner
may be made by the jail authorities but shall not originate in a petition by the prisoner to the President.
614. Prisoners petitions shall be written in half margin foolscap paper. and, if in vernacular, a translation
shall accompany them. The prisoners signature or mark shall be attested by an officer of the jail. The
petitions shall be countersigned by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent and forwarded by him, in the
case of petitions for mercy from prisoners condemned to death, direct to the Secretary of Ministry of
Home Afairs, in other cases to the Inspector General. If the petition relates to the alleged bad health of the
prisoner who makes the petition, it shall be accompanied by an expression of the Civil Surgeons opinion
on the point.
Should a petition prepared on behalf of a prisoner be presented to the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent with a view to obtaining the prisoners signature or mark thereon, it shall not, after
compliance be handed back to the person or persons who presented the petition but shall be duly
forwarded by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail to the Inspector General of Prisons or to
the Government, as the case may be.
615. In the event of any convict desiring to make petition to the District Magistrate, or his late official
superior or employers in matters of urgency relating to family affairs, civil suits, property and the like, the
Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent, after due consideration, may at his discretion permit such petition
and shall then countersign and forward it direct to its destination, provided that in no case shall any
petition of this nature be forwarded direct to the High Court Division of the Supreme Court.
Convicts of other nationals be allowed to petition to the consuls of their respective embassy, but such
petition shall invariably be forwarded to the Ministry of Home Affairs through the Inspector General of
Prisons for disposal.
107
CHAPTER XV- CLASSIFICATION
616. Each of the following classes of prisoners shall be kept entirely separate from others either in the
same jail in the separate enclosure or in the separate jail:-
1. civil prisoners.
2. Under trial prisoners (Male)
(a) Adults above 21 years of age.
(b) Juveniles between 16 and 21 years of age.
3. Under trial prisoners (Female)
(a) Adults above 21 years of age.
(b) Juveniles between 16 and 21 years of age
4. convicted prisoners (Male )
(a) Adults above 21 years of age.
(b) Juveniles between 16 and 21 years of age
(c) Long termers (above 5 years of imprisonment )
(d) Short termers (Imprisonment upto 5 years)
(e) Habituals (B) class.
(f) Non-habituals (A) class
5.Children below 16 years of age if put in Jail shall invariably be segregated from others.
6.Male prisoners who have not arrived the age of puberty should be kept entirely separate from others.
617. All prisoners shall be divided into three divisions, viz., I,II and III:-
(1) Convicted Prisoners will be eligible for Division I, irrespective of their nationality, if-
(i) they are non-habitual prisoners of good character;
(ii) they by social status, education and habit of life have been accustomed to a superior mode of living; and
(iii) they have not been convicted of -
(a) offences involving elements of cruelty, moral degradation or personal greed; (corruption) and terrorism;
(b) serious or premeditated violence;
(c) serious offences against property;
(d) offences relating to the possession of explosives, fire arms and other dangerous weapons with the object
of committing an offence or of enabling an offence to be committed;
(e) abetment or incitement of offences falling within these sub-clauses.
(2) Prisoners will be eligible for Division II irrespective of their nationality, who by social status, education and
habit of life have been accustomed to a superior mode of living. Habitual prisoners will not be excluded
automatically; the classifying authority will be allowed discretion to suggest their inclusion in this class on
grounds of character and antecedents, subject to confirmation or revision by the District Magistrate/
Government.
(3) Division III will consist of prisoners who are not classified in divisions I and II
(4) The Supreme Court , Sessions Judges, Additional Sessions Judges, Special Judges, Assistant Sessions
Judges (the latter one through the District and Sessions Judges) District Magistrate, Additional District
Magistrate, Magistrates of the first class, Metropolitan Magistrate of the 1st class ( the latter two through
the District Magistrate) shall make the initial recommendation for classification in division I or II to
Government in the Ministry of Home Affairs by whom these recommendations will be confirmed or
reviewed.
(5) Pending the orders of Government on each case referred to them convicted prisoners whose previous
standard of living has been declared to be superior to the ordinary or who while under trial have been
classed as Division I under trial, shall, if they are non-habitual of good character and are not disqualified
from being so classified by the nature of their offences, be treated as Division II convict, and convicted
prisoners whose previous standard of living has not been declared to be superior to the ordinary or who
have been classed as division III under trial (ordinary under trial), as Division III convicts .
(6) The Government in the Ministry of Home Affairs may grant higher status to any prisoner, convict or
under trial, who has satisfied the conditions set forth in rule 617 clause (1) and clause (2) on application
from the prisoner or from his relation.
108
Note.-(1) prisoners admitted to Division I and Division II shall, where possible, be segregated in separate
enclosure.
(2) Jail Code rule 617 shall apply to both civil prisoners and the prisoners belonging to the Defense
Services.
(7) Notwithstanding anything contained in sub-rule (1) Division I convicted prisoners shall include the
following persons, namely-
(i) All persons formerly placed within serial No. 1-18 in the Warrant of Precedence published by the
Government.
(ii) Presidents and Secretaries of the Central Committees of such political parties who has got
representation in the parliament.
(iii) The persons honored with Gallantry Award of Bir Uttam, Bir Bikram and Bir Protik.
(iv) The persons honored with the Independence Award or Ekushe Award.
(v) The persons currently enjoying the honor of Commercially Important Person (CIP).
(vi) The persons once appointed as Professor Emiritus.
(vii) Such other persons as may be determined by the Ministry of Home Affairs, from time to time, in
consultation with the Ministry of Law, Justice and Parliamentary Affairs.
(8) The Senior Superintendent or the Superintendent of the respective Central and District Jail are
empowered to provide Division to the persons specified in sub-rule (7) provided that the provisions laid
down in sub- rule (4) shall not be applied for providing Division to the convicted prisoners.
(9) The appointed lawyer or relatives of the prisoners may provide necessary information in this regard. If
there be any confusion as regard to the provided information, the jail authority shall first provisionally
allow Division to individual and then refer the matter to the Government.
618. 1. The following persons shall be liable to be classified as habitual criminals, namely:-
(i) Any person convicted of an offence whose previous conviction or convictions under Chapter XII, XVI,
XVII or XVIII of the Penal Code taken in conjunction with the facts of the present case show that he
habitually commits an offence or offences referred to above; or against whom an order had previously
been passed under section 118 read with section 109 or 110 of the Code of Criminal Procedure.
(ii) any person committed to or detained in prison under section 123 (read with section 109 or section 110)
of the Code of Criminal Procedure;
(iii) any person convicted of any of the offences specified in clause (i) above when it appears from the
facts of the case, even all though no previous conviction has been proved, that he is by habit a cheat, or a
member of a group of dacoits, or of thieves or a dealer in stolen property or a trafficker of women or
children for immoral purposes.
(iv) Deleted.
II.-The classification of convicted person as a habitual criminal should ordinarily be made by the
convicting court, but if the convicting court omits to do so, such classification may be made by the District
Magistrate or in the absence of an order by the convicting court or District Magistrate and pending the
result of a reference to the District Magistrate by the officer in charge of the jail where such convicted
person is confined.
Provided that any person classified as a habitual criminal may apply for a revision of the order.
III.- The convicting court or the District Magistrate may, for reasons to be recorded in writing , direct that
any convicted person or any person committed to or detained in, prison under section 123 read with
section 109 or section 110 of the Code of Criminal Procedure, shall not be classed as a habitual criminal
and may revise such direction.
IV Convicting courts or District Magistrate, as the case may be, may revise their own classification, and
the District Magistrate may alter any classification of a prisoner made by a convicting court or any other
authority provided that the alteration is made on the basis of facts which were not before such court or
authority.
Note.- Deleted.
V. Habitual criminal shall, as far as possible , be confined in a special jail in which no prisoner other than
habitual criminals shall normally be kept:
109
Provided that the Inspector General of Prisons may transfer to this special jail any prisoner, not classified
as a habitual criminal, whom for reasons to be recorded in writing, he believes to be of so vicious or
depraved a character and so likely to exercise evil influence on his fellow prisoners that he ought not to be
confined with other non-habitual prisoners, but a prisoner so transferred shall not otherwise be subject to
the special rules affecting habitual criminals.
VI .Deleted.
619. In all non-habitual prisoners, all convicted offenders in Division III other than habitual shall be
divided into two classes, namely, (a) the Star class, and (b) Ordinary. The Star class include such prisoners
as may be selected by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent (subject to the control of the Inspector
General) on the ground that their previous character has been good, that their antecedents are not criminal
and their crime does not indicate grave cruelty or gross moral turpitude or depravity of mind. One or more
previous convictions would not exclude a prisoner from the Star class, if they were for petty offences.
Even a conviction for serious crime should not be regarded as a bar, if it was committed several years
before and if, during the intervening period, the prisoner has led generally an honest life. The age of the
offender at the date of any previous conviction and at the date of his present offence should of course be
taken into account. The whole circumstances of the case should be considered with a view to determining
whether the prisoner is already of so corrupt a mind or disposition that he may contaminate others and he
cannot further corrupt himself and the question should be decided in a common sense and not on any hard
and fast lines.
The Star class prisoners except when appointed convict officers should as far as possible be segregated
from ordinary class of prisoners at night parades and work. Where separate cells can be provided and the
prisoner who is placed in the Star class prefers to be thus separated, his wishes should, as far as may be, be
complied with. When only association wards exist, every endeavor should be made to confine Star class
prisoners together without admixture of other offenders.
620.(1) With the warrant of every convict shall be sent his descriptive roll in High Court Criminal Form
No. 38 signed by the Magistrate. This roll shall be attached to the prisoners warrant and shall be returned
with it to the court after the sentence has expired.
(2) In the descriptive roll the Magistrate shall note whether the prisoner has been classed as Division I or
Division II under trial or if he has not been classified as an under trial, whether his previous standard of
living was superior to the ordinary.
(3) Unless the prisoner is eligible and is being recommended for classification as a Division I or Division
II convict the Magistrate shall also note whether he is to be classed as A or B .
(4) When the prisoner is sentenced by a court superior to that of a Magistrate, the District Magistrate will
arrange for the despatch of the descriptive roll, to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the Jail. If
the Magistrate omits to send the roll the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall ask for it and if the
omission occurs frequently he shall report the instances to the Inspector General of Prisons.
622. Previous convictions, if any, will generally appear in the warrant or in the High Court Form. The
Senior Superintendent/Superintendent should not be content with this information, but should endeavor to
ascertain from the jail officers and long term convicts, as well as from the records of his jail, if the prisoner
has been previously convicted. As the conviction Register laid down in the Bangladesh Police Regulations
and kept in the Magistrates Court, contains only the names of persons convicted of certain specified
offences it is not to be expected that all the offences of which a prisoner has been previously convicted will
be shown in the High Court Form.
110
623. The Superintendent of Police/Metropolitan Police Commissioner will notify to the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent the name of any prisoner committed to jail under chapter XII or XVII,
Penal Code, or section 123, Code of Criminal Procedure, whose identity he has been unable to ascertain;
the Jailor shall write in red ink or cause to be written or stamped at the head of each sheet of the history
ticket of such prisoner and also in the Admission Register the word Unidentified. He shall also note the
names and addresses of the correspondents and visitors of such prisoner and the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent shall send such information, in a confidential cover, to the Superintendent of police.
624. To afford the police, the Commissioner of Metropolitan Police in Metropolitan cities, the opportunity
of recognizing old offenders the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall permit a Police Officer
deputed by the Superintendent of Police or the Commissioner of Metropolitan Police on the day preceding
the weekly parade of prisoners, to have access in the jail office to the Admission Registers and Release
Diary. From these the Police Officers will prepare lists of prisoners admitted during the preceding week, of
prisoners who will be discharged in the following week, and of any unidentified prisoners still under police
enquiry, whom the police will have to inspect on parade. The prisoners named in these lists shall be
paraded next morning at 8 a.m. separately from others at the general parade, and the police (not more than
20 in number) who shall be conducted by the Deputy Jailor shall be permitted to inspect all these
prisoners. They shall not be permitted to hold any communication with a prisoner except such as is
necessary for the purpose of identification. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall inform the
Superintendent of; Police or Commissioner of Metropolitan Police on what day the weekly parade of
prisoners will be held and at what hour the police officer can have access to the jail office. Only prisoners
convicted under chapter XII and XVII of the Penal Code of offences punishable with three years, or
attempts at the same, under sections 328,363to 369 persons bound down under sections 109 and 110 of the
Code of Criminal Procedure and under trial prisoners need be paraded for the inspection of the police.
Any Police Officer duly deputed to photograph, or measure a prisoner or to take his finger impressions or
footprints shall be allowed to do so.
Prisoners should be photographed in ordinary everyday attire and not in prison dress. In the case of
prisoner impersonating others the dress to be worn by them when being photographed should be the usual
attire of the persons or class of persons impersonated.
Note. - See Rule 951 about the taking of the finger impressions of female prisoners by the police.
625. Particulars of all re-convictions shall be recorded in column 21 of the Admission Register of
convicted criminal prisoners. When the particulars noted in this column are obtained from jail records or
from the admissions of the prisoner and do not appear in the High Court Form the circumstance should be
brought to the notice of the Magistrate on B.J. Form No. 23.
626. Male prisoners of the A and B classes in Division III shall be distinguished by the difference in the
width of the blue stripes woven in their cotton clothing. The distinction in the clothing of A and B class
female prisoners is laid down in rule 1159. Each of these classes shall have, wherever possible, a separate
sleeping ward or wards, and during the day shall be kept separate as much as possible. If there are not
separate feeding platforms, latrines and bathing platforms for each class, suitable arrangements shall be
made to prevent the mixture of the two classes at the different parades. No squad of prisoners working
together or employed upon any one machine, such as a dhenki, shall on any account include prisoners of
the two classes.
627. If all the cells of a jail are not in use for purposes of punishment or otherwise, the vacant cells shall be
occupied by prisoners of class B. One prisoner of this class shall be kept in each of the vacant cells to do
his daily task, and another shall occupy the cell at night, the prisoner who occupied the cell during the day
time being sent to his ward for the night. No prisoner shall under this rule be placed in a cell for more than
12 hours at a time, nor be subjected to this restriction; the cellular system shall be applied to these classes
as far as the circumstances of the jail will permit. But care shall be taken that the prisoners, who occupy
the cells in this way and not as a punishment for breach of jail rules, are not kept in solitary confinement;
they should be allowed to take their meals, bath, etc, with the rest of their class, and they must be able to
communicate at any time with an officer of the jail. This system shall be applied in rotation to all the
habitual convicts, and if a prisoner who ought to come under the operation of this rule cannot be put into a
cell for work during the day because he is required for some jail service he should take his turn at night.
Where there are cubicles in the adult prisoners wards, the same principle shall be followed in selecting
prisoners to occupy them at night.
111
628. Deleted.
629. The class system shall be explained to all prisoners on admission, and they shall be cautioned that
they will be liable to punishment if they converse with a prisoner of a class different from that in which
they are put (specially a male adult convict associating or holding communication with any female,
juvenile, civil or under trial prisoner) or if they are found in any part of the jail set apart for the prisoners of
such other class.
630. Any jail official or convict officer wilfully or negligently allowing a prisoner to communicate with a
prisoner of another class, or to enter any enclosure set apart for another class, shall be liable to punishment,
and a convict officer repeatedly offending under this rule must be degraded.
631. Classification cannot in its integrity be applied in all jails to female prisoners, but every such
prisoners shall be classified and whenever practicable the prisoners of the A class shall be kept separate
from the prisoners of the B class.
632. Prisoners of the B class, shall under no circumstances be transferred to the A class. With reference to
Rule 541, the fact of a prisoner being police-registered shall make no difference in his classification or
treatment in a jail.
633. The barracks and cells shall be unlocked at dawn throughout the year. Twenty minutes before the
opening of the barracks and cells the rising bell or gong shall be sounded, and the watchmen shall then
rouse the prisoners and make them shake out and fold up their bedding neatly, The watchmen of group
shall see that the bedding is properly folded and surrounded by their mattress or thick cotton satranji and
arranged in line on the beds. Thereafter, the Division III prisoners in groups shall sit in file down the centre
of the barracks the leading pair sitting at the gate.Prisoners in cells shall arrange their bedding and clothing
similarly and shall stand at attention in front of the cell gate till the opening of the cell. At the same time
the warder in charge of the respective area will ascertain if any prisoners are sick or wish to see the
Medical Officer.
634. After the barracks have been opened and the prisoners counted out, they shall be marched to the
latrine in single line and allowed them to visit the latrine in turn. There should be one sanitary latrine for
every 10 (ten) prisoners and 2 bath rooms for use by 12 number of prisoners. During this parade those
prisoners who are reported to be sick shall be made to sit a little apart from the rest and shall be examined
by the Medical Subordinates who shall give them such treatment as is necessary. But if any prisoner
appears to be seriously ill he shall be sent to the Medical Officer at once.
635. Deleted.
636. On completion of the latrine parade the prisoners shall be marched to the bathing platform where
suitable tooth powder, shall be doled out for the purpose of cleansing their teeth, scale of which should be
50 grams per prisoner per month. Then they shall wash their faces and hands. After the washing parade,
early morning meal should be distributed and the Head Warders in charge of the respective areas shall see
that each of the prisoners get their due share. The Jailor shall cause to supervise distribution of morning
meal to the prisoners of the respective areas.
After washing parades and the early morning meal, the Jailor shall arrange any alteration of the groups that
may be necessary, noting any change of work he may order in the prisoners history ticket or causing such
entries to be made under his initials and having the alteration entered in the group books. See Rule 784
regarding allotment of task.
637. On completion of the early morning meal the prisoners shall be allowed to wash their hands, mouth
and feeding vessels after which the rolls shall be called, and the groups shall be marched to their working
places.
112
638. Whenever prisoners in Division III are marched from one part of the jail to another, or are sitting or
standing in groups except when actually taking meals or at work, or when paraded for inspection, they
shall be arranged in files of pairs, and shall rise, move forward, stop or sit down at the word of command
or signal.
A division III prisoner when brought before Jailor or the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent for report
or verification or petition or when addressing or addressed by a Jail Officer or by a visitor shall stand to
attention and shall pay proper compliments as is the custom of his community.
If a prisoners history ticket is required to be examined, it shall be held open in the prisoners left hand.
639.Every prisoner shall at all times carry his complete kit ( except bedding and blankets not in use) with
him. At the working places each prisoners clothing not in use shall be carefully folded and arranged in line
with that of others, the blanket kurta below, the other articles above. If the prisoners are allowed under
Rule 1226 to use a blanket to protect them from the cold during the morning parades, they shall likewise
each carry this blanket with them; it shall not be used after the morning parades are completed and shall
then be folded up neatly and kept with the clothing, being placed under the warm kurta when the kit is
arranged in line. In front of each pile of clothing shall be placed the prisoners thala and Bati, both of
which must at all times be clean and bright. The Head Warder shall be held responsible for any articles,
except the bedding and blankets not in use, found in the wards after the prisoner have left them.
640. Where a work shed is enclosed and provided with a gate, the gate shall be kept locked after prisoners
have entered, and the key of the gate shall be kept by the officer in charge of the group or if there is more
than one group, with one such officer, who shall be held responsible that no prisoner passes into or out of
the work shed without permission or proper cause.
641. Each work shed or working place where the prisoners are at work shall be provided with a sanitary
latrine with urinal for use by the working prisoners. A prisoner going frequently to the latrine out of hours
may be placed under medical observation in a segregation ward or cell, subject to such diet as the Medical
Officer may direct for such cases. If there is good cause to believe that the prisoner has visited the latrine
unnecessarily the irregularity may be treated as jail offence. In case of newly convicted prisoners some
latitude should be allowed in the enforcement of this rule.
642. When the bell for the midday meal rings the groups shall stop work. The prisoners shall then be taken
to the respective areas and those who so desire should be allowed to use the latrine. The prisoners shall
thereafter have their bath. When the bath is finished they shall be marched to their feeding platform. If
there be any complaint regarding the food the Head Warder on duty shall immediately attend to it. When
the meal is finished the prisoners shall stand up together form double file and march to the bathing
platform at the end of which shall be placed two tubs into which each prisoner shall throw any refuse food
left in his plate, separating rice or chappaties from curried food. They shall wash their plates and mouth.
When the process is completed the warder guards will be changed.
Waste food, when not required for other purposes is to be disposed of by inviting tenders for their
purchase on an annual basis.
642A. Ordinary male prisoners may be supplied with 2 cakes of washing soap,58 grams of mustard oil and 1
cake of toilet soap per month and ordinary female prisoners may be supplied with 2 cakes of washing soap,233
ml; of coconut oil, 1 cake of toilet soap and one packet of sanitary napkin (10 pieces) per head per month. The
standard weight of cakes of washing soap and toilet soap may be140 grams and 90 grams respectively. One
looking glass should be fixed on a wall in each ward. The blankets should be disinfected by prison authorities.
643. When the bell or gong is sounded for resuming work in the afternoon the groups shall be marched to their work
places, shall deposit their clothes, thala and bati, as described above, shall resume work, and continue working until
the evening bell rings for the cessation of work The groups shall then stop work, take up their clothing, etc, and
march to their respective wards or appointed places, where they shall be counted and the number compared with the
group books. They shall then perform the feeding, washing, and latrine parades under the same regulations as
prescribed for the midday parades, except that, unless specially ordered to do so, the prisoners shall only wash their
faces and hands instead of bathing entirely, but in cases where prisoners are put to exceptionally dirty work, such as
carrying earth in the hot weather, cleaning wool, etc. certain groups may be allowed to bathe entirely at the evening
parade by a written order from the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent. If necessary, the groups shall then be
broken up, and the prisoners shall be arranged according to their location in the sleeping barracks, but as far as
possible, prisoners who work together shall sleep together. They shall then be marched to their barrack gates and sit
in file there until counted in and locked up.
113
644. All prisoners working in groups outside the jail shall be brought inside and be made to take part in the
different parades. The bathing and feeding of prisoners outside the jail is prohibited.
645. One or two sanitary latrines with flash system and arrangements for tap water in an enclosed place for
the purpose of drinking; cleaning and ablution etc., should be provided in each of the dormitories
according to its size.
Similar arrangements should be made in cells, hospitals female wards, classified prisoners ward,
juvenile prisoners wards and jail schools and such other place or places for maintaining highest standard
of sanitation.
646. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall hold a parade of all the prisoners on one morning in
the week, when all prisoners will have the opportunity of making any complaint to him. In the winter
months, this parade may be held in the open air in the sun, but in the hot weather and rainy season, the
prisoners shall be paraded under shelter. At this parade the prisoners shall be arranged in line, each class in
its own division. Before each prisoner shall be spread in neat order his tat bed, blankets, blanket coat and
spare clothing, cup, plate and history ticket. All prisoners losing weight shall be paraded separately for the
inspection of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent and Medical Officer. On arrival of the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent, at the word of command all prisoners shall stand up, take off their caps,
take up their history tickets in the left hand and keep the right hand at the side of the body with fingers
extended, palms facing inwards. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall then pass down the line,
listen to complaints and requests of every description and pass orders thereon; satisfy himself that
remission has been duly awarded and communicated to the prisoners, and that the prisoners know what
remission they have earned : see that the classification rules are carried out; note that history tickets are
supplied to all prisoners and written up ; that weighments have been duly made and recorded on the
tickets; that the weighments are carefully considered by his subordinates in the distribution of labour and
that prisoners losing weight are duly set apart for medical inspection; see that prisoners clothing, bedding
and kit are duly provided in full and are clean and in good order, properly marked with prisoners numbers,
and that the prisoners are cleanly in person; and pick out any sickly-looking prisoners who he thinks
should be placed under observation. Petitions regarding the removal of fetters, letter writing, etc, should as
a rule be made at the Senior Superintendent/Superintendents parade.
647. No prisoner shall leave his work or his line to make any representation to the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent or Jailer. The Jailor shall at least once in the day visit all the prisoners and
give them the opportunity of making representations and complaints on any urgent matter; such as
appealing, assault or ill treatment. Any prisoner wishing to appeal or making such a complaint shall be
brought by the jailer before the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent, but minor complaints and petitions
should as a rule await the Senior Superintendents/Superintendents general parade.
648. Prisoners shall obey the orders of all jail officers. They shall also obey the orders of the convict
officers unless the order be one distinctly contrary to jail regulations, in which case the prisoners shall
report the matter as soon as possible to the jailer.
649. Silence shall be maintained at all times except for any enquiry or instruction relating to work. Loud
talking or quarrelling in the wards at night is prohibited. No prisoners shall leave his bed for any purpose
without first obtaining the permission of the watchmen or sit or lie on any other prisoners bed.
649.1- The singing of non-denominational or patriotic songs chosen by the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent may be authorized by him for a short period to be fixed by him. Joining in these songs will
be optional.
650. As soon as possible after admission prisoners shall be told by a responsible Jail Officer that-
(i) the jail administration is to help the prisoners to get rehabilitated in the society as useful citizen;
(ii) they should co-operate in all possible ways with the jail administration;
(iii) the acts or omissions which constitute prison offences;
(iv) the punishment which may be awarded for such offences; and
(v) the advantages to be secured by good behaviour.
Disobedience to the above or any jail rules or of any lawful order will subject the offender to
punishment according to the rules provided in chapter XIX.
114
651. All prisoners shall wash their own clothing at the bathing parade on the day preceding the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendents weekly parade. For this parade in each area/division a water reservoir be
kept at the bathing platform. The prisoners will wash their clothes with the soap provided to them as per
Rule 642A. The washing should be carried out before midday meal ward by ward. A prisoner washer man
may be employed for washing the clothes and bedding of those sick in hospital. Warm clothes and bedding
shall be washed as prescribed in Rule 1173.
652.(1) Every prisoner in Division III including convict officers shall have the hair of the head cut only
to such an extent and at such times as may be necessary for the purpose of securing health and cleanliness
and shall be allowed the use of comb. The hair of the face shall be shaved and nails of fingers and toes
closely trimmed once a week provided that
(a) the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall, at his discretion, exempt from the operation of this rule
those who object to it on the ground of case community or religious practice or belief and those to whom
the proceedings may justly be considered to be offensive or degrading;
(b) female shall not have their hair cut or removed in any way except when the Medical Officer considers
it necessary on account of any disease
(c) if on account of vermin, dirt or disease the Medical Officer deems it necessary to clip the hair or shave
the head of any prisoner, this shall be done on his written order entered on the prisoners history ticket.
Note.-Except under the orders of the Medical Officer no convict shall have his hair shaved.
(2) Under trial prisoners shall not be allowed to crop their hair or in any way to alter their personal
appearance so as to make it difficult to recognise them. To prevent this scissors and similar implements
shall not be allowed in the ward. Prisoners who have been more than a month in the jail shall have their
hair cut to the length it was when they were admitted into the jail and kept at this length as far as possible
in order to maintain their original appearance. When the Medical Officer deems it necessary on the ground
of dirt vermin or disease the hair of an under trial prisoner shall be cut but it shall not be cut closer than is
necessary for the purposes of health and cleanliness.
(3) A barbers shop shall be established in all the jails in the country for use of prisoners. This shop shall be
equipped such articles as razors , scissors, clippers nail cutters, shaving brush and soap, looking glass,
apron, tools or benches etc. required for running the barbers shop. All prisoners shall be allowed to use
combs. The jailor shall be responsible for safe keeping of the articles of the barber shop.
653. The daily routine prescribed in the foregoing rules shall be observed also on Fridays, and the gezetted
holidays observed in jails except that no prisoner shall be required to work on those days otherwise than in
performing menial offices and other necessary work, including cleaning up and tidying the jail premises.
The prisoners in the morning after unlocked should be allowed to take exercise in their respective yards
and groups for an hour (except very old, sick and pregnant women).
654. (1) All willing prisoners may be allowed books to read on holidays or during the rest hours from the
jail Library or from outside by purchase at their own cost or obtaining from their friends or relations
subject to the sanction of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent who shall satisfy himself that the
books are worth reading by the prisoners. No pornographic books or magazines shall be allowed to any
class of prisoners.
(2) The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may, at his discretion, allow a larger number and wider
selection of books, in special cases, to well behaved Division III prisoners from the jail Library provided
that not more than five books shall be issued to any prisoner at a time. The Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent may also allow prisoners to purchase from time to time approved magazines, periodicals,
daily news papers, and books at their own cost.
(3) One exercise book with pens may be allowed to well behave prisoners at their own cost per month.
The Exercise books shall ordinarily be school exercise books and the pages shall be numbered and
periodically inspected to see that none is missing. The pages shall on no account be used for writing letters.
(4) Subject to the rules of the University, Education Boards or other authorities holding the examination,
facilities may, with the previous sanction of the Deputy Inspector General of prisons, be given to well behaved
convicts and under trial prisoners to appear at the university or other examinations recognised by Government
which do not include practical or viva voce examination requiring the prisoners to go outside the jail for the
such examinations. Provided that there is no extra expenditure on the part of the Government on account of
purchase of books or examinations or other fees and the examination is held inside the jail.
115
(5) Inmates who are permitted to sit for University or other examinations should be allowed to purchase
necessary text books. If possible, arrangements may be made for lectures by School, College or University
Teachers for the intending candidates.
655.The practice of allowing prisoners to go to the bazar, on any pretext whatever, with or without warders
is strictly prohibited.
655A. Subject to the discretion of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent prisoners may purchase out of
their private cash, their reasonable requirements in respect of the following articles :-
(a) soap (both washing and toilet)/detergent.
(b) tooth paste
(c) Tooth powder
(d) Tooth brush
(e) Shaving soap/gel/cream/foam
(f) Comb
(g) Toilet paper (for female prisoner only) Talcum powder/cold cream/cocoanut oil.
(h) Loaf/Biscuits/Chanachurs/Sweets.
(i) Biri, cigarettes
(j) Fruits of any kind.
Note.- Only adult prisoners will be allowed to smoke. No prisoner shall be allowed to smoke more
than ten biris or five cigarettes a day.
G.of 656. On the last Friday of each month a census shall be taken of the convict population of each
I.Resn No.
16-697- jail, in order to ascertain the number of convicts present on that day according to the time served
706 of 21- in jail
12-1893.
Rule 1886.
See 657.Except as provided in this code-
section
42, Act (1) No person shall introduce or remove or attempt by any means whatever to introduce or
IX, 1894 remove into or from any prison, or supply or attempt to supply to any prisoner outside the limits
Rules of a prison any prohibited article;
178,200,3
87,902. (2) No officer of a prison shall allow any such article to be introduced into or removed from any
prison to be possessed by any prisoner, or to be supplied to any prisoner outside the limits of a
G.O.No.
7037 prison; and
R.J., (3) No person shall communicate or attempt to communicate with any prisoner.
dated the
25th July Whoever commits or abets any of these offences shall, on conviction before a Magistrate,
1922.
be liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding six months, or to fine not exceeding two
thousand Taka or to both.
658. When any person, in the presence of any officer of a prison, commits any offence specified in Rule
657 and refuses on demand of such officer to state his name and residence, or gives a name or residence
which such officer knows, or has reason to believe to be false, such officer may arrest him, and shall
without unnecessary delay make him over to a police officer, and thereupon such police officer shall
proceed as if the offence had been committed in his presence.
659. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall cause to be affixed, in a conspicuous place outside
the prison, a notice in Bengali and English setting forth the acts prohibited under section 42, Act IX of
1894 and the penalties incurred by their commission ( See B.J. Form No . 114)
660. In accordance with section 60 (f), Act IX of 1894 , the articles specified or included in the list
annexed to this rule shall be deemed to be prohibited articles within the meaning of sections 42 and 45 (12)
of Act IX of 1894, unless any such article shall be
(a) introduced into or removed from any jail,
(b) received, possessed or transferred by any prisoner, with the permission of the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent or other officers empowered by him in this behalf.
116
List of prohibited articles
(1) Alcohol or spirituous liquors of any kind.
(2) Materials for smoking, chewing or snuffing, such as, pipes, chilums, etc.
(3) Ganja, opium or any other drug, or poisonous article.
(4) Poisonous materials, materials for making fire, or materials which would cause disfiguration.
(5) Bullion, metal, money, currency notes, valuable securities jewellery or ornaments of any kind, and
articles of value of every description.
(6) Books, printed matter, letters or writing materials of any kind not authorised by the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent.
(7) Knives, arms, explosives, ropes string, bamboos, ladders, sticks, any article likely to facilitate escape or
implements of any kind, except those issued for use in the performance of work, and those excepted only
during work hours and at such places as they are required for jail work.
(8) Any article which has not been issued for the use of prisoners from the jail stores and supplies.
(9) Mobile phone
(10) Camera of all types.
661.Every article of whatever description shall be deemed to be a prohibited article within the meaning of
section 42 and clause 12 of section 45 of the Prisons Act in the case of-
(1) a prisoner- if introduced into or removed from any jail or received, possessed or transferred by such
prisoner and such article has-
(a) not been issued for his personal use from jail stores or supplies, under proper authority;
(b) been so issued, if possessed or used at a time or place other than such as is authorised ; or
(c) not been placed in his possession for introduction, removal or use, as the case may be, by
proper authority:
(2) a jail official- if introduced into or removed from any jail or supplied to any prisoner and such article-
(a) has not been issued or sanctioned for his personal use by proper authority;
(b) is not an article of clothing necessary for his personal wear ; or
(c) has not been placed in his possession by proper authority for introduction into or removal from
the jail or for the purpose of being supplied to any prisoner:
(3) a visitor- if introduced into or removed from any jail or supplied to any prisoner and such article-
(a) is not required for his personal use while within the jail and has not been declared by him before
entering the jail and the introduction into or removal from the jail or possession of which while in the jail
has not been permitted by proper authority;
(b) is introduced with or without authority and is not retained in his possession until he has left the jail
premises; or
(c) comes into his possession while within the jail and is subsequently removed by him from the jail;
(4) any other person- if introduced into or removed from any jail or supplied to any prisoner whether
within or without the jail.
662. Interference with the religion or caste prejudices of prisoners is prohibited; and in case of complaints
of interference the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent will take means to ascertain whether the
complaints are well founded or not. No relaxation of the working rules shall be allowed but prisoners shall
be permitted to perform their devotions at suitable times and in suitable places. The supply of the sacred
thread to Brahmin prisoners who require them may be left to the senior Hindu Head Warder or Warder.
General Rules.
G.O.No. 663. (1) Every newly convicted prisoner shall be allowed reasonable facilities for seeing or
252 R.J. communicating with his relatives or friends with a view to the preparation of an appeal or to the
dated the procuring of bail and shall also be allowed to have interviews or write letters to his relatives or
11th friends once or twice in a month, or oftener if the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent
January considers it necessary, to enable him to arrange for the management of his property or other
1923. family affairs.
117
(2) Every prisoner committed to prison in default of payment of a fine or of finding security
under chapter VIII of the Code of Criminal Procedure shall be allowed to communicate by letter
and to have interviews at any reasonable time with his relations or friends for the purpose of
arranging for the payment of the fine or the furnishing of security.
(3) An inmate may be allowed to correspond with his employer or business partners or legal
advisors relating to management of his business etc.
(4).Every prisoner under sentence of death shall be allowed interviews and other
communications with his relatives, friends and legal advisers at least once a month.
G.O.No. 664. In addition to the privileges granted in the last preceding rule every convicted prisoner in
1882 Division III shall be allowed to have an interview with his relatives or friends and to write and
P.J., receive a letter once in a month or in the case of a convict overseer once in a month during the
dated the term of his imprisonment, provided that the exercise of his privilege shall be contingent on good
26th May
conduct and may be withdrawn or postponed by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent for
1930.
bad conduct.
665. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may at his discretion grant interviews or allow the
despatch or receipt of letters at shorter intervals than provided in Rule 664 or inspite of the prisoners
misconduct if he considers that special or urgent grounds exist for such concession, as , for example, in the
event of the prisoner being seriously ill or on the occurrence of the death of a near relative, or if the friends
or relatives have come from a distance to see the prisoner and it would inflict an undue hardship on them
to refuse an interview, or if the prisoner is nearing release and wishes to secure employment , or for other
sufficient cause. Matters of importance, such as the death of a relative may also be communicated at any
time by the relatives or friends of a prisoner to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent who will if he
thinks it expedient, inform the prisoner of the substance of the communication.
666. No convicted prisoner shall be allowed to have an interview or to receive or write a letter except with
the permission of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent, which shall be recorded in writing.
667. Applications for interviews with prisoners may be oral or in writing to the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent. If the prisoner is not entitled to an interview the applicant shall be informed at once. The
particulars of interviews actually held shall be entered in the History Ticket and in a Register which shall
contain the names of the prisoners, names and addresses of the interviewing friends and relatives and the
date & time of the interviews.
668. Interviews with prisoners should be allowed all the days of week including holidays. A notice of the
interview hours shall be posted outside the jail.
G.O.No. 669. Every interview shall take place in the interview room of the jail. Unless there are a large
2034- number of interviews fixed for one day, only one interview shall take place in the same room at
P.J., the same time. Provided that interviews with female prisoners shall, if practicable, take place in
dated the the female enclosures of interview room. Provided also that if a prisoner is seriously ill, the
10th
Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may permit the interview to take place in the hospital,
October
1928.
and a condemned prisoner shall ordinarily be interviewed in his cell . Provided further that the
Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may, for special reasons to be recorded in writing, permit
an interview to take place in any part of the jail.
G.O.No. 670. Every interview with a convicted prisoner shall take place in the presence of a jail officer,
716 T.-R to be deputed by the jailer in writing who shall be responsible that no irregularity occurs and
., dated who shall be so placed as to be able to see and hear what passes and to prevent any article being
the 17th passed between the parties. Provided that a police officer may be permitted by the Senior
Septemb
Superintendent/Superintendent to interview a convicted prisoner without a Jail Officer being
er 1926.
present at the interview.
118
671. Any interview may be discontinued at any moment if the officer present considers that sufficient
cause exists. In every such case the reason for terminating the interview shall be reported at once for the
orders of the senior officer present in the jail.
672. The time allowed for an interview shall not ordinarily exceed 30 minutes but may be extended upto
one hour by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent at his discretion.
673. Every convicted prisoner and every under trial criminal prisoner shall be carefully searched before
and after an interview, whenever it is held. For searching a Deputy Jailor a Head Warder or Warder shall be
specially deputed by the jailer by an order in writing. In case of prisoners in Division I and Division II,
searching shall be made at the discretion of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent/ Jailer.
674. If a legal adviser seeks an interview with a convicted criminal prisoner, he shall give 24 hours notice
and shall state definitely the purpose of the interview. For such interview the order of the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent must be taken. If the interview is allowed, the rules relating to interviews
with under trial prisoners shall apply.
675. The Jailer may demand the name and address of any visitor to a prisoner, and, if he has good grounds
for suspecting that any visitor is taking prohibited articles to a prisoner, he may search the visitor or cause
him or her to be searched before he or she is allowed to enter the jail or see a prisoner, but the search shall
not be made in the presence of any prisoner, or of any other visitor. If the visitor is a female, the search
shall be made only by a female staff. In the case of such visitor refusing to be searched, the Jailer may
refuse to allow an interview with a prisoner. In any case when a visitor is searched or an interview with an
under trial prisoner is refused the jailer shall at once report the circumstance and the grounds for his action
in his report book and submit his report to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent at his next visit to the
jail.
676.(1) No letter shall be delivered to or sent by a convicted prisoner until it has been examined and
initialed by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent or by the Jailor or other officer under the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendents orders, but no unnecessary delay should be allowed to occur in delivery
or despatch. If a letter is written in a language unknown to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent, he
shall take steps to procure a translation before forwarding the letter. No letter written in cipher shall be
allowed. The subject matter of all letters must be limited to private affair and there must be no reference to
jail administration and discipline to other prisoners or to politics. The Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent may withhold any letter which seems to him to be in any way improper or objectionable, or
may erase any improper or objectionable passage.
(2) If the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent has any doubts regarding any letter of a convicted
prisoner he may forward it to the Additional Inspector General of Police, Special Branch, Dhaka
Metropolitan City or for other Metropolitan Cities to Commissioner of Police or the Superintendent of
Police, District Special Branch of the District, as the case may be, for scrutiny. Similarly that office may
call for the letter of any such prisoner for examination. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent is
authorised to pay the postal charges on unstamped or insufficiently stamped letters addressed to prisoners
who have no cash to their credit under the head Prisoners Property.
677. Deleted.
678. A convict may retain any letter which has been delivered to him with due authority unless the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent otherwise directs or may ask that it be kept for him.
G.O.No. 679. Writing materials including service postcards shall be supplied in reasonable quantities
4389 P.J., to any convict who has permission to write a letter and all letters shall be written at such
date the 30th time and place as the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may appoint. A convicts letters
Septemper will be written on B.J. Form No. 41 and the writing shall be restricted to one side of the
1935.
form and to the lines ruled thereon. A fixed day of the week, preferably Friday, shall be set
Bangladesh
Form No.
apart for letter writing. Service postage stamps at the public expense shall be provided for
5102. prisoners' letters.
119
680. A Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may refuse to allow any interview to which a prisoner would
ordinarily be entitled under these rules, but in every such case, if in his opinion it is inexpedient in the
public interests to allow any particular person to interview a prisoner or if other sufficient cause exists, he
shall record his reasons for such refusal in his journal.
681. Any prisoner who abuses any privilege relating to the holding of an interview or the writing of
letters or other communication with any person outside the jail shall be liable to be excluded from such
privileges for such time and may be subjected to such further restrictions as the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent may direct.
682. Under trial prisoners and civil prisoners shall be granted all reasonable facilities at proper times and
under proper restrictions for interviewing or otherwise communicating either orally or in writing with their
relatives, friends and legal advisers. Such interview may be allowed once in a week and duration may be
extended upto one hour.
683. Every interview between an under trial prisoner and his legal adviser shall take place within sight but
out of hearing of a jail official. A similar concession may be allowed by the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent in the case of an interview with any near relative of the under trial prisoner.
684. When any person desires an interview with an under trial prisoner in the capacity of the prisoners
legal adviser he shall apply in writing, giving his name and address and stating to what branch of the legal
profession he belongs and he must satisfy the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent that he is the
bonafide legal adviser of the prisoner with whom he seeks an interview and that he has legitimate business
with him. If the interview is allowed the name of the legal adviser shall be entered on the prisoners history
ticket and a record kept on the ticket of all interviews that take place.
G.O. 685. (1) The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may, in his discretion, refer for orders any
No. application for an interview made under rule 684, to the District Magistrate and in case of
1090 Metropolitan City to the Chief Metropolitan Magistrate or in case of doubt as to whether the
P.J, under trial prisoner or the interviewer has any political affiliation he may refer the case to the
dated Superintendent of Police, District Special Branch, for other Metropolitan Cities to the respective
the 23rd Police Commissioner and in case of Dhaka City to the Additional Inspector General of Police,
March Special Branch Bangladesh, Dhaka.
1935.
(2) It shall be lawful for a District Magistrate, or Chief Metropolitan Magistrate or Additional
Chief Metropolitan Magistrate, as the case may be to give directions to the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent on application for interview with any specified prisoner. Such
Magistrate may disallow an interview for reasons to be recorded in writing or allow an
interview subject to conditions provided that if any police or jail official or other person be
allowed to be present at an interview such official or person must remain at a distance, so that,
though within sight, he may not hear the conversation. The Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent shall carry out the direction so given.
686. If the application of a legal adviser for an interview with an under trial prisoner is granted, the
interview shall be arranged as soon as it is possible and a jail official is available to supervise. All such
interviews shall be arranged in a separate place other than interview room.
687. Any bonafide confidential written communication prepared by an under trial prisoner as instructions
to his legal adviser may be delivered personally to such legal adviser without being previously examined
by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent. For the purpose of this rule the term legal adviser means a
legal practitioner within the meaning of Act XVIII of 1879.
688. Civil prisoner may see their friends and relations at such times and under such restrictions as the
Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may appoint and the presence of a jail officer may not be necessary.
120
G.O.No. 235/Min/Ha- CHAPTER XVIII.- RELIGIOUS OBSERVANCES.
G(I) dated the 30th
October 1972.
G.O.No. 1/M-17/83- 689. The following gazetted holidays shall be allowed in addition to Fridays to all
jail-1/185 dated the 2nd classes of prisoners:-
April 1988.
690. On festivals, fruits and uncooked food including milk may be allowed to the prisoners either at
their own cost or that of their friends and relations at the discretion of the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent. Under the Government order the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of Jail should
also allow improved diet to all classes of prisoners at the cost of Tk. 20/- or an amount as determined
by the Government from time to time in addition to the normal diet on special festival occasions such
as Eid-ul-Fitre, Eid-ul-Azha, Eid-e-Miladunnabi, and National Solidarity day.
G.O.No. 691. Any prisoner who desires to fast he may be allowed to do so on religious occasion.
20,6P.J., No relaxation of labour shall be allowed on this account but the prisoners may be
dated the 3rd provided either with special diet, such as, milk, fruits, dahi, sweets, or allowed extra
July 1934. food on conclusion of the fast. When the fast lasts for two successive days, light food
should be allowed in the evening. The total cost of the dietary during and at the
conclusion of a fast should not exceed that of the meals given to other prisoner.
Jail cir. No. 692. The Muslim prisoners shall be allowed to observe roza during the month of
39 of 1935. Ramadan and on other holy occasions if they so desire.
(1) During the month of Ramadan Muslim prisoners observing Roza shall get extra
diet as Iftari at the scale as provided in Rule 1095(1) of this Code.
(2) They should be served with two meals one at sunset and the other (sheheri) at late
night.
(3) Prisoners observing fast employed on hard labour should be given medium labour
and those who are put on medium labour should be given light duties during the
period of fast. The hours of labour should be extended by half an hour in the morning
and curtailed by half an hour in the afternoon so as to allow them time to finish their
evening bathing and latrine parades before sunset. The hours of labour thus modified
will apply, however, to all classes of prisoners. Arrangements should also be made to
keep a sufficient supply of water for ablution in the wards or cells in which Muslim
prisoners are confined.
(4) The cells or wards cannot be unlocked at night, but the prisoners can say the
Taravi prayer in the wards.
693. The Medical Officer may, in the case of any prisoner, if he is of opinion that the continuance of
the fast by such prisoner is likely to be injurious or dangerous to health, prescribe its discontinuance.
121
694. Reasonable facilities should be allowed to all classes of prisoners for the performance of their
prayers but all prayers will be voluntary. Muslims should ordinarily be allowed to say their Jumma
prayers collectively, but the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent has full discretion to decide how
many prisoners should be allowed to congregate. The Senior Superintendent / Superintendent will
make the necessary arrangement regarding the place where prayers should be held. No religious cries
shall be allowed. Muslim prisoners may provide their own slippers but a few mats should be kept in the
jails for their use at prayers; they should be supplied with water for ablution at each prayer time. Azan
may be broadcasted on a public address system, so as to enable Muslim inmates to say their daily
prayers in congregation simultaneously in the wards they live in . Muslim prisoners should be allowed
to say their prayers during Eid-ul-Fitre and Eid-ul-Azha in congregation at such a place as selected by
the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent.
695. Interference with genuine religious or caste prejudices of prisoners should be avoided. If the
Senior Superintendent/Superintendent feels any doubt as to the validity of any plea advanced by a
prisoner on the grounds of caste or religion he should refer the matter for the orders of the Inspector
General of Prisons whose decision shall be final.
G.O.No. 696. On the application of a prisoner a known minister of his own persuasion may be
4057 P.J., admitted to the jail at the discretion of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent for
dated the 2nd religious ministration to such prisoner on Fridays and other jail holidays or any other
December day appointed for the purpose. The religious ministration shall be subject to such
1931.
conditions as to time, place, duration, etc, as the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent
considers necessary.
Rules 141-
150 697. Deleted.
IM-/92-jail- 698. In each Central or District jail two honorary teachers should be appointed if available.
1/327 dated The appointments will be made by commissioners of Divisions and will be notified in the
the 6th June Gazette. These teachers are to be appointed for the purpose of imparting moral instruction to
1993. prisoners and the Muslim teacher should also conduct the Juma prayer for Muslim prisoners.
When a vacancy exists or occurs the superintendent of the jail should report it to the District
Magistrate who should report it to the commissioner making at the same time a
recommendation as to the appointment of a suitable honorary teacher to fill the vacancy.
Such teachers shall be appointed for a period of two years and shall, unless their
appointment has been cancelled under Rule 699, be eligible for reappointment on the expiry
of such term so long as they are fit and willing to serve. In making the selection effect
should, as far as practicable, be given to nominations by representatives of the different
communities, e.g. the Muslim Advisory Board for the appointment of Kazis or any other
association recognized by Government. Instruction shall be permissible at such times and
places as the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may direct on sundays and the gazetted
holidays observed in jails and also in the case of Muslims on Fridays. Approved religious
books should be supplied to the jail Libraries
Honorary teachers may similarly be appointed in Central and District jails for prisoners of
other faiths when the number of such prisoners is four or more.
699. The appointment of honorary teacher under the preceding rule may, and shall ordinarily, be
cancelled by the authority making the appointment within the period of the term of the appointment if
the honorary teacher fails to impart moral instruction to prisoners for a continuous period of three
months.
700. No minister, priest or other religious teacher should be allowed to have access to any prisoner
who does not belong to his own denomination unless the prisoner voluntarily and spontaneously
expresses a wish to see such a religious teacher in which case the matter should be reported to the
Inspector General of prisons for orders.
701. Deleted.
122
702. For facility in offering prayers long trousers should be supplied to all Muslim male convicts
instead of shorts and should reach to within ten centimeters above the ankle.
G.O. No. 703. In the event of death of a prisoner in the jail the Senior Superintendent/
102 Superintendent shall pass order for disposing of the body in accordance with the religion
P.J.dated the or custom of the community or caste to which the deceased prisoner belonged. Bodies
11th January of Muslim prisoners unless made over to the relatives or friends of the deceased should
1929. be made over to the Anjuman-E-Mofidul Islam and where there is no such association
arrangement for the burial of such prisoners should be made with the heads of mosques,
Muslim Associations or other responsible Muslim who may be willing to undertake the
duty. In the case of non- Muslim prisoners dying in jail, their bodies, unless made over
to the relatives/friends of the deceased, should be made over for funeral to the local
religious or social organisation who may be willing to undertake the duty. If necessary a
sum not exceeding Tk. 500/- for each dead body of any community should be paid for
the cost of the funeral. The expenditure is debitable to head Miscellaneous Services and
Supplies in the 2251 Prisons Directorate.( see also Rule 98 )
CHAPTER XIX- OFFENCES AND PUNISHMENTS
Rules 399 (h) 704. The following acts are declared to be prison offences when committed by a
650(a) prisoner:
(i). Such willful disobedience to any regulation of the prison as shall have been
declared by rules made under section 59 (1) of the Prisons Act to be a prison offence.
(ii). Any assault or use of criminal force.
(iii). The use of insulting or threatening language
(iv). Immoral or indecent or disorderly behaviour.
(v). Wilfully disabling himself from labour.
(vi). Contumaciously refusing to work.
(vii). Filing, cutting, altering or removing handcuffs, fetters, or bars without due authority.
(viii).Wilful idleness or negligence at work by any prisoner sentenced to rigorous
imprisonment.
(ix). Willful mismanagement of work by any prisoner sentenced to rigorous imprisonment.
(x). Wilful damage to prison property.
(xi). Tampering with or defacing history tickets, records or documents.
(xii). Receiving , possessing or transferring any prohibited article.
(xiii). Pretending illness.
(xiv). Wilfully bringing a false accusation against any officer or prisoner.
(xv). Omitting or refusing to report, as soon as it comes to his knowledge the occurrence
of any fire, any plot or conspiracy, any escape, attempt or preparation to escape, and any
attack or preparation for attack, upon any prisoner or prison official.
(xvi). Conspiring to escape, or to assist in escaping, or to commit any other of the
offences aforesaid.
705.The following acts are forbidden, and every prisoner who wilfully commits any of the following
acts shall be deemed to have willfully disobeyed the regulations of the prison and to
have committed a prison offence within the meaning of section 45 of the said Act
(Act IX of 1894). The offences are classified into two groups major and minor:
(a) Major offences:-
(i). Concealing any article whatever.
(ii). Showing disrespect to any jail officer or visitor
(iii). Doing any act calculated to create any unnecessary alarm in the minds of the prisoners or
officers of the prison
(iv). Leaving without permission of an officer of the prison the ward, the yard, the place in the file,
the seat or berth assigned to him.
(v). Omitting or refusing to march in file when moving about the prison.
123
(vi). Removing without permission of an officer of the prison food from the cook room or
godowns or from the place where meals are served or disobeying any order
as to the issue and distribution of food and drink.
(vii). Introducing into food or drink anything likely to render it unpalatable or unwholesome.
(viii). Wilfully destroying food or throwing it away without orders .
(ix). Removing, defacing or altering any distinctive number, mark or badge attached to, or worn
on, the clothing or person.
(x). Tampering in any way with prison locks, lamps or lights or other property with which he has
no concern.
(xi). Stealing the prison clothing or any part of the prison kit of any other prisoner.
(xii). Wilfully making the wells, latrines, washing or bathing places unfit for use.
(xiii). Omitting or refusing to take due care of, or injuring, destroying or misappropriating the
materials and implements entrusted to him for work.
(xiv). Mixing or adding any foreign substances to the materials issued for work.
(xv). Doing or omitting to do any act with intent to cause to himself any illness, injury or disability.
(xvi). Causing or omitting to assist in suppressing violence or insubordination of any kind.
(xvii). Taking part in any attack upon any prisoner or officer of the prison.
(xviii). Omitting or refusing to help any officer of the prison, or omitting or refusing to perform
duties in the manner prescribed.
(xix). Disobeying any lawful order of an officer of the prison, or omitting or refusing to perform
duties in the manner prescribed.
(b) Minor offences:-
(i). Talking when at file or at unlocking or at latrine, bathing or other parades, or at any time
when ordered by an officer of the prison to desist, and singing, loud
laughing and loud talking at any time.
(ii). Quarrelling with any other prisoner
(iii). Making groundless complaints.
(iv). Holding any communication (in writing, by word of mouth or otherwise) with an outsider,
with a prisoner of the opposite sex, civil or under trial prisoner or a prisoner
of a different class, in disobedience of the regulations of the prison.
(v). Doing any act or using any language calculated to wound or offend the feelings and
prejudices of a fellow prisoner.
(vi). Leaving without permission of an officer of the prison the group to which he is attached or
the place in the file in which he is confined.
(vii). Loitering about the yards or lingering in the wards when these are open.
(viii). Refusing to eat food or the food prescribed by the prison diet scale.
(ix). Eating or appropriating any food not assigned to him, or taking from or adding to the portions
assigned to other prisoners.
(x). Omitting or refusing to wear the clothing given to him, or exchanging any portion of it for the
clothing of other prisoners, or losing, discarding, damaging or altering any
part of it.
(xi). Omitting or refusing to keep the person clean, or disobeying any order regulating the cutting
of hair or nails.
(xii). Omitting or refusing to keep clean his clothing, blankets, bedding, fetters, aluminium cups or
plates or identification token, or disobeying any order as to the arrangement
or disposition of such articles.
(xiii). Committing a nuisance in any part of the prison.
(xiv). Spitting on or otherwise soiling any floor, door, wall or other part of the prison building or
any article in the prison.
(xv). Damaging the trees and vegetables in the garden of the jail, or maltreating the prison cattle.
(xvi). Omitting or refusing to take due care of all prison property entrusted to him.
(xvii). Omitting to report at once any loss, breakage or injury which he may accidentally have
caused to prison property or implements.
(xviii). Performing any portion of the task allotted to another prisoner , or obtaining the assistance of
another prisoner in the performance of his own task.
(xix). Appropriating any portion of the task performed by another prisoner.
124
(c) The following to be treated as major or minor offences by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent
depending upon their gravity and seriousness:-
(i). Abetting the commission of any prison offence.
(ii). Omitting to assist in the maintenance of discipline by reporting any prison offence, or to give
assistance to an officer of the prison when called on to do so.
(iii). Manufacturing any article without the knowledge or permission of an officer of the prison.
(iv). Omitting or refusing to help any officer of the prison in case of an attempted escape or of an
attack upon such officer or upon another prisoner.
1 bid 706. When in the opinion of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent any of the following
Rule 75. offences are established against any prisoner, he shall refer the case to the Magistrate
exercising jurisdiction for enquiry in accordance with the Code of Criminal Procedure:-
(1) Offences punishable under sections 147,148 and 152 of the Penal Code,namely-
Rules Rioting;
387,481. Rioting armed with a deadly weapon;
Assaulting or obstructing or using criminal force to a public servant when suppressing riot
or threatening or attempting to do so.
(2) Offence punishable under sections 222, 223 and 224 of the Penal Code namely-
Intentional omission to apprehend on the part of a public servant (Night Watchman, Convict
Overseer) or intentionally aiding or suffering to escape any person lawfully committed to
custody;
Escape from confinement or custody negligently suffered by a public servant;
Resistance or obstruction to lawful apprehension, or escape or attempt to escape from lawful
custody.
(3)Offence punishable under sections 304A,309,325 and 326 of the Penal Code,namely-
Causing death by a rash or negligent act;
Attempt to commit suicide;
Voluntarily causing grievous hurt;
Voluntarily causing grievous hurt by dangerous weapons or means.
(4) Any offence triable exclusively by the Court of Sessions.
It shall be in the discretion of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent to determine with
respect to any other act which constitutes both a prison offence and an offence under the
Penal Code, whether he will use his own powers of punishment or move the Magistrate
exercising jurisdiction to enquire into it in accordance with the Code of Criminal Procedure;
but no prisoner shall be punished twice for the same offence.
Note- A prisoner of necessity removed from a prison office in consequence of judicial
conviction for an offence shall not be deemed to have been punished twice.
Jail circular 707. Action against the prisoners frequently and willfully breaking Jail discipline shall
No. 10 of be taken by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent under the provisions of section 52
1898. of Act IX of 1894.
G.of I resn 708. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may award the punishments enumerated
No. 161-172 in Act IX of 1894, including those prescribed under section 46, clause (4)(6) & (7) of
of 25-6-1908. the said Act. These are classified into minor and major punishments.
G.O.No.
1446 P.J. The following punishments shall be considered minor punishments:-
dated 7th (1) Formal warning;
April 1931. (2) Change of labour for a stated period to some more irk some or severe form.
Rule 253. (3) Forfeiture of remission earned, not exceeding 4 days;
Rule 927. (4) Forfeiture of class, grade, or prison privileges for a period not exceeding three months;
Rules 905, (5) Reduction from a higher to a lower class or grade not exceeding one month:
1014. (6) Deleted.
(7) Cellular confinement for not more than 7 days;
(8) Separate confinement for not more than 14 days;
(9) Imposition of handcuffs otherwise than by handcuffing a prisoner behind or to a staple;
(10) Imposition of link-fetters for not more than 30 days;
(11) Deleted.
125
G.O.No. The following punishments shall be considered major punishments:-
11236 R.J.,
dated the 10th (1) Hard labour, in the case of prisoners not sentenced to rigorous imprisonment;
December (2) (a) Forfeiture of remission earned, exceeding 4 but not exceeding 12 days
1923. (b) Forfeiture of remission earned, in excess of 12 days
(c) Forfeiture of class, grade, or prison privileges for a period exceeding 3 months
G.O.No. (d) Exclusion from the remission system for a period not exceeding 3 months
1273 P.J., (e) Exclusion from the remission system for a period exceeding 3 months;
dated the 11th (f) Permanent reduction from a higher to a lower class or grade;
July 1928. (3) Cellular confinement for a period exceeding 7 days ;
(4) Separate confinement for a period exceeding 14 days;
(5) Link-fetters, if imposed, for more than 30 days
(6) Bar-fetters;
(7) Cross-bar fetters;
(8) Handcuffing behind or to a staple
(9) Deleted.
(10) Deleted; and
(11) Any combination of minor punishments admissible under section 47 of the Act.
709. Every infringement of jail rules shall be brought to the notice of the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent who shall decide whether the infringement reported was committed in such circumstances,
e.g., wilfully or without excuse, as to constitute an offence. If the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent is
of opinion that the infringement of rule was committed through ignorance or excusable carelessness he shall
admonish the prisoner and dismiss the charge without recording it in the Punishment Register. But if he
finds it to be an offence, he shall award some punishment and have it recorded in the Punishment Register
(No.19) giving all details required by Rule 76 and likewise on the prisoners history ticket. [see also Rule
734 (2) regarding the keeping of a diary of the expiration of terms of punishment awarded.]
Rules 710. A formal warning is deemed to be a punishment and shall be personally addressed
75,552. to the offender by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent. In all but very exceptional
cases the punishment for a first offence should be a first formal warning. A formal
warning shall not be combined with any other punishment (see Rule 762).
711. Change of labour [minor punishment No (ii)] can be awarded only to prisoners undergoing
rigorous imprisonment and is a punishment suitable for persistent short work or idleness, but may be
given also for other offences. It may be given for a definite time, or until good behaviour.
Rule 402. 712. Petty offences, such as short work, etc, are unless frequently repeated, adequately
punished, in the case of prisoners coming under the remission system, by loss of
remission. This punishment should be used for minor offences in preference to all other
126
as long as the prisoner has any remission to his credit.
G.O.No. 713. Whenever application is made to the Inspector General of Prisons for sanction to
438P J. the forfeiture of remission exceeding 12 days, or for the exclusion of a prisoner from the
dated the 9th remission system for a period exceeding 3 months full particulars of the offence and of
February the remission the prisoner has earned, and a brief statement of his previous history
1931. accompanied by his descriptive roll shall be submitted.
714. Forfeiture of prison privileges under the remission system includes any of the special privileges
allowed to convict overseers and convict watchmen by the rules in Chapter VI of this Code. One or
more of these privileges may be suspended. When awarding this punishment or reduction of class or
grade [minor punishments Nos.(iv) and (v) and major punishment No.(ii)(f)] the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent shall record the period of such punishment.
715. Deleted.
716. Deleted.
717. Handcuffs may be imposed-
(a) On the wrists in front, by day or night, for a period of not more than 12 hours at a time, with
intervals of not less than 12 hours between each period, and for not more than four consecutive days or
nights.
(b) On the wrists behind, by day only, for a period of not more than six hours in any day of twenty four
hours, and for not more than four consecutive days. No slings or fastenings other than the ordinary
fastenings of the handcuffs shall be used in applying this punishment
(c) By attaching the handcuffs affixed on the prisoners wrists to a staple in front of the prisoner by day
for not more than four consecutive days and for not more than six hours on each day with an interval of
at least one hour after the handcuffs have been so attached for 3 hours: provided that the staple shall
not be higher than the prisoners shoulder nor lower than his waist and that no prisoner shall be
attached by handcuffs to a staple except in the presence of other prisoners : provided further that the
punishment referred to in this clause shall not be executed until the prisoner to whom the punishment
has been awarded has been examined by the Medical officer and pronounced to be fit to undergo the
punishment: provided also that this punishment shall be restricted to cases where the prisoner has been
guilty of repeated and wilful violations of any prison rule, and where, in fact, his conduct is evidently
due to contumacy.
The punishments prescribed in clause (b) and (c) above shall not be combined with handcuffs in
any other way in alternate intervals.
A prisoner while undergoing punishment in handcuffs shall be under complete shelter from the sun.
718. The following classes of fetters may be used in jails:
(a) Link fetters, composed of a chain and ankle-rings. The total weight of such fetters, including the
ankle rings shall not exceed 3 pounds and the chain shall be not less than two feet in length.
(b) Bar fetters, composed of two bars joined together by a link and attached to ankle-rings. The total
weight of such fetters, including the ankle-rings, shall not exceed 5 pounds, and each bar shall be not
less than twenty inches in length.
(c) Cross bar fetters, composed of a single bar for the purpose of keeping the legs apart, and of ankle
rings. The total weight of such fetters, including ankle rings shall not exceed 2.50 pounds. The length
of the bar shall not exceed sixteen inches in the case of men who are not less than five feet six inches in
height, or fourteen inches in the case of men below this height. The use of cross bar fetters should be
restricted to extreme cases of violence, and be resorted to as much as a prevention against assault as for
punishment. The full period allowed for the imposition of this punishment should be awarded only in
exceptional cases.
127
719. The maximum period for which fetters may be continuously imposed shall be-
(a) In the case of link fetters, 7 (seven) days. However he shall have to inform in writing about the
same to the Deputy Inspector General of Prisons of respective jurisdiction. If the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent considers necessary to impose link fetters for more than seven days,
written approval from same authority shall have to be obtained.
(b) In the case of bar fetters, 7 (seven) days. However he shall have to inform in writing about the
same to the Deputy Inspector General of Prisons of respective jurisdiction. If the Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent considers necessary to impose bar fetters for more than seven days,
written approval from same authority shall have to be obtained.
(c) In the case of cross-bar fetters, two hundred and forty hours.
720. A period of at least ten days must elapse after fetters of any kind have been imposed as a
punishment for a prison offence before they can be again imposed as a punishment for another prison
offence , whether of the same kind or not.
721. Fetters of every description shall always be kept bright and polished, and soft leather, blanket or
canvas gaiters shall be allowed to prevent abrasion of the skin. Link and bar fetters may be suspended
to the waist by a strip of leather, no string or rope being allowed for the purpose. When fetters become
worn or thin in any part, they shall at once be changed. Fetters imposed as a jail punishment shall
invariably be removed before a prisoner is produced in court; fetters for safe custody should only be
imposed on dangerous prisoners when appearing in the court.
722. Deleted
723. Cellular confinement is confinement in a cell, with or without labour, so as to entirely seclude
the prisoner from communication with, but not from sight of , other prisoners. The convict cell
attendants shall have access to his cell to give the prisoner his food and attend to conservancy, but the
prisoner shall have his meals alone, and bathe in his cell yard. Cellular confinement may be awarded
for not more than fourteen days, and after each period of cellular confinement an interval of not less
duration than such period shall elapse before the prisoner is again sentenced to other cellular
confinement.
Rule 708. 724. Separate confinement is confinement in a cell, with or without labour, so as to
seclude the prisoner whilst in his cell from communication with, but not from sight of,
other prisoners. The outer batten door of the cell yard in cells built on the standard plan
shall be left open, and a prisoner undergoing this punishment shall have not less than one
hours exercise daily in the common passage in front of the cells or other sufficient space
under the eye of a paid warder, and shall have his meals in association with one or more
other prisoners. Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent may award separate confinement
up to 30 days. If any period in excess of this up to 3 months is deemed necessary, the
order of the Inspector General of Prisons shall be obtained. When submitting an
application for such order the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall forward a
certificate of the Medical Officer of the fitness of the prisoner to undergo separate
confinement for the period recommended, or for any other period the Medical Officer
may consider the prisoner fit to undergo.
725. Deleted.
726. Deleted.
727. Deleted.
728. Deleted.
729. Deleted
730. Handcuffs shall only be imposed on females as a measure of restraint when there is a likelihood of
a woman seriously injuring herself or others and then for not more than 72 hours at a time.
731. Deleted.
G.I.Letter
No.269 H.D.of 732. Deleted .
30-12-1905.
128
Section 50, Act
IX of 1894
733. Except by order of a court of justice, no punishment other than the punishments specified in the
foregoing rules shall be inflicted upon any prisoner, and no punishment shall be inflicted upon any
prisoner otherwise than in accordance with the provisions of these rules.
jail circular 734. The following registers shall be maintained in respect of the punishments inflicted
No. 77 of on prisoners in any jail:-
1904.
(1) No. 19. Punishment Register.- In keeping this register the instructions given in Rule
76 shall be strictly complied with. If the prisoner punished is a convict officer his grade
shall be stated under his name. The classification of every punishment as major or minor
should be carefully recorded in the column set apart for the purpose. If the entry to be
made in the column Evidence of the offence is a long one it need not be restricted to
that column, but may be written across the book, provided space is left for necessary
entries in relation to the case in the other columns. Entries of judicial sentences for an
offence committed in jail should be entered in red ink, in order that they may be readily
distinguished. At the end of each month an abstract of offences and punishment
according to the headings in part V of the Quarterly Return No. I shall be entered in this
register for the convenience of authorised visitors. At the end of each month a record
shall also be made in this register of
(a) the total number of punishments inflicted;
(b) the daily average strength of convicts (A class and B class) ;
(c) the percentage of A class prisoners punished;
(d) the percentage of B class prisoners punished;
(e) the percentage of major punishments inflicted on B class prisoners.
This information shall also be incorporated in the Annual Report.
(2) No.20- Diary of Termination of Jail Punishments.- It is of great importance that
prisoners shall not continue to undergo punishment for longer periods than those
ordered by the superintendent. On the day an order for any punishment which will
continue for any specified term is given effect to, the date of expiry of the term of such
punishment shall be calculated and the name of the prisoner and particulars of the
punishment shall be entered in this diary under the date on which it will terminate. The
diary shall be examined by the Jailer daily and orders shall be given on the prisoners
history tickets for the discontinuance of every punishment which in each day terminates.
Note.- With regard to the application of these rules to under trial prisoners, to prisoners
sentenced to simple imprisonment and to civil prisoners see Rules 927, 944 and 905.
With regard to the use of handcuffs or fetters for restraint, see Rule 515.
Note.- The following rules shall not apply to the confinement of female prisoners in cells when at
variance with Rules 293, 947, 950, 982 and 985 of this Code.
735. Cells for separate, cellular, and solitary confinement shall, if possible, be provided in all Jails. If
such cells are not in accordance with the standard plan, the Inspector General of Prisons shall examine
them and certify that they are fit for the purposes. Each cell shall have a yard attached to it, where the
prisoner can have the benefit of fresh air without having the means of communication with any other
prisoner. There shall be a general yard in connection with the cells constructed for cellular
confinement, in which each prisoner confined in them can be bathed, fed, and exercised at the regular
hours. In the outer door of the separate yard attached to each cell an eye-hole shall be made so that the
prisoner can be seen without seeing any one.
129
736. The cells may be used for-
(a) carrying out sentences of solitary confinement under sections 73 and 74 of the Penal Code;
(b) the separate and cellular confinement of prisoners under section 46 (8), (10) of Act IX of 1894.
(c) the separation of habituals under Rule 627.
(d) the separation of juveniles at night( see Rule 965).
(e) the separation of confessing under trial prisoners (see Rule 912)
(f) purposes of restraint- (see Rule 253).
(g) the medical observation of lunatics (see Rule 1038).
(h) the medical observation and separation of prisoners supposed to be suffering from bowel-
complaints or other sickness or to be causing sickness or sores by the use of deleterious substances or
who are suffering from contagious diseases;
(i) the confinement of prisoners condemned to death (see Rule 980) ;
(j) quarantine (see Rule 505 & 1246);
(k) for separation of under trial prisoners (see Rule 912).
Note.- The punishment of handcuffing to a staple shall not be carried out in a cell.
737. Every cell shall be provided with sanitary bath with doors upto chest level, tap water arrangement
in a separate closed place for the purpose of ablution, drinking, washing etc. In every cell there should
be a plastic glass, an aluminium mug and covered receptacle for throwing refuses and dirts etc. (to be
cleaned by the sweeper every morning).
There shall be bathing place outside the cell in the cell yard.
738. Only permanent Warders shall be placed in charge of cells. The keys of cells shall, during the day,
remain ordinarily in the custody of the permanent Warder in charge. At night the keys shall remain in the
custody of the patrolling Head Warder except in the cases of cells containing prisoners under medical
observation. The keys of such cells may, at the discretion of the Medical Officer, remain with the warder in
charge.
The lock of every cell shall be examined daily by the Head Warder responsible and frequently by the
Jailor.
739. Every prisoner confined in a cell shall, invariably, be in the immediate charge of a permanent warder
assisted, if necessary, by specially selected Convict Officers. Both by day and by night the guards shall be
so posted and arranged that all prisoners in cells shall at all times have the means of communicating with a
jail officer. Every prisoner so confined shall be visited by a Head Warder once every two hours during the
day and night. The relieving and relieved Head Warders and Warders shall visit the cells together at every
change of guard to see that the correct number is confined in them and that all is well.
740. A strict watch shall be kept over all prisoners confined in cells to prevent them committing suicide or
injuring themselves. Every lunatic, suspected lunatic or prisoner suspected of suicidal tendencies under
medical observation in cells shall be carefully watched both by day and night. Specially selected Convict
Officers may be detailed for this purpose in the proportion of not more than one Convict Officer to every
three adjacent cells. Such Convict Officer shall be placed under the immediate orders of the warder in
charge, they shall be instructed as to the character and possible tendencies of their charges and shall be
warned to give immediate information to the warder in-charge of any symptom of a suspicious nature
exhibited by the prisoners under their observation. Prisoners showing symptoms of suspicious nature shall
be placed outside the cells.
A prisoner sent to a cell for medical observation shall be frequently visited by the Warder on duty,
who shall send information to the Medical Officer of any change which may take place in the
prisoners condition. During the time that the prisoner is under observation he shall receive such food
as the Medical Officer may consider necessary.
741. In case of sickness immediate notice shall be given by guard to the Head Warder on duty by passing the
word from sentry to sentry. The Head Warder shall at once report the case to the Assistant Surgeon, who
shall visit the cell, and, if necessary, remove the prisoner to hospital, and inform the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent, Medical Officer and Jailor of the circumstance at their next visit. Two prisoners shall, under
no circumstances whatever, be confined in one cell. If male condemned prisoners or dangerous lunatics have
to be watched by convicts, they must be placed outside the grated door of the cell. Convict sweepers and
cooks may enter the cells when necessary, accompanied by a Warder. Food shall be cooked and carried to
the cells by prisoner cooks of suitable caste, under the superintendence of a Jail Officer.
130
742. Every prisoner confined in a cell for more than 24 hours shall be visited daily by the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent and also by the Medical Officer or medical subordinate. The Jailor shall
visit the cells and see every prisoner confined therein daily.
743. The Warder in-charge of the cells shall receive no prisoner for separate, or cellular confinement
without a written order from the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent which shall generally be given
on the prisoners ticket and shall be produced when called for by any inspecting officer or visitor, and
shall receive no prisoner for separation by day or night under Rule 627 without an order from the
Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent or Jailor.
744. A ticket shall be hung over the cell, or cell yard door of every prisoner undergoing confinement in
such cell, showing the period of confinement ordered and the date from which such confinement
commenced.
745. A register shall be kept in the vernacular by the warder in charge of the cells, showing the date on
which each prisoner is admitted and discharged, the nature of the confinement ordered, and the amount
of assigned task/work done daily.
746. Before being put in a cell each prisoner shall be very carefully searched, and all implements and
appliances likely to facilitate escape or suicide shall be taken away. Every cell and every prisoner
therein shall be carefully searched daily at lock-up time, and oftener if necessary.
747. The bedding of prisoners in cell, except that of prisoners under observation for sickness or
insanity, shall be withdrawn from the cell during the day and exposed to the sun and air when the
weather permits . The inmate of a cell shall at all times be compelled to keep it scrupulously clean.
748. Labouring prisoners in solitary confinement shall be supplied with suitable work according to
their capacity to be determined by the Jailor in consultation with the Medical Officer.
749. Strict silence must be maintained among all prisoners in confinement in cells.
Note. For the treatment of condemned prisoners in cells, see Chapter XXXI.
In exercise of the powers conferred by section 59, sub-section (5) of the Prisons Act, l894 (IX of l894)
the Government is pleased to make the following rules to regulate the shortening of sentences by the
grant of remissions.
750. Deleted.
751. In these rules,-
(a) prisoner includes a person committed to prison in default of furnishing security to keep the peace
or be of good behaviour;
(b) class 1 prisoner means a thug, a robber by administration of poisonous drugs or a professional,
hereditary, or specially dangerous criminal convicted of heinous organised crime, such as dacoity;
(c) class 2 prisoner means a dacoit or other person convicted of heinous organised crime, not being a
professional, hereditary, or a specially dangerous criminal;
(d) class 3 prisoner means a prisoner other than a class 1 or class 2 prisoner;
(e) sentence means a sentence finally fixed on appeal, revision or otherwise and includes an
aggregate of more sentences than one and an order of committal to prison in default of furnishing
security to keep the peace or be of good behaviour;
(f) life convict means a prisoner whose sentence amounts to 30 years imprisonment.
Note.- Classification of the sentence of a prisoner under clause (f) should be made by the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent subject to the supervision of the Inspector General.
131
752. Deleted.
753. No ordinary remission shall be earned in the following cases, namely:-
(a) in respect of any sentence of imprisonment amounting exclusive of any sentence passed in default
of payment of fine, to less than six months;
(b) in respect of any sentence of simple imprisonment except for any continuous period not being
less than one month during which the prisoner labours voluntarily.
Note.- The intention of this rule is that if a prisoners sentence or total of sentences is reduced on
appeal to less than six months he shall cease to be eligible for ordinary remission under these rules, and
any remission that he may have earned prior to the reduction of his sentence or sentences shall be
forfeited . [See in this connection the definition of sentence in Rule 751 (e)]
G.O.No. 754. If a prisoner is convicted of an offence committed after admission to jail, under
11236 sections 147,148,152,224,302,304,304A,306, 307, 308, 323, 324, 325, 326, 332, 333, 352,
R.J., dated 353 or 377 of the Penal Code, or of an assault committed after admission to Jail on a
the 10th warder or other officer, the remission of whatever kind earned by him under these rules up
December to the date of the said conviction may, with the sanction of the Inspector General of
1923. Prisons be cancelled.
755. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may, with the previous sanction of the Inspector
General of Prisons re-admit to the remission system any prisoner who has been removed therefrom
under rules framed under section 59, clause (3), of the Act. Such a prisoner shall earn remission under
these rules from the commencement of the month following such re-admission.
G.O.No.112 756. Ordinary remission shall be awarded on the following scale:-
36 R.J., (a) three days per month for thoroughly good conduct and scrupulous attention to all
dated the prison regulations;
10th
December (b) two days per month for industry and the due performance of the daily task imposed.
Explanation.- A prisoner who is unable to labour through causes beyond his control, by reason of
1923.
being at court, in transit from one jail to another in hospital or on an invalid group shall be
granted remission under clause (a) of this rule on the scale earned by him during the previous
month if his conduct prior to and during the period in question has been such as to deserve such
grant. He shall also be entitled to the grant of remission under clause (b) on the scale earned by
him during the previous month if he has been in prison during that term; if not, at the rate of 3
G.O.No. days per month: Provided that if his absence from work is due to his own misconduct in jail no
4264 P.J., remission under clause (b) shall be awarded for the period of absence; Provided also that if he is
dated the in hospital or on an invalid group, no remission under clause (b) of this rule shall be granted
30th July unless the Medical Officer certifies that the prisoners absence from labour is due to causes
1932. beyond his control and is in no way caused by any action of the prisoner himself taken with a
view to escape work or to get into or to remain in hospital.
Note. Hospital includes Mental Hospital.
Rule 407 757. In lieu of remission allowed under Rule 756, convict overseer and night watchman
Rule 394 shall receive 7 and 6 days ordinary remission respectively per month
758. Subject to the provisions of Rule 755, remission under Rule 756 shall be calculated from the first
day of the calendar month next following the date of the prisoners sentence. Any prisoner who after
having been released on bail or because his sentence has been temporarily suspended is afterwards re
admitted to jail shall be brought under the remission system on the first day of the calendar month next
following his readmission but shall be credited on his return to jail with any remission which he may
have earned previous to his release on bail or the suspension of his sentence. Remission under Rule
757 shall be calculated from the first day of the next calendar month following the appointment of the
prisoner as convict overseer or convict night watchman.
G.O.No. 759. Prisoners employed on prison services, such as cooks and sweepers, who work on
2826P.J., Fridays and holidays, may be awarded three days ordinary remission per quarter in
dated the 6th addition to any other remission earned under these rules.
August
Explanation.- One days remission may be credited to the prisoner at the end of every
1931.
month during which he has been employed on any prison service.
132
760. Any prisoner eligible for remission under these rules who for a period of one year reckoned from
the first day of the month following the date of his sentence or the date on which he was last punished
for a prison offence, has committed no prison offence whatever, shall be awarded fifteen days ordinary
remission in addition to any other remission earned under these rules.
Explanation.- For the purpose of this rule prison offences punished only with a warning shall not be
taken into account.
761. Ordinary remission shall be awarded by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent or subject to
his control and supervision and to the provisions of Rule 762, by the Deputy Superintendent (in Central
Jail), Jailor, Deputy Jailor, or any other officer specially empowered in that behalf by him.
762. An officer awarding ordinary remission shall, before making the award, consult the prisoners
history ticket in which every offence proved against the prisoner must be carefully recorded.
If a prisoner has not been punished during the quarter otherwise than by a formal warning, he shall be
awarded the full ordinary remission for that quarter under Rule 756, or , if he is a Convict Officer
under Rule 757.
If a prisoner has been punished during the quarter otherwise than by a formal warning, the case shall be
placed before the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent, who, after considering the punishment or
punishments awarded, shall decide what amount of remission shall be granted under Rule 756, or if the
convict is a Convict Officer, under Rule 757. All remissions recorded on the prisoners history ticket
shall be entered quarterly on the Remission Card ( J. Register No-18 ).
763. The award of ordinary remission shall be made, as nearly as possible, on Ist January, Ist April, Ist
July, and 1st October and the amount shall be intimated to the prisoner and recorded on his history
ticket. Remission granted to a prisoner under Rule 760 shall be recorded on his history ticket as soon as
possible after it is awarded.
764. No prisoner shall receive ordinary remission for the calendar month in which he is released.
Rule 483 765. Special remission may be given to any prisoner whether entitled to ordinary
remission or not for special services as for example:-
Rule1171. (i) assisting in detecting or preventing breaches of prison discipline or regulations;
(ii) success in teaching handicrafts;
(iii) special excellence in, or greatly increased out turn of, work of good quality;
(iv) protecting an officer of the prison from attack;
(v) assisting an officer of the prison in the case of outbreak of dis-contentment,
disturbances, fire or similar emergency;
(vi) economy in wearing clothes.
(vii) showing proficiency in receiving technical or academic training.
(viii) Scrupulous attention to Jail Regulations and remaining free from Jail punishments
except warning, for three consecutive years.
766. Special remission may be awarded-
(a) by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent to an amount not exceeding 45 days in one year;
(b) by the Inspector General of Prisons or the Government to an amount not exceeding 90 days in
one year.
Explanation.- For the purpose of this rule years shall be reckoned from the date of sentence, and any
fraction of a year shall be reckoned as a complete year.
133
767. An award of special remission shall be entered on the history ticket of the prisoner as soon as
possible after it is made and the reasons for every award of special remission by Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent shall be briefly recorded.
768. The total remission awarded to a prisoner under all these rules shall not, without the special
sanction of the Government, exceed one-third part of his sentence.
769. In calculating the date of release of a prisoner the number of days of remission earned shall be
converted into months and days at the rate of thirty days, to each month.
Rule 571. 771. Save as provided by Rule 770 when a prisoner has earned such remission as
G.O.No. entitles him to release, the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall release him.
9759
R.J. dated Note. All life convicts who are not released by Government under 20 Years Rrule shall
the 29th be released under these remission rules without further reference to Government, unless
November Government. specifies any particular time when the cases of such prisoners shall again
1924. be considered.
Rules 772. When a prisoner is released under Rule 771 the total amount of remission earned
576,585. by him shall be endorsed on his warrant and the endorsement shall be signed by the
Senior Superintendent/Superintendent.
G.O.No.179 773. When a prisoner is transferred to another Jail the total amount of remission earned
6 by him up to the end of the previous month shall be endorsed on his warrant and entered
P.J. dated on his history ticket, under the signature of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent.
the 15th May
1933. The receiving Jail shall be responsible that the above information is duly obtained. Each
Jail at which a prisoner serves a portion of his sentence shall be held responsible for the
correct calculation of the remission earned in that Jail.
G.O.No. 774. Remission cards (Jail Register No.18) shall be retained in the office of a Jail for a
1796 period of one year after the release of the prisoner to whom they relate. When a prisoner
P.J.dated the is transferred to another Jail his remission card showing remission earned up to date of
15th May his transfer shall be sent with the prisoner.
1933.
775. An abstract of the above remission Rules (in J. Form No. 36 ) translated into the vernacular shall
be posted up in every barrack.
776. The appointment of convicts to the posts of Convict Watchman, and convict overseer, authorised
by chapter VI shall be dependent upon the number of days remission earned. These posts and the
privileges they carry are therefore privileges under the remission system with reference to section 46
(4) of Act IX of 1894 [See Rule 714].
777. Deleted.
778. Deleted.
134
779. When recording the award of ordinary remission as prescribed in Rule 763 the entering officer
shall at the same time bring forward in the prisoners history ticket the total of all remission previously
earned in the following manner:-
135
781.1 PAROLE :- Certain classes of prisoners who have fulfilled the following conditions may be
released on parole:-
(1) That he has served half of his sentence including remission ;
(2) That he has maintained good conduct in the prison throughout his imprisonment ;
(3) That he must have completed thorough training on a particular trade allotted to him in the
prison industries. The certificate for completion of his training on a particular trade will be issued
by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent on the recommendation of the Deputy
Superintendent (in central jails) ;
(4) That he will not revert to crime after release and shall in no case be a problem to the society.
781.2. No prisoner of the following category will be eligible for parole under rule 781.1:
(i) Prisoner under sentence of death.
(ii) Prisoner sentenced to rigorous imprisonment for life.
(iii) Prisoner sentenced for sedition and treachery against the state.
(iv) Prisoner convicted under the Arms Act, 1878 (Act No XI of 1878) the Explosive Substances
Act, 1908 (Act No VI of 1908) and the Narcotics Control Act,1990 (Act No XX of 1990) or
any other Act relating to Drugs.
781.3 Upon release of a prisoner on parole he shall remain under parole supervision for the remaining
period of his sentence under social welfare department or any other voluntary organisations as
determined by the Government.
781.4 The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail to which such prisoner belongs shall make
initial recommendation for release of a prisoner on parole to the Parole Board.
781.5 Parole Board shall consist of the following members:-
(1) Secretary, Ministry of Home Affairs, who shall also be the Chairman of the Board.
(2) Secretary, Ministry of Social Welfare.
(3) Secretary, Ministry of Law, Justice & Parliamentary Affairs.
(4) Inspector General of Prisons, Bangladesh.
(5) Deputy Inspector General of Prisons of the Division to which such prisoner belongs.
(6) Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of Jail who made the initial recommendation for release
on parole, who shall also be the Member- Secretary of the Board.
781.6 If a prisoner, released on parole, violates any conditions setforth in rule 781.1, he shall be re-
arrested and committed to the prison to serve out the remaining portion of his sentence.
CHAPTER XXII. - LABOUR AND JAIL INDUSTRIES.
136
784. All labour exacted from prisoners shall be classified as hard, medium or light according to
the amount of physical exertion required for the performance of a fixed task, and maximum tasks
which shall be exacted from any prisoner shall be fixed. The tasks or proportion of a task or special
labour which each prisoner is physically fitted to perform is determined by the Medical Officer and no
prisoner shall be caused to perform any harder labour than that fixed by the Medical Officer and
entered from time to time on each prisoners history ticket.
The task to be imposed on any adult female or juvenile convict shall not in any case exceed two thirds
of the maximum task for hard and medium labour respectively prescribed in respect of adult male
convicts.
785. Every jail shall be provided with apparatus for hard labour sufficient for the number of prisoners
who are likely, under the rules, to be employed on such labour, and no prisoner bound under the rules
to perform hard labour shall be placed upon medium or light labour from any consideration of profit.
786. Every convict on being first put to do any kind of work shall be allowed a reasonable time in
which to acquire the skill necessary for the performance of the prescribed task, and if during this time
he shows due diligence and makes satisfactory progress he shall be allowed the remission for industry
and shall also be granted a certificate in Jail Form No. 124 on release. The time necessary for working
up to a full task will depend upon the nature of the work. At such work as grinding, breaking metal,
yarn reeling or twisting, etc. a few days experience will be sufficient, and a full task shall then be
exacted. In industries needing greater skill, such as weaving, carpet or durrie making it may be three
months or more before a prisoner can give a full task, according to his intelligence; and care must be
taken to make due allowance, in estimating a convicts progress, for differences of mental and physical
capacity. In every case when allotting to a prisoner new work (whether on admission or subsequently)
the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent, or, subject to his control, the Deputy Superintendent or
Jailor, shall note on the prisoners history ticket the exact task he is to begin with, and subsequently
every increase required, up to the full task.
Frequent change of work, except on medical grounds, should be avoided, but the harder forms of
labour, should not be continued indefinitely without variation, and sedentary work should occasionally
be changed for work involving more general movement. It is expected that every Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent shall be acquainted with the tasks to be exacted from his prisoners. No
general reduction of the tasks fixed in Rule 789 shall be allowed in any Jail without the sanction of the
Inspector General of Prisons. In allotting labour to a prisoner and fixing his tasks the Deputy
superintendent or Jailor must be guided by the record of fortnightly weighments in his ticket.
787. Whenever the material given to a prisoner to work upon admits of weighment or measurement,
the task he is to perform in the course of the day shall be weighed or measured out to him before he
commences the work, in order that both the prisoner and the Warder in charge of him may see how the
work progresses as the day advances.
788. Before the prisoners leave their worksheds or places of work on stoppage of work in the
afternoon, the Jailor, Deputy Jailor and Head Warders or Factory Overseer if any, shall go round and
measure the work done, at the same time carefully noting it in the task ticket of the prisoner concerned.
The task ticket may be kept in vernacular. In large Jails an educated prisoner may be employed to assist
in keeping this task-ticket. Every prisoner who has done less than the task allotted to him shall also
have it recorded on his history ticket and shall be brought before the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent. In respect of prisoners working at industries requiring skilled workmanship the task
may be taken and recorded every second or third day as found expedient.
All prisoners with sentences of rigorous imprisonment for more than three months shall be paid wages
for the work done in Jails where the system of payment of wages to convicts is operative provided that
no payment will be made to a convict for the first three months and no payment will be made when the
output of work falls short of the prescribed task.
789. The various industries and kinds of work carried on in the Jails have been classified as shown in
the following statement, in which also the maximum tasks to be exacted are indicated where the work
admits of a uniform task being fixed.:-
137
Manufacture Description of Classification and Task. Remarks.
or service work
Hard labour Medium labour Light labour
1 2 3 4 5 6
Aloe pounding leaves 40 leaves or 20 leaves or 466 233 grams of per man
to extract fibre. 933 gm. dry gm of cleaned cleaned dry
fibre. dry fibre. fibre.
spinning fibre 933 gm 466 gm per man
into yarn
string matting .... 9045 cm per man
Bamboo and splitting and .... .... Task according
cane work. dressing cane. to thickness and
length.
Floor matting .... .... 63 per man
(bamboo).
privy baskets .... 8 4 per man
(bamboo)
Scoops ditto .... 3 1-1/2 per man
Tokas ditto .... 2 1 per man
Umbrellas ditto .... 1 per man
Cane baskets .... 2 1 per man.
(coolles)
Cane chairs .... to 1/5 per man.
Blankets By machinery .... .... .... Special tasks
for the Dhaka
mill, hard,
medium and
light.
Blacksmith's various hard or Task according Task according ...
work. medium. to work. to work
As per task book
Book-binding Hard, medium of the Rajshahi
and light. Central Jail press.
Deleted.
Carpet preparing warp .. .. 2.799 kg Per man.
opening cotton
yarn.
Twisting cotton yarn, .. .. 1.166 kg Per man.
4- fold No. 10.
138
Cleaning and .. .. .. 100 lamps Per man.
trimming
lamps
Coir Pounding 1.399 kg 700 gm .. Per man.
cocoanut with
mallet.
Picking , rubbing 4.666 kg 2.333 kg .. Per man.
and teasing fibre.
Spinning and .. 10 hanks or .. Per man.
twisting fibre 36.58 metres
(fine). long
Spinning and .. 15 hanks .. Per man.
twisting fibre
(coarse)
Plaiting sinnet .. .. 27.43 metres Per man.
Ditto double .. 9.14 metres .. Per man.
Weaving brush- .. 1858 sq cm .. Per man.
mat (fine)
Weaving brush- .. 5574.89 sq cm .. Per man.
mat (coarse)
Weaving matting, 457.2 cm in .. Per man.
91.44 cm wide length
Cooking Hard or medium 1 cook to 30 1 cook to 20 ..
labour. prisoners prisoners
Convict overseer, Light work .. .. .. Cannot be
clerical work,
compounders tasked.
assistant.
Cotton Bowing cotton 3.732 kg 1.866 kg .. Per man.
with dhanuk.
Spinning by hand .. 175 gm 87.50 gm Per man.
(coarse) 10s
Twisting cotton .. .. .. Per man.
yarn, see carpets.
Twisting cotton .. .. 4.665 kg Per man.
yarn No. 6 for
cotton rope and
threads.`
Weaving dusters, 18.28 metres 9.14 metres .. Per man.
76.2 cm side,
with fly shuttle
loom.
Weaving prison 18.28 metres 9.14 metres .. Per man.
clothing 66.04
cm wide with fly
shuttle loom
Ditto country 10.968 5.484 metres .. Per man.
hand Loom. metres
Weaving durries .. 60.9660.96 cm 30.4860.96 cm Per man.
Ditto newar 5.04 .. 1391.6 cm .. Per man.
cm
139
Dyeing Medium or light special tasks for the Rajshahi or other central jail.
140
Masonry and Mason's work up to 0.704 cu metre 0.422 cu .. Per man.
building 91.44 cm metre
work.
Ditto above 91.44 0.422 to 0.563 0.281 to .. Per man.
cm cu metre 0.422 cm
metre
Attendants .. 1 to each .. Per man.
mason.
Digging and 2.817 cu metre 1.408 cu .. Per man.
excavating metre
foundation
Money-bag For Tk. 1,000 .. .. 1 bag Per man.
For small change .. .. bag Per man.
Oakum- By hand 900 gm 450 mg 225 mg Per man.
picking picked. picked. picked.
Winnowing castor .. .. 111.972 kg Per man.
seed.
Oil-pressing Crushing packing 223.944 kg per .. ..
into canvas and press, 7 men.
pressing on screw
press, boiling and
preparing castor oil.
Printing Hard, medium and As per task book
light. of Rajshahi
central jail
press.
Repairing Jail Breaking up .. 4.645 sq .. Per man.
roads. separating metal, metres
relaying and
ramming.
Scavenging Removing night-soil, 1 mehtar to 50 1 mehter to ..
cleaning latrines. prisoners 30 prisoners.
Soorkey Pounding hard bricks 0.338 cu 0.169 cu .. ..
pounding (dhenki) metres per metres per
dhenki per 3 dhenki per 3
men. men.
Ditto soft (dhenki) 0.422 cu 0.225 cu ..
metres do. metres Do
Sweeping and Light labour .. .. May be done
weeding by special
roads. group
Tailoring Special task in central
jails; may be either
medium or light.
Tin-work Various medium .. Task
labour according to
work.
Washerman for Medium labour .. Cannot be
hospital dress, tasked.
guarding staff
141
790. In the selection of prison labour the main object to be kept in view should be the reformation of
the criminal. Nonproductive labour should be avoided. Short term prisoners must necessarily be
employed mainly on unskilled labour. But if such a prisoner has previous knowledge of any trade,
where possible, he should be put on that trade. The principal mode of employment of long term
prisoners should be intramural. The prisoner derives greater benefit by getting the best available
instruction in up-to-date methods of labour and this also fits him for free living under modern
conditions. To ensure this one or two main industries should be carried on in the larger Jails. Jail
industries should be set up to meet the needs , firstly, of the Jail Department and, secondly, of other
consuming departments of Government. These departments are bound to obtain articles which they
require from jails when these are suitable, provided they are not inferior in quality or of higher price
than those obtainable in the open market. In Central Jails power driven machinery may be employed
for the main industries provided these do not interfere with nascent or unorganized enterprises. This is
conditional on consultation and co-ordination between the Jail and the Industries Departments,
including consultation of the latter by the former on the prices to be fixed for jail products.
790.1- No new industry shall be introduced in any Jail without the sanction of the Government. It
may be noted that the intention behind operating prison industries is not to maximise profit but to
utilise productively the prison inmates so that work discipline installed in them come to their aid after
release, but the industrial units in Jails must have a productive target and utmost efforts must be made
to achieve this target.
Note.- Labour charges should be fixed at the time of obtaining sanction of Government for
introduction of Jail industry.
G.O.No.1487 791. A complete and detailed catalogue of the articles made in the manufacturing
P.J., date the department of jails shall be published at the beginning of every year and distributed
25th April to the departments of the Government. Prices of the articles shall be fixed as far as
1930. possible for a period of one year, and shall not be subject to variation. All articles
mentioned in the catalogue and required by Government departments may directly
G.O.No. 2748 be purchased from jails without any tender process and may only be purchased from
P.J., dated the private firms if the cost of buying articles in this way is less than that of obtaining
27th November them from the jails after taking the cost of transport into account, or if the jail
1930. intimates its inability to supply the articles within the time specified. Orders for all
articles required by the different departments should be obtained from the
appropriate jails shown in the catalogue. This rule does not apply to any
Government department institution or concern which by reason of its nature is in a
position to produce similar articles.
792. In deciding upon the work to be done , the Jailor or the Dy. Superintendent (Central Jails) must
exert himself, in conjunction with the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall ascertain what are
the branches of labour which will meet the requirements, firstly of the jail service; secondly, of the
other consuming Departments of Government; and thirdly, the demands of Local Bodies. After these
means of employment are exhausted he must make himself acquainted with the state of the market
and ascertain what other industries are likely to be most profitable and how articles can be best
disposed of. At the same time, in deciding on the nature of industries he must consider whether the
work is useful and profitable and whether training in the particular branch of work will be helpful in
the ultimate rehabilitation of the prisoner after discharge from jail.
792.1.- Marketing of prison products should be promoted by organising display and sales centres in
prominent places and also by participation in the exhibition if held in the District .
Separate Accounts should be maintained for operating prison industries as separate commercial unit.
142
G.O.No. 793. The total number of menial servants employed regularly (i.e., cooks, barbers, water
821. R.J., -carriers, sweepers, etc.) shall not exceed 15 per cent of the total number of prisoners in
dated 21st the Jails. The proportion of cooks, sweepers and hospital attendants to the number of
January prisoners to be attended to, which may be employed, is stated in rule 789. The
1926 appointment of cooks is regulated by Rule 1117. The barber shall belong to the A class.
Sweepers shall be chosen from any prisoners who volunteer to do the work. Hospital
Rule attendants shall be selected from prisoners passed for light work or those who have
1306 completed at least half of their sentences. Hospital attendants shall wear a plain square
red badge 5 cm 5cm on the left breast of the kurta. Prisoners in the convalescent and
infirm group may be put to this duty under the Medical Officers orders. If there is a
large number of a serious cases in hospital, the proportion of one attendant to 10 patients
may be temporarily exceeded; with this exception, Senior Superintendent
/Superintendents must see that no more than the authorised percentage of prisoner is
employed as jail servants or as convict officers. If any convict employed as a menial
servant has not enough work to occupy his whole time, he shall be placed upon some
other work for the remainder of his time.
G.O.No.1 794. Employment of prisoners beyond the jail is prohibited, except with the previous
003 T.-R, sanction of Government, and then convicts may be utilized provided that-
dated the (1) climatic conditions are favourable;
4th (2) proper accommodation is arranged;
Septemb (3) sanitation is satisfactory; and
er 1923. (4) habituals are separated from casual convicts.
They shall also be used as far as possible in the preparation of materials within the jail
Rule 121.
premises for the Public Works Department, Local Bodies and private individuals.
For these works, the jail labourers should be granted some remuneration by the
Department concerned and the amount will be fixed by the Government which will help
their rehabilitation upon release.
G.O.No. 795. Every prisoner who has not more than one year of sentence remaining may be
1953 H.J., employed on extramural labour irrespective of the portion of sentence already passed in
dated the jail. No prisoner who has more than two years of sentence to run shall be so employed
21st without the sanction of the Inspector-General. No prisoner sentenced to more than
October
eighteen months imprisonment shall be selected for extramural work until he has served
1946.
G.O.No.3
at least one-third of his sentence. This rule applies to either A class or B class prisoners,
88 but the two classes shall not work together, and also applies to work either on jail land or
P.J. dated beyond the jail precincts. No prisoner shall be passed out of the jail for extramural work
the 31st without the sanction of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent recorded on his history
January ticket; and every prisoner so passed who is not a convict officer, shall wear an iron ankle-
1935. ring.
Rules 336,
552. Note.- But discretion should be exercised not to pass out prisoners who have shown, or
likely to have, a strong inclination to escape.
796. Prisoners employed in the garden shall ordinarily be of the A class with short
Rule- unexpired sentences, and shall be specially passed for such work by the Senior
1151 Superintendent/Superintendent's order recorded on the history ticket; and no prisoner
passed for hard or medium labour shall be put to the lighter forms of gardening or
agricultural work, which shall be reserved for those passed for light labour or specially
ordered such work by the Medical Officer on medical grounds. No B class prisoner shall
be put to such work except by the Medical Officers order.
Rules
183,202 797. Deleted.
143
G.O.No.
3771 P.J., 798. Deleted.
dated the
23rd
October
1933
Rule 1376
(2).
Rule 183.
Rule 1142.
Rules 799. The employment of prisoners as clerks in Jail offices is strictly forbidden. But the
328,551 Inspector-General may, when there is special necessity for it, sanction the employment of
an educated prisoner in the copying of letters, preparing of rolls, writing of registers,
Rule 441 which have no connection with warrants, remission, or money transactions. The Jailor
will be held responsible for seeing that a prisoner so employed is provided with a place
Rule 788 for writing inside or near the main gate quite apart from the Jail office and under the eye
of a warder. These prisoners are forbidden to enter the jail office on any excuse whatever
unless called before the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent or an inspecting officer.
Rule 556. 800. No unauthorized work shall be done either in or out of the jail workshops, and no
job either of manufacture or repair shall be put in hand until the order for its execution
has been duly entered in the Jailors report book or in the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendents or Deputy superintendents Minute Book or in any special book kept for
such purpose , under the initial of the Deputy Superintendent or other officer deputed to
be in charge of the workshops , or , in the case of repairs to a prisoners clothes until the
order of the Jailor has been recorded in the history ticket of such prisoner.
801. The raw material for manufactures shall be under the charge of a jail servant, who shall give out
each morning what is required for the days work, and shall receive into store again in the evening the
material which has not been used up. He shall also examine the days work, and satisfy himself that the
material reported as used up has really been used; but this shall not relieve the Deputy Superintendent
or Jailor, as the case may be, of his general responsibility for the safe custody and proper expenditure
or disposal of the manufactory stores.
Rule -27. 802. For supplying raw material, the best practicable arrangements shall be made, and, if
contracts are entered into the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall satisfy himself
of the respectability of the contractor, and also that no corrupt arrangement is made
between him and the jail officers, and submit the contract to the Inspector-General of
Prisons, for approval. Contracts may, with the approval of the Inspector General of
Prisons, be made by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent with mercantile firms or
individuals for the disposal of articles of jail produce or manufacture.
Rule-155 803. All accounts regarding manufactures shall be kept by a paid jail servant, under the
supervision of the Jailer or Deputy Superintendent who shall be responsible for the
correctness of the accounts.
804. When at a public exhibition a prize of money is obtained by any Jail for the excellence of its
manufactured goods, such money may be awarded with the approval of the Inspector General of
Prisons to the deserving officers of the staff of the successful jail.
Bangladesh 805. The following register shall be maintained in respect of the distribution of all
Form No. convicted prisoners:-
4982.
No. 5.- Distribution Register.- This register shall be written up early on the following day.
Prisoners admitted or released on any day and not working shall be entered as exempted
from labour. On Fridays and holidays all prisoners, except the sweepers, cooks, overseers,
etc, who work every day, are exempted from labour. In making up averages from this
table, Fridays and holidays shall always be excluded and may, therefore, be left blank.
144
CHAPTER XX111.-ACCIDENTS AND SUICIDES.
806. In all cases of sudden or violent death, or of a death due to an accident or of supposed suicide,
an inquest by the proper officer shall be held on the body. The proper officer to hold the investigation
is the Magistrate of the District, or an officer deputed by him. He will hold an inquest respecting
every death, which occurs in the jail, except when the death occurs from cholera or other epidemic
disease, or is the result of an execution. A careful enquiry shall be made into the circumstances of
every case and a report shall be submitted by the investigating officer without delay to the Inspector
General of Prisons. This report shall contain a distinct and formal finding in addition to the
depositions of the witnesses examined. The Inspector General of Prisons need not submit such reports
to Government unless they are of special importance, or indicate some defect in the existing system of
Jail administration to which the attention of Government should be specially invited. In all other cases
these reports may be withheld at his discretion. A full report of the circumstances attending every case
of sudden or violent death shall likewise be submitted by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent to
the Inspector General.
806.1. Incidents like escape, attempt to escape, jail break, clash between two groups of prisoners or
between the prisoner and jail staff etc. shall at once be reported to Government directly in the
Ministry of Home Affairs, Inspector General Of Prisons, Magistrate of the District and as well as
other concerned authorities for appropriate action under the relevant rules.
807. Knives, pieces of broken glasses, ropes etc., shall not be allowed to lie about: knives and other
tools used in the work sheds and barbers and tailors implements shall be counted over and locked up
by the warders at the close of work. Poisonous drugs shall on no account be left within reach of
prisoners. They must be kept locked up in a safe box or cupboard in the dispensary, the key of which
must be kept by the Medical Officer/Assistant Surgeon and on no account entrusted to a prisoner.
808. Deleted.
809. Deleted
810. Sections 24, 25, 26 and 30 of Act XXV of 1934 (Factories Act) shall apply to any jail in which
steam, water or other mechanical power is used for manufacturing processes.
811. Under the provisions of section 30 of the Factories Act referred to above and of any other rules
made by the Government from time to time, notices of all accidents resulting in-
(1) death, or
(2) such injury that there is probability of death, or
(3) such injury that there is no reasonable prospect that he
will be able to resume his employment within 20 days ;
(4) the permanent privation of a limb, or
(5) the permanent loss of sight or hearing:
145
812. Every factory accident, which, under the foregoing rule, has to be reported to the Magistrate
or the Commissioner of Police/Superintendent of Police, shall likewise be reported to the Inspector
General of Prisons, and such report shall be accompanied with a copy of the proceedings and finding
of the Magistrate, or the Police Officer, at his enquiry. In cases where the injury is reported by the
Medical Officer to be severe, this report, with the proceedings and finding, shall be forwarded by the
Inspector General of Prisons to Government.
CHAPTER XX1V. -TRANSPORTATION.
Jail Code Rule 813 to 839 Deleted as per recommendation of the committee.
813. Deleted.
814. Deleted.
815. Deleted.
816. Deleted.
817. Deleted.
818. Deleted.
819. Deleted.
820. Deleted.
821. Deleted.
822. Deleted.
823. Deleted
824. Deleted.
825. Deleted.
826. Deleted.
827. Deleted.
828. Deleted.
829. Deleted.
830. Deleted.
831. Deleted.
832. Deleted.
833. Deleted.
834. Deleted.
835. Deleted.
836. Deleted.
837. Deleted.
838. Deleted.
839. Deleted.
CHAPTER XXV.
THE TRANSFER OF PRISONERS.
840. 1 A prisoner may be removed by order of the Inspector General of Prisons at any time not
exceeding two months prior to his release, either to the prison of the district to which he belongs or to
the prison nearest to his native place.
(2). Deleted.
(3). Deleted.
841. Deleted.
842. The previous sanction of the Ministry of Home Affairs (in case of detenues) or Inspector-
General of Prisons or the Deputy Inspector General of Prisons ,as the case may be, is necessary for the
transfer of any of the prisoners from one Jail to another, except-
(a) Prisoners required to give evidence or to undergo trial for an offence in another District.
(b) Youthful offenders transferred to a reformatory institution when a warrant for detention
in a reformatory institution is received.
(c) P.R.T. prisoner.
With regard to prisoners sent to appear in any court the provisions of part IX of the Prisoners
Act, 111 of 1900 and the rules framed under section 51 of the Act (see Appendix No.4) shall be
strictly observed. With regard to juveniles see Rule 966.
146
843. Subject to the sanction of the Inspector General or Deputy Inspector General of Prisons the
following transfers shall be made :-
(See Rule 30)
Class of prisoners. Purpose of transfer. Jail to which transfer is to be Period prior to Reference
made. expiry of sentence to
at which transfer is J.C.Rule
to be made.
Note.: Prisoners having unexpired period of 10 years of sentence or less may be retained in District
Jails subject to the approval of the D.I.G of Prisons . Prisoner having longer period of sentence,
however, may be detained in District Jail only with the permission of the Deputy Inspector General
of prisons/Inspector General of Prisons.
No prisoner shall be transferred -
(a) until he has been certified by the Medical Officer as physically fit to undertake the journey;
(b) until he has preferred his appeal or in case he declines to appeal the term of appeal period is over.
(c) while any dangerous epidemic is prevalent in either the transferring or receiving institution until
the Medical Officers of these institutions are mutually satisfied that transfer can be effected without
danger of contamination.
147
844. With every application for orders to transfer prisoners or report of transfer in anticipation of
sanction (which must be made immediately after prisoners have been despatched with the exception
allowed in Rule 855), a descriptive roll in J. Form No. 8 (Bangladesh Form No. 5069), stating the
numbers and names of prisoners to be transferred (or who have been transferred) shall be submitted to
the Inspector General of Prisons/Deputy Inspector General of Prisons as the case may be, by the
Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the Central/District jail (Rule 846). This roll shall contain
detailed information of each prisoner as required by the column headings to be extracted from
Register No.6. Columns 15 and 16 should be filled in with due consideration to the average character
of convicts as exhibited by the annual statistics. The report of the Medical Officer in column 17 is of
paramount importance as it is one of the biggest factors in determining whether the prisoner shall or
shall not be transferred; great care should, therefore, be exercised in compiling this report which
should be sufficiently detailed as to give the selecting officer a correct idea of the health and physical
capabilities of each prisoner. Full reasons for the transfer should be given in column 12 and such other
information as the Inspector General of Prisons/Deputy Inspector General of Prisons may require.
Note :-The fact of a prisoner being P.R.T should always be entered in descriptive roll.
845. Should any delay occur in transferring a prisoner the sanction for whose transfer depends on
his condition of health and capacity to perform hard labour, he shall not be transferred until the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail to which he is under orders for transfer has been consulted
and informed of the fact of the delay and the prisoner's present state of health; should the latter then
see any objection to the transfer he shall refer the matter to the Inspector-General for orders.
846. When transmitting rolls of prisoners for transfer to the Inspector General, the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail shall note in regard to each prisoner whether he sees any
objection to the transfer, and the Inspector General shall determine what prisoners shall be transferred.
The order of the Inspector General sanctioning the transfer shall contain only the serial numbers and
names of the prisoners, and shall be sent to the jail in which the prisoners are confined, the roll itself
being sent to the jail or jails to which the prisoners are to be transferred. A duplicate copy shall be
kept in the jail office.
847. It shall be the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent's duty to see that descriptive rolls of all
prisoners, whose transfer is desirable, especially long-term convicts, educated convicts, and convicts
possessing local influence, violent one are submitted to the Inspector General for orders. If overcrowding
be anticipated, the action ordered in Rule 1185 shall be taken by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent
without delay. The jailer shall also be held strictly responsible in these matters. He shall, on receipt of any
educated prisoner, or prisoner of local influence, or of a dangerous character, specially bring him to the
notice of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent and point out the rule, which requires his transfer.
848. All P.R. (police-registered) prisoners of the first class (see Rule 541), against whose names the
letter T appears in the Admission Registers and Release Diaries, also prisoners of classes I and II of
the remission rules who have earned conditional release, shall be transferred. The transfer shall be
made one month before the date of the expiry of their sentences (after deducting any remission
earned), and in other cases at any time not exceeding two months before that date.
849. deleted.
850. When a prisoner is transferred under the Extradition Act from a foreign Jail to any Jail in
Bangladesh to be tried for an offence committed in Bangladesh and is re-transferred to a foreign jail to
complete his term of imprisonment, the period passed by the prisoner in Bangladesh and in transit to
and fro, shall not count against the original sentence in the foreign jail.
148
851. If a P.R./T. prisoner is unfit, by reason of sickness, for transfer two months before his release,
the fact should be communicated to the Superintendent of Police of the District to which the prisoner
belongs and also to the local Superintendent of Police. If the prisoner subsequently becomes fit for
transfer in time to allow of his reaching the Jail of his District before his release is due, he shall then
be transferred. If when only a fortnight of his sentence remains to be served, he is still unfit for
transfer, his P.R. slip should be sent to the local police with a note of the fact on it, and on the day of
his release, he should be discharged at the Jail gate without further action being taken. Leper prisoners
marked P.R./T located in Jails set apart for persons so diseased, shall not be transferred to their home
Districts until only sufficient time is left for them to reach the Jail from which they are to be released
on the morning of their release, or the day before release. The P.R. slips of such prisoners shall be sent
to the Superintendent of Police of their Districts by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the
Leper Jails.
852. Prisoners who, in addition to a substantive sentence, are ordered to furnish security to keep
the peace, or in default to undergo further imprisonment, shall be transferred to the Jail of their
District two months before the substantive sentence expires to enable them, if possible to arrange for
furnishing the required security.
853. Prisoners sentenced to imprisonment for smuggling of dangerous drugs such as opium,
cocaine, heroin etc. shall be transferred to the jails of the district to which they belong at any time not
exceeding two months prior to their release. Descriptive rolls in triplicate of all such prisoners shall be
submitted in time to the Inspector General of Prisons/Deputy Inspector General of Prisons who will
sanction their transfer and at the same time inform the Department of Narcotics and Drug Control.
854. The rolls of female convicts for whom there is not sufficient accommodation in any Jail shall
be sent to the Deputy Inspector General of Prisons/Inspector General of Prisons for transfer to a jail
where accommodation and training facilities are available.
855. In the case of the Jails where there are no juvenile wards, as required under section 27 (2) of
Act 1X of 1894, such prisoners i.e. juveniles between 16 to 21 years of age should be transferred to
the Jail where separate enclosure for the confinement and reformatory training of the juvenile
offenders is available. Under no circumstances, the juvenile should be allowed to mix up with adult
offenders. There should be separate enclosure for the rigid seclusion of the juvenile offenders from the
adults in every Central and District Jails. The children under the age of 16 years should be transferred
to Tongi Juvenile Development Institution or similar Institutions.
856. Habitual convicts shall be kept separated from the casuals, if possible, in separate jails meant
for the habitual or in the same jail in the separate enclosure.
857. Deleted.
858. If notorious Jail breakers or other violent characters be imprisoned in an unsafe Jail, or if any
Jail officer or servant be imprisoned for a period of over one month, or if any relation of any Jail
officer, or any person of great local influence, or any person whose transfer to any other jail may be
regarded as expedient, be imprisoned, the descriptive roll of all such prisoners shall at once be sent to
the Inspector General of prisons/Deputy Inspector General of prisons, with a view to the transfer of
such prisoner.
858.A When a prisoner, who is likely to attract public attention, cause trouble etc. is under
order of transfer to another Jail, the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the receiving jail shall
be informed in advance. The Deputy Commissioner of the District from where the prisoner is
transferred as well as the Deputy Commissioner of the receiving District shall be informed beforehand
who will inform the fact to the Intelligence Branch of the Police for taking necessary security
measures.
149
859. Only prisoners sentenced to 10 years rigorous imprisonment and more, who are in good health
and fit for hard or medium labour and are not over 45 years of age shall ordinarily be transferred from
District to the Central Jails to which they are respectively affiliated.
Prisoners sentenced to10 years rigorous imprisonment or more, however, may be detained in
District Jails only with the sanction of the Deputy Inspector General of prisons of the Division or
Inspector General of Prisons as the case may be.
860. In order to discharge the duties of convict officers, sweepers, trade instructors, etc, in jails
where, owing to the short terms of sentence, prisoners locally confined are ineligible for such duties,
qualified prisoners shall be imported from the nearest Central jail. All applications for convicts
required for these purposes shall be addressed to the Inspector General. Only mether prisoners
sentenced to rigorous imprisonment, who are not P.R.T. prisoners who have served half of their
sentences or have not more than six months of unexpired sentence, shall be selected for conservancy
work in jails.
861. Transfer for the benefit of health should be recommended only in cases of prisoners in
indifferent health, who are not suffering from active or marked disease when a change to a healthier
climate will probably effect restoration to a normal condition of health. No prisoner should be
transferred who is in a bad state of health.
862. No prisoner shall be removed from one Jail to another unless the Medical Officer certifies that the
prisoner is free from any illness rendering him unfit for removal. On the day any prisoner is to be
transferred he shall be brought before the Medical Officer, who shall furnish a certificate (in J. Form No.
13) to the effect that each prisoner selected for transfer is in a fit condition to travel, and shall specify
whether the journey shall be undertaken on foot, by steamer, by boat, by train, or by other means of
conveyance. Aged and weakly prisoners shall not be sent away at unhealthy seasons. In the event of the
removal of those, who are unable or unfit to walk, being absolutely necessary, suitable means shall be
provided to carry them. It is the duty of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent to see that no prisoner,
who is incapable of bodily labour from age, sickness or infirmity or who has been exempted from labour
by his sentence, shall be recommended for transfer (unless under special circumstances which should be
stated in each case), or is transferred to another Jail without a special order from the Inspector General of
Prisons or Deputy Inspector General of Prisons as the case may be.
863. Every convict and under trial prisoner shall during transit be allowed to wear his own clothing
and shall be provided with eating and drinking vessels. If the prisoner has no suitable clothing, he
shall be provided by the Jail with clothing as stated below :-
1. Division III convict and Division II under trial, prisoners
a) For male-
b) For female-
(1) 1 cotton sharee.
(2) 2 cotton blowes.
(3) 2 under garments.
(4) 1Chadar/sweater in cold season.
(5) 1 Gamcha.
150
b) For female-
(1) 1 cotton sharee.
(2) 2 cotton blowes.
(3) 2 under garments.
(4) 1Chadar/sweater in cold season.
(5) 1 Towel.
If the journey is made during night a prisoner who has no suitable bedding shall be given a shatranjee
and blanket (two in the cold season).
864. Prisoners whether convicts, under trial or detenus shall be granted money allowance for food
at the rate of Tk.25/- (Twenty five Taka) per head per meal on travel. This rate may be changed/
revised by the Government time to time as required. The money should be given to the officer-in
charge of the police escort party by the Jail Authority.
865. Deleted.
866. For rules regulating the escort of prisoners whose attendance is required in court, (see
Appendix No.4).
867. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall send a separate written requisition in
Bangladesh Form No.5344 to the Superintendent of Police for every escort required to guard
prisoners in transfer from one jail to another or who have to be sent to a Court (including under trial
prisoners). Such requisition should state the number of prisoners to be guarded, their nationality,
Division, and sex, and whether there are any insane, violent or dangerous characters amongst them,
and should be delivered at least 48 hours (exclusive of Fridays and holidays) before the escort is
required.
After a requisition has been sent to him, the duty of providing the escort shall devolve on the
Superintendent of Police. Intimation of the proposed transfer shall be sent (in B.J.Form No.12), by the
first post to the jail which is to receive the prisoners. This will enable the receiving jail to take full
advantage of the return escort in transferring any police registered or other prisoners to the jail from
which the escort started, or to any intervening jail on the line of railway, and thus effect a considerable
saving to Government.
868 The scale prescribed for escorts for prisoners by road, country boats, rail and steamer are given below-
(1) Prisoners by road and country boat
Asstt. Sub- Head
Nk. Constables
Inspectors Constables
1 to 3 Prisoners - - - 02
4 to 10 Prisoners - - - 04
11 to 15 Prisoners - 01 - 05
16 to 25 Prisoners - 01 01 08
26 to 50 Prisoners - 01 01 12
51 to 75 Prisoners 01 02 02 20
76 to 100 Prisoners 01 02 02 30
(ii) Prisoners by rail and steamer
Asstt. Sub- Head
Nk. Constables
Inspectors Constables
1 Prisoner - - - 02
2 to 5 prisoners - 01 - 02
6 to 10 Prisoners - 01 01 04
11 Prisoner and upwards- In the proportion of four constables to every six prisoners and one head constable
to every eight constables.
151
(iii) Under trial prisoners to and from courts
Asstt. Sub- Head
Nk. Constables
Inspectors Constables
1 Prisoner - - - 02
2 to 6 prisoners - - - 04
7 to 10 Prisoners - 01 - 04
11 Prisoners and upwards same scale as for escort of prisoners by road.
(iv) Female prisoners when escorted singly should be accompanied by two constables, who should
be selected for their age and respectability of character. A female warder will also accompany the party
when the prisoner travels on transfer.
Note-1. It will be seen that the larger the group transferred, the smaller comparatively need be the
escort. It is of extreme importance in transferring prisoner that escort should, whenever possible, be
utilized to the utmost. The great economy in arranging for a maximum number of prisoners for each
group according to the scale is obvious.
Note-2. Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of jails should, when escorts are leaving, satisfy
themselves that full advantage is in every case taken to transfer all qualified prisoners.
Note-3. The transfer of prisoners between the adjacent jails may be made under the escort of jail
warders.
N.B.- Size and composition will vary according to the relevant PRB rule.
869. All prisoners to be transferred shall be carefully searched before they are made over to the
police escort to see that they do not take any prohibited articles with them, especially files, weapons,
string, silk, matchbox, liquor, lighter, blade, money or any article calculated to facilitate escape.
870. While in transit, female and juvenile prisoners shall be separated as far as possible from adult
male prisoners.
Female prisoners whether convicted or under trial shall invariably be accompanied by a female
warder to be furnished by the Jail Department. The female warder shall draw travelling allowance at
ordinary rates from the Jail from which she is sent.
871. Male prisoners on the march (except convict overseers) shall be handcuffed in couples, the
right wrist of one prisoner being attached to the left wrist of the other. When the number under escort
consists of an odd number, 3,5,7,9, etc., the odd man will be handcuffed to two other prisoners. His
load shall be divided amongst other prisoners. Male prisoners may also be fettered, if required by the
rules of the Police Department; but, if this is done, gaiters shall be provided for each prisoner to
prevent abrasion of the skin. Life term prisoners despatched to a Central Jail to undergo sentence
should be fettered. Handcuffs will be supplied by the Police Department, but riveted fetters and gaiters
will be supplied by the Jail Department. Leg irons and gaiters should be kept in stock ready for use. No
female prisoner shall be handcuffed or fettered.
872. When delivering prisoners for transfer into the custody of the escort, the Jailer shall make over
to the officer in charge of the escort a sum of money sufficient to meet all expenses allowed under the
foregoing rules, also a warrant credit note (B.J. Form No. 18) , for the number of fares to be paid under
Rule 877, the Government and prisoners' property to accompany the prisoners and the following
documents :-
(a) The original warrants, with High Court Form No.38, of all the convicts Upon the warrant shall be
endorsed the date of transfer and jail to which transferred (see also Rule 773 regarding
remission).
(b) Copies of the orders of the Court requiring the attendance of prisoners.
(c) A list of all Government property, clothing, bedding, utensils, etc, prisoners' private clothing and
other property to be taken with the prisoners, for delivery of all of which at the jail to which the
prisoners are to go, the officer is responsible (B.J. Form No 13). If any prisoner is of dangerous
character the fact should be noted on this list.
(d) The prisoners' history tickets.
(e) The prisoners' remission cards (B.J. Register No. 18).
152
(f) The Medical Officers' certificate.
(g) P.R. slips, if any.
(h) A descriptive roll in B.J. From No. 8
(i) Return No 8. For the detenus.
(j) Deleted.
A receipt shall be taken from the officer in charge of the escort for the number of
prisoners and all Government and prisoners' property delivered to him with them, on a duplicate
copy of the list referred to in clause (c).
873. As a general rule where there is rail or water carriage or other means of public transport,
prisoners shall be conveyed by these means, except when the distance to be travelled is short.
874. Special means of conveyance shall be provided for the carriage of any prisoner in whose case
the Medical Officer certifies that a conveyance is necessary. Suitable conveyance shall also be provided
for prisoners who are dangerous when passing through the streets. The Superintendent of Police or
concerned Police authority will determine the mode of transport.
875. Prisoners shall not be sent by mail trains except when, for special reasons, their conveyance by
such trains may be necessary, in which case the higher fares chargeable for journeys by mail trains
must be paid. Removable iron gratings will be fixed by the railway authorities to the openings of
compartments reserved for prisoners; at least 48 hours' notice must be given by the jail (in B. J. Form
No.17) to the station master of the station whence prisoners will start, of the number of reserved
compartments which will be required.
876. 1 The Senior Superintendent/Superintendents of transferring jails shall so arrange that prisoners
transferred may reach their destination before lock-up.
(2) Deleted.
877. No insane, violent or dangerous prisoner and no party of prisoners and guards, when their
aggregate number exceeds three, shall be despatched by rail, except in reserved compartments. The
number of persons carried in a reserved compartment must in no case be in excess of the number which
the compartment is designed to hold. Payment is to be made according to the number of compartments
required for the carriage of the whole party of guards and prisoners, irrespective of the number carried
in the compartment and should not be less than the marked maximum carrying capacity of the
compartment, e. g, supposing a party to consist of 31 persons and each compartment to be adapted for
the carriage of 10 persons, payment should be made for four compartments i.e., 40 fares. Prisoners and
guards, when the party, inclusive of guards, does not exceed three in number, and reserved
accommodation is not needed, must be paid for at the ordinary rates in force on the line. The police will
pay the fares of the escort and the balance of the number of fares for each party will be paid by the
concerned Chief Accounts Officer on the credit note system (vide Rule 1369).
Note - Arrangements for the conveyance of under trial prisoners shall be made by the police, the cost
of warrants (credit notes) issued for the transport of prisoners being debited to the head 2251-Prisons
Directorate out of the allotments placed at the disposal of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent.
878. The officer in charge of the escort shall, on reaching his destination, render a detailed account
of the funds entrusted to him to the Jailer of the receiving jail, who, after examining it, shall take over
any balance that may be due and remit it into the treasury. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent
shall finally send the account to the transmitting officer with such remarks as he may consider
necessary.
879. On arrival of the prisoners at the receiving jail, the Jailer of that jail shall proceed as follows :-
(1) He shall receive from the officer in charge of the escort all the documents mentioned in Rule 872
and the account mentioned in Rule 878, with any balance of the money advanced that may be
unexpended.
(2) He shall see that he receives the correct number of prisoners. If any prisoner is missing, he will
ascertain the cause from the officer in charge of the escort; and record the fact on the receipt to
be given to the officer in charge of the escort; he will also report it to the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent.
153
(3) He shall see that he receives all Government and prisoners property according to the lists from
the dispatching jail. If anything is missing, he shall note the fact upon the receipt to be given to
the officer in charge of the escort and opposite the particular item in the lists . These lists shall be
sent by post to the despatching jail, whence the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall
report any loss to the Superintendent of Police and claim the value of the property. Should the
property have been lost through the carelessness or connivance of the escort, the cost of replacing
it shall be levied from those in fault. If any Government or prisoners' property is found to be
missing, the explanation of the officer in charge of the escort shall be obtained on the spot and
recorded on the receipt.
(4) He shall question the prisoners as to their treatment on the road, the halts made, and whether they
received their meals as ordered in Rule 864. Any statement to the contrary, or complaints made,
shall be noted on the receipt to be given to the officer in charge of the escort, and reported to the
Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent in the Jailer's report book.
(5) Before dismissing the escort he shall see whether any prisoners have to be transferred to the jail
of the District whence it came or to any other jail enroute, and if there are, he shall deliver to the
escort with all necessary documents and procedure prescribed in the above rules so many of the
prisoners as the strength of the escort is sufficient to guard.
(6) When dismissing the escort he shall deliver to the officer in charge thereof a certificate in P.R.B.
Form No 11 (Command Certificate).
880. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall see that the clothing blankets and bedding
supplied to the prisoners from the despatching jail are serviceable; if they are not, he shall report the
fact to the Inspector General. If any prisoner makes a complaint of ill-treatment on the road, or that he
did not get his meals as ordered, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall personally enquire into
the matter, and report the circumstances to the Magistrate of the District, at the same time sending a
copy of his report to the Inspector General.
881. Prisoners who fall sick in transit shall not be attached to any other prisoners, but shall be
allowed, while they remain sick, to travel separately. When a prisoner becomes seriously ill on the road
so as to be unfit for travelling, he shall be left at the next police station or outpost, to be taken, as soon
as he can be moved to the nearest jail and shall there be treated by the Medical Officer, and a report of
the circumstances shall be made to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendents of the despatching jail
and of the jail to which the prisoner was travelling.
882. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail which a sick prisoner on transit is taken
shall receive and detain him, until well enough to proceed to his destination. The warrant and all papers
connected with the prisoner should be made over to the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the
jail at which he is detained, and a note of the circumstances of detention shall be made upon his history
ticket. On recovery, he shall be forwarded to his destination with his papers, and a report of the
despatch of the prisoner shall be sent to the jail to which he is to be consigned and to the Inspector
General.
883. When a prisoner in course of transfer dies, the Magistrate of the District in which
such prisoner died shall hold an enquiry into the circumstances attending such death; and
shall report the result of his investigation without delay to the Inspector General. This
report shall contain a full and formal finding in addition to the statements of witnesses
Rule 806 examined. The fact and date of death shall be noted on the warrant, which, with other
papers, and the property belonging to the prisoner, shall be returned to the jail from which
the prisoner came. Deaths of convicts in course of transfer shall not be included in
individual jail statistics unless specially directed by the Inspector General; they shall
however be shown in jail statistics.
884. If an escape occur en route, intimation shall at once be given to the authorities of the locality of
the escape, who shall take steps for the prisoner's recapture. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent
of the jail to which the convict should have been taken, and the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent
of the jail from which the prisoner came, shall also be informed of the escape; and the latter, in
conjunction with the authorities of his district, will take the usual measures to secure the prisoner's re
apprehension. If he is not immediately recaptured, the warrant and the other documents relating to the
prisoner, and the prisoner's property, shall be returned to the jail from which he was despatched.
154
885. The rolls of all prisoners who have been convicted of escaping from lawful custody shall be submitted,
by the Superintendent of the District jails, to the Inspector General for sanction to their transfer to central jails. An
entry, in red ink, under the name of each prisoner shall be made as follows:-
Escaped from police, or escaped from jail, as the case may be.
Note- So far as they are applicable, the rules of this chapter shall apply to prisoners travelling by water
or any other means.
Rule 7 887. If there be a separate civil jail the Superintendent of the criminal jail shall be
Superintendent of the civil jail also; and the Inspector General of Prisons, Magistrate, official
and non official visitors, and Medical Officer, Jailer and other subordinate jail officials shall
have the same powers as regards both civil and criminal prisoners except where distinction is
made in these rules.
6 Persons detained in the civil prison under any other law for the time being in force.
889. No civil prisoners shall be admitted into jail after the prisoners have been locked up at sunset
for the night, except the written order of the Court. (With regard to the search of civil prisoners on
admission and their property, see Rules 504 and 543).
890. Under Rule No. 39, Order XXI, First Schedule of the Civil Procedure Code, judgement debtors
shall be dieted at the expense of the decree holders. In the case of judgement-debtors under the Public
Demands Recovery Act, 1913, the Certificate Officer may either forward diet-money with the prisoner,
or order that he shall be fed on the non-labouring scale at the expense of Government. Civil prisoners
of class (5) and class (6) shall be allowed the diet of under trial prisoners (see Rule 1092), at the
expense of Government. If specially so ordered by the committing officer, civil prisoner of both classes
(4) and (5) shall receive the diet sanctioned for misdemeanants of the first degree in rule 936.
891. Where a judgement-debtor is committed to the civil prison in execution of a decree, the Court
shall fix the monthly allowance for his subsistence in accordance with the scale approved by High
Court (Rule 892). The first payment shall be made to the proper officer of the Court for such portion of
the current month as remains unexpired before the judgement debtor is committed to the civil prison,
and such officer shall send the amount paid with the civil prisoner to the Jailer. No debtor shall be
received into the jail unless the proper amount of subsistence allowance is received with him.
Subsequent payment (if any become due) shall be made to the Jailer by monthly payments in advance
to the full amount due for the ensuing month before the first day of each month. Should the decree-
holder omit to pay the allowance as above, the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall, without
reference to the Court, release the judgment debtor. The release shall be made on the morning of the
day for which no allowance has been paid. A receipt from counter foil book (B.J. Form No. 78), shall
be given to the decree-holder for subsistence money paid into the jail, the amount received being
credited in the contingent cash-book.(see Rule 1351, regarding the record of receipt and disbursement
of civil prisoner's diet-money.)
155
892. The Court in fixing the amount of monthly allowance for the subsistence of a judgment-debtor
committed to civil prison should take into consideration only the class of the prisoner and not his race
or nationality [High Court Rule 15 of 1932 (civil)]. The following scale has been approved by the High
Court as a guide to the discretion of courts in fixing the amount for the individual case. It is not to be
treated as a rigid scale.
1.
Third Division (includes persons of the day-labourer class and of similar status and similar
mode of living) shall be entitled to diet of Division III Convicts.)
2.
Second Division (includes persons of the artisan class of similar status and similar mode of
living) shall be entitled to diet of Division III Convicts.
3.
First Division (includes persons superior to those of the second Division in status and mode
of living) shall be entitled to diet of Division II Convicts).
893(1) The date of release of a civil prisoner in anticipation of his having to complete the whole term
of his imprisonment shall be calculated according to Rule 524, and his name shall be entered
in the Release Diary under that date (i.e. date of release).
(2) If a civil prisoner is ordered to be detained in a civil jail under more than one warrant, each
warrant shall have full effect from the date thereof, although the prisoner may thus be
detained beyond six months.
894. Every person detained in the civil prison in execution of a decree shall be so detained-
(a) where the decree is for payment of a sum of money exceeding fifty Taka, for a period of six
months, and
(b) in any other case, for a period of six weeks ; Provided that he shall be released from such
detention before the expiration of the said period of six months or six weeks, as the case may
be-
(i) on the amount mentioned in the warrant for his detention being paid to the officer in charge of
the civil prison, or
(ii) on the decree against him being otherwise fully satisfied, or
(iii) on the request of the person on whose application he has been so detained, or
(iv) on the omission by the person, on whose application he has been so detained, to pay
subsistence allowance, or
(v) on the omission of the person (being a private person) on whose application he has been so
detained, to pay to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent the cost of the clothing and
bedding supplied by him.
Provided, also, that he shall not be released from such detention under clause (ii) or clause (iii)
without the order of the Court.
The provisions of this rule shall apply as far as possible to judgment-debtors detained in a Civil
Prison under an order from a Certificate-Officer under the Public Demands Recovery Act (Act III of
1913). The period of detention in such cases may, however, be less than six months or six weeks, as the
case may be, at the discretion of the Certificate-Officer.
895. A judgment-debtor may be released from the civil prison-
(a) by the Government on the ground of the existence of any infectious or contagious disease or
(b) by the committing Court, or any Court to which that court is subordinate, on the ground of his
suffering from any serious illness.
896. After a civil prisoner has been released, if there is any balance of diet-money in the Jailor's
hands, it shall be returned to the Court. For every such refund of diet-money a receipt shall be taken
and pasted into the cash-book opposite the entry to which it relates.
156
897. Civil prisoners shall be allowed to use their own clothes, bedding and cooking utensils and to
purchase or receive from private sources food, clothing and bedding or other necessaries. If a civil
prisoner is unable to provide himself with sufficient clothing and bedding, the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent shall supply such clothing and bedding as may, in his opinion, be necessary.
898. Whenever clothing or bedding is so supplied to a civil prisoner who has been committed to jail
in execution of a decree in favour of a private person, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall
submit to such person an account of the cost of the clothing or bedding with a demand in writing for
payment of the cost, and if payment is not made within 48 hours of receipt of this demand, the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent shall release the civil prisoner in respect of whom the demand was
made. The name and address of the judgment creditor shall be ascertained from the Civil Court which
issued the decree. The demand shall be despatched by registered letter to the address of the judgement
creditor and after sufficient time for delivery thereof has elapsed shall be deemed to have been duly
received. When the time allowed by law has elapsed, if payment has not been made, the Jailer shall
bring the civil prisoner before the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent for release. Before releasing
the prisoner, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall satisfy himself, firstly, that the demand
was duly sent, and that sufficient time, as required by law, for delivery of the demand and for payment
has been given; secondly, that payment has not been tendered or made.
899. If clothing and bedding have been supplied at the expense of the decree-holder, there shall, at
the time of the release of the judgment-debtor, be issued by registered letter to the decree- holder a
notice informing him that if the clothing and bedding are not claimed by him on or before a certain date
they will be sold at his risk. The clothing and bedding may be sold accordingly and the proceeds
deposited with the Court.
900. Civil prisoners may be supplied with food by their friends through the jailor at such hours as
the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall fix, in which case the subsistence allowance deposited
by the detaining creditor may be made over to such friends; but in other cases it shall be credited to the
jail and the Jailer shall supply the prisoners with good and wholesome food according to their own
choice, provided that the daily cost does not exceed the amount lodged by the detaining creditor. If it is
preferred, the money may be given to the prisoner and arrangements made for allowing him to
purchase the food which he requires from the jail contractor or from an approved shopkeeper. Civil
prisoners supplied with food at Government expense under Rule 890 shall have their food cooked by
convicts in the convict's cook-house and supplied by convict cooks. Other civil prisoner shall cook
their own food. If any extra articles of diet are ordered by the Medical Officer for civil prisoners on
medical grounds, any excess of cost beyond the daily diet- money shall be paid by Government.
901. Civil prisoners may be allowed to smoke, but not to use intoxicating drugs or liquors, unless
prescribed by the Medical Officer. All purchases or supplies of food, clothing, bedding or other
necessaries shall be made through the Jailer subject to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent's
sanction, and shall be examined by the Jailer before delivery to a civil prisoner. Food shall be examined
by the Assistant Surgeon and shall not be delivered if it contains any intoxicating drug or liquor or is
unwholesome. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may refuse to allow the purchase or delivery
of anything which he considers to be unnecessary or unsuitable.
902. No part of any food, clothing, bedding or other articles belonging to or delivered to, any civil
prisoner shall be given, hired or sold to any other prisoner. Any civil prisoner transgressing this rule
shall lose the privilege of purchasing food or receiving it from private sources for such time as the
Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent thinks proper and any civil prisoner committing an offence
under section 42 of Act IX of 1894 shall be prosecuted before a Magistrate.
903. Benefactions or donations of money or other articles, except intoxicating drugs or liquors, may
be distributed to civil prisoners according to the desire of the donor, if not contrary to these rules. They
may be allowed books from the jail library, and they may be permitted to obtain, at their own expense,
any books and newspapers of an unobjectionable kind as may be approved by the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent. They should also be allowed harmless indoor games. No visitor shall
be allowed to take within the civil jail, any sweetmeats or other articles of consumption, without the
permission of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent.
157
904. Civil prisoners shall be permitted to maintain themselves. They should be encouraged to
work at such trade or calling as they like, subject to the approval of the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent, and should be allowed to receive the profits thereupon; but if jail implements be
supplied to them, a reasonable deduction for the hire of the implements shall be made from the profits,
and, in the case of those maintained at Government expense, also deduction for maintenance. No civil
prisoner shall be compelled to work against his will, but cleanliness of person and clothing shall be
enforced.
905. Civil prisoners must be clean and properly dressed when leaving their rooms or wards during
the day; they must stand up when any inspecting officer or authorised visitor visits the civil ward, must
answer any questions put to them by such officers or visitors in the discharge of their duty, and
otherwise treat them with respect; and they must comply with the regulations of the jail and the Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent's orders. Any civil prisoner assaulting or insulting another prisoner or
jail officer, or quarrelling or talking loudly and boisterously, or guilty of indecent or immoral conduct,
or communicating with outsiders in an unauthorised manner, or bribing or attempting to bribe any jail
officer, or gambling or spitting about and soiling the ward verandah or passages or disobeying the
orders of or showing disrespect to the jail authorities in any way, may be punished by minor
punishments Nos. 1, 7 and 8 or major punishment No. 4 or may be punished according to any law in
force.
906. Any jail officer who may intentionally or negligently suffer a civil prisoner to escape is liable
to be punished under section 222 or 223 of the Penal Code, as the case may be. The civil prisoner by
escaping commits an offence under section 225 B of the Penal Code. On the occurrence of an escape of
a civil prisoner intimation shall be given to the judgement-creditor who may, if he be able to ascertain
the whereabouts of the prisoner, assist the jail authorities and the police in re-capturing him. On re-
capture after escape, or on the occurrence of an attempt to escape, the prisoner shall be prosecuted
before a Criminal Court under section 225B of the Penal Code.
907. A notice shall be posted up in the civil ward of every jail to the effect that all information and
assistance will be furnished by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent to those civil prisoners who
may wish to be declared insolvents. Petitions of insolvency may be written by a jail official, and such
paper and writing materials as are necessary may be supplied.
Note:- Deleted
908. The following registers shall be maintained in respect of the civil prisoners detained in any jail:-
No. 9. Register of civil prisoners.
Column 5 :- For race, religion or caste:- If Christian the denomination to be mentioned; if Muslim, the
sect; if Hindu, the caste.
Column 8 :- In describing a prisoner, colour, distinguishing marks, and other peculiarities sufficient to
identify him, shall be recorded.
Column 13:- To show cause of release whether on account of satisfaction of decree or completion of
period of imprisonment, on furnishing security, by escape, or death, etc.
Column15:- Should record whether in sound health or sick on admission and discharge; if sick, the
class, order, and specific disease, with physical condition and previous ailments, as far as can be
ascertained, shall be entered.
Column 16- Is to furnish an account of the receipts and disbursement of diet-money. All receipts
of diet-money from detaining creditors and daily payments of diet-money to civil prisoners shall be
entered in the Cash-book, Register No. 31, at the time of receipt and payment. Amounts received
should also be entered at the time of receipt in the receipt side of the account in column 16, and at the
end of each month, and on discharge of a prisoner, the total of the daily payments recorded in the cash -
book shall be entered on the disbursement side of that column. If on discharge of a civil prisoner any
balance of diet-money remains unexpended, it shall be dealt with as directed in Rule 896.
Note:- With regard to interviews and communications, see Rules 682 and 688.
CHAPTER XXVII. -UNDER TRIAL PRISONERS.
158
909. A Court may order an accused person to be detained in, or remanded to custody in, jail. Provided
that, except in case of persons committed for trial at a court of sessions, no person shall be ordered to
be detained in or remanded to jail for a period exceeding 15 days at a time, and provided that every
such order made by a Court other than High Court shall be in writing signed by the presiding Judge or
Magistrate.
Note.- Accused persons so confined in jail will be referred to in this Code as under trial
prisoners.
910. (1) Under trial prisoners shall be divided into two Divisions, viz., Division I under trial (i.e.
classified) and Division II (i.e. non classified or ordinary) under trial. Division I (i.e. classified) under
trial shall include all prisoners who by social status, education and habit of life have been accustomed
to a superior mode of living, while Division-II (i.e. non-classified or ordinary) under trial shall include
prisoners whose status and mode of living are not superior to the ordinary and who are consequently
not eligible for Division I. The classification of under trials will be done by the trying Courts, District
Magistrates, Chief Metropolitan Magistrates or Session Judges considering the previous standard of
living which will be the sole criterion.
(2) Division I under trial shall be kept separate from Division II under trials.
(3) Under trial prisoners both male and female shall be strictly segregated from convicted
prisoners in the same jail or in a separate jail for the under trials, and arrangements shall be made,
where male under trial prisoners under the age of 21 are confined, for separating them altogether from
other prisoners, and for separating those of them who have arrived at the age of puberty from those
who have not.
(4) Notwithstanding anything contained in sub-rule (1) Division I under trial prisoners shall include the
following persons, namely-
(i) Persons formerly placed within serial No. 1-18 in the Warrant of Precedence published by
the Government.
(ii) Presidents and Secretaries of the Central Committees of such political parties who has got
representation in the parliament.
(iii) The persons honored with Gallantry Award of Bir Uttam, Bir Bikram and Bir Protik.
(iv) The persons honored with the Independence Award or Ekushe Award.
(v) The persons currently enjoying the honor of Commercially Important Person (CIP).
(vi) Such other persons as may be determined by the Ministry of Home Affairs, from time to
time, in consultation with the Ministry of Law, Justice and Parliamentary Affairs.
(vii) The persons once appointed a Professor Emiratus.
(5) The Senior Superintendent or the Superintendent of the respective Central and District Jail are
empowered to provide Division to the persons specified in sub-rule (4).
(6) The appointed lawyer or relatives of the prisoners may provide necessary information in this regard.
If there be any confusion as regard to the provided information, the jail authority shall first
provisionally allow Division to individual and then refer the matter to the Government.
911. Rules relating to the admission, search, release, and property of prisoners apply to prisoner's
under trial and will be found in Chapter IX. Except in the case of prisoner committed to the Sessions,
on every warrant should be stated the day on which the prisoner is to be brought up before the
Magistrate or other officer issuing the warrant. In Sessions cases when the date is fixed for the
production of a prisoner it should be endorsed by the Jailor or any other executive officer deputed by
the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent on the warrant and prisoner's history ticket; the prisoner shall
be duly informed of the date fixed for holding of the Sessions so that he may make all needful
arrangements for the conduct of his defence. The number and name of every under trial prisoner may
be roughly entered in the Release Diary at the top of the page relating to the date on which each is to be
produced in Court, but in central jails where large numbers are kept under detention, it will be more
convenient to keep the warrants in a special almirah having a pigeon- hole for each day of the month.
159
912. Any under trial prisoner whom the trying Magistrate or the police notify to be a confessing
prisoner shall be kept separate from others concerned in the same case. When there are separate cells or
compartments in the under trial ward these should be utilized for the purpose. If there is not any
separate compartment, such prisoners may be kept in separate cells by day and in separate wards by
night, but care must be taken that they are not kept in solitary confinement. A confessing under trial
prisoner shall have the company of other under trial prisoners not connected with his case, or if this
cannot be arranged, an extra warder may be entertained to keep him company. If a cell is used for
segregating a confessing under trial prisoner, he shall be allowed the use of the yard in front of the cell.
Any special direction as to the separation of an unconvinced criminal prisoner given by the Magistrate
shall be carried out. Such separation should be unaccompanied by any irksome conditions beyond
those necessary to secure the object in view, namely, to prevent his communicating directly or
indirectly with other prisoners concerned in the same or other cases.
913. Test identification shall, whenever circumstances permit, be held inside the jail. The above rules
are applicable in the case of an under trial prisoner or a suspect in jail. Men on bail shall not be mixed
up with under trial prisoners except with the permission of the Magistrate. In the case of confessing
accused, separate test identification parade shall be held unless the Magistrate insists that it is essential
to mix confessing with non-confessing accused and hold the test identification parade simultaneously.
In subsidiary Jails the accused shall, if necessary, be mixed up with outsiders for holding the test
identification parade simultaneously.
914. It is the duty of the jail authorities to endeavour by all the means in their power to ascertain
whether an under trial prisoner has been previously convicted. Information on this point shall
invariably be supplied to the Superintendent of Police in B.J. Form No. 23. This form will also be
submitted to the Magistrate when subsequent to conviction it is discovered that a prisoner has been
previously convicted. If possible, under trial prisoners who are known to be habitual criminals shall be
kept separate from those who are not. Juvenile under trial prisoners shall be segregated from adults,
and prisoners committed to the Sessions from those charged with minor offences, as far as is possible.
914(A). Probation Officer of Social Welfare Department shall have lawful access into Jail. He will
work in co-ordination with the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent as per existing rules and
regulations.
915. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall report to the Magistrate/Judge all cases of under
trial prisoners admitted for bailable offences, specifying the names of the persons who, the prisoners
respectively state, are likely to furnish bail. Senior Superintendent/ Superintendents shall also submit to
the Magistrate in return No. 27 fortnightly reminders regarding all cases in which prisoners have been
detained under trial for more than 14 days. Cases awaiting trial at the next Sessions shall not be
referred to in these reminders. The Inspector General may call for an explanation from a Magistrate in
cases where under trial prisoners have been detained in hajut an unusual length of time, and, if the
explanation does not seem satisfactory, may bring the case to the notice of the Commissioner or
Government.
If date for production of an under trial prisoner before the court is not found, jail authority
shall take necessary action by coordinating with respective court and Public Prosecutor.
916. On the date entered in the original warrant, or on the date fixed by any subsequent orders, under
trial prisoners shall be placed in the custody of the police to be taken to Court. If any prisoner wishes
that cash belonging to him in the hands of the Jailer shall be returned to him when sent to Court to
enable him to pay for legal assistance, this may be done, and a receipt shall be taken from the prisoner,
otherwise such money shall be retained by the Jailer and shall, if the prisoner be released in Court, be
delivered to him at the jail gate together with his private property on his application.
160
917. The names of all prisoners to be produced each day before the Magistrate must be entered in the
Hajut Register (Bangladesh Form No. 3831) by the Court Officer, whose duty it is to ensure the
punctual attendance of prisoners at Court on the day fixed. The officer commanding the Court Officers
guard will produce the register to the Jailer or Deputy Jailer in charge of admission section who will
make over under written acknowledgement for production before the Magistrate those prisoners,
together with their warrants whose production has been duly ordered and whose names are entered
therein. The Jailer or Deputy Jailer as the case may be shall also initial in column 4 of this register the
entry of the name of every prisoner received from court either on remand or conviction. Whenever
possible, prisoners shall be conveyed to and from the court in a prison van. There shall be separate
compartment in the prison van for conveying female prisoners to and from the court.
918. If an under trial prisoner has more than one case pending against him in the same or different
courts, a cross reference on the back of each warrant for intermediate custody shall be made in red ink
under a dated initial of the Superintendent in the following form:-
Another case pending. Not to be released from Court.
A notice of discharge as required by jail Code Rule 920 shall be sent by the court to the jail when
an under trial prisoner is discharged from the case in which he had appeared before the court, so that
necessary corrections in other intermediate custody warrants may be made by the jail.
918.1 An under trial prisoners may be allowed all reasonable facilities at their own cost for preparing
notes and collecting papers in connection with their defense and to take these with them to the courts at
the time of their production. Ordinarily such notes and papers should not be examined by the Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent. But if he has reason to suppose that these contain matters not relating
to their cases he may inspect them for the purpose of verifying whether it is so. For confidential
instructions of under trial prisoners to their legal advisers, see Rule 687.
919. On receipt of a warrant or order of revision directing the release of an under trial prisoner, if
not otherwise required to be detained in the jail by an order of the competent authority as per law in
any other case, he shall be at once released (unless the order be received after the wards are locked up
for the night, in which case he shall be released immediately after the wards are opened next morning)
and the warrant of detention and order of release shall be returned to the Court which issued them, with
an endorsement by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent certifying that the order of release has
been carried out. All the properties of the under trial prisoner shall be made over to them on release
whether from the jail or from the Court. For procedure when a sentence is annulled and a retrial
ordered, see Rule 611.
920. If an under trial prisoner be discharged in open Court, or released on bail while attending the
Court, by the Magistrate or Sessions Judge, a notification of the fact under the signature of the officer
so discharging or releasing him shall be sent on the same day to the Jailer.
921. The weight of every under trial prisoner on release shall be recorded in the Under trial
Register. In the case of under trial prisoners who are released from Court the last weighment recorded
on the history ticket prior to release shall be taken to be the weight on release.
922. (1) An unconvinced criminal prisoner shall be subjected to as little interference as is consistent
with the maintenance of order and discipline in the jail and with his safe custody ; but he shall keep
himself and his clothing and bedding clean. He shall be allowed to change his clothes, provided that his
appearance is not thereby materially altered. He shall also be allowed to retain his shoes.
(2) He should be encouraged to work at such trade or calling as he likes, subject to the approval of
the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent and should be allowed to receive the profits thereupon. But
if jail implements be supplied to him, a reasonable deduction for the hire of the implements shall be
made from the profits, and in the case of those maintained at Government expense, also deduction for
maintenance. He may be required to keep the ward cell or other compartment occupied by him clean, if
accustomed to do similar work in his own home.
(3) He shall be advised to take walking exercise for not more than one hour in the morning and
one hour in the evening, if the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent and the Medical Officer consider
it advisable.
(4) No work of a degrading character shall be exacted from any unconvicted criminal prisoner, and
in no case he shall be employed outside his own enclosure.
161
923. An under trial prisoner may obtain his food as well as clothing, bedding and other necessaries
at proper hours at his own expense or from his friends and relations subject to examination and to such
rules as may be approved by the Inspector General. The food so obtain shall be simple in character and
in a form in which it can be taken without further preparation. If the prisoner elects to obtain the entire
food from outside, no food shall be supplied to him from jail.
An under trial prisoner may be allowed books from the jail library. He may also be allowed to
procure from outside at his own expense and in reasonable quantity books, newspapers, stationery and
writing materials subject to the approval of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent. Facilities for
harmless indoor games may also be provided at the cost of the prisoner subject to the sanction of the
Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent,
Purchase of all articles of food, clothing, bedding or other necessaries by an under trial prisoner or
supplies thereof by his friends and relations shall be made through the Jailer who shall examine them before
delivery to the prisoner. Nothing deleterious to health and no drugs or intoxicants shall be allowed to a
prisoner. Food supplied from private sources shall be examined by the Medical Officer who shall report to
the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent if it contains anything prohibited or deleterious to health. If any
prohibited articles as specified in Rule 660 is found concealed in any food or other thing supplied to an
under trial prisoner, such food or thing shall be confiscated to Government. The prisoner shall be allowed to
procure at his own cost or at the cost of his friends and relations betel nuts as well as tobacco for smoking in
quantities which the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent considers to be reasonable. The Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent may refuse to allow the purchase for or delivery to an under trial prisoner of
anything which he considers to be unnecessary or unsuitable.
924. No part of any food, clothing, bedding or other necessaries belonging to any unconvicted
criminal prisoner shall be given, hired or sold to any other prisoner; and any prisoner transgressing the
provisions of this section shall lose the privilege of purchasing food or receiving it from private sources
for such time, as the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent thinks proper.
925. Every unconvicted criminal prisoner who is inadequately clad or is unable to obtain clothing
from outside, shall be provided with bedding and suitable clothing which shall not be prison clothing,
by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail. All purchases or supplies of food, clothing,
bedding or other necessaries shall be made through the jailer, subject to the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent's sanction, and shall be examined by the Jailer before delivery to an under trial
prisoner; nothing deleterious to health and no drug or intoxicating liquor shall be allowed. Food
supplied from private sources shall be examined by the Jailer and by the Medical Officer who shall
report to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent if it contains any thing prohibited or deleterious to
health. If any prohibited article is found concealed in any food or other thing supplied to an under trial
prisoner under the two preceding rules, such food or thing shall be confiscated to Government, and the
privileges accorded in the above Rule 923 shall be withdrawn. Rule 660 defining what are prohibited
articles applies also to under trial prisoners. But they should be allowed to procure at their own cost
betel and nuts as well as tobacco in reasonable quantities for use by way of chewing, smoking or
snuffing as the case may be. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may refuse to allow the
purchase for, or delivery to, an under trial prisoner of anything which he considers to be unnecessary
or unsuitable
926. Under trial prisoners shall be dieted according to the scale prescribed in Chapter XXXVI.
Division I under trial prisoners shall be given the diets prescribed for Divisions I and II convicts, and
Division II under trials the diets prescribed for Division III convicts. They shall have their food cooked
in the regular cookhouse by the convict cook.
927. Subject to the exceptions therein contained, the rules in Chapter XIX relating to jail offences
and punishments are applicable to under trial prisoners.
928. An under trial prisoner attempting to escape should be brought before the Magistrate for trial
under section 224, Penal Code, without delay.
162
929. The under trial ward shall be under the charge of a selected convict officer and shall at the
regular hours be visited by the groups employed in sweeping, supplying water, and giving food, under
custody of a jail official, who shall prevent their holding communication with any of the prisoners
under trial.
930. Particulars of all under trial prisoners, together with particulars of property brought to jail,
shall be entered in the Under trial Admission Register No. 8, see Rule 933. Every under trial prisoner
shall be furnished with a history ticket showing his name, date when first placed on trial, date of
admission to the jail, crime of which accused, previous convictions, if any are known, Court in which
the case is pending, whether he is a confessing prisoner or not, dates to which his trial has been
remanded, weight on admission and weight subsequently once a fortnight. Any marks of wounds,
bruises, etc., shall be carefully recorded on the history ticket, together with the prisoners' statement
concerning them. This ticket shall always be shown to an inspecting officer.
931. (1) In every case when an under trial prisoner is so seriously ill, as to be likely to die, the
Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall report the circumstance to the Magistrate, or, if the
prisoner is awaiting trial before the Sessions Court, to the Sessions Judge, in order that, if the law
permits and the Court thinks it proper, the prisoner may be released on bail. In the event of bail being
refused, the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent, if he considers it necessary, may remove the
prisoners to the local hospital for better treatment and in such cases the instructions contained in Rule
597 (b) and the note there under should be followed. Rules 591 and 592 do not apply to under trial
prisoners.
(2) In the event of an under trial prisoner being too ill to attend Court on the appointed date, the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent shall report the circumstance as required by clause (1) of this rule and
shall ask for authority to further detain the prisoner in custody. This report must be sent as soon as it is
clear that the prisoner will not be able to appear, and must in any case be sent (by telegram, fax or any
other electronic media if necessary), so as to reach the Court on the morning of the day fixed for the
trial.
The report should contain the following particulars :-
(i) when the under trial prisoner was taken ill,
(ii) what illness he is suffering from,
(iii) what his present condition is, and
(iv) when in the opinion of the Medical Officer the prisoner is likely to be able to attend the court.
If in the meantime the prisoner recovers or his illness seems likely to be prolonged another report
should at once be sent to the court.
932. A notice of the death of any under trial prisoner or suspected lunatic shall be sent as soon as
possible, by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail, to the Court or other authority under
whose warrant or order such under trial prisoner or suspected lunatic was detained.
933. The following register shall be maintained in respect of under trial prisoners detained in any jail:-
No. 8 Register of prisoner under trial.- The following explanations are given for filling in this register :-
Particulars as to age, wounds or marks on the persons, health and weight on admission and
discharge required in columns 4,7 and12 shall be entered by, or under the direction of the Medical
Officer (see Rules 122 and 507); other entries in column 7 shall be made as directed in Rule 511.
Column.5. For race, religion, or caste-If Christian the denomination to be mentioned; if Muslim, the
sect; if Hindu, the caste.
Column 9.- In this column should be shown the cause of detention; if for trial, the crime with which
the accused is charged shall be noted; whether re-captured having escaped while previously under trial;
whether Political prisoner or detained pending enquiry. The crime, whether the same or any other that
may be established after trial, should be entered in the Register of convicted prisoners , No.6.
Column- 10 :- If there be two warrants of commitment, as first by a magisterial officer for enquiry and
secondly after enquiry, for trial before Sessions Court, both shall be entered.
Column 11.- In this column every date to which the prisoner's production in Court is remanded shall
be entered.
163
Column 12.- Shall show whether in good health or sick; if sick, the class, order, and specific disease,
with physical condition and ailments previous to admission as far as can be ascertained from the
prisoner himself; or, if received by transfer, from the jail whence received as shown by his history
ticket. If the prisoner is discharged in court, the last previous weighment shall be taken as the weight on
discharge.
Column 13.- Full details of the reasons for discharge shall be given, i.e., whether acquitted, charge
abandoned, released on bail, transferred to convicted prisoner's department on conviction, transferred
to another jail for trial, transferred to another jail on re-capture, etc.
Column 15.- Shall show the duration of imprisonment in the under trial ward from date of first
imprisonment to date of transfer to convicted prisoners department, or of release from any cause.
Column 17.- All property brought with each prisoner, or received from him afterwards, should be here
entered, and a note should be made against such items of clothing, bedding or other necessaries as he is
allowed to take inside the jail for use, recording the fact.
Column 18 and 19. - Weekly examination and attestation shall suffice.
Note.- With regard to interviews and communications with legal advisers and friends, see chapter
XVII. For rules relating to hair of under trial prisoners, see rule 652. The rules in chapter XXV relating
to transfers apply to under trial prisoners transferred. The rules in chapter VII relating to night-
guarding apply to the under -trial yard.
CHAPTER XXVIII. PRISONERS UNDERGOING SIMPLE IMPRISONMENT.
934. Prisoners of the A class sentenced to simple imprisonment shall be kept separate from prisoners
sentenced to rigorous imprisonment unless they elect to work (in which case they may work with A
class labouring convicts during the prescribed hours), and also from B class prisoners. Prisoners of the
B class sentenced to simple imprisonment shall also be kept separate, if possible, but if there is no
separate accommodation for them they may be located with B class labouring prisoners.
935. If any prisoner in Division III sentenced to simple imprisonment for an offence involving no moral
turpitude is considered by the District Magistrate to be a Person for whom exceptional treatment in regard to
separate accommodation is desirable, he shall refer the matter to the Inspector General of Prisons. If the
Inspector General agrees in the Magistrate's recommendation, he shall make such arrangement as he thinks
proper for classifying such prisoner as misdemeanant of the first degree and for providing him with
separate accommodation. If he does not agree with the Magistrate he shall refer the matter to Government
for orders.
936. Deleted.
937. Prisoners sentenced to simple imprisonment shall remain during the day-time in the part of
the jail assigned to them, and shall not enter the labour yards or communicate with the labouring
prisoners unless they elect to work, in which case they must remain with the group to which allotted.
938. They shall be subjected to a minimum of severity consistent with the maintenance of order and
discipline in the jail. They shall be allowed to wear their own clothing, and shall be exempt from
having their hair or beard cut or shaved. In case the private clothing of such a prisoner is insufficient
for decency or warmth, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall order the supply of whatever
jail clothing is necessary to make up the deficiency.
Note.- Deleted.
939. Blankets and bedding, cup and plate, shall be supplied to simple imprisonment prisoners as
to labouring convicts, and when not in use, the former shall be kept neatly folded, and the latter clean
and arranged in an orderly manner, as required by Rule 639.
940. Simple imprisonment prisoners shall keep their clothing clean and in good order, and their
yards clean, provided they belong to a class of society the members of which would in their own
houses perform such duties. They shall not be compelled to do any other work, or to perform any
menial duties for others, or to do any work of a degrading character, such as scavenger's work.
941. They will be allowed to converse together in their own ward or place in a quiet and orderly
manner except at parades, at exercise time, and at night.
164
942. Any simple imprisonment prisoner who volunteers to work shall be allowed to choose such work as is
available in the jail and shall be put to such work, provided he is physically fit to perform it, of which the
certificate of the Medical Officer shall be obtained on his history ticket. If he does a reasonable amount of
work he shall be supplied with jail diet according to class I. Should he fail to do so, the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent may punish him by the alteration of his diet from the labouring to the non
labouring scale, but in no other way. In case the prisoner wishes to cease working, and to return to his
original position, he shall be allowed to do so. With regard to the award of remission, to prisoners of this
class who work see rule 753.
943. Non - labouring prisoners shall be asked to take walking exercise for not more than an hour
in the morning and an hour in the evening, if the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent and Medical
Officer consider it advisable.
944. Except where exception is allowed by the rules in this chapter and in the chapter relating to
diet, all the rules in this Code, applicable to convicted criminal prisoners, shall be applicable to
prisoners sentenced to simple imprisonment; provided that the following punishments shall not be
applied to such prisoners, namely, minor punishments Nos. 2 to 5 and 7, and major punishment No. 2,
unless the prisoner is under the remission system.
945. Female prisoners shall be rigidly secluded from the male prisoners, and the under trial
females shall, if possible, be kept apart from the convicts. The female ward shall be so situated as not
to be overlooked by any part of the male jail; and there shall be a separate hospital for sick female
prisoners within or directly adjoining the female enclosure. They shall not be required to attend at the
jail office. All enquiries and verification of their warrants shall be conducted by the jailer in the female
enclosure.
946. In the female division of every jail there shall be a block of cells sufficient in number for use as
punishment cells and to afford separate accommodation for female under trial prisoners. A female
under trial prisoner may, at the option of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent, if cell
accommodation is available, have the choice of occupying a cell in the female enclosure instead of
being confined in the under trial prisoners ward: provided the arrangements prescribed in Rule 954
regarding the guarding of cells in the female ward and the custody of the keys of these cells can be
made.
947. Up to the limit of accommodation in the female ward of each jail, all female convicts of whatever
terms, except those sentenced to imprisonment for life and long term habitual criminals (B class), shall
be retained in the jail of the district to which they belong. Female convicts who have children with
them in jail (except prisoners sentenced to life imprisonment) shall not usually be transferred to central
jails until the children have been made over to their friends or have otherwise been taken charge of.
948. Deleted.
949. No female prisoner shall, on any consideration, be allowed to leave the female enclosure of the
jail.
950. No male officer of the jail shall on any pretext enter the female prisoner's enclosure alone or
unless he has a duty to attend to there. If a male officer has to attend to any duty in the females'
enclosure and there is a paid matron or female warder, he may enter the females' enclosure in her
company, and shall be accompanied by her to whatever part of the female jail he may have to go; if the
matron is a convict, he shall be accompanied by a Head Warder, and the two shall not separate whilst in
the females' enclosure. Should it be necessary to enter the females' enclosure at night, the Head Warder
on duty shall call the Jailer, and these two officers together shall enter the enclosure. Warders acting as
escorts to official visitors must remain outside the enclosure while it is being inspected, etc.
165
951. When a police officer is required to take the finger impressions or foot-prints of a female
prisoner or to photograph or measure her, she shall not be brought outside the enclosure for females,
but the police officer, in accompany with a Deputy Jailor or a Head Warder, shall be allowed to go to
the female enclosure, and shall there take the finger impressions, foot-prints, photograph or
measurement in the presence of the matron (where such exists) or of the female convict overseer in
charge . The Deputy Jailor or Head Warder shall remain with the police officer till his work has been
finished and shall then accompany him out of the female enclosure.
952. The keys of the female division of a jail shall be kept by the paid matron or female warder
during the day, and after the wards and enclosure have been locked up at night shall, except those of
any occupied female cells, be made over to the Jailor, and shall remain in his custody until required
next morning for the opening of the female wards. With regard to the keys of cells occupied at night,
see Rules 293 and 953
953. The locks of the female yard, cells and wards, shall be different from those in use in other
parts of the jail, and the same key shall not unlock locks used both in the male and female divisions of
the jail. If there be no paid matron or female warder, the keys of the female ward shall, during the day
time, be kept by the Head Warder on duty, but he shall not enter the female ward except to accompany
the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent, or visitors, or the Jailer, or Deputy Jailer (one of whom shall
open and lock up the female ward) or the warder placed in charge of the sweepers who have to enter
the ward to attend to conservancy. The warder told off for this duty shall be an old and trustworthy
officer.
954. When cells in the female enclosure are occupied, arrangements shall be made that, at night, a
paid female officer, and in the day-time, such an officer or a female convict officer, shall always be
within hearing of the occupants. The keys of the cells shall always be at hand and in the custody of a
paid female officer. If there are not two paid female officers, so that one shall always be present in the
female enclosure with the keys of the cells throughout the day and night, continuous confinement in the
female prisoners' cells cannot be allowed; no female shall be locked in a cell at any time during which
a paid female warder is not present. As this prohibits the execution of a judicial sentence of solitary
confinement in any jail which has not two paid female warders, whenever a female prisoner is so
judicially sentenced, her descriptive roll shall be submitted to the Inspector General for transfer to any
jail for which the necessary establishment has been sanctioned.
955. Female prisoners shall not be allowed to cook for themselves. Cooked food shall be brought
to them by a convict cook, accompanied by the warder in charge, and shall be placed outside the
enclosure gate. The menial duties connected with the female wards shall, if possible, be carried out by
the female prisoners themselves, and all refuse matter, etc., shall be placed at stated times outside the
enclosure to be carried away by male convicts. If there are no suitable female prisoners for
conservancy work, two or three specially selected male convict sweepers may be taken into the
enclosure by a warder under the conditions prescribed in Rule 950, but shall be kept together and shall
not be allowed to go out of the warder's sight or to hold any communication with the females.
956. At the weekly parade to be held by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent, female
prisoners shall be paraded with their faces uncovered but may be permitted to wear their saris over
their head or to cover their head with hair dress (ornah).
957. Female prisoners may retain their children up to the age of 4, or with the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent's approval upto 6 years. They shall be allowed such diet as the Medical
Officer may order for them, and shall be provided with suitable clothing.
958. In the event of a child being born in a jail notice of the birth should be sent to concerned City
Corporation/Municipality. If the mother so desire, be permitted to perform the ritual either within the
jail or outside it.
166
959. When a child in jail attains the age of 4, or at the discretion of the Superintendent 6 years or
when a female prisoner dies in jail and leaves a child, notice shall at once be sent to the Magistrate of
the District, who shall make arrangements for the care of such child. Should no relation or friend be
found willing to take care of the child, the Magistrate shall either place it in some approved institution,
or shall entrust it to some respectable person.
960. The hair of a female prisoner shall not be cut except by order of the Medical Officer entered
in her history ticket in any case where he considers this necessary on account of vermin or disease. A
comb and four necessary towels or napkins shall form part of every female prisoner's outfit and she
shall be provided with a reasonable supply of oil for dressing her hair. Female prisoners shall also be
allowed the use of looking glass, one in each cell and one or two in each ward being provided for the
purpose.
961. The rules regarding labour in Chapter XXII, shall be applicable to female convicted
prisoners, sentenced to rigorous imprisonment, likewise all other rules in this code including those
relating to Remission under Remission Rules to classification, Chapter XV, to appointments as convict
officer chapter VI, and offences and punishments, Chapter XIX, when not at variance with the Rules in
this chapter (see rule 730 exempting from whipping and fetters and handcuffs as a punishments).
Note :- With regard to the release of female prisoners, see Rule 579, and for rules relating to the
pregnancy of female sentenced to death, see Rules 994 and 995. For rules relating to the transfer of
female lunatics, see Rule 1033 and Appendix No. 15.
961.1. It is desirable to encourage among female prisoners the arts of sewing, knitting, weaving,
spinning, needle work and other domestic pursuits in order to help them to become earning member of
the family instead of becoming burden to the family and thereby grow in them self confidence and
sense of self respect for their reconciliation upon release.
The female Instructors from the Bangladesh small cottage industries corporation and the
voluntary organizations outside may come forward to impart such training to the female prisoners.
The Department of social welfare will take charge of a female prisoner for her rehabilitation upon
her release if she has none to take charge of her.
167
(3) As the confinement of youthful offenders in a jail is objectionable in many ways, the Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendents should whenever a youthful offender, child, young person or
adolescent offender is committed to jail to undergo imprisonment, ascertain from the court concerned
as to the circumstances, such person could not be dealt with under the Reformatory School Act, the
Bangladesh Children Act 1974 or the Borstal school Act, of 1928 whichever is applicable to the
particular case, and report the result of the communication to the Inspector General of prisons
submitting a descriptive Roll of the prisoner.
Note :- The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent should consult the following sections of law and
Government orders with particular care and where necessary they should take the initiative in giving
effect to the provisions of these sections and Government orders: -
(a) Sections of the Reformatory school Act.
(b) Provisions of the Bangladesh children Act, 1974.
(c) Section 10 of the Bangladesh Borsal School Act, 1928.
(d) And G.O. Nos- 268 (8) MINS/HA/Jails-I) dated 27. 5.1982 G.O.No 112 (80)
MINS/HA/Jails-I) dated 11. 3.1982 G.O.Nos.1/P225/86-Jails-(I)/275(67) dated
5. 7. 1989 And G.O.Nos.1/p-25/86-ails-I/200(67) dated 2. 4. 1991.
964.(1). When a warrant for the detention of a youthful offender in a reformatory school is received,
the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent before transferring such prisoner to Correctional Institute
shall ascertain by Radiogram or over phone whether there is accommodation available, and shall not
transfer such prisoners until he receives intimation that there is accommodation for him, but shall
transfer him, if fit to travel, as soon as he receives such intimation. If a youthful offender, whose
detention in a Correctional Institute has been ordered, cannot be transferred to such institution before
the expiation of any sentence or sentences of imprisonment awarded to him, he shall be released on the
expiration of such sentence or sentences. Removal to a Juvenile Development Centre should not be
postponed pending the filing or decision of an appeal.
(2) When any boy or girl has been sentenced to detention in a correctional institute he should be
detained in the under trial ward pending removal to the Correctional Institute.
(3) The boys or girls under orders of detention in a Correctional Institute shall be allowed to wear
their own clothing if sufficient and suitable while under transfer from jails to the correctional
institute.
(4) All youthful offenders should be protected from all contact with other criminals. All youthful
offenders under orders of detention in a Correctional Institute who are admitted to a jail should
be transferred to the Correctional Institute direct without waiting for the result of appeal, if any.
(5) Deleted.
965. In jails which have separate wards for juvenile prisoners such wards shall be fitted with
cubicles for the separation of such prisoners at night. If there is not a sufficient number of cubicles for
all, those who have arrive at the age of puberty should be kept in the cubicles in preference to those
who have not.
In jails where there is no separate juvenile ward, juvenile prisoners sentenced to a month's
imprisonment or less, or whilst awaiting transfer, shall be confined at night in cubicles or separate
sleeping places, and during the day time shall be kept rigorously under the eye of an elderly and
reliable warder, whose duty it shall be to prevent any familiarity between them and the adult convicts.
966. Deleted.
967. Deleted.
968. At least six weeks before the date of expiry of the sentence of a girl convict, the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent of the jails shall ascertain from her the name and address of her parents
or nearest relations. The Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall forward this information to the
Magistrate of the District to which she belongs, and request him to send word to her parents or
guardians informing them of the date of her release, and urging them to be present at the jail gate to
take charge of her on that date.
969. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail shall arrange to re-transfer the girl under the
charge of a female warder or a suitable female escort specially engaged for the purpose, to the jail of the
district to which she belongs, so that she may arrive there at least a week before her release.
168
970. In the event of no relative appearing to take charge of the girl on her release, the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail shall send her to the Magistrate of the District for conveyance
to her home under suitable escort.
971. Juvenile prisoners shall be exempt from full hard labour; they shall be taught and be
employed on some simple handicraft, which it is likely that they may carry on as a trade after they
leave the jail.
972. The diet of juvenile prisoners shall be regulated according to their age and apparent physical
requirements. Boys or girls over the age of 16 shall receive the diet of an adult.
973. All juveniles who are mentally fit, shall be taught reading, writing and arithmetic, science &
religious education in accordance with a syllabus approved by the Directorate of Primary Education. They
shall be taught for an hour in the morning and an hour in the afternoon. In addition to paid teachers, suitable
elderly prisoners, if available, may be employed to teach the boys under proper supervision, with the
permission of the Inspector General of Prisons and may be granted special remission if they perform their
duty satisfactorily. Teachers and warders who are allowed to enter the juvenile ward should be persons of
irreproachable character. Books and writing materials shall supplied at Government cost.
974. deleted.
975. The teaching classes shall be visited regularly by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent and
once in every month he shall examine their progress.
976. In central jails at least half an hour a day should be devoted to the exercise of juvenile
prisoners either in marching or by drill or gymnastics.
977. Except where at variance with the rules in this chapter, all the rules in this Code relating to
prisoner are applicable to juvenile prisoners, but juveniles under 16 years of age shall not be punished
by reduction of diet.
978. Male prisoners aged between 18 and 21 years of each class (A and B) whom it may be
desirable to separate shall, if possible, sleep in wards separated from other male prisoners. If there are
cubicles in the adult male wards, such prisoners shall be located in them at night.
Note.- Regarding the release of juvenile prisoners, see Rule 580.
Note:- Deleted.
CHAPTER XXXI-PRISONERS CONDEMNED TO DEATH.
979. When a prisoner is sentenced to death, the police officer who attends the trial shall at once
inform the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the jail in writing of the sentence that has been
passed by the Court, and, if the sentence is passed by a Sessions Judge, that officer will issue a warrant
of commitment pending confirmation of sentence by High Court Division of the Supreme Court. When
the sentence has been confirmed by the High Court Division or is passed by the High Court Division a
warrant for the execution of the sentence will be transmitted by the Sessions Judge, or an officer of the
High Court Division (Supreme Court) as the case may be, to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent
of the jail in which the person so sentenced is confined.
979. 1. In case of a death sentence passed by a special court or Tribunal the warrant of execution
shall be sent by the special court or Tribunal after the sentence has been confirmed by the High Court
Division (Supreme Court) and in the event of such court becoming functus officio, by the successor in
office as nominated by Government in each case.
980. Every prisoner sentenced to death shall, from the date of his sentence, and without waiting
for the sentence to be confirmed by the High Court Division (Supreme Court), be confined in some
safe place, a cell if possible, within the jail, apart from all other prisoners. The cell or room in which a
convict condemned to death is confined shall invariably, before he is placed in it, be examined by the
Jailor, who shall satisfy himself of its fitness and safety, and shall record the result of the examination
in his report book.
169
981. Immediately on his arrival in the prison, if the prisoner is a male, the Jailor shall have him
stripped and searched in his presence, shall take every articles of private clothing or other property
from him and shall give him a suit of jail clothing, three blankets (one blanket being instead of the
usual tat bedding) and a melamine cup and plate. If the prisoner is a female, she shall be searched in
private by the matron or female warder who shall take the same action as the Jailor in the case of a
male prisoner. A prisoner shall not be put in fetters or hand cuffs unless danger to the guard or to the
prisoner himself, may reasonably be apprehended from the prisoner's violence. If it is deemed
necessary to put on fetters or handcuffs, the circumstance and the reasons therefore shall be reported to
the Inspector General.
The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may issue to a condemned prisoner who has been
classified in Division -I under trial an iron cot, one mattress, one pillow, a bed sheet a pillow case, a
mosquito net and a chair and a table.
982. A female prisoner condemned to death shall be kept in a cell in the female yard and shall be
guarded by female warders.
983. From the time the prisoner is received back from Court after sentence, he or she shall be
placed under the constant charge and observation of a warder of the jail, both day and night. Convict
officers shall not be employed on this duty. As a rule the ordinary warder guard of a jail ought to be
sufficient for the occasional guarding of a condemned prisoner.
984. The warder shall be armed with a regulation baton, and shall, wherever it is possible, be
placed outside the grated door for of the cell. The key of the cell lock shall be kept with the warder or
matron on duty so as to be immediately available in case of an emergency. The lock must be one which
cannot be opened by any other key in use in the jail. Under any circumstances it is essential that the
warder shall have a complete view of the prisoner and of all parts of the cell in which he or she is
confined. In case of failure of electricity during the night a lantern/charge light shall be so placed as to
throw a good light on the prisoner. The door of the cell of a prisoner sentenced to death can be opened
if he/she tries to commit suicide or there is an emergency. For other routine purposes, if the door need
to be opened, minimum three guards will remain present to restrain individual, if necessary, from
committing any violence.
985. When there are two or more prisoners sentenced to death confined at the same time in cells
situated at some distance from one another, a separate guard shall be placed over each cell ; but, it the
cells are contiguous, one warder shall be posted to guard three prisoners in contiguous cells. For any
number of cells in excess of three, an extra guard shall be posted, even when the cells are contiguous.
986. The Head warder on duty shall frequently visit the sentries placed over such prisoners at
uncertain hours during both day and night, and shall at once report to the Jailor/ Deputy. Jailor for
communication to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent,any suspicious conduct on part of the
prisoner, or any fault committed by the warders on guard.
987. Morning and evening daily, the Jailor/Deputy Jailor shall carefully search every male prisoner
condemned to death with his own hand and examine his cell and certify that the prisoner has no weapon or
other means of effecting his escape or suicide in his possession. This duty shall under no circumstances be
delegated to the Warders. Female prisoners shall similarly be searched in private by the Matron and or
where there is no Matron in that Jail by a Female Warder but their cells shall be examined by the Jailor
/Deputy Jailor and in both the cases the Matron/Jailor/Deputy Jailor should certify that the prisoner has no
weapon or other means of effecting her escape or suicide in her possession.
988. A prisoner under sentence of death shall be allowed the ordinary diet of a labouring prisoner, if
previously classed in Division II under trial, but if previously classed in Division-I under trial, the diet
prescribed in rule 1100 shall be given and no indulgences shall be given in the shape of extra diet or
sweetmeats. His food shall invariably be examined by the Jailor or a Deputy Jailor before delivery to
him and shall be given to him in the presence of one or other of these officers.
170
989. A prisoner condemned to death may be visited by his relatives, friends, and legal advisers, at his
own request, on an order in writing from the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail. All
visitors shall in such cases be conducted to the prisoner's cell by the Jailor, Deputy Jailor or who shall
be present during the interview and see that nothing is passed to the prisoner. No other person shall
have access to such prisoner except the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail, the Medical
Officer and Medical Subordinate, the Jailor, official and non- official visitors, prisoners who have to
bring food and attend to conservancy, and, if the prisoner requires it, a priest, minister or religious
instructor of the religion to which he belongs. A condemned prisoner who can read may be supplied
with suitable reading material either books or periodicals which have been passed for his use by the
Senior Superintendent/Superintendent, and may be supplied with copies of weekly newspapers, which
have been approved for prisoners classified in Division II, and subject to the restrictions laid down in
rule 1074. An exercise book and pencil may be allowed subject to the restriction laid down in rule
1056. A condemned prisoner who smokes may be supplied with cigarettes or tobacco.
990. When intimation of a sentence of death passed by a Sessions Judge is received, the Jailer shall
enquire from the sentenced prisoner whether he wishes to appeal and to have his appeal forwarded by
the jail authorities. If he desires to do so, the Jailor shall at once have his appeal prepared for him as far
as possible in his own words and shall forward it under registered cover to the Register of the Supreme
Court. It is not necessary to obtain and forward a copy of the judgment in such cases.
991. Every prisoner condemned to death shall have the privilege of petitioning for mercy. The
following instructions shall be observed by the Senior Superintendents/Superintendents of jail in
connection with petitions for mercy to the President of the Peoples Republic of Bangladesh by or on
behalf of a condemned prisoner:-
1. Immediately on receipt of a warrant for execution consequent upon the confirmation by High
Court of a sentence of death, the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall inform the
convict concerned that if he desires to submit a petition for mercy, it must be submitted in
writing within fifteen days of the date of such intimation.
II. If the convict submit a petition within the period of fifteen days prescribed by Rule 1, it should
be addressed to the President of the Peoples Republic of Bangladesh and the Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent of the jail shall forthwith dispatch it to the Secretary to the
Ministry of Home Affairs, together with a covering letter reporting the date fixed for execution
and the date on which the convict has been informed of the confirmation by the High Court of
the sentence passed on him. The Superintendent shall further certify that the execution has
been stayed pending receipt of the orders of the Government on the petition. If no reply is
received within sixty days from the date of the dispatch of the petition, the Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent shall inform to the Secretary of Home Ministry drawing
attention to the fact, but he shall in no case carry out the execution before the receipt of the
Government's reply.
III. If the convict submits a petition after the period prescribed by Rule 1, the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail shall at once forward it to the Government and at the
same time inform the substance of it requesting orders whether the execution should be
postponed and stating that, pending a reply, the sentence will not be carried out. If, however,
such petition is received by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent later than noon on the
day preceding that fixed for the execution, he shall at once forward it to the Government and at
the same time inform the substance of it; giving the date of execution and stating that the
sentence will be carried out unless orders to contrary are received.
IV. Deleted.
171
V. If intimation is received by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the Jail from or on
behalf of a convict that it is intended to apply to the Appellate Division of the Supreme Court
for special leave to appeal the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the Jail shall forthwith
dispatch the intimation to the Secretary Ministry of Home Affairs together with a covering
letter reporting the date fixed for the execution and, if possible, the name and address of the
Counsel acting for the prisoner, and shall certify that execution has been stayed, pending
receipt of the orders of the Government on the intimation. If no reply is received within fifteen
days from the date of dispatch of the intimation the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent
shall inform the Secretary to the Government drawing attention to the fact, but shall in no case
carry out the execution before the receipt of the Governments reply.
VI. As soon as by fax intimation is received by Government of the rejection of application for
special leave to appeal or of the dismissal of an appeal which has been admitted or if proof is
not furnished before the date fixed that necessary papers, instructions and also (except in the
case where the prisoner definitely states that he is applying for special leave to appeal in forma
pauperis) funds have been sent to a firm of solicitors/lawyers on behalf of the condemned
prisoner, the District Magistrate and the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the Jail will
be informed by fax or any other electronic media and the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent of the Jail will be authorized to fix the date of execution not less than twenty
one days or more than twenty eight days ahead of the date on which he receives such
intimation. He will at the same time be instructed to stay the execution pending the receipt by
him of the post copy of orders of the Appellate Divison of Supreme Court.
V11. In the event of its coming to the knowledge of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent at
any time before the execution of the sentence that altogether exceptional circumstances have
arisen which plainly demand a reconsideration of the sentence, he is at liberty, anything in the
foregoing rules notwithstanding, to report the circumstances by fax or any other electronic
media to the Secretary of Ministry of Home Affairs and ask for its orders, and to defer
execution till they are received.
VIII. The Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall at once repeat back to the Secretary to the
Ministry of Home Affairs all communications/ orders regarding result of mercy petition
received by him, by way of acknowledgement.
172
993. If any prisoner awaiting sentence of death shows signs of insanity which, in the opinion of
the Medical Officer, are not feigned, or require observation to determine whether they are feigned or
not, the circumstances shall at once be reported to the Secretary, Ministry of Home Affairs and
execution of sentence shall be deferred pending receipt of the orders of Government. The Medical
Officer shall keep the prisoner under observation and, as soon as he can form an opinion, which should
be within thirty days after the date when the symptoms of insanity are first reported to him, shall certify
whether the prisoner is insane or not. His certificate shall immediately be forwarded to the Secretary,
Ministry of Home Affairs in a registered cover. On receipt of the orders of Government, the Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent shall give effect to them. If they direct that the sentence of death shall
be carried out, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall at once fix a fresh date for the execution
of the sentence which shall be not less than a week nor more than a fortnight after receipt of the orders
of Government. The postponement of the execution of sentence under this rule with the reason
therefore, the final orders of Government and the new date fixed for the execution of the death
sentence, if it is to be carried out , shall be reported to the Court which sentenced the prisoner, and also
to the Magistrate of the District.
The Inspector General of Prisons shall also be informed of the above facts.
994. When a female prisoner sentenced to death is certified by the Medical Officer to be pregnant,
the fact shall invariably be noted on the warrant, which shall be returned by the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent of the Jail to the Judges of the relevant Court for endorsement thereon of an order for
the suspension of execution until the orders of the High Court have been taken under section 382,
Criminal Procedure Code.
995. When a female prisoner sentenced to death declares herself to be pregnant, and the Medical
Officer is unable to certify to the truth or otherwise of the statement, he shall state the fact in writing,
and also the interval of time necessary to enable him to satisfy himself on the point, and the statement
shall be attached to the warrant and forwarded therewith to the Sessions Judge for the procedure
specified in the last preceding rule.
996. When execution of a capital sentence on a female convict has been suspended under either of
the last two preceding rules, it shall not afterwards be carried into execution without the express orders
of Government, for which the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall apply through the Inspector-
General.
997. Should any extraordinary or unavoidable delay occur in carrying a capital sentence into
execution, from any cause other than the submission, under rule 991, of a petition for mercy or an
application for leave to appeal to the Appellate Division of the Supreme Court, the Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent of the jail shall immediately report the circumstance to the Sessions
Judge/relevant Court, returning the original warrant either for the issue of a fresh warrant, or for the
endorsement upon the same warrant of an order containing a definite date for carrying the postponed
sentence into effect.
Note.- (1) This rule is based on section 381, Criminal Procedure Code, and does not apply to
warrants for execution issued by the High Court. If for any reason a capital sentence is not carried into
execution on the date fixed in such warrants, execution should be carried out on receipt of instructions
from the executive Government.
(2) When the Senior Superintendent /Superintendent is acting under rule 991 in relation to
petitions for mercy and petitions for leave to appeal to the Appellate Division of the Supreme Court, he
should, in postponing execution in accordance therewith, himself fix dates from time to time as
necessary, the warrant remaining unaltered.
998. When the evidence of a convict under sentence of death is required, the Court shall proceed
to jail for the purpose, and shall not require the convict's attendance under part IX of the Prisoners Act,
III of 1900: Provided that if the presence of a prisoner under sentence of death is required by Sessions
or High Court for the purpose of taking additional evidence in the case under section 428 of the Code
of Criminal Procedure, the prisoner's attendance may be required under part IX of the Prisoners Act, III
of 1900.
173
999. Unless specially directed in the warrant, or the condemned prisoner is transferred to another jail
under the orders of the Inspector General (Rule 843), the execution shall take place at the headquarters
of the district in which the prisoner is confined at the time the sentence of death has been passed. The
Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the jail shall, on receiving a warrant of capital punishment,
communicate the fact at once to the Magistrate of the District, and the Inspector General of Prisons. He
shall be solely responsible that the execution is properly carried out, and shall make timely
arrangements to engage the services of a hangman, to have the gallows in order, and the rope, cap, and
pinioning straps ready. A Manila rope, 25.4 mm in diameter, shall be used for executions, and two such
ropes should be available. The rope need not be new, but must be capable of standing the strain caused
by dropping a sack of sand or earth, one and-a-half times the weight of the prisoner, the height of the
drop it is proposed to give. This test should be made at least a week before the date fixed for the
execution, so that other ropes may be procured in good time, if necessary, and subjected to the same
test. After being tested the ropes should be locked up in a safe place. On the evening before the
execution, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall have the gallows, if a temporary structure,
erected in his presence, as far as possible near the condemned cell but not visible from it, and shall
examine the ropes to satisfy himself that they have received no injury since being tested. When a
condemned prisoner is transferred from one jail to another, the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendents
of the receiving and dispatching jails shall report the fact to the Magistrate of their respective Districts
and the Inspector General of Prisons.
Note. - Ropes of the authorised pattern may be ordered from the central jail by fax or any other
electronic media, if necessary. Owing to the liability of these ropes to deteriorate indents should not be
submitted until the appeal has been rejected.
999.1. When the date of execution has been finally fixed the nearest relations of the condemned
prisoner if their addresses are known shall be informed by post, and also through the Magistrate of the
District. The time that will be normally required for a letter to reach the relatives and for the latter to
make the journey to the place where the jail is situated, shall be taken into consideration in fixing the
final date.
1000. The following scale of drop, proportioned to the weight of the prisoner, is given for general
guidance, but the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent must use his discretion according to the
physical condition of the prisoner, and should consult the Chief Medical Officer on the subject :-
For a prisoner weighing under 44.45 kgs. -- 2.00 metres.
For a prisoner weighing under 57.00 kgs. -- 1.84 metres.
For a prisoner weighing under 70.00 kgs. -- 1.70 metres.
For a prisoner weighing 70.00 kgs. and over - 1.50 metres.
Note . The actual length of rope required necessarily varies in individual cases, the situation of
the knots has no precise relation to the drop. The following formula may be used to ascertain the
length of rope required:-
Let A be the distance from the top of the knot clamp to the platform.
Let B be the height of the condemned person to the angle of the jaw (this is
approximately165.1mm. less than total height).
Let C be the prescribed drop.
Let D be the difference between A and B.
Then D+C= the length of rope required, ie. from the top of the knot clamp to
the ring of the loop drown to the size of the circumference of the neck.
174
1001. All executions shall take place in an enclosure within the jail walls in any hour of the night on
any day; but in order to prevent anything of a private character being given to the proceedings, adult
male relatives of the prisoner, and other respectable male adults, not exceeding twelve in all, shall be
allowed to witness the execution. The names and addresses of these spectators shall be recorded in the
Gate-Register, so that they may afterwards, if occasion requires it, be called as witnesses. No such
person shall be admitted within the jail without the special permission of the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent of the jail. Discretion is reserved to the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent to refuse
admission altogether, or to particular individuals, in cases in which the circumstances justify such a
course. In doubtful cases the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall consult the District
Magistrate. The prisoner in the jail shall not be made to attend, and should, as a rule, be kept locked up
in their sleeping wards until the execution has taken place.
1002. A guard of not less than 12 men armed with approved rifles and with cartridges in their pouches,
shall be mustered in front of the gallows, to repulse any attempt at rescue. In central jails this guard
shall be furnished by the reserve warder guard. For District jails, if necessary, the Superintendent of
Police should be requested to furnish the guard and necessary officers.
1003. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail shall be present at every execution and
likewise the Magistrate of the District, or an officer of magisterial rank deputed by him at jail. The
Police Commissioner or a Deputy Police Commissioner of Metropolitan Cities and other than
Metropolitan Cities the Superintendent of Police shall be present at every execution.
1004. Before the condemned prisoner leaves his cell, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall
read the warrant aloud in English and the Jailor or other official shall read a translation of it in the
vernacular. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent and the Jailor shall then identify the prisoner as
the individual named in the warrant and make him over to the hangman.
1006. The body shall hang for half an hour and shall not be taken down till the Chief Medical Officer
declares life to be extinct. The post mortem examination of the body shall be made. The warrant of
execution shall be returned with an endorsement by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of jail
that the sentence has been carried out.
1007. Unless the removal of the body of an executed criminal is likely to be made the occasion of
public demonstration, such body-
(1) may, at the request of the friends or relatives of the deceased, be made over to such friends or
relatives, or
(2) if not made over to the friends or relatives, under clause (1), may be disposed of under Municipal
or other local arrangements.
175
1008. In the event of the District Magistrate or the Magistrate in charge considering it undesirable that
the body of an executed criminal should be made over to the relatives or friends of the deceased, such
body shall, under the written order of the Magistrate, be burnt or buried within the jail in consonance,
as far as possible, with the racial or religious customs of the community to which the deceased
belonged. Friends of the deceased, not exceeding four in number, may, at the discretion of the
Magistrate, and under such conditions as he may impose, be admitted to the funeral ceremony and
allowed to perform any customary rites. In the absence of any of the friends of the deceased, the
ceremony shall be performed under the direction of the senior Christian, Hindu or Mohammedan
official of the jail, as the case may be.
1009. All charges incurred in connection with an execution shall be paid by the Jail Department.
CHAPTER - XXXII - STATE PRISONERS.
State prisoners rules no 1010 to 1023 deleted. The Special Powers Act, 1974 (as amended from time to
time) is in force and being followed by the jail authorities under the orders of the Government.
CHAPTER XXXIII.- LUNATICS.
1024. Persons who are supposed, or are known, to be of unsound mind may be detained in jails and
may be divided into five classes:-
(1) Persons who have not committed a crime and who are supposed to be lunatics placed under
medical observation under the provisions of the Lunacy Act (IV of 1912).
(2) Persons accused of a crime and supposed to be of unsound mind placed under the observation of the
Civil Surgeon under section 464 of the Criminal Procedure Code.
(3) Persons accused of a crime and found incapable of making their defence owing to unsoundness of
mind, and detained under section 466 of the Criminal Procedure Code, pending the orders of
Government.
(4) Persons who have committed a crime and have been acquitted on the ground of having been insane
when the crime was committed, detained under section 471 of the Criminal Procedure Code, pending
the orders of, or at the pleasure of, Government.
(5) Prisoners who have become insane after their conviction and admission into jail.
Persons of class (1) are non-criminal lunatics. Others are denominated criminal lunatics.
1025. When the Medical Officer, who is required by a Magistrate to report on the state of mind of a
supposed lunatic sent to jail for observation, is not also the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of
the jail, the Magistrate shall send to the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the jail a copy of any
orders he may address to the Medical officer regarding the supposed lunatic and the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent shall ascertain from the Medical officer whether, in his opinion, it is
necessary to take any special precautions to prevent the supposed lunatic from doing injury to himself
or to others, and he shall see that suitable precautions are taken, if necessary.
1026. Under section 16 of Act IV of 1912, the detention of a non-criminal supposed lunatic under
medical observation may be authorised for a period not exceeding ten days; if, however, the Medical
Officer certifies that further detention is necessary to enable him to form an opinion as required by the
Act, the Magistrate or Commissioner of Police may authorise such future detention up to a maximum
period of thirty days from the date of the first order of detention.
Immediately upon expiry of this period, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall address
the Magistrate or officer under whose writ, warrant or order the person is detained, pointing out that the
maximum period of detention authorised by the Act has expired, and requesting that an order for the
release of the person detained, or his transfer to a Mental Hospital, be furnished. If by the end of seven
days more, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent has not received the Court's order, he shall report
the matter to the Inspector General of Prisons for necessary action.
In every case when a non-criminal lunatic has been detained in jail for more than thirty days
the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall report the circumstances to the Inspector General.
1027. Non-criminal lunatics shall be entirely excluded from all statistical returns relating to jails, and
the cost of their maintenance and clothing (if supplied) and transfer to a Mental Hospital shall be
recovered from the Court under whose warrant they are received.
176
1028. Criminal lunatics of class (2) and class (3) may be remanded to jail for medical observation by
order of a Magistrate or Court ; and in any case when any lunatic of class (2) or (3) has been detained
in a jail for more than a month the case shall be reported to the Inspector General.
1029. (1) In the event of any prisoner confined in any jail exhibiting signs of insanity which in the
opinion of the Medical Officer are not feigned, the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall cause
such prisoner to be kept under medical observation in a cell in the manner prescribed in Rule 740 or
Rule 993.
(2) If the supposed lunatic be-
(a) an accused person under trial the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall report the
circumstances to the trying or committing Magistrate for necessary action under section 464, Criminal
Procedure code;
(b) a prisoner awaiting sentence of death, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall proceed as
prescribed in Rule 993 ;
(c) a person detained or imprisoned under any order of sentence of any Court, the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent shall apply to the Magistrate of the district in which such order or
sentence was passed, for a Descriptive Roll in the prescribed form.
Note :- The Descriptive Roll should ordinarily be received within fourteen days.
1030. If any prisoner becomes insane after his admission to a jail, a report regarding his case shall
immediately be submitted by the Senior Superintendent /Superintendent to the Inspector General, with
the view of obtaining the orders of Government for his removal to a Mental Hospital. With this report
shall be forwarded in duplicate-
(1) a Descriptive Roll in Form C (Bangladesh Form No.216);
(2) a Certificate, signed by the Medical Officer of the prisoner's insanity, in Bangladesh Form
No. 215 ;
(3) a Certificate of the prisoner's fitness for transfer in Bangladesh jail Form No. 119 (in
manuscript);
(4) a Descriptive Roll in Bangladesh Jail Form No. 8 (Bangladesh Form No. 5069).
Note. -When lunatics are certified to be violent, dangerous, suicidal, etc., a statement of
actual facts should be entered in the certificate.
1031. On receipt of a writ, warrant or order for removal of a lunatic to a Mental Hospital, the Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent shall forward him to the Mental Hospital specified, with a copy of the
order, a copy of the History Sheet, and a duplicate of the Medical Officer's certificate of fitness for
transfer, and also, if the lunatic is a convicted prisoner, with his original warrant of imprisonment, and
other documents prescribed in Rule 872. No lunatic shall be transferred to a Mental Hospital unless the
Medical Officer certifies immediately before dispatch that he is fit, both mentally and physically, to
travel with safety, and the original of this certificate shall be sent to the Superintendent of the Mental
Hospital by post or any other reliable means. Every precaution shall be taken to secure that the lunatic
is properly cared for whilst in transit to the Mental Hospital; he shall be sent in charge of a police
escort, and proper arrangements shall be made regarding his property, clothing, bedding, and food, as
directed in the rules relating to transfer (Chapter XXV), except that two complete suits of clothing and
an extra blanket, shall be provided, and, if the lunatic is of class (1), the clothing shall be ordinary
clothing, not jail clothing.(See Rule 1027.) Fetters shall not be used unless absolutely necessary.
Note: Deleted
1032. Whenever a Police Registered convict is sent to a Mental Hospital from a jail, the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent shall communicate the fact fifteen days before the transfer of the
convict to the Finger Print Bureaus of the Police Department. In the cases of convicts who have not
been made P.R. intimation should be given to the Superintendent of Police of the district in which the
jail is situated.
1033. Female lunatics when transferred to or from a jail, or forwarded for release to the custody of
relations or friends, shall invariably be accompanied by a female warder or attendant (Vide Appendix
No. 15).
177
1034. In urgent and special cases (e.g., if the lunatic is noisy, filthy or dangerous) Senior
Superintendents/Superintendents are authorised to transfer insane convicted prisoners from jails to
Mental Hospitals in anticipation of Inspector General of Prisons sanction; the necessary documents
shall in such case accompany the prisoner.
1035. When certifying to the fitness for transfer of any insane person, the Medical Officer shall be
careful to record minutely the existence of any disability or marks of violence exhibited by such
person.
1036. The Medical Staff authorised by the Medical Officer shall invariably be present when an insane
prisoner is made over by the Jailor to the police escort; he shall acquaint the officer in command of the
escort with the exact mental and physical condition of such prisoner and shall bring to his notice such
disability or marks of violence as may exist; he shall ask him to satisfy himself that the condition of the
prisoner is as stated. The Jailor shall note in his report book the fact of this rule having been complied
with.
1037. When a criminal lunatic of class (5) cannot be transferred under a Government order, so as to
reach the Mental Hospital before his sentence expires, he shall be detained until the expiration of his
sentence, and then be treated as a non-criminal lunatic for whose transfer the Magistrate shall obtain
orders from the Government.
1038. Whenever a lunatic is found to be dangerous, noisy, or filthy in habits, he shall be confined in a
cell; otherwise lunatics of classes (1) to (4) inclusive may be detained either in the jail hospital or in the
under trial prisoners' ward at the discretion of the Medical Officer. Every lunatic confined in a cell shall
at all times be watched in the manner prescribed in Rule 740.
1039. Every lunatic shall receive the ordinary jail dietary, unless the Medical Officer otherwise
directs, but persons coming under class (1) may be supplied with food from outside the jail under the
same conditions as are prescribed in the case of under trial prisoners in Rules 923 to 925.
1040. When it appears to the Government that any convicted Prisoner of class (5) has become of
sound mind, and a warrant has been issued for the remand of the prisoner to the jail from which he was
removed, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail shall reckon the time during which the
prisoner has been confined in the Mental Hospital as part of his term of sentence.
1041. The rules issued by Government relative to the treatment of recovered criminal lunatics of class
(4) transferred from Mental Hospitals to jails, in anticipation of their ultimate release, will be found in
Appendix No 14. Lunatics so transferred shall be treated strictly in accordance with the orders of
Government passed in each case. Such lunatics will ordinarily undergo a term of probation in jail as
determined by the Government.
A brief note of the case of every recovered criminal lunatic confined in a jail should be brought
to the notice of the Inspector General of Prisons at his inspection.
1042. Deleted.
1043. Whenever a recovered criminal lunatic undergoing probation in a jail has a relapse of insanity,
he should be immediately returned to the Mental Hospital from which he came, with a certificate in
Form No. 3 in Schedule 1 to the Bangladesh Lunacy Act 1912, and the case should be reported to
Government through the Inspector General. With every lunatic transferred either from a Mental
Hospital to a jail, or vice versa, full details of his medical history up to date shall be forwarded.
1044. Under section 471 (2) of the Criminal Procedure Code and section 30 (2) of the Bangladesh
Lunacy Act 1912, the Government has empowered Senior Superintendent/Superintendent to discharge
all the functions imposed on the Inspector General of Prisons by section 30 (1) of the Bangladesh
Lunacy Act, 1912 and sections 473 and 474 of the Code of Criminal Procedure in respect of persons
confined in jails under section 466 or 471 of that code. (see Rule 36).
1044.1. If a person detained under section 466 of the Criminal Procedure Code recovers and is
certified by the Inspector General to be capable of making his defense he shall be taken before the
Magistrate or the court, as the case may be, at such time as the Magistrate or the court appoints for
action under section 468 of the Code of Criminal Procedure .
178
1045 On the 15th February and 15th August, Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall forward in
Return No. 9 to the Inspector General, in respect of each lunatic in his custody a report showing the
physical and mental state of health of the lunatic at the time, and during the interval since the previous
report was submitted.
CHAPTER-XXXIV. - LEPERS.
1046. When any convicted prisoner is found to be suffering from leprosy, the Medical Officer shall
record the fact on his History Ticket and likewise his opinion whether it is necessary to segregate the
prisoner from those who are healthy.
1047. Whenever the Medical Officer records that a convicted prisoner is suffering from leprosy he
should at once be separated from other prisoners and the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall
submit his descriptive roll to the Inspector General for orders for the transfer of the prisoner suffering
from leprosy to Sylhet Central Jail or any other Jail where facilities for treatment and segregation of
leper prisoners are available.
1048. Deleted.
1049. Any under trial prisoner suffering from leprosy, whose segregation the Medical Officer
recommends, or leper convict whose transfer to a leper jail has been recommended, or leper convict
received for release, shall, pending transfer or release, be confined in a cell, but care shall be taken that
such confinement is not solitary. The prisoner shall see and may converse with other prisoners but shall
be kept separate. Any cell or building occupied by a leper prisoner shall be thoroughly disinfected, the
walls scraped and white-washed and the floor, if of earth, renewed before it is used for any other
purpose.
Clothing and bedding that has been used by leper shall never be re-issued, except to another
leper prisoner, and shall be thoroughly disinfected and washed before re-issue. The case of any civil
prisoner admitted with ulcerative leprosy shall at once be reported to the Inspector General with the
view of obtaining the orders of Government for his release . On the day before the release of a leper
whose segregation has been ordered is due, the fact that such prisoner will be released shall, be
reported to the police, in order that they may, if necessary, take action under section 7 of Act 111 of
1898.
For orders regarding the release of leper prisoner, See rule-851.
CHAPTER XXXV- RULES FOR THE TREATMENT OF PRISONERS IN DIVISIONS 1 AND II.
1050. Classification. -Convicted prisoners will be admitted to division 1 in the manner, and on the
grounds, indicated in Rule 617.
1051. Accommodation.- Prisoners in Division I shall whenever possible be allotted cells, but except
when imposed as a jail punishment, their imprisonment shall in no case involve anything in the nature
of separate confinement.
1052. Furniture and equipment. The cells allotted to Division I Prisoner shall contain as their normal
equipment, a chair and a table; a light for use at night until 10 p.m. melamine feeding utensils, and an
iron cot, a mattress, two pillows, two bed sheets, four pillow cases, one or two fresh blankets with
cover as may be required, a mosquito net, and a small hand mirror and comb. Each prisoner in this
Division shall also be given a tooth brush, tooth pest, soap, shaving cream, slipper, cap, Zainamaz,
towel if required, and in addition may provide, at his own expense, such other furniture, bedding,
utensils and hair oil, others toiletries etc., as the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may approve as
consistent with his ordinary habits and the accommodation of the jail.
1053. Travel in custody- When it is necessary for prisoners in Division I to travel in custody they
shall be provided with second class accommodation. If prisoners in this Division desire to travel by a
higher class they shall be allowed to do so, provided they themselves pay all additional expenses. If the
journey involves a night in the train, prisoners shall be allowed to take with them their bedding and
personal kit. In the case of prisoners who are considered to be dangerous a reserved compartment may
be engaged. The subsistence allowance for Division I prisoners shall be Tk.100/- (hundred) per diem.
179
1054. Clothing. - Each prisoner may wear his own clothing provided that it is sufficient, fit for use
and not objectionable. Additional clothing may, with the approval of the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent, be obtained from time to time at the expense of the prisoner. This concession does not
cover the wearing of political symbols. If the prisoner desires to have clothing at govt. expense, he
shall be provided with the clothing and equipment prescribed for Division II convicts in Rule 1165.
Soap shall be provided to enable the prisoners to wash their persons and clothes, but if they are not
accustomed to wash their own clothes, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent will make
arrangements for the regular washing of clothes without cost to the prisoners.
Note :- Deleted.
1055. Visitors: A special Board of Visitors shall be appointed by Government for each jail containing
Division I prisoners consisting of the District Magistrate or in case of Metropolitan area Commissioner
of Police and two non-official visitors specially appointed by Government. Other non-Official visitors
will not be permitted to inspect Division I prisoners or the wards or cells in which they are kept.
1056. Writing materials.- As a privilege, the use of note books and pencils, or pen will be allowed,
in addition to the books, magazines, and papers provided for in Rule 1074. The exercise books should
be ordinary school note books and the pages must be numbered; they should periodically be inspected
to see that no pages are missing. The pages must not be used for writing letters.
1057. Cropping of hair.- Division I prisoners shall have the privilege of utilizing the service of jail
barbers for having their hair cropped and their beard shaved. They may also be allowed at the
discretion of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent to have their personal shaving materials, but not
more than one blade or one time razor be allowed at a time and should not be allowed to replace by a
new one till the used one is made over to the Head Warder in charge of the area.
1058. Diet.- Division I prisoners shall receive the diet of classified prisoners and no extra privilege
in regard to issue of diet should be allowed to such prisoners, but may also obtain at their own expense
under the usual restrictions and to examination and at the discretion of the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent, extra provisions of a simple character, excepting alcohol or spirituous liquors or drugs
of any kind which will only be supplied under the orders of the Medical Officer. A reasonable supply of
cigarettes and tobacco may also be allowed at prisoners' expense. The Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent should regard the scale prescribed in Rule 1100 as a guide and vary the diet as much as
possible within the sanctioned scale.
Section 11.- Division - II prisoners.
1059. Classification.- Convicted prisoners will be admitted to Division II in the manner, and on the
grounds, indicated in Rule 617.
1060. Accommodation.- Prisoners in Division II shall be given cellular accommodation, if available,
under the same conditions as prisoners in Division 1, but otherwise association within the class at the
discretion of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent.
1061. Furniture and equipment.- The privileges allowed to Division I prisoners in Rule 1052 will
be applicable to prisoners in Division II.
1062. Travel in custody.- When it is necessary for prisoners in Division II to travel in custody, they
shall be provided with intermediate class accommodation. If the journey involves a night in the train
prisoners shall be allowed to take with them their bedding and personal kit. In the case of prisoners
who are considered to be dangerous a reserved compartment may be engaged. The subsistence
allowance of Division II prisoners shall be Taka 100/- (one hundred) per diem.
1063.Clothing. (1) Prisoners in Division II shall be furnished with the clothing and equipment
prescribed in Rule 1165.
(2) Prisoners in Division II employed as convict overseers shall be provided with suits
of plain cotton drill instead of suti cloth.
(3) Prisoners in Division II of the A and B classes shall wear distinguishing badges of
size 5 cm. x 5 cm. on the right breast the distinguishing colour of the badges being green for ''A'' and
red for ''B'' class.
180
1064. Cleaning of cells, etc.- Prisoners in Division II shall keep their cells or wards, utensils,
clothing, and bedding clean and neatly arranged, and shall be allowed two cakes of toilet soap per
month or in lieu thereof 8 grams of mustard oil or coconut oil daily to keep the person of the prisoner
clean.
1065. Writing materials.- The privileges allowed to Division I prisoners in Rule 1056 will be
applicable to prisoners in Division II.
1066. Cropping of hair The privileges allowed to Division I prisoners in Rule 1057 will be
applicable to prisoners in Division II.
1067. Diet.- The privileges allowed to Division I prisoners in Rule 1058 will be applicable to
prisoners in Division II.
Section 111.- General.
1068. Jails and accommodation.- (1) Prisoners in Division I shall ordinarily be confined in central
jails. They may, however, be confined in District jails if so ordered by the Inspector General of Prisons
provided that the jails where such prisoners are transferred have the necessary arrangements for the
confinement and treatment of such prisoners.
(2) When a prisoner is admitted to Division I or II the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent will
send his descriptive roll to the Inspector General of prisons for orders as to his place of confinement; if
he wishes to appeal,he may be detained for two or three days to admit of his making arrangements with
his legal advisers and friends. He shall not, however, be detained until the result of his appeal is known.
(3) Prisoners in Division I and II shall be kept in separate wards from those occupied by convicts
in Division III, and prisoners sentenced to simple imprisonment should be kept apart from those
sentenced to rigorous imprisonment, and short term prisoners from those sentenced to long terms.
These arrangements will be made as far as accommodation admits.
1069. Tasks.- The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail shall see that the tasks allotted to
prisoners in Divisions I and II are assigned after due consideration on medical grounds and with careful
regard to the capacity, character, previous mode of life, and antecedents of the prisoners. Prisoners shall
complete their full tasks as allotted, before being allowed any time for studying or recreation.
1070. Articles supplied to prisoners.- No, article shall be passed for the use of a prisoner unless it
has been noted in his ticket, and passed by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent.
1071. Separate cooking.- The diet of prisoners in Divisions I and II shall be cooked separately from
that of prisoners in Division III.
1072. Interviews.- A prisoner in Division I or II shall not be permitted to hold any interview during
the period of his sentence, except in accordance with the following rules :-
(1) With the approval of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent prisoner may be allowed to see a
visitor once a fortnight in the case of a Division I prisoner, or once a month in the case of a
Division II prisoner, for the purpose of discussing family or domestic affairs.
(2) Such interviews shall be conducted in the presence of the Jailor or a Deputy Jailor deputed by the
Superintendent; and the discussion of political nature or of any matter other than family or
domestic affairs are strictly prohibited. Any breach of this rule will liable the prisoner to
disciplinary action.
(3) No one who has taken prominent part in any political agitation in which the prisoner was
concerned, or whose object is suspected to be to obtain an opportunity of publishing accounts of
grievances in the press will be allowed to interview a prisoner.
(4) If matters discussed at interviews or the substance of letters received from prisoners is published,
the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall report the matter to the Inspector General of
Prisons/Government who will then decide if the privilege of interviews and communications
shall be withdrawn or not in the case of particular prisoner concerned.
(5) In all other respects, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall be guided by the rules for
interviews given in Chapter XVII.
181
1073. Letters and communications. No letters or communications from or to prisoners in Division I
or II shall be permitted, but well conducted prisoners may be allowed to write and receive one letter to
or from a near relation not more frequently than once a fortnight in the case of a Division I prisoner, or
once a month in the case of Division II Prisoner, under the same conditions as those applicable to
interviews. On urgent occasions, e.g., a death or serious illness in the family, this rule may be relaxed at
the discretion of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent. The subject matter of all letters must be
limited to private matters and there must be no reference to jail administration and discipline, to other
prisoners or to politics. Such letters will be subject to the censorship of the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent, who may, if he has any doubts regarding any letters, forward them to the Special
Branch of the Police Department for scrutiny. Similarly, that department may call for the letters of any
prisoner in Division I or II for examination.
1074. Books & Newspapers.-(1) Prisoners in Divisions I and II may be allowed to have a maximum
of five books at a time either from the jail library or from outside and may also be allowed periodicals
and magazines from outside subject to approval of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent. If the
Senior Superintendent/Superintendent has any doubt as to the propriety of any book or magazine, he
may refer the question to the District Magistrate or in the case of Central Jails to the Government/
Inspector General of Prisons. In special circumstances and with the previous approval of Government
some daily newspapers may be allowed to prisoners in both Divisions I and II. Prisoners in Divisions I
and II shall be supplied with a few copies of daily/weekly newspaper from a list of newspapers to be
approved by Government and subject to censorship when necessary by the jail Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent as regards the matter contained in particular issues published.
(2) Every prisoner in Division I or II shall be supplied with the Holy-`Quran/Bible or respective prayer
Books of the denomination to which he belongs, and any other religious books as authorised by the
Government. These religious books shall be in addition to the five books authorised in paragraph I
above.
1075.Exercise.-All prisoners shall take such exercise daily in the open air as the Medical Officer considers
necessary and under such regulations as the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall prescribe.
1076. Opening of barracks.- The barracks and cells shall, subject to Rule 1226, be unlocked at
dawn throughout the year, Twenty minutes before the opening of the barracks and cells the rising bell
or gong shall be sounded, and the watchmen shall then rouse the prisoners. Every prisoner shall fold up
his bedding neatly and shall sit in file down the centre of ward for the purpose of being counted before
being taken out of the ward. Prisoners in cells shall stand at attention at the cell gate facing outwards,
The convict officers will ascertain if any prisoner is sick or wishes to see the Medical Officer.
1077. Latrine arrangements.- (a) Separate Latrine and bathing places, if possible, shall be provided
to the prisoners in Division I and Division II. Prisoners may, however, provide a chamber and a
commode at their own expense subject to approval of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent.
(b) After the ward has been opened, the prisoners shall be allowed to go to the latrine in batches
according to the accommodation in the latrine. Prisoners while not in the latrine will remain together in
the ward. Sick prisoners shall be seen by the Medical Subordinate in the ward.
(c) Reasonable time shall be allowed to all classes of prisoners for visiting latrines and taking baths.
1078. Bathing and washing arrangements.-
(a) Separate bathing places shall be provided for prisoners in Division I and II. After the latrine parade,
the prisoners shall go to the bathing places where prisoners in Division II shall wash their hands and
faces, and Prisoners in Division I shall take their baths. The time allowed to Division 1 prisoners for
bathing shall be such as to allow every prisoner ten minutes for bathing ; if necessary, the Prisoners
will go in batches.
(b) After washing or bathing, the early morning meal shall be distributed. At this time the Jailor shall
arrange any alternations of the groups that may be necessary, noting any change of work he may order
in the prisoners' history tickets, or causing such entries to be made under his initials, and having the
alterations entered in the group books. (See Rule 784 regarding allotment of tasks.)
(c) On completion of the early morning meal the prisoners shall be allowed to wash their hands, after
which the rolls shall be called, and they shall go to their working places.
182
1079. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall appoint reliable convict Officer of A (non
habitual) class of prisoners in Division III to carry out the duties of convict officers for prisoners in
Division I and Division II but, as far as possible, the prisoners shall be guarded by warders.
1080. Disposal of kit.- Prisoners shall not be required to carry their kit with them. At working time
the kit shall be left in the ward or cells in charge of a convict officer.
1081. Midday meal and washing arrangements, etc.- Prisoners shall be given their meals in sheds
or other suitable shelter, When the bell for the midday parade rings, the prisoners shall go to their
bathing places, have their baths, unless exempted on medical grounds. After bathing they shall go to
the feeding sheds or other allotted places for taking their meal and the meal shall be distributed under
the superintendence of a convict officer. They shall wash their own feeding utensils, but the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent can, at his own discretion, allow the employment of an ordinary
prisoner for this purpose in the case of Division I prisoners. Prisoners in Division I and Division II
cannot however be allowed to use other prisoners as their personal servants. Complaints about food
shall be reported at once to the Jailor as provided in Rule 642.
After the meal prisoners shall be allowed to visit the latrine for a reasonable time [Rule
1077(c)]. After that they shall return to their ward and cells.
Note: Food will served to the prisoner at their convenient time during the month of Ramadan. (See
Rule 692 regarding ifter and seheri)
1082. Resumption and cessation of work.- Prisoners will resume work in the afternoon on the sound
of a bell or gong and cease work when the gong is again sounded in the evening and go through the
same procedure as in the morning, except that bathing in the evening should not be insisted on, except
washing of hands, feet and face.
Note: See Rule 692(3) regarding distribution of labours to the fasting prisoners.
1083. Night latrine arrangements.- Such number of sanitary latrines as necessary shall be provided
for each ward/cells and shall be screened off for purposes of decency. There should be washing basins
in each of the wards and cells for washing purposes and also for the purpose of ablution during the
month of Ramadan.
1084. Complaints.- Parades will be held on a convenient date (once in a week) one Sunday morning
to hear complaints, but this does not preclude any prisoner from interviewing the Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent/ any other Jail officers at other times with legitimate complaints.
1085. Silence during work.- Silence shall be maintained during work except when any enquiry or
instructions relating to work are necessary. All loud talking, singing or quarrelling is prohibited, but out
of working hours prisoners shall be permitted to converse quietly. Between lock-up and 10 pm
prisoners may also read aloud from books provided from the jail library or recite verses of the Holy
Quran.
Note: The prisoners may be allowed to enjoy the programme of B.T.V. between lock up and 10 P.M.
Such hour can be extended at the discretion of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent.
1086. Misconduct.- The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may, in cases of misconduct,
withdraw individual concessions allowed by these rules, subject to the sanction of the Inspector
General of Prisons when the period exceeds 3 months. The power to remove a prisoner from Division I
or Division II vests in the Government.
1087. Clothing, etc, on release.- (1) Prisoners in Divisions I and II shall ordinarily be released from
jail in the clothing in which they came to jail, but if their personal clothing has been destroyed or
appears insufficient for decency, they shall be issued with a shirt and a pair of trousers and in cold
weather additional clothing and subsistence allowance at the rate of Tk.100/- per diem per prisoner in
case of Division I and II prisoners. For women convenient cloth should be given and in cold weather
additional cloth also be given.
(2) When released prisoners in Divisions I and II shall have to travel to their homes by rail,
they shall be provided on the Railway Credit Note system with second class or equivalent
accommodation.
183
1088. Weighment. - Prisoners in Division I and Division II shall be weighed in shirt, trousers and
socks once a fortnight and prisoners loosing weight for more than 2 kgs. shall be checked by the
Medical Officer and shall take such action as he deems fit and proper for recoupment of his health.
1089. Prisoner subject to Jail Code in other respects: In all other respects prisoners in Division I and II
are, unless otherwise provided, subject to the ordinary rules of the Jail Code. The Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent has no power to modify, relax or change any of the rules at his discretion.
1090. Abstract of rules to be hung in cells and wards. The Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent
shall cause an abstract of the rules relating to discipline and conduct, rewards and punishments
affecting prisoners in Divisions I and II to be placed in each cell or ward.
1091. deleted.
CHAPTER XXXVI. FOOD.
Section-1: Diet.
1092. Deleted
1093 All the prisoners shall have three meals a day-the early morning meal before the hour of labour, a
mid-day meal, and an evening meal before they are locked up for the night. (see Rules 636, 642 and 643).
1094. Deleted
1095. The following are the scales of diet sanctioned for Division III convicts and Division II under
trials (non-classified under trials) per day:-
184
Note.5- Gas should preferably be used for cooking purposes where it is available. If gas is not
available, fire wood/coal will be used.
Note-6: If banana, guava, papaya etc., is/are issued, each prisoner will have one fruits. If water melon
are/is served, each prisoner will have l20 grams.
1095(I) During the month of Ramadan Muslim prisoners fasting shall get diet as Ifteri at the
following scale per head at the sunset, this is in lieu of their morning meal:-
Items Quantity
Chola 60 Grams
Muri 50 Grams
Lemon no.
Sugar 30 Grams
Zelapi 35 Grams
Bringal 30 Grams
Bason 25 Grams
Oil 15 Grams
Onion 8 Grams
Green chillies 10.00 Grams
Banana 1 no.
The midday meal will be served at late night as sheheri to the fasting prisoners. The prisoners not
fasting will get the normal diet.
Note: At the discretion of the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent 50 grams of dal may be served
in the from of peyazu but in this case the dal must be deducted from the regular allowance so that
no extra expenditure is incurred on that account.
1095.2 The following are the scales of diet sanctioned for the prisoners admitted into hospital.
1096. In the case of evening meal 80.00 grams or less of dal may, once or more in a week at the
discretion of Senior Superintendent/Superintendent be added to the diet, which should then be served
in the form of khicheri seasoned with salt, but in this case the dal must be deducted from the
allowance of the mid-day and evening meals, (see Rule-1097). 50 (Fifty) grams of cucumber and 10
grams of onion will be issued in the form of salad to all prisoners the day when khicheri will be
served.
1097. The articles of diet provided for the mid-day and evening meals shall be equally divided
between such meals.
185
1098. Medical officer can suggest increase in scale of meat or fish by deducting 50 grams of dal,
provided the cost remains the same.
Note:- Meat/egg can be substituted for fish and fish/egg can be substituted for meat. Once egg is
being substituted for meat/fish, it should be given at the scale of 1 (one) per prisoner.
Note:- The quantity of fish or meat authorised under this rule may be issued on alternate days or
accumulated and issued either once or twice a week or on every fourth day according to the discretion
of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of jail
1099. The allowance of chillies, onion and fresh vegetables may be increased by Medical Officer to
any reasonable extent that can be supplied from the jail garden. The allowance of salt and oil may be
temporarily increased by Medical Officer when there is unusual sickness and tendency to loss of
weight observed amongst the prisoners.
Note- Deleted.
1100. The following is the scale of diet for Division I and II convicts and Division I under trial
prisoners.
Diet scales
A diet. B Diet.
Items of diet Items of diet
quantity. Quantity
For early morning meal For early morning meal
Bread or atta or rice or suji 120 grams 117 grams
Tea or cocoa or coffee- 15 '' 15 grams
Sugar -- -- 60 '' 60 grams
Butter -- -- 22 '' 30 grams
or ghee -- -- 15 '' 15 grams
Milk (Powder) -- -- 60 '' 60 grams
186
Note:- Prisoners on first admission will be allowed to take either A or B diet and no subsequent change
will be allowed. The Senor Superintendent/Superintendent shall issue a menu in accordance with the
quantities authorized and shall use his discretion in allowing substitutes. The issue of atta or rice can be
made in any proportion required. Any alterations of diet considered necessary which are not authorized
should be reported to the Inspector General of prisons in accordance with jail code Rule 96.
1101. No reduction from, or alteration of, these diet scales shall be made otherwise than under the
circumstances prescribed in Rule 97,722,942, 1102 to 1104,1221 and 1224. But when there are less
than five prisoners in a mess, the firewood may be increased to 700 grams, or even to 1000 grams per
man; the expenditure for fuel should be economised as much as possible by using prepared cowdung,
or twigs, branches and dried jungle from the garden which should be stacked for this purpose during
the dry season. Civil prisoners shall be provided for in accordance with Rule 890. With regard to
hospital diet, see Rule 1238.
1102. Every convict, and every unconvicted or civil prisoner who does not maintain himself, shall,
when not placed on special diet on medical grounds, daily receive the scale of diet provided for
prisoners of the class to which he belongs, provided that-
(1) Deleted.
(2) In times of scarcity or famine the Chief Medical Officer shall pay special attention to the dietary
of newly admitted prisoners. All such prisoners as may be weekly should be placed in either the
convalescent or special groups, or the Medical Officer may, in his discretion, and with the
previous sanction of the Inspector General of Prisons, devise a special scale of diet for such
prisoners who should only gradually be permitted to be put upon the ordinary jail diet;
(3) Prisoners sentenced to rigorous imprisonment shall, when undergoing punishment involving a
cessation from labour, receive diet according to Scale II of Rule 1095.
(4) Nursing mothers shall be allowed 117 grams of rice or atta and 29 grams of mustard oil in excess
of the ordinary labouring ration.
1103. Children admitted to jail with their mothers shall be dieted as the chief Medical Officer may
direct ; or the following may be issued: -
(a) For children under 12 months-when the milk of nursing mother is scanty, it may be supplemented
with cow's or any other milk suitably mixed with water, at the discretion of the Medical Officer.
A melamine cup may be supplied for such child.
(b) For children between 12 and 18 months 0.5 litre of milk or 60 grams of powder milk, 116.00
grams of rice and 29.00 grams of dal.
(c) For children between 18 and 36 months 230.00 ml. milk or 30 grams of powder milk, 233.00
grams of rice and 29.00 grams of dal.
(d) The following are scales for all children between 36 months and 72 months-
Milk- 0.230 litre/30 grams (powder).
Rice- 350 grams.
Dal- 50 grams.
Fish/meat- 35 grams.
Note.- Diet may be issued to children above 2 years of age at the discretion of the Medical
Officer.
1104. Whenever the Medical Officer considers it desirable, 58.32 or 116.64 grams of meat or fish, or a
nutritive equivalent of dahi shall be given from two or four times a week, instead of 58.32 grams of dal.
The dahi should be prepared or obtained the day before it is required for issue. The solid curd should be
obtained by straining the dahi through a thin bag and should be issued in full weight according to the
allowance ordered. The whey should be added to the curd after its distribution at the feeding platform,
and be issued as an extra on account of its wholesome properties. Under the following circumstances,
however, no option will be allowed in regard to issuing animal food, of which 116.64 grams or such
quantity as is of fully equivalent nutritive value must be substituted for 58.32 grams of dal four times a
week:
(a) If the fortnightly weighments indicate that an unusual proportion of the healthy prisoners have
lost weight.
187
(b) If there is any general tendency to scurvy with ulceration of the gums.
(c) If the number of admissions into hospital from dysentery is on the increase and the disease is of a
severe or scorbutic type.
1105.The following registers shall be maintained in respect of the issue of food :-
Nos. 36 A and 36 B, Diet Rolls for ordinary prisoners (Rule 1095) and Division I and II convicts
and Division 1 under trials. The careful keeping up of these rolls is very necessary. Many who are
released during the day, or come into jail in the afternoon, can take respectively only either the morning
or the evening meal. A detailed account of the number of prisoners fed at each meal is necessary to
afford a correct check upon the issue of food in full quantity according to scale- a matter of great
importance in maintaining their health; it is also necessary for checking over-issue or peculation. This
calculation the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent ought to compare with the actual issues recorded
in the stock Book No. 33.
1106. Of equal importance is the quality, proper preparation, and cooking of the food and its issue in
full quantity. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent and the Medical Officer shall therefore exercise
the utmost vigilance in the supervision of food supplies, and when the food is cooked and ready for
issue, and also after distribution into the prisoners plates, it shall, at least once in every week, be
inspected without previous notice, by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail and by the
Medical Office, to see that it is properly prepared. At this inspection the weight of the food distributed to
several of the prisoners should be tested.
1107. All items of the dietary shall be weighed out to the cooks in a fully prepared state, or if this is
impossible, with a full allowance for any loss which must occur in preparation by the cooks. All food
shall be issued as early as possible of its being cooked.
1108. 291.60 grams of atta corresponds nearly with 437.40 grams of dough and 379.08 grams of
chappati. Each chappati shall be weighed as dough, which shall be slowly and thoroughly kneaded and
then be rolled to a uniform thickness on a table by a rolling pin, not patted by hand; the cooking must be
done slowly on a gently heated plate, so as not to burn the out side whilst the inner part remains
uncooked. Chappati shall be made of two sizes, i.e., large, containing 116.64 grams of atta, and small,
containing 58.32 grams. The following table shows the weight of flour and number and size of chappatis
that can be issued to each prisoner :-
Number of chappatis.
Weight of
Class Made from 117 grams of Made from 58 grams of
Atta in grams.
Atta. Atta.
188
Prisoners of Class 1 292 grams. 2 1
Prisoners of Class 11 204grams. 1 1.5
1109. Dal which will be purchased for the prisoners shall be selected by the Inspector General of
Prisons from amongst masur and chola, preference should be given to the masur dal for prisoners
consumption. The cooked dal should be frequently tested by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent,
Medical Officer and Jailor to ensure its standard quality.
1110. Deleted.
1111. Only succulent vegetables shall be issued. They shall be freed from stalks, fibrous portions and
rotten leaves or parts, and shall be cut up ready for the pot before they are weighed out to the cooks.
Light labour or special group prisoners may prepare the vegetables. Arrangements must be made to
ensure a sufficient supply during the hot weather and rains of succulent, nutritious and antiscorbutic
vegetables; sags should be given only at intervals, and when young and tender; successive crops of
country radish should be ready at this time, and cabbage should be largely cultivated. Seasonal
vegetables and fruits should be specially grown and stored for issue at this season. Potatoes and onions
when issued may be spiced with oil and chillies and given in the form of ''bhurta''. The vegetables should
be examined daily by the Medical Office or Medical Subordinate.
1112. An allowance of 25% should be given for heads, tails and scales when fish is issued and for
bone an allowance of 33% and 25% should given respectively when beef or goats meat is issued. These
allowances will be an addition to the actual prescribed scales.
1113. All articles issued for rations shall be inspected frequently by the Medical Officer, and any
defect of quality noted by officer shall be reported at once to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent
by the Jailor.
1114. Correct and well-made beam scales and weights shall be used in every jail, both for weighing
supplies in bulk and for weighing the food after distribution, and shall frequently be tested by the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent; the scales should be kept properly adjusted. Proper tin measures
carefully and frequently tested shall be kept for the distribution of all food that has to be given out by
measure. All complaints of prisoners respecting the quantity, quality, or cooking of the rations shall be at
once brought to the notice of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent and promptly enquired into, and
if the complaint be found true and the irregularity is due to the fault of any jail official, the Senior
Superintendent/ Superintendent shall record his orders in his minute-book.
1115. The uncooked food shall be weighed out to the cooks by the Jailor, Deputy Jailor, Clerk or Head
Warder specially appointed to keep the godown. The Jailor shall, however, be always held responsible
for seeing that the full quantity is issued. The edible oil shall not be issued until it is required to be put
into the cooking pot. The oil shall be put into the cooking pot in the Presence of a Head Warder.
1116. Deleted.
1117. Deleted.
1118. The cook shall perform all preparations and processes necessary after issue of the daily supplies
to them and shall cook food with due care and attention. Metal cooking pots shall be used. All cooking
utensils must be kept scrupulously clean and bright and the cook-house and feeding places as clean and
tidy as it is possible to make them. Any breach of this rule shall render the cooks liable to punishment.
1118.1 The cooks employed both in the general and hospital kitchens of the jail should be medically
examined at least once a month so as to ensure that no prisoner who is suffering from any disease is
employed in the kitchen for preparation and supply of food to the prisoners.
1119. Places at which prisoners take their mid-day or any meal in the hot weather or any meal when it
rains should be sheltered from the sun and rain. If there are no sheltered roofs over the ordinary feeding
platforms, the prisoners must sit at this meal in verandahs, or, if necessary, in the worksheds or wards, or
wherever shelter can be found.
1120. Deleted.
189
1121. Purchase should be made as per existing Government Rules.
1122. The Jailor shall be responsible for the weighment of all supplies and their safe keeping after
delivery, but the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall examine a portion of every delivery of
grain brought into the jail and satisfy himself that it is of good quality and suitable for its purpose before
it is stored. There should be no delay between delivery and weighment, and payment must be made at
once after weighment and approval by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent. Unless prompt
payment is made, it cannot be expected that dealers will give the most favourable terms.
1123. Grain should not be finally stored until thoroughly dry; if very new and damp, it should be
spread out to dry in the sun for two or three days before it is stored. During this time it should be
frequently turned over by light labour prisoners. It must not be left lying in the open air at night. While
in store it should be protected from the depredation of birds and vermin, and as far as possible be
inaccessible to prisoners other than those employed in its preparation. Grain should be stored in bags
and not loose in bulk.
1124. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent, in consultation with Medical Officers, should use
their discretion in storing either paddy or rice according to the circumstances of each jail, having regard
to the labour available and the profit to be obtained. It is not expedient to husk paddy in jails where the
labour can be more profitably employed for the benefit of government. The boiling and drying of paddy
preparatory to husking shall not be carried on during the rainy season, i.e., during the 4.5 months from
1st June to the 15th October. Arrangements must be made to complete the boiling and thorough drying of
the paddy during the dry season. If the labour available is not sufficient to prepare in the dry season the
whole of the paddy required for the years supply, rice must be purchased and stored for issue during the
rains.
1125. Great care must be exercised in husking paddy, that the rice is not damaged by over-boiling or
stepping that the grain is thoroughly freed from the outer husk, and that excessive waste is not caused by
breaking the grain. Every batch of rice produced should be examined by the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent and Medical Officer and any rice damaged should be condemned and used for cattle; if
the rice is imperfectly husked, it shall be returned to the convicts to be properly cleaned. Those in fault
either in respect of damage or waste should be punished, and the quantity damaged or lost as waste
should be written off the accounts. Where female convicts are available those should be employed in
husking paddy in preference to males, as many of them are accustomed to such work in their own
homes. If the work is done by male convicts, the Jailer must himself supervise the work and will be held
responsible that due care is taken to obtain clean and good rice.
1126. So far as possible, articles of diet required for feeding prisoners shall be raised on jail land and
be prepared by the jail labour. All pulses required for consumption in a jail shall invariably be husked by
prisoners; and both in regard to these and the manufacture of flour and mustard oil for food, the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent should frequently compare the amount of the out turn with the grain
issued and see that a full return is obtained.
1127. In order to furnish an economical supply of fish, whenever there is a tank within the jail
precincts, it should be periodically stocked with fish fry of the roho, mirgal and cutla varieties of the
carp (cyprinide) species. If there are tanks in the vicinity, which can be properly preserved, these may be
rented with the sanction of the Inspector General to the extent necessary for the supply of a sufficient
quantity of fish, and should be so stocked. Every Jailor should study the subject of fish-breeding, and be
able to distinguish the full-grown fish and the fry of the above species, and also fry of fish which are
carnivorous feeders, which should be excluded from fish tanks. Instructions regarding fish-breeding are
furnished for guidance in Appendix No. 25. The theft of fish from a fish tank on the part of a prisoner
shall be punished as a jail offence, and if committed by a subordinate officer, will render him liable to
dismissal.
1127.1 For correct evaluation of the comparative progress in fish rearing in jails in successive years, the
Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall mention in the Annual Administration Report of the jail total
quantity and the estimated value of fish raised from the jail tanks for use in the jail and the total expenditure
incurred on purchases of fish during the year under report as well as the preceding two years.
190
1127.2 All the jail staff are required to be in close touch with the jail through the day, they get a very little
opportunity for recreation and hence, to avoid monotony of work they are allowed angling in the jail tank on
Friday and holidays on a nominal charge of Tk. 5 per rod per day and Tk. 20/- per rod per month.
Section 1V- THE DAIRY.
1128. In jails where facilities available may have a dairy. Well-roofed and ventilated sheds shall be
provided. The floor should be of well-burnt brick-on-edge or other good material pointed with cement. To
prevent slipping the slope of the floor should be slight, only sufficient to carry off the urine and washing to a
masonry drain emptying through a spout into iron receptacles removable by hand, and not into the surface
drains of the jail. The vital necessity of cleanliness must always be borne in mind. The floor of the cow shed
must be scrubbed and washed daily and afterwards thoroughly dried. Sand and straw should be thrown on the
floor to prevent the cows slipping. The presence of flies in the cow-house is a sure sign of neglect. A separate
shed or separate division of shed should be provided for weaned calves.
1129. Care should be taken to select the best breed of cows that can be obtained either locally or by
purchase in other districts ; as a rule it will be found in Bangladesh that the best cows locally obtainable
do better than importation's from distant parts. The improvement of the breed should always be kept in
view. Well-bred bulls when available will be supplied by the Livestock Department of Government;
these shall be maintained at the jail, and the use of them by raiyats, gowalas, and cattle breeders in the
neighborhood shall be allowed, on payment of the usual local charge. If a good bull is not in stock the
services of the best procurable in the neighborhood should be obtained. Two much inter-breeding should
be avoided.
1130. Dry cows, calves, bulls and bullocks should be allowed to graze outside the jail, and they should
be housed outside the jail walls. Cows actually in milk should be stall-fed and may be kept inside the jail
enclosures, a sufficiently large shed in two divisions being made for them and for their calves.
1131. Care should be taken to ensure sufficient milk being available for prisoners. To provide for this,
cows should be covered, so that they calve at periodic intervals throughout the year, bearing in mind that
more milk is required during the autumnal fever season. At the same time a cow should be sent to the
bull whenever, after calving, she shows desire. Generally this will not be before three months. Where
fodder is cheap, female calves and a sufficient number of male calves of good breed for use as bulls and
bullocks should be reared.
1132. Registered numbers shall be given to every head of cattle; these numbers shall be inscribed on a
wooden or metal ticket suspended from the neck of each animal: in the case of calves the ticket shall
bear in addition the registered numbers of the mothers.
1133. As directed in rule 642, food not eaten by prisoners shall be carefully separated into two
buckets- one for the rice or chappaties, the other for curried refuse food. Only the former should be
given to cattle; the latter should be used for feeding fish or be buried as manure. All rice water, rice
washings, dal husks, and any other refuse from the preparation of grain which may be wholesome for
cattle, oil-cake from the manufacture of mustard oil and grass from jail lands should be used as cattle
food and should be supplemented with such purchase or other food as are necessary.
1134. In the hot weather cattle should be washed thoroughly in the sun daily, care being taken to dry
them well. In the cold weather they should be rubbed down and brushed.
1135. The full quantity of milk (or any article made from it) shall be used in the jail for Government
purposes only; and none shall be sold to jail officials or outsiders. The milk (or its produce) yielded by
the dairy shall first be utilised to meet the needs of the sick in hospital (especially those suffering from
bowel diseases) and of prisoners in the convalescent and special groups. After the requirement of these
and of old and weakly prisoners have been fully satisfied the surplus milk, if any, shall be issued as food
for ordinary prisoners, see Rule 1104.
191
1136. The manufacture of butter or ghee (except for prisoners' diet, vide Rule 1100, under the
conditions specified in Rule 1135 or if ordered in lieu of oil for misdemeanants of the 1 st degree, vide
Rule 936)is prohibited. Milk should be issued to prisoner's either boiled or as dahi, and in no other form.
If boiled this should be done in the hospital enclosure under the supervision of the Medical officer, who
shall be responsible for the proper disposal of the milk from the time it is obtained from the cow to its
final distribution. In preparing dahi no water should be mixed with the milk before boiling.
1137. Great care should be taken that all vessels in which milk is manipulated are kept perfectly clean.
For unboiled milk the vessels should be made of tin. An iron karahi may be used for boiling milk; but
earthenware vessels should be used for setting dahi; if glazed vessels are procurable they should be used.
All vessels should be scalded and washed with boiling water immediately after use. They must not be
allowed to stand in a dirty condition. A properly secured and well-ventilated place should be provided in
which the milk should be stored as soon as possible after milking and until it is issued. It would be well
if this were in some prominent situation where the milk as well as all vessels used for storage or
preparation might be within the notice of inspecting officers.
1138. The manure from the dairy should be used for improving the jail garden and lands. In jails which
have a sufficient supply of manure from other sources the cow-dung should be utilised as fuel. Cakes
composed of one-fourth paddy husk and three-fourths cow-dung mixed with coal dust make good fuel
for the kitchen.
1139. Bulls under three and over eight years of age should not be used for breeding. No bull should be
allowed to serve more than two cows a week. Bulls should be kept apart from the cows.
Castration by cutting should be done between the ages of two and six months by crushing
between eighteen months and two years. If no jail officer or warder is competent to perform this
operation, the services of the local veterinary officer should be asked for.
1140. Animals suffering from infectious disease, e,g., rinder-pest, foot and mouth disease, anthrax,
etc., should advisable also be isolated under a tree in the jail garden. It is advisable also to isolate any
animal suffering from fever until the nature of the disease is apparent.
1141. Arrangements should be made with local veterinary assistants for attendance on jail cattle in
terms of Government order No. 562 T.R., dated the 20th May 1920.
1142. No jail subordinate except the Jailor may ordinarily be permitted to keep cattle on or near the
jail premises. The jailer shall be allowed to keep two cows with their two calves, but private cows shall
on no account be kept with the jail cattle, nor shall any of the jail refuse food or grass be allowed for
them.
The Inspector General of Prisons may at his discretion sanction the keeping of private cattle by
any other jail subordinate in special cases where in his opinion the restriction would impose extreme
hardship upon the officers concerned.
1143. Jail dairies shall be open to the inspection of officers of the Livestock Department, who see that
the bulls supplied by that Department are well cared for and utilised for the public benefit.
1144. The Jailor or Deputy Jailor and the Medical Officer shall visit the dairy daily and the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent shall inspect all cattle once weekly.
1145. Annually in the first week of January the dairy live-stock shall be revalued by the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent in consultation with the Jailor and other officers; the prevailing local
prices shall be entered as if it were a bona fide valuation for sale.
1146. A careful record of dairy stock and transactions shall be kept in Register No. 35, Dairy Accounts
and Cattle Register. This Register is in four parts :-
192
Part 1:- Monthly statement of receipt and disposal of live stock. A record of the number of
cattle of each kind. and of purchase or receipt and disposal of them. This is in the form of a monthly
abstract account, and needs no explanation. Opposite every item of purchase or sale of cattle the actual
price given or received shall be entered, and in the column of remarks drawn to pay for a purchase or the
date of entry in the cash-book of receipt of sale proceeds shall be shown. The number of draught
bullocks should likewise be stated.
Part 11:- Particulars of purchase of fodder and other miscellaneous cash expenditure and daily
disbursement. This is a condensed form of Register No. 33, Stock-book of provisions, etc, allowing the
accounts of five different kinds of fodder besides miscellaneous items to be kept in one page. Not only
fodder purchased should be entered here but also the issue to cattle of bye-products of provisions
purchased for the prisoners, such as bhusi, oil-cake, etc; the expenditure on working bullocks calculated
as in Rule 1147 need not be recorded here but must be taken into account when estimating the financial
results of the dairy in the Monthly Return No. 17 A.
Part 111:- An account of the receipt and issue of milk and of dahi made from any portion of it.
Individual milk record for each cow shall also be maintained in Director of Agricultures non-standard
Form No. 50.
Part 1V:- A record of the history and pedigree of each cow shall be maintained in Director of
Agriculture's Form No. 36 (new). It is very important that entries should be made in this part
immediately each event occurs; the Jailor will be held responsible for this. From these accounts shall be
prepared and furnished in Monthly Return No. 17 A an abstract showing on the one side all expenditure
incurred for the dairy, including issue of bye-products as recorded in the Stock Register No. 33, and all
entries in the dairy register of loss or depreciation of stock; and on the other, the value of milk and sale
of any of the spare stock; with the loss or profit made.
1147. Expenditure on the maintenance of working bullocks shall be calculated as follows:- Count
every two calves as equal to one head of cattle; divide the total quarterly expenditure for maintenance of
the dairy by the total head of cattle and multiply the result by the number of working bullocks.
1149. The jail garden shall be kept neat and clean, free from weeds and undergrowth. Cow dung from
the dairy shall be used in the gardens as manure. In the rainy season succulent weeds should be dug into
the soil, but fibrous and woody vegetable refuse should be put into manure pits as far as possible from
the jail and allowed to rot until they are in a condition suitable for manuring the land. For instructions
regarding trenching, see Rule 1195.
1150. Care shall be taken that all available sources of water supply in gardens are utilised as far as
possible. Irrigation channels should be of pucca masonry or burnt earthenware in mortar, and leakages
should be promptly repaired.
193
1151. The number of prisoners employed in the garden for the production of jail vegetables,
condiments and antiscorbutics ought not ordinarily to exceed 6 per cent. of the strength of the prisoners
confined in the jail. The numbers may be increased under intimation to the Inspector General of Prisons
if necessary. Prisoners employed in the garden shall be selected in accordance with Rules 795 and 796,
and special care must be taken in guarding them as directed in Chapter VII. The warder in charge of the
garden should be a man who thoroughly understands gardening, and if possible, he shall have charge of
the garden group for the whole day, and sleep in the garden at night in a hut provided for him.
1152. The Jailor shall be responsible to the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent that the full supply
of vegetables required for prisoners' consumption shall, as far as possible, be grown in the jail garden,
and that when vegetables are bought an explanation of the failure to obtain the supply from the garden
shall be furnished by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent to the Inspector General of Prisons.
1153. The Jailor shall be responsible that the garden contains at all seasons a sufficient quantity of
good succulent vegetables, condiments and antiscorbutics for jail use, and that the whole of the jail land
outside the jail walls available for cultivation is cultivated to the best advantage. A garden of sufficient
size to supply all vegetables and condiments required should be laid out and surrounded by a hedge and
ditch, and no warders or other subordinate officers should be permitted to go into the garden except
when on duty there. Another plot of land should be set apart for a lime orchard, which should contain
one full bearing lime bush of the kaghzi variety for every prisoner the jail can contain. Both the
vegetable garden and lime orchard should be situated near the source of a good supply of water. After
the garden and orchard have been provided for, any spare land that may be available shall ordinarily be
utilised for raising crops suitable for the prisoners' food; but wet cultivation shall not be allowed close to
the jail.
1154. In addition to the lime orchard a good supply of antiscorbutic fruits should be provided for by
planting tamarind (Tamarindus Indica), bael (aegle marmelos), amrah (Spondias mangifera), and mango
(Mangifera Indica) trees along the margins of roads, the boundaries of the jail land in other available
places, so as not to interfere with cultivation more than can be avoided. Such trees give agreeable shade
if grown within the jail walls in spaces available, but must not be allowed to interfere with the
ventilation of the wards or workshops. There shall be at least one tamarind tree to 50 prisoners and one
bael tree to 30 prisoners of the maximum capacity of the jail. The Jailor shall be held responsible for the
number of these trees and for seeing that they are kept in a healthy condition.
1155. Bangladesh vegetable seeds suitable for cultivation in the hot weather and monsoons should be
purchased or specially grown. Supplies of seed for cold - weather crops shall be obtained on indent
through the Inspector General. Indents should be submitted on the 1 st April each year. The jail garden is
primarily intended to grow vegetables for prisoners, and therefore, only such seeds should be obtained
as are most useful for jail purposes. In the proper seasons crops of potatoes, onions, radish, turnip, sweet
potato, kutchu, cabbage, and such as will be available for use in the hot weather or can be stored for
issue in the rainy season should be grown to the fullest extent of probable requirements. Radishes should
be available for issue to prisoners early in August.
1156. Jailors shall be responsible that crops grown on jail land are reaped at the proper time, that no
unnecessary delay occurs between reaping them and bringing them into store; that proper precautions
are taken against peculation or loss by vermin; that the bye-products are properly disposed of for
Government purposes only; and that the value of everything is duly accounted for in the jail accounts.
Every opportunity must be taken of effecting economy by utilising every product of the jail land, and all
products suitable for fodder must be appropriated for consumption in the dairy. An annual statement
shall be submitted to the Inspector General of Prisons of the value of vegetables and other products of
the jail land and farms used to supplement supplies purchased for the maintenance of the jail.
194
1157. Vegetables from the jail garden may be allowed daily free of charge to Deputy-Superintendents
(except when land is allowed to the Deputy-Superintendent for a private garden), Jailors, Deputy-Jailors,
Assistants and Medical Officers, Pharmacists sufficient for the requirements of each household,
provided that the requirements of jail shall have been in the first place fully supplied. Free supply of
vegetables from jail garden to the staff shall cease if any vegetables have to be purchased for the jail.
The allowance of vegetables for each officer shall be inspected by the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent daily on his arrival at the jail. If there are vegetables or fruit to spare they may be given
to Head Warders and Warders to the extent of their personal needs only.
1157.1. No trees on jail lands shall be cut down or their branches lopped off or otherwise removed,
without prior sanction of the Inspector General, unless immediate danger is threatened to security or to
buildings, etc., in which case, such sanction may be obtained afterwards. The products and the parts of
the trees felled, shall be fully accounted for, the fruits being disposed of suitably and logs and branches
being either utilised for the purpose of the jail or sold by auction, according as the Inspector General
may direct.
CHAPTER XXXVIII.- CLOTHING, BEDDING, AND JAIL EQUIPMENT.
1158. The supply of clothing and bedding when necessary to civil and under trial prisoners, and of
clothing when necessary to prisoners sentenced to simple imprisonment, is regulated by Rules 923 to
925 and 939. Any bedding supplied to under trial prisoners, or clothing supplied to simple imprisonment
prisoners, from jail stores, under those rules, shall be of the same pattern as that supplied to labouring
convicts. When, however, it is necessary to wash or disinfect the clothing of civil, under trial or simple
imprisonment prisoners, long-half sleeved kurtas and payjama/trouser made of plain cotton cloth,
without any distinctive marks, shall be supplied to such prisoners until their own clothing is returned to
them, provided that if any such prisoner is in possession of spare clothing he shall be allowed to wear it
at such times. Under trial prisoners shall be supplied with a melamine plate, bati and mug, and simple
imprisonment prisoners with these and with blankets and bedding as ordered in Rule 939.
1159. All prisoners in Division III sentenced to rigorous imprisonment shall be furnished, on
admission, with the following jail equipment :-
Males. Females.
1 Cotton full sleeved shirt. 3 Cotton saris/salowers and kamises.
2 Cotton half sleeved shirts. 2 Cotton blouses 2 petty coats/ 3 dupattas/ ornas.
3 Cotton Nimes. 4 Cotton Gamchas.
2 Cotton Trousers (pair) 2 Cotton Bed sheets.
2 Cotton Caps. 1 Comb.
4 Cotton Gamchas. 3 Blankets.
2 Cotton Bed sheets. 2 Jute mats or satranjis 2.oo metre.
1 Comb 1 Melamine plate, bati, mug.
1 Warm sweater or pullover (half or full).
1 Melamine mug, plate, bati
3 Blankets.
1 Jute mat or satranji 2.00 metre.
Note 1.- One mirror ( 1 feet 1.5 feet for male and 2 feet 2 feet for female) will be fixed in suitable
places of each ward.
Note 2.- Married and unmarried female prisoners of ''A'' class shall be supplied with 1 blue bordered
plain white saries and of "B" class with 1 blue bordered striped saris. Widow prisoners shall be
provided with plain white saris without colored borders. Female prisoners of both "A" and "B" classes
shall be provided with chemise or kurta made of plain suti cloth manufactured in jail.
195
1160. All these articles shall be of standard pattern determined by the Inspector General, and, except
a blanket, or the blankets, and bedding, shall remain with the prisoners at all times and seasons. The
cotton clothing of male "A" class prisoners shall be distinguished by a narrow blue stripe woven in it;
that of male "B" class prisoners by a similar but broader stripe. The pattern of clothing of female "A"
and "B" class prisoners is laid down in rule 1159. Pillows shall not be allowed for prisoners. If
bamboo or iron cots are used, or if the masonry beds show any indication of dampness a bamboo or
grass mat/polethin/plastic sheet of the size of the bed shall be supplied in addition to other bedding.
1161. Prisoners who have escaped shall wear a red cap, and prisoners who are excluded as a
punishment from the benefits of the remission system shall wear a blue cap, instead of one of the
ordinary pattern. Only jail clothing shall be worn by prisoners sentenced to rigorous imprisonment;
the use or possession by them of private clothing, or by any criminal prisoner or lotas, mugs, or other
articles not issued from the jail stores, or not specially allowed to them, or ornaments, except the
Brahmanical thread or articles allowed under Rule 695 and Rule 701 is strictly prohibited. No
prisoners shall be allowed to wear their blankets while at work but may use a blanket at the early
morning parades in accordance with Rules 639 and 1226. A prisoner shall always wear his jail cap
during the day. The wearing of gumchas and other clothes about the head is absolutely forbidden. No
restriction shall be placed on the wearing of jersey/pullover by prisoners at any time of the day or
night except on medical grounds.
1162. All articles of jail clothing of every prisoner shall be marked with his or her jail number in figures at
least one inch long and the class letter A or B. For marking jail clothing the extract of permanent ink
(semecarpus anacardium) should be used, and care must be taken that the irritant properties of this dye are
neutralised by the application of fresh lime-water before the clothing is worn. Woollen clothing should be
stamped with white paint. Whenever the marking fades, or is obliterated, it should be renewed. The year of
manufacture of jersey/pullover and blankets shall be indicated by the number.
1163. The allowance of cotton clothing prescribed in Rule 1159, supplemented during the year with an
additional jungeah, cap and gumcha, should ordinarily last for 12 months, the jersey/pullover should
last at least two years, jute mat or satranji and blankets three years.
1164. Prisoners sentenced to imprisonment for one year and upwards shall ordinarily be supplied
with new cotton clothing, unless there is an accumulation of old clothing in stock. Used clothing in
serviceable condition shall be issued to shorter-term prisoners. Convict overseers shall be provided
with the uniform and clothing prescribed in Rules 411 and 425, but shall have the same bedding,
blankets, mug and plate as ordinary labouring convicts. All issues of clothing, bedding or other
articles of jail equipment shall be recorded on the prisoners history tickets, and whenever used
clothing or bedding is issued, the fact that it is not new shall likewise be so recorded.
1165. Convicted prisoners in Division II sentenced to rigorous imprisonment shall be furnished with
the following equipment :-
Male Female
Items Quantity Life Items Quantity Life
Cotton Paizamas 3 1 year. Cotton saris/salowers-kamises 4 1 year
Cotton trousers 1 6 Months Cotton blouses and pety coats/ornas/ 4 1 year
Dupattas
Cotton half sleeved shirts. 2 1 year. Shemises 2 1 year
Cotton full sleeved shirts. 2 1 year. Cotton/synthetic socks 2 1 year
Cotton caps 2 1 year. Leather sandals or shoes. 2 1 year
Cotton socks 2 1 year.
Cotton underwears. 2 1 year.
Shoes/sandals 1 1 year.
For both sexes
Items Quantity Life
Bed sheet 1 1 year.
Tooth brush 1 6 Months
Tooth paste 1 As and when the required
196
Spoon/Fork 1 1 year.
Melamine plate 1 No. 1 year.
Melamine cup 1 No. 1 year.
Melamine mug 1 No. 1 year.
Small hand mirror 1 No. 1 year.
Towels 1 1 year.
Pillow with cover 1 1 year.
Comb 1 1 year.
Blankets 3 No. As and when the required
Zaynamaz 1 No. 1 year.
Note.1 Articles of clothing solely for the use of female convicts need not be kept in stock, but may
be ordered as necessity arises. Pending issues females shall retain their private clothing.
Note.2 Married and unmarried female prisoners shall be provided with plain white saris with coloured
borders. Widow prisoners shall be provided with plain white saris without coloured borders.
All clothing shall as far as possible be manufactured in the jail and a standard shall be selected
for all jails.
1166. Prisoners while attending Courts after conviction to give evidence or to appear in any other
case should not wear prison clothing, but should be provided with decent clothing from the jail
suitable to their station in life.
1167. Special cotton clothing, blankets, bed sheets, 7 feet in length and 4 feet in width, and tatputee
bedding of the regulation size, shall be supplied for Hospital use. Cotton articles shall have red
stripes instead of blue, woven in them. Blankets and tatputee shall be marked with an "H" meaning
Hospital. All clothing and bedding set apart for the use of patients suffering from tuberculosis shall
be marked with a "T" and for patients suffering from Dysentery and Diarrhoea with a "D". The
Hospital clothing shall be kept under the charge of the Medical Subordinate. On admission into
hospital, the Medical Subordinate shall take from each prisoner his clothing, blankets, and bedding,
and place them, after they have been washed by the Hospital dhobi, in the Hospital store-room and
shall issue for the prisoner instead a suit of Hospital clothing, as many blankets as the necessity of
the case required, a bed sheet, and a tatputee. On discharge of a prisoner from hospital, his own jail
clothing and bedding shall be returned to him.
1168. The Medical Officer is empowered to order the issue of extra cotton or warm clothing or
bedding to any prisoner who needs them on medical ground. A pair of trousers, a blanket cap and an
extra blanket may be issued to all prisoners of 50 years of age and upwards and to all prisoners of the
convalescent and special groups, and shall remain with them at all seasons. Where there is any
tendency to bowel - disease a woolen cholera belt may also be issued to such prisoners and to any
others whom the Medical Officer may declare to require them. At the discretion of the Medical
Officer an extra blanket may be given to prisoners at any time. Care must be exercised to secure that
this extra clothing and bedding is taken from every prisoner when discharged from these groups, or
when the Medical Officer declares it is no longer necessary.
1169. Prisoners who work in the open shall in the rainy season if their cotton clothing becomes wet,
it shall be taken from them to be dried and other clothing shall be given to them to wear in their
wards, until their own clothes are returned to them dry, when the extra clothing shall be given up. All
extra clothing reserved for this purpose shall have a distinctive mark and shall be kept together when
not in use and entirely separate from the prisoners ordinary clothing. Such prisoners shall also in the
hot weather and rainy season each be supplied with a toka or sun-hat. The jailor shall at all times
have in store a stock of extra clothing sufficient to meet all demands under this and the preceding
rule.
1170. Deleted.
197
1171. Any prisoner who, willfully, or through want of care, renders any articles of this clothing or
equipment unserviceable before he is entitled to a new issue, shall be liable to punishment. The
possession of extra clothing or portion of clothing not authorised by these rules or of other articles of
jail equipment, the loss or exchange of any articles of clothing or equipment, the making of pockets,
langoti or extra sleeves, and the altering or erasing of the numbers on clothing, should be punished in
accordance with the rules in Chapter XIX. On the other hand any prisoner who makes his clothing
last in serviceable condition for one or more months beyond the prescribed period, shall be rewarded
by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent by the grant of such extra remission as he thinks
proper, within the limit allowed by Rule 765.
1172. Each prisoners clothing and equipment shall be renewed from time to time as necessity
arises; no date for the general or periodical issue of clothing, etc., is fixed; prisoners should not be
allowed to remain in tattered and unserviceable clothing. As pointed out in Rule 646 the Senior
Superintendent /Superintendent should pay attention to this matter at his weekly parades and see that
repairs are effected when damage or sings of wear appear. One or more light-labour prisoners,
according to the size of the jail, shall be kept constantly employed in repairing clothing which should
be taken up group by group under the supervision of a Head Warder. These are matters to which the
Jailer must give special attention at all times.
1173. Prisoners shall wash their own clothes as directed in Rule 573. Blanket kurtas and bedding
shall be boiled once in two months, and hospital clothing and bedding at short intervals by a group of
men specially set apart for this work. In order that this may be done systematically and thoroughly, it
should be done ward by ward. Spare kurtas and bedding should be temporarily issued while the
soiled articles are being dried, repaired or renewed. When practicable, the soiled blankets should be
replaced by a fresh issue and after being changed and thoroughly overhauled, be taken into the
godown for reissue in exchange for the soiled blankets of the next batch or ward. Each jail shall
have adequate facilities to clean the blankets regularly so that cleaned and hygienic blankets can
be issued to the prisoners. The boiling must be done thoroughly; there ought to be no vermin in the
clothing. At least once a week when the weather is fine, the bedding and blankets shall be aired in
the sun for at least three hours. This should ordinarily be done after the mid-day meal, and the
bedding left out until the prisoners return from work in the evening.
1174. The manufacture of clothing, bedding and other articles of jail equipment shall be
concentrated in manufacturing jails. Indents for annual requirements of clothing, bedding and
uniform (in B.J.Forms Nos. 61,61A and 62) shall be submitted through the Inspector General to the
supplying jails on the 1st March of each year. Supplementary indents should be avoided.
Manufacturing jails shall dispatch clothing and bedding so that they may arrive at their destination
before the 1st October, i.e., before the cold weather sets in. Indents for Melamine mug, plates, etc.,
shall be submitted to the Dhaka Central Jail through the Inspector General as occasion demands.
1175. Deleted.
1176. One of the Head Warders shall be placed in special charge of the clothing godown, and shall be
made responsible for the state of the clothes. The godown itself should be dry and well ventilated
and shall be fitted with proper shelves or bamboo machans. The blankets and clothing shall be
arranged in these shelves either separately or in complete kits ready for issue.
198
1177. The godown Head Warder, on taking over the kit of a released prisoner, shall see that all the
articles have been carefully washed and dried and shall on no account store blankets and clothes in a
dirty or damp state; all clothing taken back from prisoners shall be carefully examined, and any that
may be fit for further use shall be mended and kept in store for re-issue to newly-admitted prisoners.
The blankets and clothing in store shall be aired in the sun at least once a month, and, if possible, on
Friday.
1178. A careful record of the receipt and issue of all clothing and bedding shall be kept by the
Deputy-Jailor or Jail Clerk under the supervision of the Jailor in Register No. 34, Clothing Account
Book. A separate account shall be opened for each item of clothing and bedding, both new and old,
and the entries of receipt and issue shall be made daily. An account shall also be kept in this book of
melamine mugs, bati and plates, leather gaiters, and straps, etc. In every jail a separate account book
shall be opened for hospital clothing. The accounts shall be checked at the end of every month and
the balances in the godown or with the prisoners carried forward. The officer in charge of the
clothing godown shall each month verify by actual counting some or all of the balances shown as
remaining. Clothing considered to be unserviceable shall be brought at least once a month, before the
Senior Superintendent/Superintendent who shall if necessary, condemn such clothing and shall cause
it to be written off under his initial in the Account Book. Condemned clothing shall be torn up (under
the personal supervision of the officer in charge of the godown) into pieces not larger than 6 inches
square, except such as may be fit for use in the repair of other clothing.
1179. (1) In every sleeping ward, superficial and cubical space shall be allowed for each
prisoner, as stated below, according to the conditions specified :-
199
(7) All barracks should, if possible, be provided with verandahs 2.43 meters deeps, of masonry if
double storied ; of corrugated iron (or tiled) if single storied. (these verandahs also serve as feeding
platforms)
(8) Masonry berths one for each prisoner-on ground floor to be 1.82 metres x. 91 metres high x. 46
metres broad. In upper stories, the berths need only be. 15 metres above the floor. Iron beds may be
supplied in lieu of berths at the discretion of the Inspector General.
(9) In all sleeping barracks a sanitary latrine attached to the ward should, if possible, be provided.
(9.1) Each of the dormitories, barracks, cells, cubicle and Hospital wards should be provided with the
electric fans and Mosquito proof wire netting arrangements in order to protect the inmates from
mosquito bites and extreme heat of the night during hot weather.
1180. In jail hospitals the floor space should be not less than 6.50 square metres per head, i. e., for a
hospital ward of 20 sick, the size should be 6.1 metres x 21.31 metres. Not less than 25.49 cubic metres
shall be allowed to each prisoner in hospital. All new cells for the separate or solitary confinement of
prisoners shall have a superficial area of not less than 29.26 superficial metres and cubical capacity of
not less than 304.8 metres. There shall be thorough ventilation in every cell which, at the back of the
cell, may be by a clerestory window. The chief Medical Officer shall inspect all new cells, wards or
compartments, which shall not be occupied until he certifies that they are in all respects fit for
occupation.
1181. Thorough ventilation of the sleeping barracks is of the greatest importance; at least 93 square
metre of ventilation area per prisoner should be provided. Prisoners shall not be permitted at their
pleasure to close the windows and ventilation openings with shutters or purdahs, if these are provided,
so as to prevent necessary perflation of air, except temporarily to prevent rain from beating in. In new
barracks the ventilating area per head shall be half a window; as the standard grated window is 2.13
metres x 1.07 metres half a window will equal 1.11 square metres. The ventilation must however, be
controlled according to season; otherwise the barracks will be too cold and draughty in cold and damp
weather. The condition of the atmosphere in which the prisoners sleep at night may be judged of by
visiting the sleeping wards several hours after the prisoner have been locked up and noting the condition
of the air in the barracks; and this should be done at uncertain intervals by the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail and the Medical Officer. Whenever it appears that a barrack is
either insufficiently or over ventilated, necessary steps must be taken to remedy the defect. Whatever
arrangements are made, all shutters or other means of closing the windows which are not fixture (i.e.,
brick work) must be kept open during the day time to the fullest extent possible, and catches shall be
provided for the purpose. See Rule 1173 regarding the airing of blankets and bedding.
1182. Over the door of every ward there shall be an inscription, either in letters painted on the wall or on
a tablet of wood or metal, showing the class of prisoners for which it is intended, the number of cubic
and superficial feet it contains, and the number of prisoners which it is capable of accommodating.
Every ward should contain a bed for each prisoner; the number of beds to be exactly according to its
capacity. Temporary accommodation shall be provided for any prisoner in excess of this number. Care
shall be taken to see that the lock-up Register (No.12) shows the accommodation available in each ward,
so as to enable the Superintendent to judge at a glance whether any particular ward is overcrowded or
not.
1183. When the prisoners have left the barracks, the sweepers shall sweep thoroughly clean every part of
them and subsequently rub down all window sills, doors, shutters, and gratings on which dust and dirt
should not be allowed to accumulate, and shall then sweep the enclosures and remove all litter. Walls
inside should be frequently rubbed down with cocoanut husk and lime washed once a year, or oftener if
necessary. The inside wall of hospitals shall be rubbed down and lime washed once in every three
months, not clay-washed, but the wards for dysentery and infectious diseases shall be lime-washed once
in every month, whilst they are occupied by patients suffering from such diseases and immediately after
they are vacated. If the sleeping wards are infested with bugs, kerosine or cocoanut oil shall be liberally
applied and be followed with a coat of lime -wash.
200
1184. If, from unavoidable causes, prisoners have temporarily to sleep in worksheds, or verandahs or
other buildings not arranged for their accommodation at night an iron cot and mat, bamboo machan or
some sort of raised bed shall be provided for every prisoner, and arrangement must be made for their
protection from the weather by the use of jhamps, matting or purdahs. Every prisoner sleeping
temporarily in such places shall have an extra blanket. Whenever floors are liable to become damp, they
should be coated with a mixture of tar and ashes, or some equivalent substance; and if raised masonry
beds are used, this coating should intervene between the beds and the floor.
1185. Timely arrangements shall be made to avoid the confinement of prisoners in excess of the
sanctioned number. When the arrival of excess numbers is apprehended, the Superintendent shall at once
communicate with the Inspector General's office by letter or,. if urgent, by electronic means asking to
what jail a stated number of prisoners may be transferred. Descriptive rolls of prisoners shall at the same
time be prepared and submitted as soon as possible, but the reference to the Inspector General's office is
not to be deferred for the completion of these descriptive rolls. On receipt of a reply from the Inspector
General's office, if there is any urgency the Superintendent shall, under Rule 843, transfer a sufficient
number of prisoners in anticipation of formal sanction.
1186. Return No. 2 shall be submitted punctually on the first of every month to the Inspector General,
showing the number of prisoners who slept in the wards, cells and hospitals on the previous night,
together with the number for whom the wards are adapted. In the case of overcrowding or anticipated
overcrowding it shall be stated whether the overcrowding is likely to continue, and what measures are
proposed for its relief.
1187. The walls and roofs of worksheds shall be swept down once a week, and the walls shall be lime-
washed at least once a year. The floor of every workshop should be swept daily immediately after
prisoner stop work, and every part including manufacturing appliances should be kept clean and free of
dust and refuse.
1188. The enclosure area within the four walls of a jail should not be less than 75 square yards per head
of total capacity, where land is cheap not less than 100 square yards per head of total accommodation
should be the minimum or 30 acres for a full sized Central Jail. The height of the main or outer jail wall
should be 16 feet. All corners should be rounded. Partition walls round female wards should be 12 feet
high; in other cases 5 to 8 feet. No building should be nearer than 16 feet to a main wall. In the case of
double-storied buildings, the distance from the outer wall should be equal to the height of the building or
approximately so. No inside building, latrine, shed, etc., should be built against an outer wall and all
such buildings should be 16 feet away from the wall (or never less than 12 feet).
Section 11.- Conservancy.
1189. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent, Medical Officer, Jailor and all subordinate officers are
responsible for any want of attention paid to conservancy; it is the duty of official visitors and
Magistrates to satisfy themselves that conservancy is properly carried out. The superintendent and jailor
should give attention not only to the more important subject of disposal of night-soil and refuse matter,
but also to every detail connected with the cleanliness and neatness of the jail and its surroundings. The
following maters are specially referred to:-
(1) Grass plots, paths and open spaces should be kept free from fallen leaves, weeds and rubbish;
accumulations of broken bricks, manufactory rubbish, etc., should not be allowed. The whole of the jail
premises must be cleaned out daily. Grass plots should be kept cut and the edges trimmed, and paths
should be picked up once or twice a year and relaid with a dressing of surkhi siftings.
(2) Drains and latrines must be kept scrupulously clean. Cesspools of any kind or description are
prohibited within jail precincts and no sewage matter shall be permitted to find its way into the drains of
the jail. The use of sunk reservoirs for refuse water is to be avoided. Rubbish and manure pits are not to
be allowed within or near the jail walls. No irrigation or manuring is to be allowed within jail walls; any
prisoner found polluting the drains shall be reported for punishment, likewise any convict or other
officer who permits such a nuisance.
(3) Rules 651, 1118 and 1183, relating to the cleanliness of the persons and clothing of prisoners, of
cooking utensils, workshops, wards, doors and gratings should be strictly enforced.
201
(4) The inner aspect of the walls of the jail and outer walls or wards should, after the rains have ceased
when they are weather-stained, be rubbed down and lime-washed.
(5) Cleanliness and order should be observed in the offices in respect of ceilings, floors, walls, furniture,
etc, and at the main gate.
(6) The hospital should receive special attention. Godowns must be kept clean, well arranged, and well
ventilated; their contents should be aired as often as possible.
1190. Each enclosure shall, if possible, have a separate day latrine, on the approved type plan, and there
shall be a sufficient number of seats to allow the latrine parade to be carried out rapidly. The number of
seats shall be sufficient to complete the latrine parade in half an hour, allowing each prisoner 5 minutes,
and more if necessary. When overcrowding occurs additional temporary latrines must be promptly
provided.
1191 Provision shall be made for the permanent supply of dry earth in every latrine. A sufficient quantity
should be pounded and stored during the dry season for use during the rains. The mehters shall daily
place in each latrine a sufficient quantity of earth for use during the day, and between or in front of every
two seats there shall be a box containing dry earth, furnished with a wooden or iron scoop of sufficient
dimensions. The earth should be garden mould and be dry and sifted so as not to be coarser than
ordinary surkhi for mortar.
1192. Separate receptacles shall be provided in all latrines for solid and liquid excreta, and the use of
them shall be fully explained by the mehters to all prisoners. The mehters shall put a layer of dry earth at
least one inch thick in to each receptacle for solid excreta before it is used, and every prisoner after he
has used a receptacle shall cover his dejecta with a scoop-full of dry earth.
Note: Deleted.
1193. Vessels for urine shall be one-third filled with water. Besides those in the latrine, a vessel shall
be placed in each work-shed and ward. Iron vessels should be thoroughly washed out daily and
frequently tarred.
1194. Each latrine seat should have washing arrangement in it. Where however, this arrangement does
not exist, a special well-raised platform draining into a receptacle which can be removed and carried
away when filled, shall be provided outside each latrine for personal ablution and shall be properly
screened off from public view with partitions similar to those in the latrines. In the latter case, the
number of partitions shall be, at least, in the proportion of one-fourth the number of latrine seats; the use
of water for personal ablution inside any such latrine is absolutely prohibited.
1195. In jail where the sanitary latrine is inadequate or when the safety tank overflows due to
excessive pressure the sweepers shall cover up all the solid excreta with thick layer or dry earth and
remove it and the soiled vessels to the garden where it shall be buried in trenches. The removal of all
solid and liquid excreta from the jail shall be done in covered iron receptacles by means of an ejector
and not through the main gate. Having cleaned the vessels, the sweepers shall bring them back and
replace them in the latrines ready for the next parade. The cleaning of all vessels connected with
conservancy outside the jail walls. Before taking up ground for trenching it shall be efficiently drained
so that the surface layers of the soil shall be free from saturation by storm or floodwater. The trenches
shall be 3 metre broad 3 metre deep, running parallel to each other at intervals of .46 metre. The night-
soil shall be deposited there in to the depth of .08 metre and the earth dug out shall then be returned to
the trenches. The trenches shall be made as straight as possible with the help of a rope, and right across
the field to be manured, and may be dug by the garden group, but must be filled in by the sweepers. The
trenches should be prepared a day in advance every day for the next day's excreta. The urine and latrine
ablution water should be burried in separate trenches some distance removed from the night-soil
trenches. The warder in charge of the sweeper group shall be punished for permitting neglect of these
orders. The opening and the locking up of the ejector shall be done strictly under the supervision of a
Head Warder.
202
1196. The earth with which night-soil trenches are refilled should be tightly rammed and if flies are
numerous in any jail the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent should at once personally take steps to
ascertain whether they are coming from these trenches by, if necessary, netting them with muslin for a
few days. If it is found that flies are coming from that source it is clear that more attention needs to be
paid to the carrying out of the night-soil system. As a further prevention against flies, the plan may be
tried of fastening sheets of oiled sacking tightly down over recently closed trenches and covered with a
layer of earth.
1197. All refuse from the cook-house not fit for food for cattle shall be disposed of in the same way as
night-soil, but sweepings and dry vegetable refuse should be thrown into a manure pit on jail land as far
from the jail as possible.
These filthy matters should be removed from inside the jail through ejector - truck under the
supervision of a Head warder.
1198. A latrine shall be provided for the warders, in their respective duty areas with water supply
arrangements and shall be worked on the same principles as are prescribed for the prisoners' latrines.
Any warder found defaecating about the jail or on jail land should be punished.
1199. Every sleeping ward/dormitory/cell shall be provided with a sanitary latrine with water supply
arrangement. The latrines for the sake of decency shall have a screen. 91 meter high in front of it. The
watchmen should be warned to carefully watch any prisoner who goes to the night latrine and report his name
in the morning to the Head Warder on duty. Solitary cells shall also be provided with sanitary latrines.
There shall be one or two sweepers in every sleeping ward at night proportionate to the number of
prisoners accommodated therein.
Note:- Necessary cleaning materials shall be provided for cleaning all the sanitary latrines.
1200. All work sheds shall be provided with required number of sanitary latrines. All receptacles for
refuse food shall immediately be removed when these are filled up.
1201 When any prisoner is attacked during the night with cholera, or with violent diarrhoea and
vomiting, in a sleeping ward, shall immediately be removed to jail hospital for necessary treatment. At
the same time the places where such patients vomited or voided his stools the dry place should
immediately be cleaned & disinfected. All such arrangements shall be made by the night watchman/
convict overseer with the help of area head warder.
1202. The drainage of the land round the jail shall be carefully attended to, and drainage channels
should be made where necessary. All low or hollow ground and stagnant pools shall be filled up with
clean earth. It is the duty of the Medical Officer to bring to notice any defects of drainage within the jail
area or its vicinity. The construction of public latrines, sewage drains, or any unsanitary condition in the
neighbourhood of the jail likely to affect the health of the prisoner shall be reported to the Inspector
General.
1204. Water when obtained from the rivers it should be drawn from the main current and not from any
back channel or stagnant water, or from shallow places near the bank.
1205. Deleted.
203
1206. Every reservoir, the water of which is used for drinking, cooking, or bathing shall be carefully
cleaned out and the silt removed every hot weather, before the rains set in, and oftener if the depth of
water permit. Wells which have been cleansed should be disinfected with permanganate of potassium
before the water is used.
1207. Deleted.
1208. Wherever necessary, jails shall be provided with filters. Arrangements shall be made for
chlorinating the drinking water and that used at the cook-house and in the preparation of food. The filter
should be at such a height from the ground that the water may be distributed from it by pipes to places
where it is required for use. For the distribution of drinking water at meal times covered cans with short
spouts shall be used; and the water-carriers shall be prevented from touching the water with their hands.
Two glasses shall be provided at the filter to compare the unfiltered and filtered water.
1209. Every sleeping ward and cell shall be provided with drinking water, and prisoners at work shall
be supplied with as much drinking water as is necessary. The receptacles used for holding or conveying
drinking water shall be covered and shall be thoroughly cleaned out daily. They shall be used for no
other purpose. The water should be kept as cool as possible.
1210. Water used for drinking and culinary purposes shall be analysed every year and a bacteriological
and arsenic examination shall be made when required. The examination of these waters will be carried
out by the Department of Public Health Engineering, Bangladesh, and special instruction as to the
collection of samples will be duly notified by Circular from time to time.
1211. A bathing platform on an approved plan shall be provided in each enclosure of the jail in which
prisoners are confined. These bathing platforms shall be filled with water every morning and afternoon,
and shall be visited by the prisoners in groups in the manner laid down in Chapter XVI. In the hot
weather the supply of bathing water should be increased in quantity. Bathing in tanks is forbidden.
CHAPTER XL. -MEDICAL ADMINISTRATION.
Section 1. -General Matters.
1212. The health of every prisoner shall be described as either good, bad or indifferent. Prisoners
who on admission to jail appear to be in normal health, are free from organic disease and are well up to
average weight shall be recorded as in good health. Prisoners, who on admission to jail are found to be
suffering from serious malnutrition, or disease (other than trivial or temporary ailments), such as
necessitates immediate medical treatment, shall be recorded as in bad health. The same standard of
health shall be adopted throughout the country.
1213. There is no direct relation between the health of a prisoner as recorded by the Medical Officer, and
the task to be exacted from him; this latter necessarily varies with the physical capability of the
individual. The duty of the Medical Officer is to see that no labour is allotted to any prisoner that is not
consistent with his physical condition, e.g, a prisoner with only one arm may be in good health but is
certainly incapable of hard labour, whereas a skilled printer in indifferent health may be capable of
giving a full task at composing.
Note. Instructions in regard to the Medical Officers duties on the admission of prisoners and the
preparation of descriptive rolls are given in Rules 507 and 844, respectively.
204
1214. One of the more important duties of the Medical Officer is to keep under his immediate
supervision those prisoners who are below the normal standard of health or whose physical condition or
previous history appear to indicate a predisposition to disease. The aged and infirm, the anemic, those
with large spleens or livers, or with spongy gums or stomatitis of any degree and those whose
appearance or physical condition appear to indicate malnutrition should be sought for and selected,
especially during the unhealthy months of the year. Prisoners who, with no apparent organic disease,
come frequently to hospital for irregular fever, obscure chest pain or looseness of the bowels, however
mild or short in duration the symptoms may be, should be kept under supervision. Prisoners admitted
from unhealthy districts are predisposed to ailments which run a rapid and fatal course. They should
therefore be kept under special medical observation for one or two weeks after admission, in order that
the effect of imprisonment and jail diet upon them may be noted; but if kept in hospital, they shall be
shown as under observation for 48 hours only.
Jail Circular 1215. Variation in weight is one of the most valuable means at our disposal for
No. 19 of 1895. estimating the condition of health of individuals. The ratio of body weight to height is
Rule 542 (1).
Rule 131. fairly constant. A Standard weighment chart is shown below for example :-
G. O. No. 1882
P. J. dated the A man of 1.580 Metre should weigh about 49 kg.
26th May 1930 " 1.702 " " " 54 "
" 1.763 " " " 57 "
G. O. No. 1882 1216. Every prisoner in the jail shall be weighed once a month on Friday and his weight
P. J. dated the shall be recorded on his history ticket in kilogram. The Medical Officer shall carry out
26th May 1930
Rule 131. this duty with assistance, if necessary.
Rule 556 (r).
1217. An abstract of the results of each weighment shall be furnished to the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent and Medical Officer on the following day, showing-
(1) The number who gained weight.
(2) The number whose weight remained stationary.
(3) The number who during the last three successive weighments have lost under 1.36 kgs.
(4) The number who during the last three successive weighments have lost above 1.36 to 2.27 kgs.
(5) The number who during the last three successive weighments have lost above 2.27 kgs.
(6) The number who have lost more than 3.18 kgs. since admission.
(7) The percentage to the total number weighed or those who gained weight and lost weight, respectively.
All prisoners who have lost weight to the extent indicated in items (4), (5) and (6) shall be separately
paraded for the inspection of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent and Medical Officer.
A weight chart (B. J. Form No. 103) shall be maintained for each long-term prisoner and also for every
prisoner below the standard referred to in Rule 1215.
1218. A system of groups has been adopted for the special observation and treatment of those prisoners-
not actually in hospital-whom the Medical Officer considers to require his special supervision. It should,
however, be remembered that a high rate of sick in hospital with a low group rate is, as a rule, better for the
general health than the opposite conditions.
. Prisoners who, from age or infirmity, are permanently unfitted to work, and convalescents recently
discharged from hospital who are temporarily unfitted to work, shall be placed in the Convalescent and
Infirm Group (referred to as the Convalescent Group); other weakly prisoners who, though requiring
special consideration, are yet able to perform light tasked labour, shall be placed in the Special Group.
Prisoners who, without exhibiting any particular debility, are losing weight should be placed in a Losing
Weight Group for more particular observation and weekly weighment.
All hospital groups shall be subdivided into A and B class and the classes shall be kept as separate as
possible.
1219. The special and convalescent groups, the prisoners of which shall respectively always remain
together and not be mixed up with other groups, shall be weighed every week instead of every monthly, on
such days as the Medical Officer may fix, and the progressive weekly weighments shall be recorded in a
special register (No. 29) to be shown to the Medical Officer. A separate record shall be kept of the numbers in
these groups daily, and the daily average number in each shall be furnished in the monthly return.
205
1220. The labour on which the special groups shall be employed shall be light work suitable to their
condition, and if necessary under cover. The Convalescent and Infirm Group shall be seen every day by the
Medical Officer, under whose order some light work, without task, such as sorting wool, winding yarn,
attending the sick, etc., may be given to them, or the Medical Officer may recommend any weak or
convalescent prisoner for un-tasked work in the garden. The special group shall be seen daily by the
Medical Officer. The mid-day rest prescribed in Rule 783 shall throughout the year be allowed to them in
their wards.
1221. The Medical Officer shall devise a special diet scale for each of these groups, or order any special diet
necessary in particular cases. They may be given a better quality of rice than ordinary prisoners and may be
allowed oil for inunction daily before bathing. Meat, fish, milk, dahi, goor, potatoes, or extra vegetables may
be allowed. Meat, fish, milk or dahi may be given in lieu of quantities of dal of equal nutritive value, to be
deducted from the regular ration.
1222. These groups should, if possible, be accommodated in better wards at night. Prisoners of these groups
should all have the extra clothing and bedding ordered for them in Rule 1168.
1223. Both these groups shall be carefully and frequently examined by the Medical Officer with the view to
the early detection of sickness and of removing from them every prisoner who has recovered health and no
longer required special attention. A register (No.29) showing for each group separately the name, register
number, date of attachment to the group, and date of discharge of each prisoner, shall be kept, and no prisoner
shall be placed in, or discharged from, these groups except by order of the Medical Officer.
Rule 553 1224. Whenever there is an unusual proportion of the prisoners who have lost weight, or there
is a general tendency to scurvy or to ulceration of the gums, or anaemia, or an increase of
admissions to hospital from dysentery or other bowel complaints, the Medical Officer shall
make careful inquiry to ascertain the cause. The diet of all the prisoners shall be varied by the
liberal issue of animal food in lieu of dal, etc., as ordered in Rule 1104, and potatoes, onions,
and radishes may be added to the vegetables. Both the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent
and the Medical Officer shall occasionally visit the prisoners while at their meals to ascertain
if there are any complaints regarding the food, and note if much of it is left uneaten. If the
food appears to be unpalatable owing to want of variety, this should be remedied as far as
possible.
Rule 252. 1225. If the loss of weight is more marked amongst prisoners on one form of labour than on
another, the tasks should be carefully regulated, and the prisoners employed on that particular
work should be changed if the tendency to lose weight continues. Prisoners who at three
successive weighments are found to be losing weight, or in whom the loss of weight at any
Rules 94, weighment is found to be great, shall not be placed on labour . On the other hand, the Medical
119, 127. Officer should guard against being imposed upon by prisoners who seem to loose weight or to
cause sickness. This is attempted chiefly amongst the prisoners of the habitual class. Prisoners
who are losing weight and are found to leave their food for a day or two immediately before
the day for their usual monthly weighment should be weighed unexpectedly at short irregular
intervals, until it is clearly demonstrated whether they are willfully causing the loss; and any
prisoner proved beyond doubt to have done this, or to have taken any deleterious substance to
cause sickness, should be punished when fit to bear punishment.
Rules 633, 1226. Medical Officers should carefully regulate the hygienic treatment of the general
639 body of prisoners according to season. The Medical Officer shall, therefore, exercise his
discretion as to the time at which the prisoners shall be taken out of their wards in the
early morning, and he may direct that at the early morning parades before prisoners march
to their work, they shall be allowed to have with them, and cover themselves with, one of
the blankets supplied to them as bedding.He should ascertain that the orders in Rule 1169,
given with the object of ensuring that prisoners shall have dry clothing when they return to their wards
after their work, are carried out; that prisoners are not unnecessarily exposed to the weather either whilst
at work or in their wards, and, if he is not Senior Superintendent/Superintendent, bring any neglect of
these rules to the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendents notice.
1227. The prophylaxis and treatment of malaria and dengue in Jails are matters requiring the constant
attention of the medical staff. Destruction of mosquito larvae by kerosine oil or other larvicides of
proved efficacy should be accompanied by systematic drainage or filling up of stagnant pools, holes and
other places that may become breeding places for the anopheles; empty tins and other vessels should not
be allowed to lie about.
1228. Deleted.
206
1229. Deleted
Section 11. - Hospital Management.
1230. It is the duty of every jail official at once to bring to the notice of the Medical Officer any
circumstances from which the sickness of any prisoner may be inferred.
1231. In every jail, separate hospitals shall be provided for male and female prisoners. All prisoners
complaining of illness shall be brought before the Medical Officer and shall be examined by him, and he
shall determine whether they shall be placed under medical observation or treated as out-patients, or
admitted to hospital; or if he thinks necessary, he shall take any other action he is empowered to take by
these rules.
1232(1) Any prisoner may be detained in the hospital for 48 hours, but not longer, under medical
observation, without being brought on the hospital register. Every prisoner who is under medical
observation or treatment for longer than 48 hours, and is not in the convalescent or special groups,
or a supposed lunatic, shall be entered in the hospital resister and be included in the hospital statistics.
Bengal Form (2) The names of prisoners so detained under observation shall be entered in the
No. 5135 Morning State of Sick (B. J. Form No. 104) or in a special register, and their disposal
either by admission to hospital, further detention, or discharge, shall be entered therein
daily by the Medical Officer or under his supervision by the Medical Subordinate.
Rules 1167, 1233. Every patient in hospital shall be provided with bed which shall be furnished
1168 with a proper mattress, a pillow, mosquito net and white sheets marked H. He shall
G. O. No. 58.
R. J. dated 3rd also be provided with as many blankets as the Medical Officer deems necessary.
August 1523.
G.O.No.4896 If an epileptic is placed in a cell, there should be no bed or raised masonry berth in it,
R. J. dated 9th but he should be provided with a mat of a thicker pattern and should sleep on the floor.
5th July 1523.
Rule 111. 1234. Over every occupied bed in hospital shall be placed a ticket in B. J. Form No.
Bengal Form 101, wherein shall be recorded full particulars of the previous history, progress of the
No. 5132. case and its treatment. In the case of dysentery it should be noted whether the prisoner
had suffered from the disease in his own home or had previously acquired it in the jail.
Bengal Form In every case of fever a temperature chart, in B. J. Form. No. 102, recording the
No. 5133. patients temperature shall be attached to the bed-head ticket. Suitable plastic file
Rule 99. cover for holding these tickets should be provided.
Rules 117, 1235. Hospitals shall be kept scrupulously clean and well ventilated, the yard of a
1181. hospital shall be turfed and flower-beds may be kept up in it. The Medical Officer shall
Rule 1173. take such steps as will secure the strictest cleanliness in the bedding and clothing.
G. O. No. 1236. Where the Medical Officer considers it desirable, the cots of sick prisoners should
4896- be carried out with the patients on them and placed in the hospital yard under the shade
R. J. dated the either or trees of buildings at least for part of the day so that they may get more fresh air
July 1923. than in the hospital.
Rules 651, 1237. A proper place for washing and boiling the soiled hospital or other clothing and
1172. sheets shall be provided, and the blankets and blanket clothing shall frequently be
boiled. Prisoners in hospital who are not too ill shall bathe daily at such time as the
Medical Officer shall direct.
Rule 641 1238. The diet of prisoners in hospital is entirely under the Medical Officers control, and he
may order in each individual case such diet as he considers necessary, and may fix the hours
at which the food shall be distributed, but, as a rule, all sick prisoners in hospital should
receive three meals a day, and oftener if necessary. In large jails there shall be a separate
Rule 1117. cook-shed in the hospital for the preparation of food for the sick, and a special convict cook,
or cooks, shall be appointed. Utensils of suitable size and capacity shall be provided
specially for the hospital; and arrangements should be made for the frequent feeding of the
sick, and for having sago and other invalid food constantly ready.
207
1239. Dangerous, noisy or filthy lunatics shall not be kept in the hospital, but in separate cells (see Rules
740 and 1038).
1240. In some cases it will be well for prisoners actually in hospital to have some employment. Easy
work should therefore be provided for these prisoners, but no task should be exacted.
1241. No prisoner shall be transferred for the benefit of his health without the previous sanction of
Deputy Inspector General of Prisons/Inspector General of Prisons. If any prisoner, transferred for the
benefit of his health, dies, within three months after his arrival, of the disease on account of which he
was transferred,his death shall be borne on the returns of the transferring jail; but if he dies of a different
disease or after the lapse of three months from the date of his transfer, the death shall be included in the
returns of the jail at which he died. In the former case, his admission shall not be included in the
statistics of the receiving jail, or his transfer in the statistics of transfer of the dispatching jail.
1242. Prisoners suffering from venereal disease should also be segregated as far as practicable.
All cases of pulmonary tuberculosis should, as far as practicable, be segregated in special wards and open air
treatment adopted wherever possible. Such cases of tubercle as are fit for removal should be transferred to a
specific jail where T.B. treatment is available but every death at these centres shall be debited to the jail from
which the patients came, whatever length of time may have elapsed since the transfer.
All cases of malarial fever and dengue should be provided with mosquito nets. The administration of
quinine in small doses in the treatment of true malarial fever is practically useless. Kochs five days
consecutive quinine treatment is commended for general use; it consists of administering 30 grains in
the morning of each of the first and second days and 15 grains on each of the third, fourth and fifth days.
Bengal 1243. The following registers shall be maintained by Medical Officer and Assistant
Form Surgeon:
No. 5001-3
and 5004. (a) No. 1, Medical Officers minute-book, see Rule 92.
(b)Post-mortem Register No. 26 (in central jails).
(c) & (d) Registers Nos. 27 and 28.-The Hospital Register and the Hospital Roll of sick
diet, bazar medicines, etc., and other hospital records shall be kept under the direction of
the Medical Officer, who is responsible for their correctness. The instructions in Rule 99
must be carefully complied with, and all the information required by the column
headings filled in.
Bengal (e) No. 29 Register of Convalescent and Special Groups-This register should be divided
Form into four parts :-
No. 5005.
(1) The convalescent and infirm group A class.
(2) Ditto ditto B do.
(3) The special group A do.
(4) Ditto ditto B do.
The name of every prisoner ordered by the Medical Officer to be placed in either of these
groups shall be entered according to the group and according to the class, also any special
diet or any special treatment ordered in individual cases. When a prisoner is discharged from
the group his name shall be scored through. At the beginning of every three months a new list
should be made out of every group.
(f) No. 30, Register of weekly weighments of prisoners losing weight.-For instruction
regarding this register, see Rule 1219.
Bengal 1244. The following returns and reports shall be submitted by the Medical Officer :-
Form
No. 5048. (a) Return No. 29 (Table A).Monthly return of sick prisoners shall show the number
of admissions and deaths amongst prisoners of all classes from the chief
diseases.
(b) Return No. 9.- Half-yearly Report of health and mental condition of criminal
lunatics (see Rules 36 and 1045).
(c) Annual Return No. 9 (Table B)- Annual Return of sick prisoners. These returns
Bengal shall be prepared by or under the orders of the Medical Officer, and when the
Form Inspector-General of Prisons is not a Chief Medical Officer, duplicates shall be
208
No. 5060. submitted to the Director General of Health. The Medical Officer shall also
forward duplicates of his annual report and of his monthly and annual returns to
the Director-General of Health through the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent of the jail, when the Inspector-General of prisons is not a
Medical officer. He shall also keep, or cause to be kept all such records as may
be prescribed.
(d) Annual Returns Nos. 7 and 8.
(e) B.J.Form No.108-Report of the occurrence of grave infectious disease.
(f) M.S.D.135-Annual indent for medicines and stores [see Rule 104 (a)].
Bengal Form 1245. Prisoners who are dangerously ill,or moribund, may be permitted to see their
No. 5059. relations. Intimation of the condition of the prisoner shall be promptly given to the
Bengal Form Magistrate and also direct by post to the relatives of the prisoner. As to searching
No. 5138. visitors, see Rule 677.
Note. - For the disposal of a sick prisoner whose sentence has expired, see Rule 102; for orders
regarding procedure to be followed on the death of a prisoner, see Rules 98 and 99; and for the
procedure relating to the release of prisoners on account of serious sickness, see Rules 591 to 598.
1246. When epidemic disease exists in the vicinity of a jail, communication with the infected locality
shall be, as far as possible, prevented. Newly-admitted prisoners shall be kept in quarantine, as far as the
structural arrangements of the jail permit, for seven days or such longer period as may be necessary to
cover the incubation period of the disease to be guarded against.
1247. The Medical Officer shall in the event of the appearance of epidemic disease of any kind among
the prisoners or officers of the jail, be responsible that all measures and precautions which may be
necessary or expedient to meet the emergency and prevent the spread of the disease, are promptly taken
and that the rules and orders regulating such matters are fully enforced.
1248. Immediately upon the appearance of any case of infectious disease or any disease which is likely to
assume an epidemic form, the Chief Medical Officer shall report the fact to the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent for the information of the Inspector-General of prisons, together with the recommendations he
may think fit to make in view of preventing the spread of the disease and of otherwise dealing with it.
1249. On the occurrence of any case of grave infectious disease the Senior Superintendent/
Superintendent shall at once report (in B.J. Form No. 108) to the Inspector-General, furnishing the
following details:-
(1) If the first case-
(a) period of residence in the jail,
(b) the jail from which transferred (if received by transfer),
(c) the date on which the prisoner was last beyond the jail precincts,
(d) his sleeping place,
(e) his working place,
(f) whether employed in intra or extra-mural groups or in contact with the latter,
(g)prevalence of the disease amongst the staff or in the neighborhood,
(h) (if a case of plague) any noticeable mortality amongst rats.
(2) Brief description of the precautions taken against the spread of the disease.
(3) If a second or subsequent case-whether any connection has been traced with the first or subsequent
case.
(4) Dates of the occurrence of each case and death.
G. O. No. On receipt of the report, if the Inspector-General consider that an epidemiological
11554 enquiry is desirable, he shall ask the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the Jail or
R. J. dated the any other Medical Officer, who may be trained in epidemiology, to hold an enquiry and
17th December to report the result to the Inspector-General of Prisons, who shall send a copy of such
1923.
report to the Director-General of Health Services, Bangladesh.
209
A report of the occurrence of epidemic diseases shall also be submitted to the Director of Public Health
of the Division and Civil Surgeon of the respective district, stating the numbers of attacks and deaths
with their dates of occurrence weekly by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendents of those Jails only
in which such events take place. No report or return need be submitted by those Jails which have had no
such occurrence during the week.
1250. The existence of sporadic cases of infectious disease is, in these days of careful
segregation, no reason for the absolute prohibition of the transfer of prisoners to or from
Rule 343. the infected jail. The Medical Officer should use his discretion and, if considered
advisable, the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent may notify other jails that
transfers either to or from his jail are stopped. In the case of a transfer from an infected
jail, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall, invariably, notify the existence of
the disease to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail to which the prisoner
is transferred. Prisoners transferred from a jail in which small-pox has existed during the
previous fifteen days should, if necessary, be re-vaccinated before transfer. No transfers
should be made from a jail in which plague has occurred until ten days have elapsed
since the date of the last case of the disease inside the jail.
1251. The body of any prisoner, who has died from any grave infectious disease, shall at once be
enveloped in a sheet saturated with solution of corrosive sublimate (1 in 1000) or some other strong
disinfectant and shall be disposed of with the least possible delay; if not burnt, it should be buried with
an ample supply of quicklime.
1252. Cases of grave infectious disease shall be entirely segregated and shall be treated in separate
wards. If the isolation sheds are outside the jail, there should be a room for the medical subordinate on
duty. Special attendants and guards shall be detailed. All persons who have come or are likely to come in
contact with a case of small-pox shall be vaccinated at once.
1253. The Hospital shall be lime-washed, and especial care be taken that all hospital arrangements to
meet an outbreak of epidemic disease are complete.
1254. In the event of an outbreak or threatened outbreak of cholera the drinking water, if tank or well
water, shall, if possible, be changed to some other source of wholesome supply; wells and reservoirs
shall be disinfected. In every case the water must be chlorinated. Food should be constantly inspected to
ensure that it is of good quality, cleanly prepared, well-cooked and easy of digestion. No work shall be
done until the prisoners have had the early morning meal. Attention should be paid to regularity of
meals, so that long fasts shall be avoided; and prisoners shall be encouraged not to drink water between
meals or on an empty stomach. The food supplies and water should be carefully guarded against
contamination. The possibility of the conveyance of the cholera poison by insect life (Flies) should not
be overlooked. Special provision should be made to obviate this source of danger. The purity of milk
and of milk vessels should receive special attention. All milk should be boiled before use.
1255. Deleted.
1256. All the prisoners should be individually questioned as to the condition of their bowels, and every
man who has the slightest diarrhoea shall be immediately brought to the notice of the Medical Officer. In
a large jail this will require the co-operation of all ranks. The earlier a patient is treated, the greater is the
chance of his recovering. During the night and early morning enquiries as to the health of the inmates of
each barrack shall be made by the sentries, and any man attacked by premonitory symptoms shall be at
once removed for treatment.
1257. The bedding and clothing of all prisoners shall be well aired and then hung up in the barracks, all
of which, with the clothing and bedding, shall be well fumigated with sulfur, as directed in Rule 1260.
After the fumigation has been completed, the buildings shall be thoroughly ventilated before the
prisoners are allowed to occupy them. The numbers confined in the barracks at night should be reduced
as much as possible by providing short-term prisoners with temporary accommodation elsewhere.
Rule 1252 1258. Deleted.
1259. Deleted.
Rule 1201. 1260. Deleted.
1261. Deleted.
Rules1252, 1262. deleted.
210
1265.
1263. Deleted.
1264. On the recovery or death of a patient from such grave infectious disease, his bedding and clothing
shall be immediately burned, and the tent or hut shall be thoroughly fumigated with sulphurous acid.
1265. If the circumstances of the jail should render the segregation of a case of grave infectious disease
impossible, the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent shall, with the sanction of the Magistrate of the
district, remove the prisoner to any hospital which has been set aside for the accommodation of such
patients, provided his offence was trivial and the term of his sentence is short. The prisoner, on recovery,
and when the risk of infection has passed, shall be remanded to jail to serve the remainder of his
sentence.
1266. Minor infectious diseases- such as mumps, measles, chicken-pox, etc. must on no account be
neglected. Segregation for the full period must be enforced. These diseases, if allowed to spread, may
seriously interfere with the industries of a jail. The value of oil inunction in the exfoliative stage of
infectious exanthematous disease should be remembered. Cases of scabies need not, as a rule, be
admitted to hospital, but segregation should be enforced.
Section IV.-Health Camps.
1267. deleted.
1268. deleted.
1269. Deleted.
1270. Deleted.
1271. Deleted.
1272. Deleted.
1273. Deleted.
1274. Deleted.
1275. Deleted.
1276. Deleted.
1277. Deleted.
G. O. No. 589 R. J. dated the 1278. Deleted.
16th January 1924.
1279. Deleted.
1280. Deleted.
1281. Deleted.
1282. Deleted.
1283. Deleted.
1284. Deleted.
1285. Deleted.
1286. Deleted.
1287. Deleted.
1288. Deleted.
1289. Deleted.
1290. Deleted.
1291. Deleted.
1292. Deleted.
1293. Deleted.
1294. Deleted.
1295. Deleted.
1296. Deleted.
1297. (a) Public Works in Jails come under the following heads :-
211
Petty, costing Tk. 25,00,000 or under.
B. Repairs. Special.
Periodical.
Occasional and Petty.
(b) Class A- includes all new construction, whether of entirely new works or of additions and alterations
to existing works, excepting as hereinafter provided; also all repairs to newly purchased or previously
abandoned buildings required for bringing them into use.
When a portion of an existing structure or other work is to be replaced or remodelld, whether or not
the change involves any dismantlement, and the cost of the change represents a genuine increase in the
permanent value of the property as an asset, the work of replacement or remodlling, as the case may be,
should be classed as original work, the cost of the portion replaced or remodelld being credited to the
estimate for original work and debited to repairs. In all other cases, the whole cost of the new work
should be charged to repairs. It also includes works of a temporary or petty nature which can be
executed by the Jail Department without the intervention of the Public Works Department.
P. W. D. (c) Class B. - Special repairs are those of an extensive nature which are not classed as
Code periodical such as the complete renewal of a roof or floor. Special repair estimates do
not lapse with the official year, but remain current till the completion of the work, in the
same way as estimates for original works.
Periodical repairs are such as are included in annual and quadrennial estimates and
Para. 154.
comprise not only such work as painting and white-washing, but also such
P.W.D. Code.
miscellaneous repairs as it may be convenient to carry out at the same time.
Occasional and petty repairs are such as become necessary from time to time and which
may have to be carried out between the times of periodical repairs.
1298. The powers of the Inspector-General to sanction estimates and expenditure in connection with
Public Works, except buildings connected with residences of Government officers, which should be
sanctioned by the Government, are laid down in Rules 1300 to 1302 and 1309.
G. of B. No. 1299. All outlay in connection with constructions of additions to, or improvements of,
4903 P. Dated residential buildings occupied by officers, whatever the estimated cost may be, require
the 8th August the sanction of the Government.
1911.
1300. The power of the Inspector General of Prisons to accord administrative approval to expenditure
on original works, other than in connection with residences, is Tk.8,00,000 (subject to the change as per
delegation of Financial Powers by the Government from time to time).
1301. The following procedure will be adopted in the case of new works or additions the cost of which
is not likely to exceed Tk. 10,000.
On the requisition of the Inspector General of Prisons or the jail Senior Superintendent/Superintendent,
the Executive Engineer, Public Works Department will prepare plans and estimates in detail, provided
the Executive Engineer is satisfied that the work is likely to be sanctioned on the lines proposed and that
the work is one which is likely to be financed in the near future.
The Executive Engineer will send the plans and estimates direct to the Inspector General of Prisons for
administrative approval in case the requisition was received from him; but if it was received from the
Jail Senior Superintendent/Superintendent, to the latter officer for submission to the Inspector General of
Prisons for such approval.
212
1302. If the work is likely to cost more than the amount beyond the Financial Power of the Inspector
General of Prisons the administrative approval of Government is required before detailed plans and
estimates are prepared.
The following procedure should be adopted :-
(1) The Inspector General should furnish the Chief Engineer, Public Works Department with
particulars as to the reasons for which the building is required and as to the accommodation
which has to be provided; and
(2) The Executive Engineer, Public Works Department will furnish a rough plan for, and
approximate estimate of the cost of the work proposed. These will in all cases be sent to the
Inspector General through the Superintending Engineer who should state if he considers that the
amount provided in the approximate estimate is fair for a work of the class proposed.
On receipt of the rough plan and approximate estimate from the Superintending Engineer, the Inspector
General will submit them to the Government in his Department. When administrative approval has been
accorded orders will issue in the Public Works Department to the Superintending Engineer for the
preparation of detailed plans and estimates.
1303. The Executive Engineer will take all necessary action in regard to repairs other than those referred
to in Rule 1304; in consultation with the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent. When necessary the
senior Superintendent/Superintendent should call the attention of the Executive Engineer to any repairs
that may be required.
G. of B. 1304. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent will be responsible for all petty repairs
Resn. of doors and windows, including the replacement of broken glass. He should make the
No. 577.-A Jailer or some other officer answerable for the general condition of the building,
of 18th May including the glass in each room, and fixtures, also for keeping a watch on the attacks of
1906 white ants. The same person should also pay strict attention to the cleanliness of the
interior and the neatness of the exterior of the building and of its surroundings, etc, and
keep the rain water down-pipes and surface drains free from all obstructions. Charges
for such items shall be made by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent in his
contingent bill. Repairs to Government residential buildings on the books of the Public
Works Department should, however, be done by the Public Works Department. Budget
for all repair works should be placed with Inspector General of Prisons.
Para. 134, 1305. (a) Nothing in this chapter is to be construed into a permission to any officer to
P.W.D. code. carry out in portions any system of works or alterations of which the cost in the
aggregate would exceed what he is empowered to sanction.
G. of B. Resn. (b) No buildings on the books of the Public Works Department shall be added to, altered
Nos.24B of 25- or dismantled, and no fresh detached structures shall be erected on land attached to such
101906 and
22B of 18th June buildings, without the sanction of the Public Works Department.
1895.
Jail Circular 50 (c) The deposit of religious relics or symbols and the erection in jail of shrines or places
of 1904. of worship on Government lands are forbidden; the Jailer shall at once report to the
G. of B.
Circular Senior Superintendent/Superintendent any new encroachment or extension of
No. T.-B of encroachment within the jail precincts.
26th may 1905.
Para. 189, (d) No new buildings with roofs composed of thatch or other inflammable material shall
P.W. be constructed within a minimum radius of 46.00 metres of a buildings constructed of
D. Code permanent materials.
(e) No work shall be commenced till sanction to it has been accorded, allotment of funds made and
orders for its commencement issued by competent authority. In emergent cases of danger or
inconvenience suddenly arising, a definite written request must be made to the Executive Engineer,
Public Works Department, who will act on his own responsibility.
Jail Circular (f) Contractors shall not be allowed to store materials in a jail for more than seven days
No. 1 of before or after they are actually required. In emergent cases this period may be extended
213
1904 in consultation with the jail authority.
(g) Executive Engineer shall see that there is no undue delay in the execution of any work.
(h) Executive Engineer is responsible that proper measures are taken to preserve buildings and works in
his Divisions and to prevent encroachment on Government lands.
Executive Engineer shall see that there is no undue delay in the execution of any work.
1306. Deleted.
1307. Deleted.
(a) Deleted.
(b) Deleted
(c) Deleted.
(d) Deleted.
(e) Deleted.
(f) Deleted.
(g) Deleted.
(h) Deleted.
(i) Deleted.
(j) Deleted.
(k) Deleted.
1308. When Government sanction is obtained to the carrying out of any major public works through the
Superintendent of the jail, the following rules shall be observed :-
(a) Deleted.
(b) Deleted.
(c) Deleted.
(d) Deleted.
(e) Deleted.
(f) Deleted.
(g) Deleted.
(h) Deleted.
(i) The work to be done shall be laid out either by the Executive Engineer or any public works
subordinate deputed for that purpose, and no deviations from the plan shall on any account be permitted
unless the previous sanction of the Superintending Engineer has been obtained.
(j) The Jail Department may have old materials from the dismantled buildings borne on the books of the
Public Works Department on payment of their depreciated value according to the condition of the
materials, provided that they are not required by the latter Department for any specific work connected
with the Jail. All Jail buildings including minor works borne on the books of the Works Department
should be treated as the property of the Department.
(k) On the completion of the work provided for in the estimate, all surplus materials charged for but not
consumed, shall be returned to the Executive Engineer ,Public Works Department for disposal, who will
either bring them into stock if they are likely to be used within 6 months with the approval of the
Superintending Engineer or transfer them to some works in progress where they can be used, or if there
be no chance of their being utilized obtain the sanction of the Superintending Engineer for their sale
outright to avoid loss from deterioration. The value of the materials so brought into stock or transferred
to other works, or the amounts realized by the sale should be credited by the Executive Engineer in
transfer to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent who shall adjust the amount by crediting the
account of the work concerned and debit to transfer.
(l) On the completion of any one building or work, the Executive Engineer , Public Works Department
shall at once submit a consolidated completion statement of the actual expenditure incurred to the Chief
Engineer and Inspector General of Prisons.
(m) On the completion of each building or portion on work, the Executive Engineer shall be furnished
with a statement showing the expenditure which has been incurred on work.
(n) The Executive Engineer, Public Works Department shall understand that while being relieved of
actual supervision of the work, he is expected to afford any necessary professional advice, and to supply
214
information and advice regarding rates, etc., and generally to comply with such reasonable requirements
as the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent may make.
1309. The Inspector General may direct that any minor original work, addition or alteration, not
exceeding Tk.1,00,00,000 sanctioned by him under rule 1301, shall be carried out by the jail
establishment.
In such cases the following rules shall be complied with :-
(a) No work shall be carried out under these rules unless the estimate has been previously sanctioned by
the Inspector General of Prisons.
(b) If the work is not of a simple and ordinary nature, the Inspector-General shall consult the officer of
the Public Works Department whose duty it is to advise in such cases.
(c) The estimate shall invariably state distinctly the purpose of the proposed work and its probable cost.
(d) Regular Public Works estimates are not required; but if the amount is above Tk.. 50,000 as full detail
as may be practicable shall be given.
(e) Deleted.
(f) Estimate shall be sanctioned in accordance with the orders of Government in the Public Works
Department, Resolution No. 3815-3933A. dated the 17th September 1921, and forwarded to the
Superintending Engineer.
(g) No buildings on the books of the Public Works Department are to be dismantled without the
authority of Government in the Public Works Department.
(h) If radical or extensive alterations are desired the orders of Government must be taken.
(i) The Superintending Engineer if he considers it necessary to make any remarks regarding the work for
the information and guidance of the jail authorities shall then do so, sending a copy of the remarks to the
Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail, to whom, if the work is to be executed by the jail
establishment, he will likewise forward the estimate.
(j) The Jail Department may have old materials taken from the dismantled buildings free of charge,
provided that they are not required by the Public Works Department for any specific work connected
with the jail, and that their value has not been credited in the estimate for the jail which entails the
dismantling of the buildings from which they have been obtained; if however, they are sold by the Jail
Department, the amount received as sale-proceeds must be credited to the Public Works Department.
(k) The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail shall obtain funds from and submit accounts to
the Controller General of Accounts, Bangladesh/concerned Accounts Officer as provided in Bangladesh
Financial Rule 156.
1310. Instances having occurred of buildings or other public works built by jail officers and not on the books
of the Public Works Department having fallen or become dilapidated and unsafe owing to defects in
construction or want of periodical examination and repair, the Public Works Department have undertaken the
periodical examination of such buildings. A list of the buildings to be placed under their charge shall be given
in the following form to the Executive Engineer, who shall periodically examine them and submit an estimate
through the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent for any repairs that may be required :-
Statement of buildings and works in the jail at------------------------------
Not on the books of the P. W. Department,
Description of buildings Description of buildings as regards Area By whom When
as regards use and construction, materials of which covered by erected. erected.
situation in the jail. constructed, and nature of the roof. building.
1311. No allotment shall, as a rule, be made to any particular jail for petty construction and
repairs; any works that are necessary will be sanctioned by the Inspector- General on receipt of
estimates from the grant under his control.
215
CHAPTER XLII.-OFFICE PROCEDURE AND ACCOUNTS, REGISTERS, FORMS, ETC.
Section 1. -General Rules.
1312. None but duly authorized persons shall have access to jail records and official correspondence,
which must be considered to be confidential, except so much as may be published for general or
particular guidance by order of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent. Subordinate officers are
forbidden to communicate, without authority, information concerning jail matters to outsiders, or to
gossip about the affairs of the jail or its inmates.
1313. Rules concerning the responsibility of the jailer for the custody of documents, the correctness and
punctual submission of returns and the general supervision of the jail office are to be found in rule 262.
1314. A Responsibility list shall be pasted inside the cover of each register (except Register Nos. 1
and 2 combined B. form No.4980) in which shall be entered the name of the officer deputed to
maintain it, together with the dates of commencement and termination of the duty. Errors, omissions
and carelessness of any sort in maintaining a jail register may be visited on the officer whose name,
entered in this list, shows him to be responsible, no matter how long a period may have elapsed.
Should there be no name entered in the list, the jailer in charge at the time the carelessness, etc, was
committed, shall be held to be personally responsible.
The responsibility for maintaining any jail register shall not be entrusted to a convict.
1315. All jail registers, returns, letters and records of every description shall, for the purposes of
preservation or destruction, be classified under four heads (A) those to be preserved permanently;
subject to description under the personal supervision of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent and
the sanction of the Inspector General of Prisons where entirely illegible or useless from age, worms or
other causes as laid down in rule 230 of the Bangladesh Records manual, 1928; (B) those to be kept
for 12 years; (C) those to be kept for 5 years; (D) those to be kept for 2 years. For rules regarding the
destruction of Account record in offices rendering accounts to Audit offices, see F. R. Appendix 15 to
the Bangladesh Financial Rules
Separate cases or receptacles shall be provided for each of the four classes of records, and the records
in them so arranged as to make it easy to select those, which have to be destroyed.
A register of records classified under A which are destroyed, should be maintained.
Section II. Correspondence.
1316. Correspondence shall on no account be allowed to fall into arrears. No unreasonable delay in
replying to official letters shall be permitted. When replies are not received with in a reasonable time,
reminders should be sent. In matters of ordinary routine, reminders may be sent as follows:-
To Supreme Court after one month;
To Inspector General of Prisons after ten days ;
To other Jails, etc., after seven days;
but special cases should be considered on the urgency demanded and dealt with accordingly.
1317. Proper names of places or persons which are not familiarly known or commonly used shall
invariably be printed by hand. The use of vernacular terms in official correspondence should be
avoided as far as possible. Two different subjects must not be dealt with in a single communication.
1318. Care should be taken not to use larger covers than are necessary for the despatch of official
correspondence. In franking a cover, the subordinate who franks it must enter his own official
designation. Signing for other officers is not authorized.
1319. All contracts and agreements shall be in Bengali/English Office copies of all letters, returns and
invoices shall be kept. When forwarding petitions submitted by subordinates, they should be duly
endorsed and should be accompanied by such information as will help the InspectorGeneral to
dispose off the matter without recourse to avoidable correspondence.
1320. When printed forms are used they should be carefully and neatly filled in, in accordance with
instruction, and no unauthorized headings should be added nor should existing headings be struck out
or erased.
216
1321. Demurrage charges due to carelessness in forwarding railway receipts shall be debited to the
officer at fault.
1322. (1) Covers containing official correspondence, which is not of a confidential nature, should be
addressed to the officer for whom they are intended by his official designation only and without the
addition of his name.
(2) Confidential communications should be placed in double covers, the inner cover being marked
confidentialand super-scribed with the name only of the addressee, the outer cover being addressed
in the manner prescribed in sub rule (1)above.
1323. The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall exercise his discretion as to the classification of
letters and correspondence, except in regard to documents bearing on the following subjects, which
shall be permanently preserved:All letters and documents relating to standing orders, important
public works and manufactures, orders of Government sanctioning establishment, the release of
prisoners before expiry of sentence, the acquisition and renting of land, pensions, and any permanent
charges upon Government, and correspondence regarding escapes when the prisoner is not re-
captured. The files to be permanently preserved should be marked with a coloured slip of paper, and at
the close of each year be placed in the receptacle for permanent records.
1324. Registers of letters received and issued. The following rules for recording correspondence
shall be carefully followed: -
(a)The following registers shall be maintained :---
Register of letters received. Bangladesh Form No .16.
Register of letters despatched. Bangladesh Form No 19
(b) All letters received on all subjects shall be entered in a single consecutive series in Bangladesh
Form No 16, and all the letters despatched shall, in like manner, be entered in one consecutive series
in Bangladesh Form No 19.The series shall be conterminous with the calendar year. Letters
despatched by hand shall be recorded also in the peon Book(Bangladesh Form No 47)
(c) In respect of every letter despatched by post, the value of postage stamps affixed to it shall be entered in the
remarks column of Register of letters issued. The entries for postage in the value of stamp column shall be
totalled and the totals carried forward until each supply of stamps is exhausted. Before ordering the purchase of
another supply of stamps, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall compare the total in this column and
the stamps in hand with the amount of the last purchase and see that the stamps are duly accounted for.
1325. (a) All correspondence shall be arranged in the correspondence almirah (each years
correspondence separately) according to the subject. The classification of subjects shall be fixed by
the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent, and a statement showing the classification to be adopted
shall be entered on the inner side of the front board of Register of letters received. The following
classification is suggested, but may be modified by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of any
jail to suit the work of his office:-
(1) Accidents, assaults or outbreaks.
(2) Accoutrements, arms, uniform, and ammunition and indents therefor, alarm parades, and
military training.
(3) Admission and release of prisoners, including correspondence regarding warrants, fines and
fine realisation statements, remission of sentence, release of moribund prisoners.
(4) Annual reports and returns.
(5) Appeals
(6) Bills and accounts, general maintenance and manufactory, including budget.
(7) Civil prisoners.
(8) Classification, separation of classes, including correspondence about habituals and previous
convictions.
(9) Convict officers, clerks and servants, their appointment, degradation, etc.
(10) Discipline, offences and punishments of convicts, rules and regulations.
(11) Epidemics and outbreak of infectious disease, health camps, etc.
(12) Escapes and re-captures, guarding, watch and ward.
(13) Establishment, appointment and dismissal, offences and punishment of jail officers, leave
and transfer of officers, pay and travelling allowances. In one file, the bottom one or first
will bear the number 1, and top or last letter the number 25. (ii) Every letter issued should
217
bear three numbers thus
(14) Executions, obtaining hangmen and necessary appliances.
(15) Garden, dairy, and fish tanks.
(16) General registers and returns.
(17) Indents for clothing, blankets, bedding, stationery forms, and other supplies.
(18) Labour and employment of prisoners.
(19) Lunatics.
(20) Police-registered prisoners, finger-impressions, etc.
(21) Prisoners property and petitions.
(22) Public works, original works, petty additions and alterations and repairs and estimates
therefor.
(23) Sickness and mortality, and matters connected with sanitation, conservancy or medical
administration.
(24) Storing grain and purchase of supplies, including contracts.
(25) Transfers and including over-crowding, escorts, railway passes.
(26) Visitors remarks and inspection.
(27) Miscellaneous.
Jail The above 27 collections should be kept entirely separate in the almirah. Each
Circular collection is comprised of files which relate to distinct subjects under
No. 6 of correspondence. The following rules need to be observed :-
1913
(i) A letter on being received should be bundled separately with red tape and should bear its
distinguishing consecutive file number; thus, if there are 25 letters in one file, the bottom one or
first will bear the number 1, and the top or last letter the number 25.
(ii) Every letter issued should bear three numbers, thus-
1. The consecutive number in the Register of letters issued.
2. The collection number.
3. The file number.
Of these numbers only the first will change in any subsequent communication.
(b) The letters comprising each separate correspondence shall be tied together into one file arranged in
order of date. These files shall then be grouped together to form collection according to the
classification adopted under the preceding paragraph, and in each collection the separate files of
correspondence shall be serially numbered. At the bottom of each collection shall be placed a
cardboard Slip of one eight the size of a foolscap sheet, bearing on the side turned outwords a copy of
the subject heading according to the classification adopted, with its number and the year. Both the file
number and the collection shall be shown in column 6 of Register of letters Received, and in column 5
of Register of letters Issued, against entries made therein. When not in use the collection shall be
arranged on a shelf in the correspondence almirah with the cardboard slips uppermost in order of
collection numbers.
(c) No file shall be kept in any officials desk or anywhere but in its place in the collection of the year
to which it belongs, unless it be in actual use. Whenever a file is taken out of its place in the collection
to which it belongs, a long slip of paper shall be substituted, signed by the official who takes away the
file, who shall remain responsible for it until it is restored to its place.
(d) Under this system there ought not to be the slightest difficulty in finding any letter at any time.
When once it has been found in Register of letters received or issued, the number of its file will be
known, and it may be produced at once from its proper place on the shelf.
Jail Circular 1326. All letters sent by Government officers in their official capacity, in reply to
No. 45 of communication of any kind received from private individual or association, shall be
1905. despatched service paid.
Jail Circular 1327. Stamps of as high denomination as possible should always be used to pay the
No. 9 of necessary postal charges, e. g one two Taka stamp should be used rather than two one-
1908. Taka stamps. An account of service postage stamp shall be kept in the Register
(Bangladesh Form No. 42) prescribed for the purpose.
218
G. O. Nos Section 111.- Accounts
-33-83T. F
dated the 1328. The business transactions of a jail are divided between two entirely separate
24th April departments-the Manufactory and General - each of which is self-contained and
1930. independent of the other. The system of accounts in each department is similar,
though the various forms and records used are, for the most part, different. Every
article which enters, or leaves, or is produced, or consumed in a jail, must be checked
and accounted for in one or other of these departments. The Manufactory Department
deals with raw materials, manufactured articles, dead and live stock used in the
Manufactory. The General Department deals with everything else.
1329. The daily books and ledgers shall be examined every morning, and shall not, on any account, be
allowed to fall into arrears.
1330. No knife erasures shall be permitted in any documents, registers or accounts relating to money
or stock. If alterations should be necessary, they shall be made by passing the pen through the
incorrect items in red ink, and writing the correction above, and all such corrections shall be initialed
by the person who signed or has to sign the documents. Before submitting accounts or bills to the
office of the Inspector-General, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall satisfy himself that no
knife erasures appear upon them; and he shall reject any documents so altered and have new ones
prepared and signed.
1331. A monthly certificate of completion of accounts in Return No. 4 shall be forwarded to the
Inspector- General of Prisons as soon as possible after the 15 th of every succeeding month. With
regard to the half-yearly certificate of correctness of stock (B. J. Returns No. 5 and 6), see rule 87.
Before submitting these certificates the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall initial each
separate account in each day book and ledger belonging to the Manufactory Department.
1332. Every Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of a jail shall furnish the Inspector General
annually, not later than the 31st. July with a budget estimate in return No.18 (Bangladesh form No.
5041), and the Inspector General shall make due provision in his budget for all sums necessary for the
maintenance of each jail and the purchase of raw material for manufactures, work sheds, machinery,
etc. For the preparation of the revised estimate which is compiled along with the budget estimate for
the ensuing year the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent must keep himself informed as to the
progress of revenue and expenditure for the corresponding period of the previous year and prepare as
accurate a forecast as it is possible to make at the time of preparing the budget, that is, in July.
The budget estimate of revenue should be prepared from the registers of demands as well as on the
basis of any out standings of previous years that are likely to be realized during the ensuing year. The
budget estimate of expenditure should provide for (a) fixed charges, viz., pay of gazetted officers and
subordinate staff, etc.; (b) new charges which have been finally sanctioned for introduction in the
ensuing year, and (c) fluctuating charges, such as, travelling allowances, supplies and services and
contingencies. For fixed charges, the estimate under the detailed budget heads under Pay of
Officers and Pay of Establishment should show the full amount of sanctioned scale, permanent or
temporary, with numbers and rates of pay for officers and establishments with increments falling due
during the ensuing year in the case of progressive or time scale pay and any extra expenditure due to
officiating pay as far as can be foreseen. For fluctuating charges such as, travelling allowances,
contingent charges and the like, the estimate should be based on the actual expenditure of the three
years last past which should be shown in the appropriate columns of the budget form with an
explanation in the remarks column for any allowance for increase or decrease in the ensuing year. The
classification of expenditure should be based on the schedule to rule 1339. A memorandum should be
attached to the budget estimate clearly explaining the variations in the figures and repetition or
omission of any special item.
1333. Deleted.
Sec. C. A. 1334. Deleted.
Code Art.1.
219
Bengal Form 1335 . Money realised from sales for cash and from credit sales of previous months
No. 5117. shall always be paid into the treasury by district jails, whenever the sum of Tk. 5000,
and by central jails whenever Tk..10,000, has accumulated, and also (irrespective of
the amount) on the last working day of every month, and treasury receipts for the
amounts [in Treasury remittance voucher (form No. 80) for the Manufactory, or
Treasury Chalan (Bangladesh form No2381) for the General Department, signed by
the treasury officer] shall be attached to the monthly statement of Receipts, submitted
to the Inspector Generals office.
1336. Earnest money deposits of contractors shall be remitted to the treasury for deposit under the
head. Revenue Deposit in favour of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail. The
original Treasury Challan showing the credit shall accompany the tender. Successful Tenderes shall
likewise deposit their security money direct into the Treasury and submit the original Treasury
Challan to the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the jail along with the contract deed.
Contractors whose tenders are accepted may also deposit their security in the form of G. P. Notes or
postal cash certificates, which will be kept, after proper scrutiny, in the jailors safe custody.
Note- 1. A successful tenderer who has deposited G.P. Notes as security money shall be required to
endorse these in favour of the authority concerned.
Note. 2. Earnest money deposits are refundable only under the authority of an order endorsed upon
the original treasury challan by the departmental office in whose favour the deposit was made [(Civil
Account code, Article 201 (b) ].
1337. In order to meet emergent petty charges of all kinds, separate permanent advances of the
following scale for General and Manufactory Departments are allowed. They may be renewed in each
department as often as necessary during the month by presenting an abstract bill in detail for the
amounts paid out of them up to date :-
220
1339. Expenditure shall be classified as shown in the following schedule. This classification is based on
the following principles: firstly, that each item shall be classified according to its main purpose, secondly
that ordinary current expenses shall be shown separately from extraordinary expenditure on tools, dead or
live stock which remain in use for long periods and are purchased at long intervals. Extraordinary
expenditure on plant, tools and stock is defined as expenditure upon such articles as may be expected to
last with fair wear and tear for three years and upwards, and upon live stock; but exception is made to this
rule in the case of office furniture, which shall be included under Contingencies.
G. O. No. 3478- P.J., dated Schedule showing items of expenditure classified according to the
the 20th September 1933. classification adopted in the jails :
Jails-General. Department.
Heads adopted in the Budget of Sub-heads Classification of items.
the country required for Pay of Senior Superintendent/Superintendent and
Pay of officers. Deputy Superintendent is adjusted under this head in
Senior administrative
purposes the accounts. No distribution of allotment is necessary.
Superintendent/ Superintendent
Pay of Medical Officer is adjusted under this head. No
and Deputy Superintendent. ---
Medical Officer. distribution of allotment is necessary.
---
Pay of Establishment. The nomenclature of these heads shows how
1. Deleted.. expenditure is adjusted in the accounts on account of
2. Jailors and Deputy Jailors. pay of various subordinate staff in the General
3. Clerical, educational and Department of jails. No allotment is necessary under
mechanical establishments.
these heads except for Temporary servants: and
4. Assistant Surgeons.
5. Pharmacist and dressers.
Temporary watch and ward. Pay of temporary staff
6. Permanent watch and should also be adjusted under the respective heads
ward. except the pay of temporary warder guard.
7. Permanent servants. Pay of temporary warder guard only is adjusted
8. Temporary servants. under the head Temporary watch and ward.
9. Temporary watch and
ward.
Allowances, honoraria etc, Travelling and conveyance allowance are adjusted
12 Travelling allowance. under this head. Expenditure under this head should
be separately shown as voted or charged
according as the allowance is drawn by an officer
whose pay is voted or otherwise.
13 House rent and others This sub- head includes expenditure on house rent
allowances. allowance and compensatory allowances including
jail allowance of Assistant Surgeon and Pharmacists,
fees to Veterinary Assistants or to any other officer
for meritorious work (see head 23D).
Expenditure under this sub-head should also be
separately, shown as voted or charged according as
the allowance is drawn by an officer whose pay is
subject to the vote of the Legislature or protected
from such vote.
221
17.Dietary charges A.-Rations This sub-head should include cost of provisions and
fuel for prisoners except hospital diets and extras
ordered by the Medical Officer. No charge shall be
made for vegetables, condiments, cereals, firewood
or fish obtained from the Jail premises.
19. Clothing and bedding of D. Proportion See above Dietary charges (D).
prisoners. dairy expenses.
222
Not only the cost of new clothing, and bedding, but
all charges for repairs (needles, thread, cloth, etc.)
should be included under this head. The cost of new
bed-steads (wood or iron) should be included under
Extraordinary charges, heading No 24 (J).
20. Sanitation charges A. - Under this sub- head should be included of all municipal
Conservancy, charges for special conservancy work done, expenditure
washing and for brooms, tar or pitch, privy and dry earth baskets, or
purifying. bamboo for making such baskets, rope for mehtars or jute
for making it; Kodalies or hoes for conservancy, soap or
sajjimatti for washing prisoners clothes; shell lime for
white-washing (if not treated as a public works charge);
earthen pots and vessels for conservancy; repairing
conservancy utensils, carts, etc disinfectants, sulfur for
fumigation, and other conservancy items not coming under
the definition of Extraordinary expenditure.
223
23.Other charges. A. - Lighting This head should include such items as gas-rates,
provided the gas is used (this rate will also be an
exception to the rule that municipal rates shall be
charged to contingencies, if the gas works are under a
municipality); Kerosene or other lamp oil wicks,
renewal of lamp glasses, repairing gas pipes, lamps,
etc, oil pumps. Extra ordinary charges are to be
excluded.
B. - Disciplinary This head should include such items as materials for
charges. repairing anklerings, wrist-rings or fetters; iron for
rivets, smithy coal, Aluminum identification tickets,
leather or canvas for gaiters, cane for permanent ink
for marking clothes. etc, combs for females, shaving
or hair cutting charges ; repairing locks and keys.
Extraordinary charges excluded.
C. Uniform and This head should include such items as uniform,
equipment of shoes, great coats, umbrellas for warders,
warders ammunition (when paid or charged for); repairs to
arms, accoutrements or uniform; oil for arms
Extraordinary charges for new arms,
accoutrements, arm-racks are to be excluded.
D. Money This head should include such items as rewards for
payments as recapturing prisoners; allowances to recovered
reward for lunatics, rewards for meritorious service. Rewards
recapture and paid to private persons only should proceed against
service. this head, but rewards to Government servants
should be met from head 13-House rent and other
allowances.
E. Execution This head should include such items (if paid by the
charges. jail Department) as the cost of temporary gibbets,
execution ropes, cap, pay of executioner and domes,
cremation or burial. Expenditure for permanent plant
should be included under Extraordinary charges,
Miscellaneous No 24 (J).
F. Other This head should include such items as oil for unction for
miscellaneous females, aged and infirm, coolie hire, carriage and freight,
services and packing, umbrella for convict over-seers, paper, pen,
supplies. pencil and slates for education, brass wire, wire-netting
(unless required for the garden). Dyes, camphor, packing
charges, paint and paint brushes, linseed oil, saws, enamel
solder, burial and cremation charges, purdashs for ward
windows, mats for closing windows or for prisoners to sit
upon, bamboos for making these, chalk, glue, fodder,
straw and medicines for draught cattle, shoeing of
bullocks. Extraordinary charges should be excluded.
24. Extraordinary charges for A.-Conservancy This sub-head should include such items as night-soil
live stock, tools and plant. and water-supply ejectors, iron urine tubs, conservancy pans, etc., iron
dead-stock. blanket-boilers, water-pumps, pipes or reservoirs, water
carts, iron water-tanks or drums, iron or brass taps, iron or
wooden buckets, water boilers (if of a lasting kind).
Note.-Where these articles are supplied by Public Works
Department Workshops, the Jail Department should be
debited and the Public Works Department credited with
their value. (Expenditure by the Public Works Department
on building, however, is recorded in the accounts of the
Public Works Department and should be excluded from
the accounts of the jail Department).
224
B. Dietary dead To include cooking ranges, grain carts, wheat mills,
stock. scales and weights for grain godowns or cooks, if of
metal, iron or copper, for cooking utensils, ovens, if
of iron or lasting material ; malamine or brass cups
or plates, axes and the like.
C. Hospital To include cost of iron beds, covered iron pans, iron
dead stock. urinals or metal bed-pans, excreta-incinerators and
similar lasting appliances.
D.Garden and To include iron ploughs, fencing, pumps for
agricultural irrigation wells (if not treated as Public Works
plant. charges) or other lasting plant.
E. Lighting Here should be shown the cost of laying down gas-
dead stock pipes or of new kerosene or other lamps of a
substantial kind likely to last for three years or
upwards, iron oil-tanks, and such like lasting plant.
F- Disciplinary To include the cost of weighing machines or scale for
stock weighing prisoners, measuring rods, or instruments
for anthropometry, iron for fetters and wrist-rings,
black-smiths implements for making fetters, etc. (if
likely to last three years), new locks, handcuffs,
removable fetters, flogging triangles, hair-clippers,
scissors or razors (if lasting for three years and
upwards), steel dies and types for numbering
identification-tickets and similar lasting stock.
G. Arms and To include original cost of arms (if charged for),
accoutrements. belts, badges, pouches and bayonet scabbards,
batons, arm-racks, snap caps, alarm rattles, etc.
H. Dairy live- To include cost of cows, iron or metal milk pails,
stock and plant. receptacles, lactometers, metal or wooden churns,
cow-sheds (if they are not buildings erected by the
Public Works Department) and other lasting plant.
Maintenance charges to be included under Dietary
Charges (D) and Hospital (D).
I. Draught To include the cost of bullocks, horses, Ponies, and
cattle sheds for sheltering them (if not charged to public
works). Maintenance charges to be included under
Miscellaneous services ( F ).
J. - Other miscellaneous To include iron cot or beds(except when intended for
dead stock not coming
under the above heads. the hospital), permanent gibbets, ladders and other
stock which cannot be classified under above heads.
25.Other repairs and A. - Petty All expenditure for temporary buildings, kutcha
maintenance. construction erection or minor works and the repair of buildings
not belonging to the Manufacture Department, or not
on the books of the Public Works Department, or
petty repairs of doors, whitewashing, etc., of such as
are on the books of the Public Works Department, i.
e., such works as come under the head of petty
construction and repairs. Charges under A-petty
construction must be shown separately from B-
petty repairs.
225
B.-Petty Repairs. Petty constructions and repairs may be executed by
the Senior Superintendent/Superintendents of jails
departmentally when the expenditure on any one
project does not exceed Tk.50,000 in amount.
26. Rents, rate and taxes. A- Rents. This head should include rents on buildings or land
whether payable to municipalities or private
landlords.
B. Rates and All kinds of rates and taxes except water rates and
taxes gas rates are to be included under this head. Water
rates should be included under head 20-B and gas
rates under 23-A, Water rates and lighting and
conservancy taxes may, however, be included under
this head, if no service is rendered and the payments
are simply made as taxation, the water supply, etc,
being otherwise arranged for.
27. Other charges A. - Current To include such items as country stationery, book
office expenses binding, gharry hire to officers (if allowed), dusters,
matches, oil for punkha wheels, cost of hanging and
removing punkhas, punkha rope, repairing and
polishing furniture, cooly hire for carrying office
materials, supply of drinking water in office,
newspaper and similar charges.
B. - Office To include cost of almirahs, racks, shelves, tables,
furniture and desks, chairs, stools, mats, floor matting, durries or
dead stock. carpets, purdahs, punkha fringes, clocks, gongs,
letters scales and weights, iron safe, type writers, and
duplicators required for office. This is an exception
to the rule that "Extraordinary expenditure' is to be
shown separately.
C. Service To include cost of postage stamps and telegram.
postage and
telegram charges.
D. - Rent of --------
telephone
connection
E. Pay of menials Pay of sweepers and other menials who are non-
pensionable should be included under this head.
F. - Livery of ------
office peons and
menials.
28. Purchase of books. Books and Purchase of books and publication required for office
and periodicals- publication and prisoners should be included under this head.
29. Contribution for passages of ---- This head relates to inter adjustment on account of
officers transferred from other contribution for passages. No allotment is necessary
Governments, Departments, etc. under this head.
30. Deleted. ----- Deleted.
31. Charges on security ------- The cost of credit notes issued for transport of
forces. prisoners either on transfer from one jail to another
or on release is adjustable under this head in the
accounts. No distribution of allotment is necessary.
226
32. Other charges. A. -Transfer This sub head should include all cash payments on account
charges and road of transfer or release of prisoners such as carriage hire and
subsistence for subsistence and other expenses for dieting prisoners in
convicts. transit Rail-way fares and carriage when necessary of
released convicts: subsistence allowance or gratuities
given to convicts on release if granted for subsistence on
the journey home, but not if granted as rewards: clothes
for released convicts: transfer charges for lunatics sent to
asylum. No distribution of allotment is necessary.
B. Deleted. Deleted.
Pay of officers. JAIL MANUFACTURES (MANUFACTURE DEPARTMENT
1.Deleted. ---- Deleted.
14. Establishment charges --- Under other contingent charges should also be
recoverable from other recorded the expenditure on such items as coal,
Governments, Departments, electric energy, and any other item which cannot be
etc. included under any of the above heads.
227
15. Deduct-Recoveries on --- Recoveries by the book adjustment of the actual cost
account of supplies to jails. of supplies made by the Manufacture Department to
the General Department of the same jails or to other
jails are shown under this head in the accounts. The
figures under this head should be the same as those
shown in Return No. 22.
If expenditure is incurred on any item not included in the above list, the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent will be guided in classifying it by the principles enunciated above; it is not
intended that the classification shall be minute and elaborate beyond any useful measure; the object is to
reduce to a minimum the chance of such an inaccuracy as would have a serious effect in comparing the
financial results of different jails.
1340. Charges of the following description require the special sanction of the Inspector General, which
shall be obtained previously to incurring the expenditure, but when there is extreme urgency, expenditure
may be incurred (with the approval of the Magistrate in the case of district jails) in anticipation of
sanction, which shall be applied for without delay :-
Charges for extra establishment, construction and repairs either of ordinary jail buildings or
manufactory sheds; new office furniture; expensive iron vessels for conservancy purposes or for carrying
water, costing more than Tk. 5,000; ground-rent and other items, such as hospital beds, handcuffs, locks,
etc., which are not ordinarily recurring monthly charges; expenditure for storing provisions or materials,
for plant for manufactory purposes, and large purchases of tools; and in any case when the budget grant is
not sufficient to cover the proposed expenditure.
1341. (1) In all applications for sanction to proposals involving expenditure it should be distinctly stated
whether the proposed charge can be met from the budget grant under appropriate head, and if it cannot be
so met, whether it can be found by reappropriation from savings under other heads.
(2) No disbursing officer may, without previously obtaining an extra grant, incur expenditure in excess of
the grant placed at his disposal under the heads concerned, and when a disbursing officer exceeds the
annual grant, he may, under orders of Government be held responsible for the excess. In rare cases
however when expenditure in excess of the grant is urgent and inevitable, this may be incurred, but the
officer incurring it does so on his own responsibility and must immediately report the fact to the Inspector
General with the request that an additional grant may be sanctioned to cover the excess and at the same
time explain why it was not possible to foresee the necessity for the extra grant.
(3) All charges incurred must be paid and drawn at once and under no circumstances may they be allowed
to stand over to be paid from the grant of another year.
1342. A register of contingent expenditure shall be maintained both in the General and Manufactory
Departments. In the register of the General Department (B. J. No. 32) the column headings are assigned
in accordance with the Schedule given in Rule 1294. In the register of the Manufactory Department (F. R.
Form No. 8) also the column headings shall be indicated in accordance with the headings in that
Schedule. Details of budget grants shall be entered in the appropriate columns. Details of payment,
whether made from the Permanent Advance or by Abstract Bill, together with the date, serial number and
name of the payee, etc., shall be entered in appropriate column immediately after each transaction is
effected. A yearly serial number should be given against every item of cash expenditure irrespective of
the amount, and a separate monthly serial number should be given in addition to the yearly serial number
to receipt obtained from vendors and entered in the column for number of voucher. The Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent shall enter his initial against the payment of each item. Interdepartmental
transfer shall be similarly entered in red ink.
228
At the end of each month the following totals shall be made under head :-
(a) Cash Expenditure.
(b) Inter departmental transfer ( i. e., by book transfer).
(c) Total of (a) and (b).
(d) Progressive of all expenditure incurred since the beginning of the financial year; this total should be
carried forward to the beginning of the next month.
G. O. No. 1343. (1) Service and supplies are obtained and disposed of
3478P. J.
dated the 20th (a) by cash transactions ;
September (b) By inter or intra-departmental supply.
1933. (2) Accounts are settled-
(a) by bills on the Treasury;
(b) by inter or intra-departmental transfer (i. e., by book transfer).
B. Form No. 1344. (1) Supplies obtained by cash purchase shall be ordered either on the Store
5107. Order (Form No. 64) or on the Contract Forms (73 and 74). Orders in the form of
Bangladesh
Form Nos. chits or letters are prohibited.
5155 and 5115.
B Form (2) Supplies obtained inter-departmentally shall be ordered on the Store Order except
No. 5108. where special forms of indent are prescribed.
B. Form Nos. (3) Supplies disposed of for cash or credit shall be delivered out of the jail godown
5109 Store Delivery Voucher (Form No.65) and shall be allowed to pass out of the gate on a
B Form Nos. Gatekeepers Pass (Form No. 66), an entry being made in the Gatekeepers Register of
5000. Articles (Register No. 25). If the articles are supplied on cash payment, a Cash Bill
B Form Nos.
(Form No. 67) shall be given to the purchaser, if required by him; if supplied on credit
5110.
G. O. No.
the purchaser shall sign a receipt on a Credit Bill(Form No. 68) and payment shall be
1732P. applied for in Form No. 69. Bill for articles supplied to the public.
J. dated the
28th
August 1928.
(4) Supplies disposed of inter or intra departmentally shall be dealt with as prescribed
in rule 1362 (2).
B Form Nos. 1345. In regulating the price of jail-manufactured articles, whether offered for sale to the
5111. public or to consuming departments of Government, the prevailing market rates for
B. Form Nos. similar articles should be followed as closely as possible; when such market rates do not
5112 exist or cannot be ascertained the following procedure should be adopted, care being
taken that, in estimating the price to be assigned to jail products, due allowance is made
for the admitted inferiority of convict labour to free labour.
G. of 1. Resn. The price of jail manufacture supplied to the public and to departments other than
No.20-1406-19 Prisons Directorate and offices subordinate to it should always include-
of (a) the price of raw materials;
22nd September (b) the wages of jail labour rated according to the wages for free labour of the same class
1882.
in the neighbourhood;
(c) 5 per cent. On cost of raw materials for wear and tear of plant;
(d) 10 per cent. Profit on raw materials and labour for supplies to Government or
wholesale dealers, 25 per cent for supplies to retail dealer and 37.50% per cent for
supplies to the general public; and
(e) Packing and other charges.
229
In the case of jail supplies to other jails the cost of raw materials only shall be debited to the consuming
Jail.
1346. No officer of the jail is permitted to make advances from his own pocket. Petty sums shall be paid
by the Jailer in cash out of the Permanent Advance. In payment of a large sum, the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent shall draw upon the Treasury by an abstract bill.The money when
received from the treasury shall be paid at once to the person to whom it is due and shall not be kept in
hand more than 48 hours. It is a standing rule that no money shall be drawn from the Treasury before it is
required for disbursement. There should, therefore, seldom be a balance against the jail, except the
Permanent Advance, prisoners property, diet money, proceeds of manufacture sold, and possibly petty
refunds.
1347. If purchases are made through a contractor, he shall ordinarily be expected to act without an
advance of money,as there is no fund from which such an advance can be made; but it should be settled
with as often as possible, and in every case before the 25 th day of the month, and the expenses from the
25th to the end of the month shall be paid by the 10th of following month.
1348. Remittances to tradesmen of sums exceeding Tk. 50 shall be made by remittance transfer receipts
and not by money orders, and those not exceeding Tk.. 200/- by money orders. No charge for a money
order for remitting any sum exceeding Tk..50 shall be passed. Remittance transfer receipts shall be
applied for in B.J. Form No.77.
1349. (1). A receipt shall be taken from the vendor for any disbursement of upwards of Tk. 200 and as far
as possible for payments of from one to ten Taka. This shall also apply to payment made by means of
endorsed abstract bills as permitted by Rule 1346. The receipts shall be in the vernacular known by the
signer, and the payee shall state in words the amount he has received. Receipts should ordinary be taken
on the voucher for cash payments (Bangladesh Form No. 54).
(2) Separate receipts shall be obtained from the vendors for payments under each head
of charge, and before sending the bill to the office of the Inspector-General, the receipts
in support of each shall be sorted together, fastened in bundles at the corners, and
labeled in large letter Dietary charges Hospital, Clothing, sanitation, etc.
according to the description of charges they support. A vendor receiving payment
exceeding Tk. 20 for supplies charged for under more than one head shall note the sums
of the several receipts and the total amount received on the back of one receipt, to
which a receipt stamp shall be affixed.
G. O. No538 p. (3) Every item of cash payment, irrespective of the amount, shall bear a yearly serial
j dated the 5th number and item for which receipts signed by the payee are obtained as prescribed in
February 1932. clause (1) above shall be given in addition to the yearly number a separate monthly
serial number. The yearly serial number in respect of each payment and the monthly
serial number in cases where receipts are obtained should be noted in the Contingent
Register and the Cash-book in the columns provided for the purpose. Each receipt
should bear both the yearly and monthly serial number and should be headed distinctly
No. for the month of January or any other month for which it may be.
1350. Two cash-books (Register No. 31) shall be maintained one for the General Department and one
for the Manufactory.
(i) The cash-books of both the General Department and the Manufactory Department shall be examined
and verified by the Jailor with the cash in hand daily except in the case of a Central jail where is a whole
time Deputy-Superintendent on whom the responsibility and verification in respect of the Manufactory
Department cash-book shall devolve. The jailor or the Deputy-Superintendent, as the case may be, shall
note the words verified and found correct above his initial in the cash-book (Rule 262).
230
(ii) The monetary transactions as entered in the cash-book should be attested by the Senior
Superintendent /Superintendent. However, in case of a central jail where there is a whole time Deputy-
superintendent the entries in cash-book of the Manufactory Department should be attested by the Deputy-
Superintendent.
Rule 891. 1351. (1) The cash-books shall contain under each days heading a statement of all the
transaction relating to that day. The entries shall be made immediately after each
transaction is effected. On the receipt side sums received to make up the Permanent
Advance, sums received from the treasury on bills for special purposes, sums received on
account of prisoners property or diet money, etc. The items of cash received from
Government on abstract bills need not be entered in full on the receipt side shall be
quoted by its serial number, and its general character may be stated, as bill for diet, for
salary, etc. All receipts shall be compared by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent
with entries in the cash-book, and each receipt shall be countersigned (or cancelled as the
case may be) by him after he has satisfied himself that it is genuine. He shall at the same
time compare the entries in the treasury pass Book with those in his cash-book relating to
all payments to, and receipts from, the Treasury, including payments on abstract bills
endorsed as permitted by Rule 1346, and see that the books agree. Subsistence allowance
to released prisoners may be entered in a lump sum daily from the release Diary (see
Rule 542 (3) (e). Receipts and disbursements on account of civil prisoners diet shall be
entered daily, the amount paid on account each prisoners being shown separately.
In checking these entries reference shall be made to column No. 16 of the civil prisoners admission
register showing the daily allowance granted and to the counterfoil of the receipt-book for diet money.
When prisoners cash property is entered in the Cash-book, the prisoners register numbers, as well as
their names, shall be entered in both the receipt and expenditure side.
(2) On the disbursement side contingent expenditure need not be shown in detail. Details of expenditure
either from permanent Advance or on account of contractors bills appear in the Contingent Register and
the total of each days transaction with the serial numbers of payments shall only be shown in the Cash-
book. All other payments, such as sums disbursed on account of prisoners property or diet money, etc.
sale-proceeds or refunds deposited in the Treasury shall be entered in the detail immediately on the
disbursement side.
(3) A daily balance shall be struck, and this balance shall correspond with the actual amount of cash in
hand, which the Jailer shall daily ascertain before initialing the balance in the books below each days
account a memorandum shall be given in the general Cash-book showing of what funds the balance
consists as follows:-
Tk.
Permanent Advance
Civil prisoners, diet money
Prisoners , property
1352. The Manufactory Cash-book (Register No. 31) shall be kept on similar principles to that in the
General Department. The receipt side shall include sums received from Government on bills for raw
material, machinery, etc., as well as sums received from purchasers; the expenditure side shall include the
disbursement on raw materials, etc., and the payments into the Treasury of the proceeds of manufactures.
Sales for which cash has been received on the day of sale need not be separately entered; it will be
sufficient to enter cash sales as per Sale Book. All profits of manufactures shall be accounted for to
Government, and shall not be utilized by the Jail Department for purchases, a memorandum shall be
given against each days balance as shown on the right hand page of the Cash-book as follows.
231
Tk.. A. P.
Payable to Government --- 0 0 0
Available for expenditure --- 0 0 0 .
Total --- 0 0 0
1353. The Treasury Pass Book (Bangladesh Form No. 2510) is an account prescribed by the Accountant-
General in which shall be entered by the Treasury Officer every money transaction between the jail and
the Treasury. The entries thereon will be made by the Treasury clerks only, and will be attested by the
Treasury Officers initials. No jail officer is to make any entry or alteration therein. Whenever the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent discovers any discrepancy between the Treasury pass and the jail cash-
books, either in the omission of, or the amount of, an entry or any other irregularity, he shall at once bring
the matter to the notice of the Treasury Officer and ascertain the cause. If the irregularity is not corrected
it shall be reported to the Inspector-General. The rules for conducting business with the Treasury require
that the pass book shall be sent to the Treasury whenever money has either to be drawn or paid in.
Bills for Encashment at the Treasury.
1354. (1) When it is necessary to draw money from the Treasury to recoup the Permanent
C. A. Code. Advance or for payment of sums in excess of the Permanent Advance to the persons to
Art. 97, et whom payment may be due, and in any case at the end of the month or on a charge of
seq. Senior Superintendent/Superintendent Abstract Bill, in Bangladesh Form No. 2474 for
the General, or Bangladesh Form No. 2453 for the Manufactory Department shall be
prepared. In these Bill such details shall be furnished as will suffice for the proper
classification of the charges, i.e., the number of the vouchers (when payment has already
been made). The detailed head of charge according to prescribed classification (Rule
1339); the authority for charges requiring special sanction and the amount under each
head.
The first abstract bill (both for general and manufactory expenditure) presented at the Treasury for
payment after the 15th of each month shall be accompanied by a certificate that:-The detailed bill for the
previous month has been submitted to the Inspector General. Without this certificate the Treasury Officers
will not pay the bill. Except to recoup the Permanent Advance no money shall be withdrawn from the
Treasury unless it is required for immediate disbursement.
(2) Three copies of each abstract bill shall be prepared and the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent
should see that every duplicate and triplicate copy is distinctly marked Duplicate, Triplicate or
office Copy as the case may be, and Not payable. The original copy only shall be forwarded to the
Treasury, the duplicate to the Inspector General to support the detailed bill in which the amount is
accounted for, and triplicate, or office copy, shall be pasted into a guard book and filed in the jail office.
The date of payment by the Treasury of each abstract bill shall invariably be noted upon the
duplicate and triplicate copies. The abstract bill forms should always be kept locked up in an almirah, the
key of which is to remain in charge of the jailer or of the officer whose duty it is to prepare abstract bills.
Pay of Establishment
1355. (1) The pay of establishments shall be drawn on the forms prescribed by the Controller General of
Accounts. Each section of establishment should be drawn separately, i.e., Executive Staff, Warder
Establishment, menials, and charges for manufactory shall be drawn on separate bill. The pay of menials
should be drawn on contingent bill forms, and should be treated as a recurring contingent charge.
Undisbursed pay must be refunded by short drawal in the next bill; it can be redrawn, when necessary, on
an arrear bill.
(2) All pay, whether of fixed or extra establishment, including those of the Manufactory Department, shall
be entered in the Office copy of the combined pay Bill and Acquittance Roll (Bangladesh Form No.
2435). Every officer receiving more than twenty taka a month shall be given a receipt stamp which shall
be affixed to this form, and the signature of the officer shall be written across it. The names of all officers
attached to the jail shall be given in this form, whether their pay is drawn separately or not, and whether
they are on leave or present; the amount of salary drawn for those present shall be entered, and opposite
the names of those who are on leave, and whose pay is not drawn, the leave granted and date from which
it runs shall be noted for guidance in drawing up supplementary pay bills subsequently.
(3) Deleted.
232
(4) Not latter than the 15 th May each year, a detailed statement in duplicate of the permanent
establishment existing on 1st April shall be prepared in Bangladesh Form No. 2440 and transmitted to the
Controller General of Accounts; that portion of the statement which refers exclusively to the warder
establishment shall be forwarded by district jail through the Deputy Inspector General of Prisons. This
statement shall be carefully checked with the service books, as it will be the chief authority by which
pension claims will be tested hereafter.
1356. Travelling allowances shall likewise be drawn separate from other charges on Bangladesh Form
No. 2445 or 2446; the bills other than those for the travelling allowance of warders shall be submitted to
the Deputy Inspector General in duplicate for his counter signature before they are presented for payment.
Detailed Bills.
1357. (1) The total expenditure of each month (except for establishment and travelling allowance),
whether by cash or inter departmental transactions, shall be accounted for in detailed bills to be submitted
to the Inspector General on the 5 th and 10th of each succeeding month by district and central jails,
respectively.
See C.A. (2) There are two forms of detailed bills-the General Contingent Bill (Return No. 10)
code and the Detailed Bill for Manufactory Contingent Charges (Return No. 20).
Art. 62.
G. O. No. (3) The general contingent bill shall account for all charges for administration except
10967 R. J., those for establishment and travelling allowances.
dated the 2nd
November
1925.
(4) The detailed manufacture bill shall account only for expenditure strictly connected with manufactures,
and the charges for material and plant shall be arranged and classified according to the manufacture for
which they were respectively incurred. Expenditure for third class Public Works shall be shown
separately at the end of the bill. With regard to establishment solely employed for the Manufactory
Department, see Rule 1355.
(5) In the detailed bills the expenditure of all money drawn from the Treasury, other than salary and
travelling allowance, shall be accounted for and no money received from the Treasury on encashment of
an abstract bill during any one month is to be included in the bill for any other month. The numbers and
dates of payment of the abstract bills, the amounts of which are accounted for in each bill, shall be noted
at the top of the bill. Full particulars of the quantities and prices of the different articles charged for in
receipts below Tk. 100 shall be given, but details of sub-vouchers above Tk.. 100 need not be repeated in
the detailed contingent bill whenever unusual charges requiring sanction are incurred, the number and
date of the sanctioning letter of the Inspector General or, in the case of rewards, of the proper authority
(see Rule 479) shall be noted. When rewards are paid, a copy of the authority for payment shall
accompany the bill, particulars should also be given of charges for railway freight, cartage, or coole-hire,
for example,-Railway freight of clothing from Dhaka, coole-hire for ditto from stations. Charges for
subsistence to released prisoners should be verified by the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent by
reference to the Release Diary.
(6) In support of each item in a detailed bill exceeding Tk.500 and of any charge for service labels or
phone, fax or other electronic means, the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall submit to the office
of the Inspector General a voucher signed by the person to whom the payment was made, prepared and
arranged in accordance with the instructions given in Rule 1349. No receipts signed by any subordinate
Government servants, except for their own salaries or for carriage-hire, shall be accepted as vouchers in
support of charges in the bills.
[
(7)Copies of countersigned invoices for the value of articles purchased by inter-department transfers shall
be attached to the detailed bills.
233
(8) The Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall also submit a Certificate in the following form after
he shall have personally satisfied himself that all payments of from one to twenty five taka and all
charges for service postage stamps and state telegrams (other than these paid for by service postage
stamps) are duly supported by vouchers that all items in the bill have been really paid, and that the
payments were necessary:-
(i) I certify that the expenditure charged in this bill could not, with due regard to the interests of the
public service, be avoided. I certify that, to the best of my knowledge and belief, the payments entered in
this bill have been duly made to the parties entitled to receive them. Vouchers for all sums above TK.25
(twenty five) in amount are attached to this bill. I have, as far as possible, obtained vouchers for smaller
sums and I am personally responsible that they have been destroyed or so defaced or mutilated that they
cannot be used again.
(ii) Certified that all articles detailed in the vouchers attached to the bill and in those retained in my office
have been accounted for in the stock register.
(iii) Certified that the purchases billed for have been received in good order, that their quantities are
correct, and their quality are good, that the rates paid for are not in excess of the accepted rates and the
market rates and that suitable notes of payment have been recorded against the indents and invoices
concerned to prevent double payments.
(iv) Certified that
(a) the expenditure on conveyance hire charged in this bill in terms of rule 2A of F. R. Appendix 3 to the
Bangladesh Financial Rules, was actually incurred, was unavoidable and is within the scheduled scale
of charges for the conveyance used, and
(c) the Government official concerned is not entitled to draw travelling allowance under the ordinary
rules for the journey, and that he is not granted any compensatory leave and does not and will not
otherwise receive any special remuneration for the performance of the duty which necessitated the
journey.
(d) Certified that all inferior official whose pay has been charged in this bill were actually entertained in
Government service during the period concerned.
Intra-departmental Transfers
1358. The rules prescribed which regulate the conditions under which one department, or branch of a
department (e.g., Manufactory Department of a Jail), of the public service may charge another
department, or branch of a department (e.g., General Department of a Jail) for services rendered or
articles supplied to it, and the procedure to be observed are contained in Articles 110 and 111 of the Civil
Account Code.
234
G. O. No. 282 P. 1359. Indents for jail supplies be submitted in prescribed forms on the dates and to the
J. dated the 9th officers mentioned below :-
September
1927.
Indent on Press and Forms To the Inspector On the 1st January.
Controller, for Bangladesh jail Forms. General.
Indent on Press and Forms Ditto
Controller, Bangladesh for Bangladesh -- On the 15th March.
Executive Forms.
Indent on Press and Forms Ditto
Controller, Bangladesh for Bangladesh -- On the 1st April.
Civil Medical Forms.
Indent on Press and Forms Ditto
Controller, Bangladesh for Bangladesh -- On the 1st August.
C. G. A., Forms.
Indent on Press and Forms
Controller, Bangladesh for Bangladesh -- On the 1st September.
Vaccination Forms.
Indent on Press and Forms Ditto On the 1st October.
Controller, Bangladesh for Bangladesh High --
Court Civil Process and Proceedings Forms.
Indent on Press and Forms
Controller, Bangladesh for Bangladesh Ditto -- On the 1st November.
High Court Civil Miscellaneous Forms.
Indent on Press and Forms
Controller, Bangladesh for Bangladesh Ditto -- On the 1st December.
High Court, Criminal Forms.
Indent on Press and Forms
Controller, Bangladesh for Bangladesh Ditto -- Ditto
Police Forms.
Indent on Press and Forms
Controller, Bangladesh for Bangladesh Ditto -- On the 15th February.
Office Routine and Envelopes.
Indent on Controller of Stationary for
Stationary. Ditto -- On the 1st July.
Jail Circular Indent on the Ordnance Department for
No. 515 of ammunition. Ditto -- On the 1st March.
1913. Indent on the Superintendent, Medical Store
Department for medicines and medical Ditto -- On the 1st January.
stores.
Deleted. Ditto -- On the 1st July.
Indent for vegetable seeds. Ditto -- On the 1st April.
Indent for warders woolen uniform and To the Senior
convicts blankets and woolen clothing. Superintendent, Dhaka On the 1st March.
Central Jail, through I. G.
Rule 1165.
Indent for officers uniform To the Senior When necessary
Superintendent Dhaka
Rule 1174. Central jail.
Indent for prisoners cups, plates etc. To the Senior Super. Ditto.
Dhaka Central Jail.
Indent on the Senior Superintendent, Dhaka Through the Though When
Central Jail, for iron cooking vessels urine Inspector General. necessary.
tubs appliances for distributing food, etc.
Deleted Deleted.. Deleted..
Indent for tat patties (coir) To the Senior On the 1st July.
Superintendent of Central
Jails of the Division.
235
Account of receipt and issue of stationery articles shall be maintained in Bangladesh Form No. 402 (vide
finance Department Memorandum No 61T-Mis.,dated the 14 th May 1926). The recipient and issuer of
stationery articles will put their initials in the columns provided for the purpose at the time of receipt and
issue of stationery. At the same time the issuer will cancel the blank columns. The opening and closing
balances will be struck monthly by the clerk in charge of stationery articles. The stock of stationery will
be verified half yearly by a gazetted officer, and a certificate to this effect, together with any remarks as to
the defects which may have been disclosed, will be submitted to the Head of the office concerned.
An account of receipts and issues of all printed forms received from the forms Department shall also be
maintained in Bangladesh form No 108 in the manner laid down in rule 144of the Bangladesh forms
manual 1927.
1360. The rules for the supply of articles for the public service are contained in Appendix No. 28. In the
matter of petty purchases the power of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent is regulated by the
Government from time to time.
1361. Deleted.
(a) Deleted.
(b) Deleted.
Jail Circular 1362. (1) The cost of supplies or services rendered by the manufactory department of a
No. 19, dated jail to the general department of the same jail or to other either within or outside the
the 3rd August departments of Government shall be adjusted by book transfer, except when such
1931. procedure is unsuited to the business methods of the receiving department concerned, as
for instance, dairy firms, when remittance shall made in cash. The supplies made to the
manufactory Department by the General Department of a Jail shall not be adjusted by
book transfer but shall be accounted for as laid down in rule 1366 (1). The supply of
convict labour by the General Department to the Manufactory Department of a jail shall
not also be charged. The General Department will however charge other departments
including the press and forms Department for supply of articles or convict labour at full
market value---
When any stores are supplied by the general department of a jail to that of another, such
supplies shall be accounted for simply as transfer of stock from one jail to another, short
explanatory notes being recorded in the relevant registers of the supplying and the
receiving jails accordingly.
(2) When adjustment has to be made by book transfer the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent of the
supplying jail, or the officer in charge of the supplying department, shall prepare an invoice of the
quantity and price of the work done, and forward it in triplicate, on the day the goods are despatched to
the officer supplied who, on approving the invoice will countersign all, and return one copy to the
supplying officer; another he will file in his own office; and the third he will attach to his detailed bill for
the current month. The amount charged in the invoice should be noted in the statement of account of the
officer supplied so as to work out the available balance of his grant. The invoice for articles supplied
during a financial year should be accepted as a debit to the budget grant of the receiving officer for that
year, irrespective of whether the invoice is countersigned during that year or the next. The indenting
officer should therefore carefully examine his budget grant and obtain an additional allotment, if
necessary, while sending indents for supplies.
(3) When goods are supplied by Jails, the invoices referred to are in B. J. Form No. 70 in the case of
goods supplied to other Jails within the country in Bangladesh Form No. 51 for goods supplied to other
departments and jails .The former invoices shall show both the market value and actual cost of articles
supplied.
(4) It is most important that countersigned invoices relating to the supplies to other departments and jails
in the country (Bangladesh Form No. 51) should reach the Controller General of Accounts with the
utmost despatch. If, therefore, any unusual delay should occur in the receipt of these documents from the
department supplied, the fact must be reported to the Inspector General. Such countersigned invoices
should be submitted to the Inspector General by Jails every month, accompanied by Return No.14.
236
Supplies by jails.
1363. (1) When manufactured articles are used for the ordinary purposes of the jail in which they are
produced or are supplied to other jails within the Country or to the Prisons Directorate and offices
subordinate to it, the actual cost of materials used shall be charged against the jail or office supplied, but
the market value shall be credited in the manufacture accounts of the producing Jail.
(2) When such articles are supplied to the other departments of Government or to jails in the country the
aggregate recoverable cost shall be calculated as in Rule 1345.
1364. (1) Supplies from manufactory to the General Department of the same jail shall be reported
monthly to the Inspector General in Return No. 22.
(2) Supplies to the Prisons Directorate and offices subordinate to it shall be reported monthly in Return
No. 22 Supported by countersigned invoices (Bangladesh Form No.5114).
(3) The value (actual cost) of supplies from the Manufactory to the General Departments of the same jail
or to the General or Manufactory Departments of other jails or to the Prisons Directorate or the offices
subordinate to it shall be shown under a separate head, viz., Deduct Recoveries on account of Supplies
to Jails subordinate to the primary unit Deduct-Establishment charges recoverable from other
Governments, Departments, etc., under the minor head Jails Manufactures in the Bangladesh
Estimate (Bangladesh Form No. 5041).
(4) Supplies to other departments and Jails in the country shall be reported in Return No. 14 supported by
Rule 1362 and in monthly statement of receipts.
Supplies to Jails.
1365. Supplies from the Manufactory Departments of jails shall be entered in the jail registers in the same
manner as cash purchases, but the entries in the Contingent Register shall be made in red ink.
1366. (1) Supplies made from the General Department to the Manufactory Department of the jail shall
not be deducted from the expenditure in the monthly detailed contingent bills of the General Department
and added to the manufactory accounts. Such supplies shall be accounted for simply as transfer of stock
from one department to another, short explanatory notes being recorded in the relevant registers of the
General Department and Manufactory Department accordingly. For administrative purposes the total
value of such supplies made during the year may, however, be shown in the Annual Financial Statement
No. IX (Bangladesh Jail Annual Return No. 4).
(2) Supplies from the Manufactory Department of other jails both to the Manufactory Department and
General Department shall be charged to the Manufactory or General Department as the case may be and
added to the monthly detailed bill supported by copies of countersigned invoice (Bangladesh Form No.
5114), the expenditure being accounted for in the Contingent Register.
(3) Supplies from other departments shall be treated as items of expenditure and shall be shown in the
appropriate place in the detailed bills as well as in the Contingent Register. Such expenditure shall then be
included with the other items in the detailed bill and other relevant accounts so as to work out the
available balance of the budget grant under the appropriate head in the same manner as cash drawn from
the treasury.
1367. When uniforms are supplied to jail subordinates at their own cost (including supply of uniform to
warders under Rule 361), the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent of the receiving jail shall countersign
and return to the supplying jail an invoice for the cost. An account of them shall be opened in the ledger
of manufactured articles, No. 44, from which they shall be sold to the officers requiring them, in the usual
way. The cost shall then be realized in the usual course and paid into the Treasury with other sale
proceeds.
1368. Deleted -
Railway Credit Note System.
1369. Money for payment of railway fares for conveyance of prisoner on transfer or on
returning to their homes after release, shall not be advanced either to guards or
Rule 1307 prisoners, or be drawn from the Treasury. The railway credit note system shall be
adopted and regulated by the following rules :-
237
(1) When a prisoner or prisoners have to be transferred from one jail to another by rail, the officer in
charge of the escort shall be given a railway warrant in Form No. 18 for the number of lower class fares
which, under Rule 877, the Jail Department will have to pay.
Bangladesh (2) When a released prisoner will have to travel to his home by rail, he shall be given a
Form No.5073 railway warrant for a single lower class ticket to the station nearest to his village. For
prisoners in Divisions I and II see Rule 1087(2).
G. O. .No.. (3) These credit notes must be signed by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent or,
11P.J. Dated in his absence, by the Deputy Superintendent or the officer acting for the Senior
the 3rd January Superintendent/Superintendent. In emergent cases during the temporary absence of the
1935. Senior Superintendent/Superintendent and the Deputy Superintendent, the jailer may
sign the credit notes, but the initial of the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent should
be obtained on the duplicate copy when he next visits the jail. The form is bound in a
counterfoil book with duplicates. Full details must be given of the number of prisoners
and escort, number of tickets required, and the amounts to be paid by the police and by
the Accountant-General. The duplicate is to be given to the party for whom the tickets
are required, and will be presented to the station master. The original will remain in the
bound cover as the jail record.
(4) On the first working day of every month the Senior Superintendent/Superintendent shall furnish to the
Controller-General of Accounts in B. J. Form No. 19, a statement giving details of all warrants issued
during the preceding month, and amounts payable thereon, and note the amount in red ink in his
contingent register under the proper heads of charges. The amounts chargeable for fares must be correctly
stated in both copies of the warrant and in the statement; any error or discrepancy will cause delay in the
adjustment of the account. Every jail should have a correct list of fares in the office.
(5) Similarly, payment of railway freight on goods received or despatched by central jails, and district
jails are made by means of credit notes, the charges being adjusted in the Exchange Accounts of the
railway concerned with the Accountant-General, Bangladesh. With a view to obviate the difficulty
experienced in adjusting under-charges due to errors in the invoiced weight or in the charges on
consignments booked under Credit Notes, the consignee should grant to the destination station a
certificate for the amount of such under-charges to serve as a voucher in support of the additional claim
by the despatching railway.
(6) Deleted.
(7) Deleted.
Registers and Returns.
1370. The following registers are prescribed for use in the Manufacture Department:-
238
Bangladesh 1371. Day Book of Raw Materials, Dead and Live Stock, belonging to the Manufacture
Form Department (Register No. 41)-
No.5107
Bangladesh (1) This book referred to for convenience as the Day Book is a rough account book or
Form
diary in which all raw materials or articles of any kind for use in the manufactures are
Nos.5155 and
5115.
entered at the time, serially and without classification, as they pass into, or out of, the
Bangladesh Manufacture Department. Every entry is the direct result of an order on a store order
Form (B.J.Form No. 64) or contract Form (B. J. Form Nos. 73 and 74), or a store Delivery
No.5108. Order (B. J. Form No. 65), and unless it refers to a transfer From the General Department
Bangladesh of the same jail, a record of it should also exist under the same date in the Gate Register
Form (No. 25).
No.5000.
G.O.No.287 (2) On the Receipt side full details of each articles as required by the column headings
T.-R., dated shall be entered on the same day, from the invoices of articles received, the description,
the 14th June quantity, weight, or measurement of the material or article, from whom purchased, and the
1924. price and value, if then known. When the article is paid for, the date of the entry of the
payment in the Cash-book shall be noted in this register, also the cost, if not previously
entered, and subsequently the number and date of the abstract bill in which each item is
included. Besides stock, all charges, such as railway freight, coolie-hire, cartage, etc., shall
likewise be entered on the receipt side of this book. The quality, quantity weight or
measurement of articles received shall be checked either at the time of or within 48hours
after delivery by an officer of the jail to be appointed by the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent. If the check is not made at the time of delivery, the
receiving officer shall note Not checked against the entry of the articles. After the
articles have been checked, the officer making the check shall note the result of the check.
All such notes shall be signed and dated. Entries of articles worth Tk.100 or more shall be
invariably checked and attested by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent.
G.O.No.2302 (3) On the disbursement side every article issued from raw material stock shall also on
P.J., dated the the day of issue be entered from the Store Delivery Orders; the entries on this side shall
24th July 1929 also include the loss of stock by accident or theft, sale of useless stock, and deterioration
in value in stock taking. Ordinarly the value of an article entered on the disbursement side
need not be stated in this register, as provision for this detail is made in the ledger of raw
material in which a monthly valuation in regard to issue for each manufacture is sufficient,
but when the sale of material or stock is effected, the amount for which sold should be
entered in the columns provided for the purpose. The issue value of any article shall be the
value of the articles as shown in the stock ledger; if any article is purchased at different
rates its issue value should be the average value of the article. In either case, the incidental
charges, e, g., freight, coole charges etc., if any, should be taken into account.
G.O.No.3888 (4) From the Day Book of Raw Materials every item shall be posted daily into the
P.J., dated the Ledger of Raw Materials and stock No. 43, and a reference shall be made to the page of
22nd August the ledger into which the entries are posted up.
1935.
1372. Stock Ledger of Raw Materials, Dead and Live Stock, belonging to the Manufacture Department
(Register No. 43)-
(1) This book referred to for convenience as the Stock Ledger is an elaborated edition of the Day Book of
Raw Materials. The difference between No. 41 and No.43 is simply that the entries in No.41 shall follow
the order of time, while in No. 43 they shall be arranged under the respective heads of the different kinds of
stock, a few pages being devoted to each article; petty items or charges which do not appertain to stock
kept in hand and which are not part of the general expenses for the administration of the Jail may be
entered in one account under the head of Miscellaneous. Cost of service postage stamps, electric charges,
freight for finished article sold or transferred and other contingent charges which are directly or indirectly
connected with the general administration of the Jail need not be included therein.
239
(2) At the end of each month total shall be made in the ledgers, and the balance of stock in hand, with its
value, shall be shown. A new page shall generally be opened for a new month to which the balance in stock
must be carried forward. Rule 1378 (4) regarding the deputation of a subordinate to receive and verify
stock applies also to the Manufacturing Department. (See Rules 151, 264 and 801 regarding the
responsibility of the Deputy Superintendent or Jailer for all manufactory stock).
1373. Dead stock Register (No. 40)- All plant, machinery and other articles of dead-stock appertaining to
the General and the Manufactory Department of the Jail irrespective of their value shall be recorded in this
register. Items shall be classified according to the sub-heads under item 24 of the schedule appended to
Rule 1339 and to the special manufacture to which they belong. After the balance in hand at the beginning
of each quarter has been struck, entries need not necessarily be made until the close of the quarter, when
details furnished by the Stock Book (No. 33) and the Day Book (No.41) shall be duly recorded.
Articles entered in this book need not be also entered in the stock ledger (No.43).
Machinery and other plant should ordinarily last for 20 years and 10 years, respectively. Deduction on
account of depreciation shall be made at the close of each half-year from the value of articles in hand at the
beginning of the year. Deduction of 5 per cent from the value of all machinery and 7 percent from that of
other plant and articles of dead-stock shall be made. The deductions on account of depreciation should be
shown in red ink in the column provided for it under 2 nd and 4th quarters in the Dead-stock Register
(Bangladesh Jail Register No. 40-Bangladesh form No. 5017).
1374. Store and sale Book of Manufactured Articles (Register No. 42)-
(1) This book, referred to for convenience as Sale Book, is a rough account book or diary which bears the
same relation to the manufactured articles that Register No.41 does to raw materials. In it every article
produced in, or sold by, the Manufactory Department are entered at the same time serially and without
classification, as they enter or leave the manufactory godowns.
G.O.No.3902- (2) On the Receipt side full details of each articles as required by the column headings
H. J. dated. shall be entered on the same day. On the Disbursement side shall be recorded every sale
28.9.37 as it takes place or despatch of goods to other jails and departments. Likewise any
manufactured stock lost, used in the process of other manufactures, or otherwise disposed
of. Sales, whether for cash or credit, shall be included in both these books, and it shall be
specified for which of the two an article was sold. Cash receipts shall of course
correspond with entries in the Cash-book, receipt side, the purchasers name need not be
entered in case of cash sales of articles of the value of less than taka one hundred, and
several articles of the same kind and value thus sold may be lumped together; but if the
article is sold for credit, the Purchasers name shall be entered.
(3) Both the market value and actual cost price of goods supplied from the Manufactory Department for
use in the jail, or to the other jails, shall be entered in the Sale Book. If an article be sold for less or more
than the value put upon it in the stock account, it will be necessary either to add or deduct the difference, as
the case may be, to or from the amount for which sold before deducting the latter from the value of the
whole stock, in order to show the correct value of the quantity remaining in store. Columns for recording
such differences are provided in the Day Book and Ledger. If articles are destroyed or lost, a note shall be
made of the circumstances and the value of the articles.
(4) From the Sale Book every item shall be posted daily into the Ledger of Manufactured Articles (No.
44), a reference shall be made to the page of the ledger into which the entries are posted up, Credit sale
shall be further posted up in the Credit Ledger, No. 45.
1375. Ledger of Manufactured Articles (Register No. 44)
This book is an elaboration of the Sale Book and bears the same relation to manufactured articles that
Register No. 43 does to raw materials. The same instructions (Rule1374) apply.
240
1377. The following Registers are prescribed for use in the General Department :-
No. 31-Cash-book see Rules 1350,1351.
No. 32-Contingent Register see Rule 1342..
No. 33-Stock Book Deleted. see Rule 1378.
No. 40-Dead stock see Rule 1373.
No. 34-Stock Book of Clothing see Rule 1178.
No. 35-Dairy Accounts see Rule 1146.
No. 36A-Diet Roll (ordinary prisoners) see Rule 1105.
No. 36B-Diet Roll (Divisions I and II Prisoners) see Rule 1105.
Combined pay Bill and Acquittance Roll see Rule 1355(2).
No. 39-Register of Ammunition see Rule 374.
Treasury Pass Book see Rule 1046.
1378. Stock Book of Provisions, Stores, and Dead Stock (other than those belonging to the
Manufacturing Department)- (Register No. 33)-
(1) This book, referred for convenience as the Stock Book, corresponds, in the General Department, to
Registers 43 and 44 in the Manufactory Department. The General Department has no equivalent to the
Day Book of Raw Materials and the Store and Sale Book. A separate account shall be opened for every
kind of stock not appertaining to the Manufactory Department, except clothing and dairy stock and
produce and ammunition, for which there are separate registers: not only shall purchased stores be
entered, but also all produce from jail lands, fish tanks, etc., and all bye products of any value resulting
from the preparation of any article for jail use, such as broken rice (khudi), bran, dal husk, oil-cake, etc.
a sufficient number of pages should be set apart for each article to contain the accounts for one year.
G.O.No.2302 (2) On the Receipt side shall be entered full details of each article including Dead
P.J. dated the Stock purchased or brought into store. Entries of articles worth Tk. 100 or more shall be
24th July 929. invariably checked and attested by the Senior Superintendent/ Superintendent. The
Senior Superintendent/Superintendent before signing an abstract bill, shall satisfy
himself that every item of stock or stores charged for in the bill is entered in this
register; and the officer who prepares the abstract bill shall note opposite each item in
the Stock Book the number and date of the abstract bill in which the item is included.
All articles taken from the Manufactory Department or received from other jails for use
in the service of the jail shall be entered in the stock book No. 33 in red ink. (See Rule
1375). All articles of dead-stock shall also be recorded in the Dead-stock Register (No.
40) in the manner prescribed in rule 1373.
G.O.No. 312 (3) It will be seen that a money column is given only on the purchase side of the account;
P.J. dated the the valuation of the stock disposed of each day is difficult, if not impossible, as a single
February1924 disbursement may include goods purchased at different rates at different times; a general
valuation, when the balance is struck each month, will suffice for all practical purposes. The
disposal of any article of Dead Stock by fair wear and tear, breakage, or loss shall be
recorded on the disbursement side with the necessary explanation, and at the same time the
entry of the article on the purchase side shall be scored through in red ink, so that when a
new register is opened once a year, the unerased entries can readily be copied into the new
book. Likewise any loss or damage of stores shall be entered on the disbursements side in
red ink and shall be reported to the Inspector General with a statement of who is responsible
for the loss, or how the article became damaged.
(4) The receipt and disposal of stock should be recorded daily as soon as possible after each transaction takes
place; but if this account be balanced once a month, it will be often enough as the abstract stock account is to
be drawn up only once in three months. This monthly balancing of the stock account shall, however, be
insisted on, otherwise the work may be allowed to fall into hopeless arrear. The Jailer may depute a
subordinate to receive and weigh, measure or count provisions etc. received into store, and the Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent shall direct by whom the account is to be kept, but the Jailer shall closely
supervise and check the work of his subordinates, as he is responsible for the quantities actually received and
issued to the cooks or otherwise disbursed. (see Rule256).
241
1379. The following returns are prescribed in the Manufactory Department for submission to the Inspector
General-
(1) Monthly-
(a) Return No. 20-Detailed Bill for Manufactory Contingent Charges. see Rule 1357.
(b) Return No. 22-Return of Jail Supplies. see Rule
1364(1).
(c) Return No. 4-Completion of Accounts. see Rule 1331.
(d) Return of Manufactory Accounts Transactions (No. 23A). see Rule1380.
(2) Quarterly return of outstanding dues for sales on credit of manufactured see Rule 1380.
articles (No. 23B).
(3) Half-yearly Return No. 5-Certificate of Correctness of Stock. see Rules 87
and 1331.
1380. Return No. 23 presents an account of the transactions of the Manufactory Department. It consists of
two parts:-
Part A (Bangladesh Form no. 5045) deals with the account of the raw materials and manufactured articles
in the Jail during the preceding month. The entries are to be abstracted from the ledger of raw materials
and the ledger of manufactured articles and arranged according to the manufacture to which they relate.
For every entry in column 6 in respect of articles which have been lost or rendered unserviceable an
explanation should be furnished in the column for remarks. All such entries should be shown in red ink
after obtaining previous sanction of Inspector General to their write off.
Part B (Bangladesh Form No. 5153) is a statement of outstanding dues for sales on Credit for the
preceding quarter. The names of creditors who are jail officers or whose accounts have been out standing
for more than six months should be entered in red ink.
1381. The following returns are prescribed in the General Department for submission to the Inspector
General :-
(1) Monthly-
(a) Return No. 10-General Contingent Bill, see Rule 1357.
(b) Return No. 4- Completion of Accounts, see Rule 1331.
(c) Return No. 17-Acount of the Dietary and other Reserve stock, see Rule 1382.
(d) Return No. 17A- Dairy and Cattle Account, see Rule 1382.
(2) Half yearly-
(a) Deleted.
(b) Return No. 6-Certificate of Correctness of stock, see Rule 87 and 1331.
1382. Return No. 17 is divided in two parts, 17 and 17 A. Return 17 (Bangladesh Form No. 5040) deals
with the account of the dietary and other reserve stock in the jail during the preceding month. Return No.
17A (Bangladesh Form No. 5150) deals with the Dairy and cattle account of the Jail for the preceding
month. Return No. 17 is an exact copy of the monthly balancing of the stores and stocks in the stock
Book (Register No.33).Return No.17A is to be abstracted from Register No.35, parts I and II.
Dead stock can only be lost, or be rendered unserviceable and therefore be sold or destroyed; when it is
so entries of this nature should invariably appear in Return No.17 with an explanatory remark made
against each such item.
Previous sanction of the Inspector General of Prisons to the write off of the residual book value of each
article of dead stock should be obtained before inclusion of unserviceable dead stock articles in Return
No. 17.
Section IV.-Registers and Books.
[Note.- The capital letter preceding each register denotes the class for preservation. (See Rule1315)]
1383. All registers and books shall be paged serially by the Forms Department. The Senior
Superintendent/Superintendent shall certify, on the first page, to the number of pages in each book.
1384.A Responsibility List shall be pasted inside the cover of each jail Register by the Forms Department.
242
1385. The following Registers and Books are prescribed :-
A. -Bangladesh Jail Registers.
Reference to
Jail Code Rule.
B. Form No. 4980. A. No.1. Minute Book 61, 73, 92
Report 109, 156, 247
B. Form No. 4981. A. No. 4. Warders Service Register 303
B. Form No.4982. D. No. 5. Labour Distribution Register 805
B. Form No. 4983. A. No. 6. Register of Convicted Prisoners Admitted. 542(1)
B. Form No. 4984. A. No. 7. Alphabetical Register 542(2)
B. Form No. 4985. B. No. 8. Register of Under trial Prisoners 933
B. Form No. 4986. A. No. 9. Register of Civil Prisoners. 908
B. Form No.4987-89. A. No. 10. Release Diary.. 542(3)
B. Form No. 4991. D. No. 12. Lock-up Register 449
B. Form No. 4993. D. No. 14. Daily Abstract of all Classes of Prisoners. 542(5)
B. Form No. 4996. D. No. 18. Remission Cards.. 780
B. Form No. 4997. B. No. 19. Register of Punishments Inflict 734(1)
B. Form No. 4998. D. No. 20. Diary of Termination of Jail Punishment 734(2)
B. Form No. 4999. D. No. 24. Gate Register of Persons 328
B. Form No. 5000. C. No. 25. Gate Register of Articles. 328
B. Form No. 5000. A. No. 26. Post mortem Register. 99,1243
B. Form No. 5001-03. B. No. 27. Hospital Register. 99,1243
B. Form No. 5004. B. No. 28. Hospital Roll of Sick, Diet, etc. 99,1243
D. No. 29. Register of Convalescent and Special group. 99,1243
B. Form No. 5005.
D. No. 30. Register of weekly weighment of Prisoners Losing weight. 103,1196
B. Form No. 5006. A. No. 31. Cash-book 1350,1352
B. Form No. 5007. A. No. 32 Contingent Register 1342
B. Form No. 5008. B. No. 33 Stock book of Provisions etc. 1378
B. Form No. 5009. C. No. 34 Clothing Account Book 1178
B. Form No. 5010 & B. No. 35 Diary Account, Parts 1 to IV 1146
406.
B. Form No. 5012. B. No. 36A Diet Roll of ordinary Prisoners 1105
B. Form No. 5013. B. No. 36B Diet Roll of Division I and II Prisoners 1105
B. Form No. 5015. A. No 38 Deleted.
B. Form No. 5015A. C. No. 38A Deleted.
B. Form No. 5016. D. No.39 Register of Ammunition 374
B. Form No. 5017. A. No.40 Dead stock 1373
B. Form No. 5018. B. No. 41 Day Book of Raw Materials 1371
B. Form No. 5019. B. No 42 Store and sale Book of Manufactured Articles 1374
B. Form No. 5020. B. No.43. Stock Ledger of Raw Materials, etc 1372
B. Form No. 5021. B. No. 44 Ledger of Manufactured Articles 1375
B. Form No. 5022. B. No. 45 Credit Ledger 1376
B. Form No. 5023. D. No. 46 Gate Register 59, 173
B. Form No. 5148. C. No. 47 Register of Clothing Account of warder guard 362
B. Form No. 5156. FA 48-Register of Prisoners valuable property-543.
B. Form No. 5157. A 48A-Register of Prisoners private property-543.
B. Other Books.
A.B.F.No.2510. Treasury Pass Book 1353
B.B.F.No.912. Service Book .. 213
C.B,F.No.107. Register of casual leave .. 221
B.B,F.No.46. Other Book . 309
A.B.F.No.2435. Combined Pay Bill and . 1355
Acquittance Roll
These registers are to be kept in manuscript.
Board of Revenue.
B.B.F.No.16. Register of Letters Received 1324.
243
B.B.F.No.19. Register of Letters issued 1324.
D.B.F.No.47. Peon Book 1324.
Section V. Returns.
Note-The capital letter preceding each form denotes the class for preservation See Rule 1315.
C No. 1-Quarterly Return of prison statistics is in itself a complete record of judicial statistics of all
classes of prisoners.
It consists of twelve parts:-
B. Form Part IA- Showing the number and disposal of the convicts in the jail during the quarter is
No. 5029 compiled from Register No.14 The Daily Abstract; the column headings and memoranda
for guidance sufficiently explain this part. On the return to jail of any convicts released on
bail or of prisoners who escaped and are recaptured, they shall be again entered as
admitted in column 3 of part IA. When the return to jail or recapture is effected in the
same year as the release on bail or escape takes place, details of such prisoners shall not
be entered twice in parts II, III, XI and XII of the return, i. e, they shall not be included in
these parts on the return of the prisoners to jail from being at large on bail in one year and
re-admitted into the jail during the following year, as well as prisoners who escaped in
one year and were recaptured during the following year, shall be included in those parts.
These instructions also apply to cases of convicts sent to a Mental Hospital and returned
after recovery to serve the remainder of their sentences.
Part IB-shows (a) the quarterly total of the numbers of each class of prisoners locked up each night,
compiled from Register No. 14;
(b) capacity of the wards for each class calculated on the standards prescribed by Rule 1179 ;
(c) the maximum number of each class present at lock-up on any one day (obtained from Register No.
14); and
244
In column 2 of Part X, provision is made for furnishing the statistics of mortality according to length of
time served in jail for the annual statements required by the Government of Bangladesh. As the time
served varies from day to day and a daily average could not be prepared without extensive and intricate
registers and heavy clerical work, the Government of Bangladesh has therefore directed that an average
shall be made of 12 monthly censuses to be taken on the last day of each month. This census may be
taken from the prisoners history tickets, or from the files of warrants. If taken from history tickets,
proper care must be taken that error does not arise from entries being obliterated and incorrectly
renewed or if the warrants are used, they must be handled so as to cause excessive wear.
245
B.- Bangladesh Jail Annual Returns.
No. 1. Part 1. General Summary
B. Form Part 2. Statement No. I, Judicial (Number and Disposal of Convicts)
No5052. Part 3. Statement No. II, Judicial (Religion, age, etc., of Convicts)
Part 4. Statement No. III, Judicial (Nature and Length of Sentence) 83
No. 2. Part 1. Statement No. IV, Judicial (Previous Convictions)..
Part 2. Identification of Habituals.
B. Form No5053. Part 3. Statement No. V, Judicial (Escapes and Recaptures)
Part 4. Statement No. VI, Judicial (Offences and Punishments)
Part 5. Offences and Punishments of A and B Class Prisoners 83
B. Form No5054. No. 3. Particulars of Corporal Punishments
B. Form no5055. No. 4. Statement No. IX, Financial expenditure 83
B. Form No 5056. No.5 Statement No. XI, Financial (Employment of convicts) 83
B. Form No 5057. No.6 Statement No. XIIA, Financial (Result of Employment) 83
B. Form No No.7 Part 1. Rewards to Assistant Surgeons.. 1244
5058. Part 2. Statement No XIV, Vital (Sickness and Mortality)
No. 8. Part 1. Statement No .XV Vital (Admissions and Deaths from Chief
B. Form No Diseases) 1244
5059. Part 2. Statement No. VII, Vital (Mortality amongst Convicts)
Part 3. Statement No XVIII, Vital (Prisoners under trial)
B. Form No5060. No. 9. Annual Return of Sick Prisoners. 1244
B. Form No5062. No.11. Part 1. Statement A (Accommodation)
Part 2. Statement B (Condition of Discharged Convicts).
Part 3. Statement C (Working of Remission System) 83
B. Form No5063. No. 12. Offences and Punishments of Warder Guard 83
No. 13+ Visits. ....... ........ 83
246
Day of Month Number of Description of Return Destination
month Return, etc.
1 2 3 4 5
247
Section VI- Forms.
(Note- The capital letter preceding each form denotes the class for preservationVide Rule 1315)
1388. The following Forms are prescribed :-
Reference to
Jail Code Rule.
D.B.F.Nos.70 & 71 Annual Indent for Forms 1359
A.No. 3+ Deleted. 827
A.No. 4 Deleted. 827
A.No. 5 Deleted. 832
A.No. 6+ Statement of Remissions 828
C.No. 8+ Descriptive Roll of Prisoner 510,844
C.No. 9 Roll of a Prisoner Recommended for Appointment as Convict 405
Overseer, or Night Guard
D.No. 10@ Letter Requesting Sanction to Transfer of Prisoners 1185
D.No. 11@ Memorandum Intimating Despatch of Rolls for Sanction of Transfer ---
D.No. 12@ Memorandum Intimating Transfer of Prisoners 867
D.No. 13 Certificate of Fitness of Prisoners for Transfer and Covering Letter 862
C.No. 16+ Memorandum acknowledging Receipt of Prisoners. ---
D.No. 17@ Application for Received Railway Accommodation 875
C.No. 18 Requistion for Transport by Railway (Credit Note) 872,1369
D.No. 19 Statement of Credit Notes Issued during the month. 1369
C.No. 20 Civil Prisoners History Ticket 549
D.No. 21 Undertrail Prisoners Ticket 549, 930
D.No. 22 A.B.C+ Convicts History Ticket .. 549
and
D.No. 23+ Previous Conviction From 625, 914
D.No. 24 Lock up Report 434, 448, 459
A.No. 25 Report of the Escape of a Prisoner 478
D.No. 26 Report of the Re-capture of a Prisoner 478
D.No. 27 Petition by Prisoners for Copy of Judgment 603
D.No. 27A Prisoners Petition 615
D.No. 29@ Enquiry Regarding Result of Appeal 609
No. 31 Certificate of Release of a prisoner 576
No. 32, 32A, Rules Under section 565, Criminal Procedure Code, in English, 568
B&C Bengali
No. 33&33A Declaration required by section 565, Criminal Procedure Code, in 568
English and Bengali
C.No. 34 Roll of Prisoners entitled to Remission 781
D.No. 35 Roster of day and night duties of Warders and convict officers 434
A.No. 36&36A Abstract of Remission Rules in English and Bengali 775
D.No. 37 Group Book 445
D.No. 38 Group Book (Convict Overseers) 422
A.No. 40 Abstract of Rules relating to Jail punishments ---
No. 41 Prisoners Letter Form 687
No. 42 @ Parade Statement ---
C. No. 58 @ Estimate for general use ---
C.No. 59 @ Estimate of Cost of Public Works 1309
D.No. 61 & 61 A Indent for Jail Clothing 1174, 1359
D.No. 62 Indent for Warders Uniform 360, 1174, 1359
C.No. 63 General Equipment Requisition (Arms, etc.) 375,1359
D.No. 64 Store order Form 1344
D.No. 65 Store delivery Voucher 1344
248
D.No. 66 Gate- keepers Pass 1344
C.No. 67 Cash Bill 1344
C.No. 68 Credit Bill 1344
C.No. 69 & 69A Bill for Articles supplied to the Public 1344
C.No. 70 Invoice for Articles Supplied to Jails 1362
C. B.F. No. 51 Ditto to other Departments 1362,1364
D.No. 73 Form of Contract 1344
D.No. 74 From of Tender and Contract 1344
D.B.F.No. 54 Voucher for Cash Payment 1349
C.No. 77+ Application for Remittance Transfer Receipt 1348
D.No. 78 Receipt for Civil Prisoners Subsistence Allowance 891
B.B.F.No. 39 Receipt for money ---
D.No. 80 Treasury Remittance Voucher 1335
No. 81 Advice of Despatch of goods ---
No. 82 Caution Slip ---
D.No. 83 @ Letter Reporting change of Superintendents 88
No. 84 Copy of Remarks made in the Visitors Book 61
No. 85 Statistics showing the Working of the Jail ---
B.No. 87+ Inventory of Articles in Charge of the Jailor 265
D.No. 88 No Demand Certificate 265
A.No. 89 Declaration Form 166
No. 90 Deleted 226,237
No. 91+ Deleted 232
B.F.No. 40 Leave Application 222
D.No. 94 Descriptive Roll of Warder Recruit 300
A.No. 95 Verification Roll of a Warder Recruit 300
No. 96 Service Record 215
D.No. 97@ Memorandum forwarding Service Book 213
No. 98&98A2B Copy of Jail Order 309
D.No. 99 Roster of Duties of Warders 434
A.No. 100 Duties of Gate-keeper and Night Sentries in Bengali. 326
C.No. 101 Hospital Ticket 1234
C.No. 102 Temperature Chart 1234
C.No. 103 Weight Chart 1217
D.No. 104 Morning State of Sick ---
D.No. 105 Recommendation for the Release of a Prisoner Under J. C Rules ---
591, 592 and 594
D.No. 106 Report of the Release of a Prisoner Under Rule 591 and 592 501
811
D.Factory Form No.7 Report of Factory Accident
No. 108 Report of the Occurrence of Grave Infectious Disease 1249
No. 112 Poisons and Antidotes 104
No. 113 Schedule of Poisons 104
No. 114 Extract from Act IX, 1894 659
No. 115 Reprint of Chapter IV, Jail Code (Visitors) 69
No. 116A Reprint of Rules 704 and 705 of the Jail Code B & C ---
A.No. 117 Form of Declaration 234(b)
C.No. 118 Form of Undertaking by sick Prisoner 597 597
B.No. 119+ Certificate of lunatics health and fitness for removal to Mental Hospital 1030
D.No. --- Application for Extra Establishment 18
D.No. 120 Statement of Private Property and cash of Prisoners 543
A.No. 121 Form of confidential report on character of Executive Officers 217
A.No. 122 Form of confidential report on Character of clerks, Technical Officers etc 217
C.No. 123 Descriptive Roll of Detune 598
D.No. 124 Form of Certificate to Prisoners 786
249
B.-Forms of other Offices in use in the Jail Department.
Accountant-General, Bangladeshs Forms.
B. F. No. 2397 Application for Pension or Gratuity. --
A. B. F. No. 2510 Treasury Pass Book 1353
A. B. F. No. 2381 Chalan 1335
B. F. No 2395 Application for Leave ---
B .F. No 912 Service Book 213
C. B. F. No 2428 Salary Bill (C.A. C Form No.1) ---
D. B. F. No 2435 Detailed Pay Bill of Payment Establishment (C.A.C. Form 1355
Nos 6, 7 and 8)
C. B. F. No 2445 Travelling allowance bill for Gazetted Officers (C.A.C. Form 1356
No. 2 )
C. B. F. No 2446 Travelling allowance Bill of the Establishment of 1356
(C.A.C.Form No.9)
C. B. F. No 2442 Increment Certificate.. 219
C. B. F. No 2502 -Assistant Surgeons Pay Bill . ---
C B F No 2508 Last Pay Certificate for non-gazetted Officers ---
D. B. F. No. 2440 1st April Statement . 1355(4)
Bangladesh Civil Medical Department Forms.
C. No M.S.D 135 Indent on the Medical Store Depot for Medical and 104
Surgical Equipment (I.M.D. Form No. 31)
C. No M.S.D 135 Emergent Indent on the Medical Store Depot for ---
Medicines (I.M.D. Form No. 32) ..
No B.F. 783 Confidential Report on Assistant Surgeons . ---
D. No. B.F. 795 Stock Ledger or Medicines . ---
A. No. 47 Rules Regarding the Custody and Dispensing of Appdx N
Poisonous Drugs. 14
A. No. 49 Rules for Collecting and Packing Samples of Water for
Analysis 15
Government of Bangladesh Executive Forms.
B. No B.F. 215 Certificate of insanity .. 1030
B. No B.F. 216 Descriptive roll of lunatic in Form C 1030
C. No. B.F. 107 Register of Casual Leave . 221
C. No. B.F. 360 Requisition for transport by railways (Credit note for 1369
warder staff and similar staff.)
High Court Criminal Forms.
No. B.F. 3877, B and C. Petition of Appeal in English and Bengali 604
3878,3879.
No. B.F.3888 Letter from Superintendent of Jail forwarding petition of 604
Appeal to Supreme Court.
No. B.F.3889 Memo. From Superintendent of Jail to sessions Judge 605
reporting that an Appeal has been made to the Supreme Court
Bangladesh Police Forms.
D. No. B.F. 5344. Escort Requisition . 867
C. No B.F. 5322. Form of drawing up proceedings 204
Bangladesh Forms Department Forms.
D. Nos. B.F. 70, 71 and 71A. Annual Indents for Forms and Envelopes 1359
250